Sie sind auf Seite 1von 310

Instrument Procedures

Handbook

2014

U.S. Department of Transportation


FEDERAL AVIATION ADMINISTRATION
Flight Standards Service
ii
Preface
This handbook supersedes FAA-H-8261-1A, Instrument Procedures Handbook, dated 2007. It is designed as a technical
reference for all pilots who operate under instrument flight rules (IFR) in the National Airspace System (NAS). It expands
and updates information contained in the FAA-H-8083-15B, Instrument Flying Handbook, and introduces advanced
information for IFR operations. Instrument flight instructors, instrument pilots, and instrument students will also find this
handbook a valuable resource since it is used as a reference for the Airline Transport Pilot and Instrument Knowledge Tests
and for the Practical Test Standards. It also provides detailed coverage of instrument charts and procedures including IFR
takeoff, departure, en route, arrival, approach, and landing. Safety information covering relevant subjects such as runway
incursion, land and hold short operations, controlled flight into terrain, and human factors issues also are included.

This handbook conforms to pilot training and certification concepts established by the FAA. The discussion and
explanations reflect the most commonly used instrument procedures. Occasionally, the word must or similar language
is used where the desired action is deemed critical. The use of such language is not intended to add to, interpret, or
relieve pilots of their responsibility imposed by Title 14 of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR).

It is essential for persons using this handbook to also become familiar with and apply the pertinent parts of 14 CFR and
the Aeronautical Information Manual (AIM). The CFR, AIM, this handbook, AC 00-2.15, Advisory Circular Checklist, which
transmits the current status of FAA advisory circulars, and other FAA technical references are available via the internet at
the FAA Home Page http://www.faa.gov. Information regarding the purchase of FAA subscription aeronautical navigation
products, such as charts, Airport/Facility Directory, and other publications can be accessed at http://faacharts.faa.gov.

This handbook is available for download, in PDF format, from the FAAs Regulations and Policies website at:

http://www.faa.gov/regulations_policies/handbooks_manuals/aviation/instrument_procedures_handbook/

This handbook is published by the United States Department of Transportation, Federal Aviation Administration, Flight
Technologies and Procedures Division, Flight Procedures Standards Branch, AFS-420, 6500 S. MacArthur Blvd, Ste 104,
Oklahoma City, OK 73169.

Comments regarding this publication should be sent, in email form, to the following address: 9-AMC-AFS420-IPH@faa.gov

John S. Duncan
Director, Flight Standards Service

iii
Acknowledgments

The following individuals and their organizations are gratefully acknowledged for their valuable contribution and
commitment to the publication of this handbook:

FAA: Project Managers: Lt Col James Rose and Maj Brian Strack (USAF); Assistant Project Manager: Gilbert Baker;
Editor: Tara Savage; Technical Illustrator: Melissa Spears; Subject Matter Experts: Dean Alexander, John Bickerstaff,
Barry Billmann, John Blair, John Bordy, Larry Buehler, Dan Burdette, Kel Christianson, Jack Corman, Rick Dunham,
Dave Eckles, Gary Harkness, Hooper Harris, Harry Hodges, John Holman, Bob Hlubin, Gerry Holtorf, Steve Jackson,
Scott Jerdan, Alan Jones, Norm Le Fevre, Barry Miller, John Moore, T.J. Nichols, Jim Nixon, Dave Olsen, Don Pate, Gary
Powell, Phil Prasse, Larry Ramirez, Mark Reisweber, Dave Reuter, Jim Seabright, Eric Secretan, Ralph Sexton, Tom
Schneider, Lou Volchansky, Dan Wacker, Mike Webb, and Mike Werner.

The Instrument Procedures Handbook was produced by the Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) with the assistance
of Safety Research Corporation of America (SRCA).

The FAA also wishes to acknowledge the following contributors:

Aircraft Owners and Pilots Association (www.aopa.org) for image used in chapter 5.

Volpe National Transportation Systems Center (www.volpe.dot.gov) for image used in chapter 5.

Gary and Cecil Tweets at ASAP, Inc. (www.asapinc.net) for image used in chapter 1.

The staff of the U.S. Air Force Advanced Instrument School (HQ AFFSA/AIS) for various inputs.

iv
Notice

The United States Government does not endorse products or manufacturers. Trade or manufacturers names appear
herein solely because they are considered essential to the objective of this handbook.

v
vi
Table of Contents
Preface............................................................................................... iii Alternate Minimums for Commercial
Operators............................................................................1-14
Acknowledgments........................................................................ iv Departure Procedures............................................................1-14
Design Criteria.......................................................................1-14
Table of Contents.........................................................................vii Low, Close-In Obstacles.................................................1-17
One-Engine-Inoperative (OEI) Takeoff
Chapter 1
Obstacle Clearance Requirements ...........................1-19
Departure Procedures.............................................................. 1-1
Categories of Departure Procedures.................................1-22
Introduction ................................................................................ 1-1
Obstacle Departure Procedures (ODPs).......................1-22
Surface Movement Safety....................................................... 1-2
ODP Flight Planning Considerations........................1-23
Airport Sketches and Diagrams........................................ 1-2
Airport Facility Directory (A/FD)....................................... 1-2 Standard Instrument Departures (SIDs)..................1-23
Surface Movement Guidance Control System Transition Routes.............................................................1-26
(SMGCS)..................................................................................... 1-3 SID Flight Planning Considerations..........................1-26
Advanced Surface Movement Guidance Control Area Navigation (RNAV) Departures.........................1-30
System (A-SMGCS)................................................................. 1-4 SID Altitudes .....................................................................1-36
Airport Signs, Lighting, and Markings....................... 1-4 Pilot Responsibility for Use of RNAV
Runway Incursions................................................................. 1-5 Departures.........................................................................1-36
Runway Hotspots................................................................... 1-6 Radar Departures.................................................................1-37
Standardized Taxi Routes.................................................... 1-6 Diverse Vector Area.............................................................1-38
Taxi and Movement Operations Change.................. 1-6 Visual Climb Over Airport (VCOA)..................................1-38
Weather and the Departure Environment........................ 1-8 Noise Abatement Procedures..........................................1-42
Takeoff Minimums................................................................. 1-8 Procedural Notes......................................................................1-42
Takeoff Minimums for Commercial Operators............ 1-8 DP Responsibilities..............................................................1-42
Operations Specifications (OpSpecs).............................. 1-8 Departures From Tower-Controlled Airports.............1-43
Ceiling and Visibility Requirements...............................1-10 Departures From Airports Without an Operating
Visibility ..............................................................................1-10 Control Tower........................................................................1-43
Prevailing Visibility..........................................................1-10 Ground Communication Outlet.....................................1-43
Runway Visibility Value (RVV)......................................1-10 See and Avoid Techniques................................................1-43
Tower Visibility..................................................................1-10 VFR Departures.....................................................................1-44
Runway Visual Range (RVR)..........................................1-10
Chapter 2
Adequate Visual Reference..........................................1-11
En Route Operations................................................................. 2-1
Ceilings................................................................................1-11 Introduction................................................................................. 2-1
Automated Weather Systems..........................................1-11 En Route Navigation................................................................. 2-2
Automatic Terminal Information Service Airways...................................................................................... 2-2
(ATIS).....................................................................................1-12 Air Route Traffic Control Centers...................................... 2-3
Digital Automatic Terminal Information Safe Separation Standards.................................................. 2-4
Service (D-ATIS)................................................................1-12 Sectors................................................................................... 2-5
IFR Alternate Requirements.........................................1-12 In-flight Requirements and Instructions................... 2-6
High Altitude Area Navigation Routing......................... 2-7

vii
Preferred IFR Routes.............................................................. 2-7 Minimum Crossing Altitude (MCA)................................2-40
Substitute Airway or Route Structures........................... 2-9 Minimum IFR Altitude (MIA)............................................2-40
Substitute Airway En Route Flight Procedures....... 2-9 Minimum Vectoring Altitudes (MVA)............................2-41
Tower En Route Control.....................................................2-10 IFR Cruising Altitude or Flight Level..............................2-42
Tower En Route Control Route Descriptions.........2-10 Reduced Vertical Separation Minimums
Airway and Route System.....................................................2-13 (RSVM)......................................................................................2-43
Airway/Route Depiction....................................................2-13 Cruise Clearance...................................................................2-43
IFR En Route Low Altitude Chart................................2-14 Lowest Usable Flight Level...............................................2-43
IFR En Route High Altitude Chart ..............................2-17 Operations in Other Countries........................................2-44
VHF Airways...........................................................................2-18 Altitude Above Ground (QFE).........................................2-45
Victor Airway Navigation Procedures.......................2-18 Barometric Pressure for Standard
LF/MF Airways.......................................................................2-18 Altimeter Settings (QNE)...................................................2-45
En Route Obstacle Clearance Areas..............................2-18 Barometric Pressure for Local
Primary and Secondary En Route Obstacle Altimeter Settings (QNH)..................................................2-45
En Route Reporting Procedures .........................................2-46
Clearance Areas................................................................2-19
Non-Radar Position Reports.............................................2-46
Changeover Points..............................................................2-20
Flights in a Radar Environment.......................................2-46
Direct Route Flights.............................................................2-21
Position Report Items.........................................................2-46
Published RNAV Routes.....................................................2-23
Additional Reports..........................................................2-47
Composition of Designators........................................2-23
Communication Failure..........................................................2-47
Use of Designators in Communications..................2-24
ARTCC Radio Frequency Outage....................................2-48
Random RNAV Routes........................................................2-25
Climbing and Descending En Route.................................2-48
Off-Airway Routes................................................................2-26
Aircraft Speed and Altitude..............................................2-49
Off-Route Obstruction Clearance Altitude.............2-27
En Route Holding Procedures..............................................2-51
Monitoring of Navigation Facilities...............................2-29 ATC Holding Instructions..................................................2-51
Navigational Gaps................................................................2-29 Maximum Holding Speed.................................................2-52
NAVAID Accuracy Check....................................................2-29 High Performance Holding..............................................2-52
VOR Accuracy....................................................................2-29 En Route Safety Considerations..........................................2-52
VOT.......................................................................................2-30 Fuel State Awareness..........................................................2-52
VOR Checkpoint Signs...................................................2-31 Diversion Procedures..........................................................2-52
Dual VOR Check................................................................2-31
Airborne VOR Check.......................................................2-31 Chapter 3
NDB Accuracy Check......................................................2-31 Arrivals............................................................................................ 3-1
RNAV Accuracy Check....................................................2-32 Introduction................................................................................. 3-1
Waypoints...................................................................................2-31 Navigation in the Arrival Environment............................... 3-2
User-Defined Waypoints....................................................2-32 Descent Planning................................................................... 3-3
Floating Waypoints..............................................................2-32 Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Planning.............................. 3-4
Computer Navigation Performance..................................2-33 LNAV/VNAV Equipment....................................................... 3-6
Required Navigation Performance....................................2-34 Descent Planning for High Performance Aircraft....... 3-6
RNP Levels..............................................................................2-35 Descending From the En Route Altitude....................... 3-8
Standard RNP Levels.......................................................2-35 Controlled Flight Into Terrain (CFIT)................................ 3-9
Application of Standard RNP Levels.........................2-35 Standard Terminal Arrival Routes (STARs).......................3-10
RNAV STARs or STAR Transitions.....................................3-12
IFR En Route Altitudes............................................................2-35
Interpreting the STAR.........................................................3-12
Minimum En Route Altitude (MEA)...............................2-35
STAR Procedures ..................................................................3-16
RNAV Minimum En Route Altitude................................2-35
Preparing for the Arrival........................................................3-16
Minimum Reception Altitude (MRA).............................2-35
Reviewing the Approach...................................................3-16
Maximum Authorized Altitude (MAA)..........................2-36
Altitude ...................................................................................3-16
Minimum Obstruction Clearance Altitude
Airspeed .................................................................................3-20
(MOCA)....................................................................................2-36
Holding Patterns..................................................................3-21
Minimum Turning Altitude (MTA)..................................2-38

viii
Approach Clearance............................................................3-22 Benefits Of WAAS In The Airport Environment
Present Position Direct.......................................................3-24 Advantages Of WAAS Enabled LPV
Radar Vectors to Final Approach Course ....................3-24 Approaches........................................................................4-25
Special Airport Qualification................................................3-26 Ground-Based Augmentation System (GBAS)...........4-26
Required Navigation Performance (RNP)....................4-26
Chapter 4 RNAV Approach Authorization ......................................4-30
Approaches.................................................................................. 4-1 Baro-VNAV..........................................................................4-31
Introduction................................................................................. 4-1 Hot and Cold Temperature
Approach Planning ................................................................... 4-2 Limitations ....................................................................... 4-31
Weather Considerations ......................................................... 4-2
LNAV, LNAV/VNAV and
Weather Sources ................................................................... 4-2
Circling Minimums......................................................... 4-33
Broadcast Weather ............................................................... 4-5
Airport/Runway Information................................................4-33
Automated Terminal Information Service (ATIS)........ 4-5
Instrument Approach Procedure (IAP) Briefing.............4-33
Automated Weather Observing Programs................... 4-5
Navigation and Communication Radios ....................4-33
Automated Weather Observing System.................... 4-5
Flight Management System (FMS).................................4-35
Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS)/
Autopilot Modes .................................................................4-35
Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS) ........... 4-5
Descents......................................................................................4-36
Center Weather Advisories (CWA).................................... 4-6
Stabilized Approach ...........................................................4-36
Weather Regulatory Requirements ................................ 4-6
Descent Rates and Glidepaths for Nonprecision
Weather Requirements and Part 91 Operators........... 4-6
Approaches ...........................................................................4-37
Weather Requirements and Part 135 Operators......... 4-7
Maximum Acceptable Descent Rates.......................4-37
Weather Requirements and Part 121 Operators ........ 4-7
Transition to a Visual Approach......................................4-39
Aircraft Performance Considerations.................................. 4-7
Missed Approach ................................................................4-39
Airplane Performance Operating Limitations............. 4-7
Example Approach Briefing ............................................4-46
Aircraft Approach Categories............................................ 4-8
Instrument Approach Procedure Segments...................4-49
Instrument Approach Charts................................................. 4-9
Feeder Routes ......................................................................4-49
Approach Chart Naming Conventions .......................... 4-9
Terminal Routes ...................................................................4-50
Straight-In Procedures ........................................................ 4-9
DME Arcs ................................................................................4-50
Circling Only Procedures ..................................................4-11
Course Reversal ...................................................................4-51
Communications .....................................................................4-11
Initial Approach Segment ................................................4-53
Approach Control ...............................................................4-13
Intermediate Approach Segment..................................4-53
Air Route Traffic Control Center (ARTCC).....................4-13
Final Approach Segment ..................................................4-54
High or Lack of Minimum Vectoring
Missed Approach Segment .............................................4-54
Altitudes (MVAs)...............................................................4-14
Approach Clearance ..........................................................4-54
Lack of Approach Control Terrain Advisories.........4-15 Vectors To Final Approach Course ................................4-54
Airports With an ATC Tower .............................................4-15 Nonradar Environment .....................................................4-56
Airports Without A Control Tower .................................4-15 Types of Approaches...............................................................4-56
Primary NAVAID........................................................................4-17 Visual and Contact Approaches .....................................4-56
Equipment Requirements.....................................................4-17 Visual Approaches...............................................................4-57
Courses.........................................................................................4-17 Contact Approaches...........................................................4-59
Traditional Courses .............................................................4-17 Charted Visual Flight Procedures ..................................4-59
Area Navigation Courses ..................................................4-18 RNAV Approaches ...............................................................4-59
Altitudes .....................................................................................4-19 Terminal Arrival Areas ........................................................4-62
Minimum Safe Altitude .....................................................4-19 RNAV Approach Types........................................................4-62
Final Approach Fix Altitude .............................................4-19 GPS Overlay of Nonprecision Approach......................4-62
Minimum Descent Altitude (MDA), Decision GPS Stand-Alone/RNAV (GPS) Approach.....................4-64
Altitude (DA), And Decision Height (DH).....................4-20 RNAV (GPS) Approach Using WAAS...............................4-68
Enhanced Flight Vision Systems (EFVS) and ILS Approaches ....................................................................4-68
Instrument Approaches.........................................................4-21 ILS Approach Categories...................................................4-71
Vertical Navigation..................................................................4-23 CAT II and III Approaches ..................................................4-71
Wide Area Augmentation System .................................4-23

ix
ILS Approaches To Parallel Runways ............................4-71 Operational Limitations of Airborne Navigation
Parallel (Dependent) ILS Approaches...........................4-71 Databases....................................................................................6-14
Simultaneous Parallel ILS Approaches.........................4-71 Closed Indefinitely Airports.............................................6-15
Simultaneous Close Parallel ILS Precision Storage Limitations.............................................................6-15
Runway Monitor Approaches..........................................4-77 Charting/Database Inconsistencies..............................6-15
Simultaneous Offset Instrument Approaches Naming Conventions.....................................................6-15
(SOIAs)......................................................................................4-79 Issues Related To Magnetic Variation.......................6-16
Converging ILS Approaches.............................................4-80 Issues Related To Revision Cycle................................6-17
VOR Approach ......................................................................4-80
NDB Approach .....................................................................4-84 Chapter 7
Radar Approaches ..............................................................4-84 Helicopter Instrument Procedures....................................... 7-1
Precision Approach Radar (PAR).....................................4-87 Introduction................................................................................. 7-1
Airport Surveillance Radar (ASR) ...................................4-87 Helicopter Instrument Flight Rule (IFR)
Localizer Approaches ........................................................4-87 Certification ................................................................................. 7-2
Localizer and Localizer DME ............................................4-87 Flight and Navigation Equipment.................................... 7-2
Localizer Back Course ........................................................4-87 Miscellaneous Requirements ........................................... 7-2
Localizer-Type Directional Aid (LDA).............................4-88 Stabilization and Automatic Flight Control
Simplified Directional Facility (SDF)..............................4-88 System (AFCS) ........................................................................ 7-2
Helicopter Flight Manual Limitations ............................ 7-3
Chapter 5 Operations Specifications .................................................. 7-5
Improvement Plans................................................................... 5-1 Minimum Equipment List (MEL)....................................... 7-5
Introduction................................................................................. 5-1 Pilot Proficiency ..................................................................... 7-5
Next Generation Air Transportation (NextGen) Helicopter VFR Minimums ................................................. 7-8
System............................................................................................ 5-2 Helicopter IFR Takeoff Minimums ................................... 7-8
NextGen Existing Improvements..................................... 5-3 Helicopter IFR Alternates ................................................... 7-8
Benefits of NextGen.............................................................. 5-6 Part 91 Operators .............................................................. 7-8
Head-Up Displays (HUD).......................................................... 5-7 Part 135 Operators ........................................................... 7-9
Synthetic Vision System (SVS)....................................... 5-8 Helicopter Instrument Approaches ................................ 7-9
Enhanced Flight Vision System (EFVS)....................... 5-8 Standard Instrument Approach Procedures to an
Developing Combined Technology ........................... 5-9 Airport .................................................................................. 7-9
Electronic Flight Bag (EFB)................................................. 5-9 Copter Only Approaches to An Airport or
Access to Special Use Airspace ..................................... 5-10 Heliport ...................................................................................7-10
Civilians Using Special Use Airspace........................ 5-11 Copter GPS Approaches to an Airport or
Heliport ...................................................................................7-10
Chapter 6 Helicopter Approaches to VFR Heliports ....................7-14
Airborne Navigation Databases............................................ 6-1 Approach to a PinS .............................................................7-14
Introduction ................................................................................ 6-1 Approach to a Specific VFR Heliport.............................7-14
Airborne Navigation Database Standardization............. 6-3 Inadvertent IMC....................................................................7-16
ARINC 424................................................................................. 6-4 IFR Heliports...........................................................................7-17
Fix Records........................................................................... 6-4
Simple Route Records...................................................... 6-4 Appendix A
Complex Route Records.................................................. 6-5 Emergency Procedures ...........................................................A-1
Miscellaneous Records.................................................... 6-5 Introduction ................................................................................A-1
Path and Terminator Concept................................................ 6-5 Emergencies ................................................................................A-1
Path and Terminator Legs................................................... 6-5 Inadvertent Thunderstorm Encounter...........................A-1
Path and Terminator Limitations.................................. 6-9 Inadvertent Icing Encounter..............................................A-2
Role of the Database Provider.............................................6-13 Precipitation Static ...............................................................A-2
Role of the Avionics Manufacturer................................6-13 Aircraft System Malfunction...................................................A-2
Users Role...............................................................................6-14 Generator Failure...................................................................A-3

x
Instrument Failure.................................................................A-3
Pitot/Static System Failure..................................................A-3
Loss of Situational Awareness (SA)......................................A-3
Inadvertent Instrument Meteorological Condition
(IIMC)...............................................................................................A-4
Maintaining Aircraft Control..............................................A-4
ATC Requirements During an In-Flight Emergency.......A-4
Provide Information..............................................................A-5
Radar Assistance.....................................................................A-5
Emergency Airport ...............................................................A-5
Emergency Obstruction Video Map (EOVM)................A-6
Responsibility..........................................................................A-6
Escort .........................................................................................A-6

Appendix B
Acronyms......................................................................................B-1

Glossary......................................................................................G-1

Index.............................................................................................. I-1

xi
xii
Chapter 1

Departure Procedures
Introduction
Thousands of instrument flight rules (IFR) takeoffs and
departures occur daily in the National Airspace System
(NAS). In order to accommodate this volume of IFR traffic, air
traffic control (ATC) must rely on pilots to use charted airport
sketches and diagrams, as well as departure procedures
(DPs) that include both standard instrument departures
(SIDs) and obstacle departure procedures (ODPs). While
many charted (and uncharted) departures are based on
radar vectors, the bulk of IFR departures in the NAS require
pilots to navigate out of the terminal environment to the
en route phase.

1-1
IFR takeoffs and departures are fast-paced phases of
flight, and pilots often are overloaded with critical flight Runway slope
information. While preparing for takeoff, pilots are busy

N
requesting and receiving clearances, preparing their aircraft

IO
for departure, and taxiing to the active runway. During IFR
conditions, they are doing this with minimal visibility, and
they may be without constant radio communication if flying

AT
out of a non-towered airport. Historically, takeoff minimums
for commercial operations have been successively reduced
through a combination of improved signage, runway

VIG
markings and lighting aids, and concentrated pilot
training and qualifications. Today at major terminals, some
commercial operators with appropriate equipment, pilot

NA
qualifications, and approved Operations Specifications
(OpSpecs) may takeoff with visibility as low as 300 feet
runway visual range (RVR). One of the consequences of Runway length and width
takeoffs with reduced visibility is that pilots are challenged

OR
in maintaining situational awareness during taxi operations.

Runway numbers
Surface Movement Safety

TF
One of the biggest safety concerns in aviation is the surface
movement accident. As a direct result, the Federal Aviation
Administration (FAA) has rapidly expanded the information
available to pilots, including the addition of taxiway and
runway information in FAA publications, particularly the
NO
IFR U.S. Terminal Procedures Publication (TPP) booklets and
Airport/Facility Directory (A/FD) volumes. The FAA has also
implemented new procedures and created educational and
awareness programs for pilots, ATC, and ground operators.
By focusing resources to attack this problem head on, the
FAA hopes to reduce and eventually eliminate surface
movement accidents.

Airport Sketches and Diagrams Figure 1-1. Airport diagram included on the Oshkosh, Wisconsin
Airport sketches and diagrams provide pilots of all levels VOR RWY 9 Approach Chart as depicted in the IFR TPP.
with graphical depictions of the airport layout. National additional details, such as taxiway identifiers, airport latitude
Aeronautical Products (AeroNav Products), formerly known and longitude, and building identification. The airport
as The National Aeronautical Charting Office (NACO), diagrams are also available in the A/FD and on the AeroNav
provide an airport sketch on the lower left or right portion Products website at www.aeronav.faa.gov. [Figure 1-2]
of every instrument approach chart. [Figure 1-1] This sketch
depicts the runways, their length, width and slope, the Airport Facility Directory (A/FD)
touchdown zone elevation, the lighting system installed on A/FD, published in regional booklets by AeroNav Products,
the end of the runway, and taxiways. Graphical depictions provides textual information about all airports, both visual
of NOTAMS are also available for selected airports as well as flight rules (VFR) and IFR. The A/FD includes runway length
for temporary flight restriction (TFRs) areas on the defense and width, runway surface, load bearing capacity, runway
internet NOTAM service (DINS) website. slope, runway declared distances, airport services, and
hazards, such as birds and reduced visibility. [Figure 1-3]
For select airports, typically those with heavy traffic or Sketches of airports also are being added to aid VFR pilots in
complex runway layouts, AeroNav Products also print surface movement activities. In support of the FAA Runway
an airport diagram. The diagram is located in the IFR TPP Incursion Program, full page airport diagrams and Hot
booklet following the instrument approach chart for a Spot locations are included in the A/FD. These charts are
particular airport. It is a full page depiction of the airport the same as those published in the IFR TPP and are printed
that includes the same features of the airport sketch plus for airports with complex runway or taxiway layouts.

1-2
The SMGCS low visibility taxi plan includes the improvement
On-airport buildings
Airport name and location of taxiway and runway signs, markings, and lighting,
as well as the creation of SMGCS visual aid diagrams.
[Figure 1-4] The plan also clearly identifies taxi routes
and their supporting facilities and equipment. Airport

N
enhancements that are part of the SMGCS program include,
but are not limited to:

IO
Stop bar lightsrequired at intersections of an
illuminated (centerline or edge lighted) taxiway

AT
Taxiway designations
and an active runway for operations less than
600 feet RVR. These lights consist of a row of red

IG
unidirectional, in- pavement lights installed along
the holding position marking. When extinguished by
EC-3, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

EC-3, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010


the controller, they confirm clearance for the pilot,
V
Precise runway direction
or vehicle operator, to enter the runway. Controlled
NA
stop bars operate in conjunction with green/yellow
centerline lead-on lights that extend from the stop
bar location onto the runway.
OR

Taxiway centerline lead-on lightsguide ground


traffic under low visibility conditions and at night.
These lights consist of alternating green/yellow in-
TF

Longitude and latitude


pavement lights.
Runway slope
Runway guard lightseither elevated or in-
pavement, may be installed at all taxiways that
NO

provide access to an active runway. They consist


of alternately flashing yellow lights. These lights
are used to denote both the presence of an active
runway and identify the location of a runway holding
position marking.
Figure 1-2. Airport diagram of Oshkosh, Wisconsin as depicted
Geographic position markingsATC verifies the
in the A/FD.
position of aircraft and vehicles using geographic
position markings. The markings can be used either
Surface Movement Guidance Control System as hold points or for position reporting. These
(SMGCS) checkpoints or pink spots are outlined with a black
The Surface Movement Guidance Control System (SMGCS) and white circle and designated with a number or a
was developed in 1992 to facilitate the safe movement of number and a letter.
aircraft and vehicles at airports where scheduled air carriers
Clearance bar lightsthree yellow in-pavement
were conducting authorized operations. This program was
clearance bar lights used to denote holding
designed to provide guidelines for the creation of low
positions for aircraft and vehicles. When used for
visibility taxi plans for all airports with takeoff or landing
hold points, they are co-located with geographic
operations using visibility minimums less than 1,200 feet
position markings.
RVR. For landing operations, this would be pertinent only to

those operators whose OpSpecs permit them to land with
Both flight and ground crews, Part 121 and 135 operators, are
lower than standard minimums. For departures, however,
required to comply with SMGCS plans when implemented
since there are no regulatory takeoff minimums for Title 14
at their specific airport. All airport tenants are responsible
Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) Part 91 operators,
for disseminating information to their employees and
the SMGCS information is pertinent to all departing
conducting training in low visibility operating procedures.
traffic operating in instrument meteorological conditions
Anyone operating in conjunction with the SMGCS plan
(IMC). Advisory Circular (AC) 120-57, Surface Movement
must have a copy of the low visibility taxi route chart for
Guidance and Control System, outlines the SMGCS program
their given airport as these charts outline the taxi routes
in its entirety including standards and guidelines for
and other detailed information concerning low visibility
establishment of a low visibility taxi plan.
operations. These charts are available from private sources

1-3
Figure 1-3. Excerpts from the Airport Facility Directory of Naples Muni, Naples, Florida.

outside of the FAA. Government sources for SMGCS decreases the potential of collisions on airport runways
charts may be available in the future. Part 91 operators and taxiways.
are expected to comply with the guidelines listed in AC
120-57, and should expect Follow Me service (when Additional information concerning airport lighting,
available) when low visibility operations are in use. Any markings, and signs can be found in the Aeronautical
SMGCS outage that would adversely affect operations at Information Manual (AIM), Chapter 14, Runway Incursion
the airport is issued as a Notice to Airmen (NOTAM). Avoidance in the Pilots Handbook of Aeronautical
Knowledge as well as on the FAAs website at http://www.
Advanced Surface Movement Guidance Control faa.gov/airports/runway_safety/.
System (A-SMGCS)
With the increasing demand for airports to accommodate Airport Signs, Lighting, and Markings
higher levels of aircraft movements, it is becoming more Flight crews use airport lighting, markings, and signs to
and more difficult for the existing infrastructure to safely help maintain situational awareness. These visual aids
handle greater capacities of traffic in all weather conditions. provide information concerning the aircrafts location on
As a result, the FAA is implementing runway safety systems, the airport, the taxiway in use, and the runway entrance
such as Airport Surface Detection Equipment-Model X being used. Overlooking this information can lead to
(ASDE-X) and Advanced Surface Movement Guidance and ground accidents that are entirely preventable. If you
Control System (A-SMGCS) at various airports. The data that encounter unfamiliar markings or lighting, contact ATC
these systems use comes from surface movement radar for clarification and, if necessary, request progressive taxi
and aircraft transponders. The combination of these data instructions. Pilots are encouraged to notify the appropriate
sources allows the systems to determine the position and authorities of erroneous, misleading, or decaying signs or
identification of aircraft on the airport movement area and lighting that would contribute to the failure of safe ground
operations.
1-4
In-pavement runway guard lights

18
Centerline/lead-on lights

18 Painted
Stop bar at instrument landing system hold position
holding
position
sign Broken taxiway edge markings may be crossed

Vehicle lanes

Reporting points

Low
visibility
hold
point
Under ATC Not under ATC control
control
Taxiway centerline marking
A A
Taxiway edge marking (do not cross)

Painted taxiway location sign

Painted taxiway direction sign

Runway holding position marking and lights for land and hold short operations (LAHSO)

Figure 1-4. Key airport lighting and markings.


Runway Incursions Any occurrence at an aerodrome involving the incorrect
On any given day, the NAS may handle almost 200,000 presence of an aircraft, vehicle, or person on the protected
takeoffs and landings. Due to the complex nature of the area of a surface designated for the landing and takeoff of
airport environment and the intricacies of the network of aircraft.
people that make it operate efficiently, the FAA is constantly
looking to maintain the high standard of safety that exists The four categories of runway incursions are listed below:
at airports today. Runway safety is one of its top priorities. Category Aa serious incident in which a collision
Beginning FY 2008, the FAA defines a runway incursion as: was narrowly avoided.

1-5
Category Ban incident in which separation Runway Hotspots
decreases and there is a significant potential for ICAO defines runway hotspots as a location on an
collision that may result in a time critical corrective/ aerodrome movement area with a history or potential risk
evasive response to avoid a collision. of collision or runway incursion and where heightened
Category Can incident characterized by ample time attention by pilots and drivers is necessary. Hotspots
and/or distance to avoid a collision. alert pilots to complex or potentially confusing taxiway
geometry that could make surface navigation challenging.
Category Dan incident that meets the definition
Whatever the reason, pilots need to be aware that
of runway incursion, such as incorrect presence of a
these hazardous intersections exist, and they should
single vehicle/person/aircraft on the protected area
be increasingly vigilant when approaching and taxiing
of a surface designated for the landing and takeoff of
through these intersections. These hotspots are depicted
aircraft but with no immediate safety consequences.
on some airport charts as circled areas. [Figure 1-6] The FAA

Office of Runway Safety has links to the FAA regions that
Figure 1-5 highlights several steps that reduce the chances
maintain a complete list of airports with runway hotspots
of being involved in a runway incursion.
at http://www.faa.gov/airports/runway_safety/.

The FAA recommends that you:
Standardized Taxi Routes
Receive and understand all NOTAMs, particularly
Standard taxi routes improve ground management at high-
those concerning airport construction and lighting.
density airports, namely those that have airline service. At
Read back, in full, all clearances involving
these airports, typical taxiway traffic patterns used to move
holding short, line up and wait, and crossing runways
aircraft between gate and runway are laid out and coded.
to ensure proper understanding.
The ATC specialist (ATCS) can reduce radio communication
Abide by the sterile cockpit rule.
time and eliminate taxi instruction misinterpretation by
Develop operational procedures that minimize
distractions during taxiing.
simply clearing the pilot to taxi via a specific, named route.
Ask ATC for directions if you are lost or unsure of
An example of this would be Los Angeles International
your position on the airport. Airport (KLAX), where North Route is used to transition
Adhere to takeo and runway crossing clearances in to Runway 24L. [Figure 1-7] These routes are issued by
a timely manner. ground control, and if unable to comply, pilots must
Position your aircraft so landing trac can see you. advise ground control on initial contact. If for any reason
Monitor radio communications to maintain a the pilot becomes uncertain as to the correct taxi route, a
situational awareness of other aircraft. request should be made for progressive taxi instructions.
Remain on frequency until instructed to change. These step-by-step routing directions are also issued if the
Make sure you know the reduced runway distances controller deems it necessary due to traffic, closed taxiways,
and whether or not you can comply before accepting airport construction, etc. It is the pilots responsibility to
a land and hold short clearance or clearance for know if a particular airport has preplanned taxi routes, to
shortened runway. be familiar with them, and to have the taxi descriptions
Report confusing airport diagrams to the proper in their possession. Specific information about airports
authorities. that use coded taxiway routes is included in the Notice to
Use exterior taxi and landing lights when practical. Airmen Publication (NTAP).

NOTE:
The sterile cockpit rule refers to a concept outlined in 14 CFR
Taxi and Movement Operations Change
Part 121, sections 121.542 and 135.100 that requires flight As of June 30, 2010, controllers are required to issue explicit
crews to refrain from engaging in activities that could distract instructions to cross or hold short of each runway that
them from the performance of their duties during critical phases
of flight.
intersects a taxi route. Following is a summary of these
procedural changes:
Figure 1-5. FAA recommendations for reducing runway incursions. Taxi to is no longer used when issuing taxi
instructions to an assigned takeoff runway.
In addition to the SMGCS program, the FAA has implemented
Instructions to cross a runway are issued one at a
additional programs to reduce runway incursions and other
time. Instructions to cross multiple runways are not
surface movement issues. They identified runway hotspots,
issued. An aircraft or vehicle must have crossed the
designed standardized taxi routes, and instituted the
previous runway before another runway crossing
Runway Safety Program.
is issued. This applies to any runway, including

inactive or closed runways.

1-6
At Long Beach/Daugherty Field Airport, the following areas have been HOT1
designated as hot spots, posing a special challenge to pilots. Runway 25R and Taxiway D
Aircraft exiting runway 30 at taxiway A turn
left on taxiway D, anticipate reaching their
destination, and fail to hold short of runway
25R.

HOT2
Runway 12 and Taxiway B
Aircraft northbound on taxiway B for departure
on runway 16R at taxiway intersection D miss
the right turn onto taxiway D and enter
runways 12, 7L, and 25R.

HOT3
Runway 25L/7R at Taxiway B
Aircraft southbound on taxiway B anticipate
reaching their destination parking ramp and
fail to hold short of runway 25L/7R.

HOT4
Runway 16R/34L at Taxiway F
Aircraft taxiing to runway 16R from the
southwest ramp miss the left turn onto
taxiway B, continue eastbound onto taxiway
F, and enter runway 16R/34L.
HOT6
Landing Runway 30
Be aware that this runway crosses every other available runway HOT5
at the airport. When exiting the runway, pilots should make sure Runway 25L at Taxiway D
they are turning with a lead-off taxiline onto a taxiway and not After completing a runup on inactive runway
onto another active runway. 34R, aircraft fail to hold short of runway 25L.

Figure 1-6. Example of runway hot spots located at Long Beach/Daugherty Field Airport (KLGB).

SW-3, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

Standardized Taxi Routes for Los Angeles

SE
International Airport (KLAX)
The following Standardized Taxi routes
N
may be issued to all taxiing aircraft.
U I O
North Route
AL T
TU
Taxi via Charlie (C) towards taxiway Sierra (S) taxi northbound on taxiway Sierra (S),
A
IG
and at Check-point-1 contact Ground Control on frequency 121.65, hold short of

AC
taxiway Delta (D). When advised by the north Ground Control, the North Route

V
continues on taxiway Echo (E) to Runway 24L or the gate, whichever applies.

A
South Route North Route
R
FO N
If the aircraft is west of taxiway Romeo (R), taxi eastbound on taxiway Echo (E) and
turn right on taxiway Romeo (R), if the aircraft is east of taxiway Romeo (R), taxi

R
westbound on taxiway Echo (E) and turn left on taxiway Romeo (R). And at

T
Check-point-2, contact Ground Control on frequency 121.75, hold short of taxiway

FO
Charlie (C).

O
West Route
N
LE T
Taxi via taxiway Charlie (C) west-bound, hold short of taxiway Alfa Alfa (AA), contact
Ground Control on frequency 121.65 when number one approaching Taxiway AA.

Bridge Route
M
P
N O
A
Taxi via taxiway Echo (E) then south on taxiway Alfa Alfa (AA), and at Check-point-3
contact Ground Control on frequency 121.75, hold short of taxiway Charlie (C).

S
(AJV-W2 4/23/2010)

SW-3, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

Figure 1-7. Los Angeles International Airport diagram, North Route, and standardized taxi route.

1-7
Never cross a runway hold marking without explicit AeroNav Products charts list takeoff minimums only for
ATC instructions. If in doubt, ask! the runways at airports that have other than standard
minimums. These takeoff minimums are listed by airport
Reminder: You may not enter a runway unless you have been: in alphabetical order in the front of the TPP booklet. If an
1. Instructed to cross or taxi onto that specific runway; airport has non-standard takeoff minimums, a T (referred
to by some as either the triangle T or trouble T) is placed
2. Cleared to take off from that runway; or in the notes sections of the instrument procedure chart. In
3. Instructed to line up and wait on that specific runway. the front of the TPP booklet, takeoff minimums are listed
before the obstacle departure procedure. Some departure
For more information on the change, refer to FAA Order N procedures allow a departure with standard minimums
JO 7110.65, which can be found at www.faa.gov. provided specific aircraft performance requirements are
met. [Figure 1-8]
Weather and the Departure Environment
Takeoff Minimums Takeoff Minimums for Commercial Operators
While mechanical failure is potentially hazardous during While Part 121 and Part 135 operators are the primary users
any phase of flight, a failure during takeoff under of takeoff minimums, they may be able to use alternative
instrument conditions is extremely critical. In the event of takeoff minimums based on their individual OpSpecs.
an emergency, a decision must be made to either return to Through these OpSpecs, operators are authorized to depart
the departure airport or fly directly to a takeoff alternate. If with lower-than-standard minimums provided they have
the departure weather were below the landing minimums the necessary equipment and crew training.
for the departure airport, the flight would be unable to
return for landing, leaving few options and little time to
Operations Specifications (OpSpecs)
reach a takeoff alternate. Within the air transportation industry, there is a need to
establish and administer safety standards to accommodate
In the early years of air transportation, landing minimums many variables. These variables include a wide range
for commercial operators were usually lower than takeoff of aircraft, varied operator capabilities, the various
minimums. Therefore, it was possible that minimums situations requiring different types of air transportation,
allowed pilots to land at an airport but not depart from that and the continual, rapid changes in aviation technology.
airport. Additionally, all takeoff minimums once included It is impractical to address these variables through the
ceiling, as well as visibility requirements. Today, takeoff promulgation of safety regulations for each and every
minimums are typically lower than published landing type of air transport situation and the varying degrees of
minimums, and ceiling requirements are only included if operator capabilities. Also, it is impractical to address the
it is necessary to see and avoid obstacles in the departure rapidly changing aviation technology and environment
area. through the regulatory process. Safety regulations
would be extremely complex and unwieldy if all possible
The FAA establishes takeoff minimums for every airport variations and situations were addressed by regulation.
that has published Standard Instrument Approaches. Instead, the safety standards established by regulation
These minimums are used by commercially operated should usually have a broad application that allows varying
aircraft, namely Part 121 and Part 135 operators. At airports acceptable methods of compliance. The OpSpecs provide
where minimums are not established, these same carriers an effective method for establishing safety standards that
are required to use FAA designated standard minimums: address a wide range of variables. In addition, OpSpecs
1 statute mile (SM) visibility for single- and twin-engine can be adapted to a specific certificate holder or operators
aircraft, and 12 SM for helicopters and aircraft with more class and size of aircraft and type and kinds of operations.
than two engines. OpSpecs can be tailored to suit an individual certificate
holder or operators needs.
Aircraft operating under 14 CFR Part 91 are not required to
comply with established takeoff minimums. Legally, a zero/ Part 121 and Part 135 certificate holders have the ability,
zero departure may be made, but it is never advisable. If through the use of approved OpSpecs, to use lower-than-
commercial pilots who fly passengers on a daily basis must standard takeoff minimums. Depending on the equipment
comply with takeoff minimums, then good judgment and installed in a specific type of aircraft, the crew training, and
common sense would tell all instrument pilots to follow the type of equipment installed at a particular airport, these
the established minimums as well. operators can depart from appropriately equipped runways
with as little as 300 feet RVR. Additionally, OpSpecs outline

1-8
C3

TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE PROCEDURES


10210

DENVER, CO

R
CANON CITY, CO
FREMONT COUNTY CENTENNIAL (APA)
AMDT 4 08213 (FAA)

O
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 29, 4600-2 or std. with a
min. climb of 450' per NM to 10400. TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 17L, std. w/ min. climb of
Rwy 17R,

F
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 11, climb runway
heading. Rwy 29, per NM to 6900.
All aircraft intercept and climb via PUB VORTAC DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 10, when departing

T E
R-262 (V244) PUB VORTAC before proceeding on
course.

O
DEN VOR/DME R-191 to DEN VOR/DME, thence ...

S
CLAYTON,
City and NM and airport name
state location Rwys 17L, 17R,
CLAYTON MUNI

N U
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 30, 1300-1 or std. with a
min. climb of 244' per NM until 6700. DME R-196 to DEN VOR/DME, thence ...Rwy 28, climb

E L
COLORADO SPRINGS, CO end of runway. All other courses: climbing right turn
CITY OF COLORADO SPRINGS MUNI

L A
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 30, 600-2 or std. with a DEN VOR/DME, thence ... Rwy 35L, climb on a heading
min. climb of 220' per NM to 6900.

P U
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwys 12,17L,17R, turn
Takeoff minimums
left. Rwys 30,35L,35R, turn right. All aircraft climb VOR/DME R-208 to DEN VOR/DME, thence ...Rwy

T
35R,

M
direct BRK VORTAC. Aircraft departing on BRK R-325
CW R-153 climb on course. Aircraft departing BRK departure end of runway. All other courses: climb
R-154 CW R-324 climb in BRK holding pattern (NW,

A C
DEN VOR/DME, thence ...
above 14000. ... Climb in DEN VOR/DME holding pattern (hold south,

CORTEZ, CO
CORTEZ MUNI (CEZ)
S A course.
NOTE: Rwy 10,
29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010


AMDT 3 10098 (FAA)
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: use LEDVE
DEPARTURE.

CRAIG, CO
CRAIG-MOFFAT

R
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwys 7,25, 800-1 , or std. with
a min. climb of 400' per NM to 7000. Rwy 17L,

O
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwys 7,25, climb direct

F ION
climbing to: aircraft departing CHE R-213 CW R-296 Rwy 17R,
depart on course; all others continue climbing to cross
CHE at or above; CHE R-076 CW R-114 10500, R-115

T
CW R-212 11300,IFR
Other-than-standard and R-297
takeoffCWminimums
R-076 11300.are published.

DEMING, NM
DEMING MUNI

O A T
N IG
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 4, NA.
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: WESTBOUND: Rwy 8,
Rwy 22, climbing right from departure end of runway, 842 feet right of
Rwy 26, climbing right turn heading centerline, 90' AGL/6021' MSL. Rwy 28, terrain

course. EASTBOUND: Rwy 8, climb direct DMN


VORTAC; Rwys 22, 26, climbing right turn direct DMN
VORTAC; then via V94 on course. NORTHBOUND:

A V
N
Rwy 8, climb direct DMN VORTAC; Rwys 22, 26,
climbing right turn direct DMN VORTAC; then via V110 Rwy 35L, terrain
on course.
SW-1,

2010

Figure 1-8. Examples of non-standard takeoff minimums for Colorado Springs, Colorado.

1-9
provisions for approach minimums, alternate airports, and approach charts as well. [Figure 1-9]
weather services in Volume III of FAA Order 8900.1, Flight
Standards Information Management System (FSIMS). Visibility
Visibility is the ability, as determined by atmospheric
Ceiling and Visibility Requirements conditions and expressed in units of distance, to see and
All takeoffs and departures have visibility minimums (some identify prominent unlighted objects by day and prominent
may have minimum ceiling requirements) incorporated lighted objects by night. Visibility is reported as statute miles,
into the procedure. There are a number of methods to hundreds of feet, or meters.
report visibility and a variety of ways to distribute these
reports, including automated weather observations. Flight Prevailing Visibility
crews should always check the weather, including ceiling Prevailing visibility is the greatest horizontal visibility
and visibility information, prior to departure. Never launch equaled or exceeded throughout at least half the horizon
an IFR flight without obtaining current visibility information circle, which need not necessarily be continuous. Prevailing
immediately prior to departure. Further, when ceiling and visibility is reported in statute miles or fractions of miles.
visibility minimums are specified for IFR departure, both
are applicable. Runway Visibility Value (RVV)

Runway visibility value is the visibility determined for a
Weather reporting stations for specific airports across the
particular runway by a transmissometer. A meter provides
country can be located by reviewing the A/FD. Weather
continuous indication of the visibility (reported in statute
sources along with their respective phone numbers and
miles or fractions of miles) for the runway. RVV is used in lieu
frequencies are listed by airport. Frequencies for weather
of prevailing visibility in determining minimums for a particular
sources, such as Automatic Terminal Information Service
runway.
(ATIS), Digital Automatic Terminal Information Service

Tower Visibility
Tower visibility is the prevailing visibility determined from
the airport traffic control tower at locations that also report
ON

the surface visibility.



TI

Runway Visual Range (RVR)


Runway visual range is an instrumentally derived value,
GA

based on standard calibrations, that represents the


horizontal distance a pilot sees down the runway from the
VI

approach end. It is based on the sighting of either high


intensity runway lights or on the visual contrast of other
NA
SE-2, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

targets, whichever yields the greater visual range. RVR, in


SE-2, 29 JUL 2010 to 26 AUG 2010

contrast to prevailing or runway visibility, is based on what


a pilot in a moving aircraft should see looking down the
R

runway. RVR is horizontal visual range, not slant visual range.


FO

RVR is reported in hundreds of feet, so the values must be


converted to SM if the visibility in SM is not reported. [Figure
T
NO

Conversion
AUG 2010

RVR (feet) Visibility (sm)


2010 to 26

1,600 1/4
2,400 1/2
Figure 1-9. Examples of weather information of various flight
3,200 5/8
information publications (FLIP).
4,000 3/4
4,500 7/8
(D-ATIS), Automated Weather Observing System (AWOS), 5,000 1
Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS), and FAA 6,000 11/4
Automated Flight Service Station (AFSS) are published on
Figure 1-10. RVR conversion table.

1-10
1-10] It is based on the measurement of a transmissometer
made near the touchdown point of the instrument runway
and is reported in hundreds of feet. RVR is used in lieu of
RVV and/or prevailing visibility in determining minimums
for a particular runway.

Types of RVR
The following are types of RVR that may be used:
Touchdown RVRthe RVR visibility readout values
obtained from RVR equipment serving the runway
touchdown zone.
Mid-RVRthe RVR readout values obtained from
RVR equipment located near the runway midpoint .
Rollout RVRthe RVR readout values obtained from
RVR equipment located nearest the rollout end of
the runway.
Far End RVRwhen four RVR visibility sensors (VS)
are installed, the far end RVR VS is the touchdown
RVR VS on the reciprocal runway. The far end sensor
will serve as additional information.

RVR is the primary visibility measurement used by Part
Figure 1-11. AWSS installation at Driggs-Reed, Idaho.
121 and Part 135 operators with specific visibility reports
and controlling values outlined in their respective OpSpecs. Automated Weather Systems
Under their OpSpecs agreements, the operator must have An automated weather system consists of any of the
specific, current RVR reports, if available, to proceed with an automated weather sensor platforms that collect weather
instrument departure. OpSpecs also outline which visibility data at airports and disseminate the weather information
report is controlling in various departure scenarios. via radio and/or landline. The systems consist of the ASOS/
Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS) and the AWOS.
Adequate Visual Reference These systems are installed and maintained at airports
Another set of lower-than-standard takeoff minimums is across the United States by both government (FAA and
available to Part 121 and Part 135 operations as outlined in National Weather Service (NWS)) and private entities. They
their respective OpSpecs document. When certain types of are relatively inexpensive to operate because they require
visibility reports are unavailable or specific equipment is out no outside observer, and they provide invaluable weather
of service, the flight can still depart the airport if the pilot information for airports without operating control towers.
can maintain adequate visual reference. An appropriate [Figure 1-11]
visual aid must be available to ensure the takeoff surface
can be continuously identified, and directional control can AWOS and ASOS/AWSS offer a wide variety of capabilities
be maintained throughout the takeoff run. Appropriate and progressively broader weather reports. Automated
visual aids include high intensity runway lights, runway systems typically transmit weather every one to two
centerline lights, runway centerline markings, or other minutes so the most up-to-date weather information is
runway lighting and markings. With adequate visual constantly broadcast. Basic AWOS includes only altimeter
references and appropriate OpSpec approval, commercial setting, wind speed, wind direction, temperature, and dew
operators may take off with a visibility of 1600 RVR or point information. More advanced systems, such as the
SM. ASOS/AWSS and AWOS-3, are able to provide additional
information, such as wind speed, wind gust, wind direction,
Ceilings variable wind direction, temperature, dew point, altimeter
Ceiling is the height above the earths surface of the lowest setting, and density altitude. ASOS/AWSS stations providing
layer of clouds or obscuring phenomena that is reported as service levels A or B also report RVR. The specific type of
broken, overcast, or obscuration and not classified as thin equipment found at a given facility is listed in the A/FD.
or partial. [Figure 1-12]

1-11
The use of the aforementioned visibility reports and approved weather sources for it to be used in the ATIS
weather services are not limited for Part 91 operators. report.

Digital Automatic Terminal Information Service
(D-ATIS)
LU SE The digital ATIS (D-ATIS) is an alternative method of
TUA
AC (704) 735-6954. receiving ATIS reports. The service provides text messages
R
WEATHER DATA SOURCES: AWOS-3 119.675
O
OT F
to aircraft, airlines, and other users outside the standard
E N reception range of conventional ATIS via landline and data
PL
SAM link communications to the flight deck. Aircraft equipped
AWOS/ASOS/AWSS information
with data link services are capable of receiving ATIS
information over their Aircraft Communications Addressing
and Reporting System (ACARS) unit. This allows the pilots to
read and print out the ATIS report inside the aircraft, thereby
Figure 1-12. A/FD entry for an AWOS station. increasing report accuracy and decreasing pilot workload.

Also, the service provides a computer-synthesized voice
Part 121 and Part 135 operators are bound by their message that can be transmitted to all aircraft within
individual OpSpecs documents and are required to range of existing transmitters. The Terminal Data Link
use weather reports that come from the NWS or other System (TDLS) D-ATIS application uses weather inputs
approved sources. While every operators specifications are from local automated weather sources or manually entered
individually tailored, most operators are required to use meteorological data together with preprogrammed menus
ATIS, RVR reports, and selected reports from automated to provide standard information to users. Airports with
weather stations. All reports coming from an AWOS-3 D-ATIS capability are listed in the A/FD.
station are usable for Part 121 and Part 135 operators. Each
type of automated station has different levels of approval It is important to remember that ATIS information is
as outlined in individual OpSpecs. Ceiling and visibility updated hourly and anytime a significant change in the
reports given by the tower with the departure information weather occurs. As a result, the information is not the most
are always considered official weather, and RVR reports are current report available. Prior to departing the airport, you
typically the controlling visibility reference. need to get the latest weather information from the tower.
ASOS/ AWSS and AWOS also provide a source of current
Automatic Terminal Information Service (ATIS) weather, but their information should not be substituted
ATIS is another valuable tool for gaining weather for weather reports from the tower.
information. ATIS is available at most airports that have an
operating control tower, which means the reports on the IFR Alternate Requirements
ATIS frequency are only available during the regular hours On AeroNav Products charts, standard alternate minimums
of tower operation. At some airports that operate part-time are not published. If the airport has other than standard
towers, ASOS/AWSS information is broadcast over the alternate minimums, they are listed in the front of the
ATIS frequency when the tower is closed. This service is approach chart booklet. The presence of a triangle with an
available only at those airports that have both an ASOS/ A on the approach chart indicates the listing of alternate
AWSS on the field and an ATIS-ASOS/AWSS interface switch minimums should be consulted. Airports that do not qualify
installed in the tower. for use as an alternate airport are designated with an A
N/A. [Figure 1-13]
Each ATIS report includes crucial information about
runways and instrument approaches in use, specific The requirement for an alternate depends on the aircraft
outages, and current weather conditions including category, equipment installed, approach navigational aid
visibility. Visibility is reported in statute miles and may (NAVAID), and forecast weather. For example, airports with
be omitted if the visibility is greater than five miles. ATIS only a global positioning system (GPS) approach procedure
weather information comes from a variety of sources cannot be used as an alternate by TSO-C129/129A users even
depending on the particular airport and the equipment though A N/A has been removed from the approach
installed there. The reported weather may come from a chart. For select area navigation (RNAV) GPS and GPS
manual weather observer, weather instruments located approach procedures, the A N/A is being removed so
in the tower, or from automated weather stations. This they may be used as an alternate by aircraft equipped
information, no matter the origin, must be from NWS
1-12
INSTRUMENT APPROACH PROCEDURE CHARTS

IFR ALTERNATE AIRPORT MINIMUMS


Standard alternate minimums for non precision approaches are 800-2 (NDB, VOR, LOC, TACAN, LDA,
Other-than-standard IFR alternate
VORTAC, VOR/DME, ASRminimums
or WAASare published.
LNAV); for precision approaches 600-2 (ILS or PAR). Airports within

N
this geographical area that require alternate minimums other than standard or alternate minimums with
restrictions are listed below. NA - means alternate minimums are not authorized due to unmonitored facility

G A T IO
VI
or absence of weather reporting service. Civil pilots see FAR 91. IFR Alternate Airport Minimums: Ceiling

A
and Visibility Minimums not applicable to USA/USN/USAF. Pilots must review the IFR Alternate Airport
Minimums Notes for alternate airfield suitability.

R N
FO
NAME
AKRON, CO NOT
COLORADO
ALTERNATE MINIMUMS NAME
COLORADO SPRINGS, CO
CITY OF COLORADO SPRINGS
ALTERNATE MINIMUMS

PLAINS RGNL ................. RNAV (GPS) Rwy 11 MUNI .............................. ILS or LOC Rwy 17L
NA when local weather not available. ILS or LOC Rwy 35L
ILS or LOC Rwy 35R
ALAMOSA, CO RNAV (GPS) Y Rwy 17L

E
SAN LUIS VALLEY RGNL/ RNAV (GPS) Y Rwy 17R 4
BERGMAN FIELD .............. RNAV (GPS) Rwy 2

A L U S RNAV (RNP) Z Rwy 17R5

ACTU
RNAV (GPS) Rwy 20 Categories A, B, 900-2; Category C, 900-2 ;
NA when local weather not available. Category D, 900-2 .

FO R ILS, Category D, 700-2.


SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

ALBUQUERQUE, NM
T

SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


O
NA when local weather not available.

LE N
23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


ALBUQUERQUE INTL 4
Categories A, B, 1100-2; Categories C, D,

SAMP
SUNPORT ..................... VOR or TACAN Rwy 8 1100-3.
Categories A,B, 900-2; Category C, 900-2 ; 5
Categories A, B, C, D, 800-2 .
Category D, 900-2 ; Category E, 900-3.
City and state location CORTEZ, CO
CLAYTON, NM CORTEZ MUNI ............ RNAV (GPS) Y Rwy 21
Airport
CLAYTON name
MUNI and applicable
AIRPARK ............approach
NDB Rwy 2 RNAV (GPS) Z Rwy 21
NDB Rwy 20 VOR Rwy 21
RNAV (GPS) Rwy 2 Category D, 900-3.
Other-than-standard IFR alternate
RNAV minimums
(GPS) Rwy 20 Categories A, B, 1300-2; Categories C, D,
NA when local weather not available. 1300-3.
Categories A, B, 900-2; Category C, 900-2 ,
Category D, 900-2 . CRAIG, CO
Category D, 800-2 . CRAIG-MOFFAT .................... VOR/DME Rwy 7
VOR Rwy 25
Figure 1-13. Examples of IFR alternate minimums.

with an approach approved Wide Area Augmentation An alternate must be listed on an IFR flight plan if at the ETA
System (WAAS) receiver. Because GPS is not authorized and for 1 hour after the ETA, the ceiling is at least 1,000 feet
as a substitute means of navigation guidance when above the airport elevation, or at least 400 feet above the
conducting a conventional approach at an alternate lowest applicable approach minima, whichever is higher,
airport, if the approach procedure requires either distance and the visibility is at least 2 SM.
measuring equipment (DME) or automatic direction finder
(ADF), the aircraft must be equipped with the appropriate Not all airports can be used as alternate airports. An airport
DME or ADF avionics in order to use the approach as an may not be qualified for alternate use if the airport NAVAID
alternate. is unmonitored, or if it does not have weather reporting
capabilities. For an airport to be used as an alternate,
For airplane 14 CFR Part 91 requirements, an alternate the forecast weather at that airport must meet certain
airport must be listed on IFR flight plans if the forecast qualifications at the ETA. Standard airplane alternate
weather at the destination airport, for at least 1 hour minimums for a precision approach are a 600-foot ceiling
before and for 1 hour after the estimated time of arrival and a 2 SM visibility. For a non-precision approach, the
(ETA), the ceiling is less than 2,000 feet above the airport minimums are an 800-foot ceiling and a 2 SM visibility.
elevation, and the visibility is less than 3 SM. A simple way to Standard alternate minimums apply unless higher alternate
remember the rules for determining the necessity of filing minimums are listed for an airport. For helicopters, alternate
an alternate for airplanes is the 1, 2, 3 Rule. For helicopter weather minimums are a ceiling of 200 feet above the
14 CFR Part 91, similar alternate filing requirements apply. minimum for the approach to be flown, and visibility at

1-13
least 1 SM but never less than the minimum visibility for the dispatcher; this is especially true for Part 121 pilots. To
the approach to be flown. aid in the planning of alternates, dispatchers have a list of
airports that are approved as alternates so they can quickly
Alternate Minimums for Commercial Operators determine which airports should be used for a particular
IFR alternate minimums for Part 121 and Part 135 operators flight. Dispatchers also use flight planning software that
are very specific and have more stringent requirements plans routes including alternates for the flight. This type of
than Part 91 operators. software is tailored for individual operators and includes
their normal flight paths and approved airports. Flight
Part 121 operators are required by their OpSpecs and planning software and services are provided through
14 CFR Part 121, sections 121.617 and 121.625 to have private sources.
a takeoff alternate airport for their departure airport in
addition to their airport of intended landing if the weather Though the pilot is the final authority for the flight
at the departure airport is below the landing minimums and ultimately has full responsibility, the dispatcher is
in the certificate holders OpSpecs for that airport. The responsible for creating flight plans that are accurate and
alternate must be within 2 hours flying time for an aircraft comply with the CFRs. Alternate minimum criteria are only
with three or more engines with an engine out in normal used as planning tools to ensure the pilot in command and
cruise in still air. For two engine aircraft, the alternate must dispatcher are thinking ahead to the approach phase of
be within 1 hour. The airport of intended landing may be flight. In the event the flight would actually need to divert
used in lieu of an alternate provided that it meets all the to an alternate, the published approach minimums or
requirements. Domestic Part 121 operators must also file lower-than-standard minimums must be used as addressed
for alternate airports when the weather at their destination in OpSpecs documents.
airport, from 1 hour before to 1 hour after their ETA, is
forecast to be below a 2,000-foot ceiling and/or less than Departure Procedures
3 miles visibility. Instrument departure procedures are preplanned IFR
procedures that provide obstruction clearance from
For airports with at least one operational navigational the terminal area to the appropriate en route structure.
facility that provides a straight-in non-precision approach, Primarily, these procedures are designed to provide obstacle
a straight-in precision approach, or a circling maneuver protection for departing aircraft. There are two types of
from an instrument approach procedure determine the Departure Procedures (DPs): Obstacle Departure Procedures
ceiling and visibility by: (ODPs) and Standard Instrument Departures (SIDs).
Adding 400 feet to the authorized CAT I height above
airport (HAA)/height above touchdown elevation When an instrument approach is initially developed for an
(HAT) for ceiling. airport, the need for an ODP is assessed. If an aircraft may
turn in any direction from a runway within the limits of the
Adding one mile to the authorized CAT I visibility assessment area and remain clear of obstacles that runway
for visibility minimums. passes what is called a diverse departure assessment, and
no ODP is published. A diverse departure assessment
This is one example of the criteria required for Part 121 ensures that a prescribed, expanding amount of required
operators when calculating minimums. Part 135 operators obstacle clearance (ROC) is achieved during the climb-out
are also subject to their own specific rules regarding the until the aircraft can obtain a minimum 1,000 feet ROC in
selection and use of alternate minimums as outlined non-mountainous areas or a minimum 2,000 feet ROC in
in their OpSpecs and 14 CFR Part 135, sections 135.219 mountainous areas. Unless specified otherwise, required
through 135.225, and are similar to those used by Part obstacle clearance for all departures, including diverse, is
121 operators. based on the pilot crossing the departure end of the runway
(DER) at least 35 feet above the DER elevation, climbing to
Typically, dispatchers who plan flights for these operators 400 feet above the DER elevation before making the initial
are responsible for planning alternate airports. The turn, and maintaining a minimum climb gradient of 200
dispatcher considers aircraft performance, aircraft feet per nautical mile (FPNM), unless required to level off
equipment and its condition, and route of flight when by a crossing restriction until the minimum IFR altitude
choosing alternates. In the event changes need to be made is reached. Following ODP assessment, a SID may still be
to the flight plan en route due to deteriorating weather, established for the purposes of ATC flow management,
the dispatcher maintains contact with the flight crew system enhancement, or noise abatement.
and reroutes their flight as necessary. Therefore, it is the
pilots responsibility to execute the flight as planned by

1-14
Previous TERPS Departure Procedures
Positive course guidance must be acquired
within 10 NM for straight departures and
within 5 NM for departures requiring turns.

V186

Required climb gradient of 200 FPNM


feet
400

96 feet
)
feet (OCS
200 surface
rance

48 '
lea
cle c
Obsta

304 feet
152 feet
35 feet

10 NM
1 NM 2 NM

Figure 1-14. Previous TERPS departure procedures.

Aircraft reaches en route obstacle Beyond the diverse obstacle assessment


clearance of 1,000' (nonmountainous area (25/46 NM) there might be significantly
areas) or 2,000' (in mountainous areas). higher obstacles.

25/46 NM

M
FPN
f2 00
CGo
ign
S Des 2 FP
NM
TERP IS at 15
40:1 O

4NM

Figure 1-15. Diverse Departure Obstacle Assessment to 25/46 NM.

1-15
New TERPS Departure Procedures
Start End of Runway (SER)
The beginning of the takeoff runway available.

Approach End of Runway (AER)


The first portion of the runway available for landing.
If the runway threshold is displaced, the displaced
threshold latitude/longitude is the AER.

V186
e b M

et
ov clim PN

e
ab :1

96 feet 0 f
or path r 40
ed 00 F

40
t i r Mo
a qu f 2 PN
Landing Distance Available (LDA) d limb Re nt o 152
F
The length of runway that is declared available and me t c of
su af die pe
suitable for the ground run of an airplane landing. as aircr g r a Slo
um ed
nim nd

et
ce
Mi inte

fe
ran
lea

48 ' 00
c )

304 feet
2
cle (OCS
sta
Ob urface
s

152 feet
35 feet
Runway
Centerline Extended

1 NM 2 NM
15

Departure End of Runway (DER)


The end of runway available for the ground run of an aircraft
departure. The end of the runway that is opposite the landing
threshold, sometimes referred to as the stop end of the runway. Positive Course Guidance (PCG)
A continuous display of navigational data
that enables an aircraft to be flown along a
Takeoff Runway Available (TORA) Takeoff Distance Available (TODA) specific course line (e.g., radar vector,
The length of runway declared available and suitable The length of the takeoff runway available plus RNAV, ground-based NAVAID). PCG must
for the ground run of an airplane takeoff. the length of the clearway, if provided. be acquired within 10 NM for straight
departures and within 5 NM for departures
requiring turns.
TORA
Clearway First
Significant Initial Climb Area (ICA)
Obstacle The ICA is the segment of the departure procedure that
75 Meters starts at the DER and proceeds along the runway
(247 Feet) centerline extended to allow the aircraft sufficient distance
TODA
to reach an altitude of 400 feet above DER elevation and
Accelerate-Stop Distance Available to allow the establishment of positive course guidance by
TORA Stopway (ASDA) all navigation systems. A typical straight departure ICA
The runway plus stopway length extends 2-5 NM from the DER along the runway centerline
declared available and suitable for extended. It is 500 feet wide each side of the runway
the acceleration and deceleration centerline at DER, then spreads out at 15.
ASDA of an airplane aborting a takeoff.

Figure 1-16. New TERPS departure procedures.

Design Criteria If taking off from a runway using a diverse departure


The design of a departure procedure is based on terminal (a runway without a published ODP), beyond these
instrument procedures (TERPS), which is a living document distances the pilot is responsible for obstacle clearance if
that is updated frequently (FAA Order 8260.3). Departure not operating on a published route, and if below the MEA
design criterion begins with the assumption of an initial or MOCA of a published route, or below an ATC-assigned
climb of 200 FPNM after crossing the DER at a height altitude. [Figure 1-15]
of at least 35 feet. [Figure 1-14] The aircraft climb path
assumption provides a minimum of 35 feet of additional Recent changes in TERPS criteria make the OCS lower and
obstacle clearance above the required obstacle clearance more restrictive. [Figure 1-16] However, there are many
(ROC), from the DER outward, to absorb variations ranging departures today that were evaluated under the old criteria
from the distance of the static source to the landing gear, that allowed some obstacle surfaces to be as high as 35 feet
to differences in establishing the minimum 200 FPNM climb at the DER. [Figure 1-14] Since there is no way for the pilot
gradient, etc. The ROC is the planned separation between to determine whether the departure was evaluated using
the obstacle clearance surface (OCS) and the required climb the previous or current criteria, and until all departures
gradient of 200 FPNM. The ROC value is zero at the DER have been evaluated using the current criteria, pilots need
elevation and increases along the departure route until to be very familiar with the departure environment and
the ROC value appropriate for en route flight is achieved. associated obstacles, especially if crossing the DER at less
The appropriate ROC value for en route operations is than 35 feet.
typically achieved about 25 NM for 1,000 feet of ROC in
non-mountainous areas, and 46 NM for 2,000 feet of ROC All departure procedures are initially assessed for obstacle
in mountainous areas. clearance based on a 40:1 Obstacle Clearance Surface (OCS).
If no obstacles penetrate this 40:1 OCS, the standard 200

1-16
FPNM climb gradient provides a minimum of 48 FPNM of These formulas are published in TERPS Volume 4 for
clearance above objects that do not penetrate the slope. calculating the required climb gradient to clear obstacles.
The departure design must also include the acquisition
of positive course guidance (PCG), typically within 5 to 10 The following formula is used for calculating SID climb
NM of the DER for straight departures. Even when aircraft gradients for other than obstacles (i.e., ATC requirements):
performance greatly exceeds the minimum climb gradient,
the published departure routing must always be flown. CG = A E
D
Airports publish the declared distances in the A/FD. These
include takeoff runway available (TORA), takeoff distance A = climb to altitude
available (TODA), accelerate-stop distance available (ASDA), E = climb gradient starting MSL elevation
and landing distance available (LDA). These distances are D = distance (NM) from the beginning of the climb
calculated by adding to the full length of paved runway any
applicable clearway or stop-way and subtracting from that Example:
sum the sections of the runway unsuitable for satisfying the
required takeoff run, takeoff, accelerate/stop, or landing 3000 1221 = 355.8 round to 356 FPNM
distance as shown in Figure 1-16. 5

Optimally, the 40 to 1 slope would work for every departure NOTE: The climb gradient must be equal to or greater than
design; however, due to terrain and manmade obstacles, the gradient required for obstacles along the route of flight.
it is often necessary to use alternative requirements to
accomplish a safe, obstacle-free departure design. In The published climb gradient, obstacle or otherwise, is
such cases, the design of the departure may incorporate a treated as a plane which must not be penetrated from
climb gradient greater than 200 FPNM, an increase in the above until reaching the stated height or has reached
standard takeoff minimums to allow the aircraft to see and the en route environment (e.g., above the MEA, MOCA).
avoid the obstacles, a standard climb of 200 FPNM with a Departure design, including climb gradients, does not
specified reduced takeoff length, or a combination of these take into consideration the performance of the aircraft; it
options and a specific departure route. only considers obstacle protection for all aircraft. TERPS
criteria assume the aircraft is operating with all available
If a departure route is specified, it must be flown in engines and systems fully functioning. Development of
conjunction with the other options. contingency procedures, required to cover the case of
an engine failure, engine out procedures (EOPs) or other
The obstacle environment may require a climb gradient emergency in flight that may occur after liftoff, is the
greater than 200 FPNM. In these cases, the ROC provided responsibility of the operator. When a climb gradient is
above obstacles is equivalent to 24 percent of the required for a specific departure, it is vital that pilots fully
published climb gradient. The required climb gradient, understand the performance of their aircraft and determine
for obstacle purposes on ODPs and SIDs, is obtained by if it can comply with the required climb. The standard
using the formulas: climb of 200 FPNM is not an issue for most aircraft. When
an increased climb gradient is specified due to obstacle
Standard Formula DoD Option* issues, it is important to calculate aircraft performance,
particularly when flying out of airports at higher altitudes
CG = O E CG = (48D + O) E on warm days. To aid in the calculations, the front matter
0.76 D D of every TPP booklet contains a rate of climb table that
relates specific climb gradients and typical groundspeeds
O = obstacle mean sea level (MSL) elevation [Figure 1-17].
E = climb gradient starting MSL elevation
D = distance (NM) from DER to the obstacle Low, Close-In Obstacles
Obstacles that are located within 1 NM of the DER and
Examples: penetrate the 40:1 OCS are referred to as low, close-in
obstacles and are also included in the TPP. These obstacles
2049 1221 (48 3.1 + 2049) 1221 are less than 200 feet above the DER elevation, within 1 NM
= 351.44 = 315.10
0.76 3.1 3.1 of the runway end, and do not require increased takeoff
minimums. The standard ROC to clear these obstacles
Round to 352 FPNM Round to 316 FPNM would require a climb gradient greater than 200 FPNM

*Military only 1-17


E
US
AL
Ground speed is 180 knots.

TU
Required climb gradient of 297 FPNM

AC
R
FO
Given the parameters, you would need to climb at a rate
of 892 feet per minute to maintain the required climb gradient.
T
NO
E
PL
M
SA

Figure 1-17. Rate of climb table.

for a very short distance, only until the aircraft was 200 to cross well above the obstacle(s);
feet above the DER. To eliminate publishing an excessive If the obstacle(s) cannot be visually acquired during
climb gradient, the obstacle above ground level (AGL)/ departure, preflight planning should take into account
MSL height and location relative to the DER is noted in the what turns or other maneuver(s) may be necessary
Takeoff Minimums and (Obstacle) Departure Procedures immediately after takeoff to avoid the obstruction(s).
section of a given TPP booklet. The purpose of this note
is to identify the obstacle and alert the pilot to the height These obstacles are especially critical to aircraft that do not
and location of the obstacle so they can be avoided. This lift off until close to the DER or which climb at the minimum
can be accomplished in a variety of ways: rate. [Figure 1-18]
The pilot may be able to see the obstruction and
maneuver around the obstacle(s) if necessary; One-Engine-Inoperative (OEI) Takeoff Obstacle
Early liftoff/climb performance may allow the aircraft Clearance Requirements
Large and turbine-powered, multiengine transport
category airplanes and commuter category airplanes

1-18
YUBBA INT before proceeding on course.
NOTE: Rwy 7, trees beginning 1117' from DER, 504' proceedingon course. Rwy 12, climbing left turn via
right of centerline, up to 40' AGL/1708' MSL. Pole 1365'
from DER, 600' right of centerline, 59' AGL/1679' MSL. VORTAC before proceeding on course. Rwy 30,
Tree 3791' from DER, 700' right of centerline, 40' AGL/ L2
1639' MSL. Rwy 25, tree 37' from DER, 479' left of
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE
Rwy 5, bush 17' from PROCEDURES
centerline, 40' AGL/1528' MSL. Tree 86' from DER, 461'
NOTE: departure end of runway, 67'
S E
R-250 to ECA VORTAC before proceeding on course.

U
10266 right of centerline, 40' AGL/1532' MSL. Fence 301' from right of centerline, 6' AGL/52' MSL. Rwy 12, multiple

L
DER, 244' right of centerline, 8' AGL/1508' MSL. Trees trees and bush beginning 240' from departure end of

A
beginning
AUBURN, 660' from DER, 249' right of centerline, up to
CA BISHOP,
runway,CA 286' right of centerline, up to 39' AGL/76' MSL.
40' AGL/1559' MSL.

U
AUBURN MUNI (AUN) Rwy 30, multiple
EASTERN SIERRA poles, building, and terrain beginning
RGNL

T
AMDT 1 10098 (FAA) 66' from departure
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: end of runway,
Rwys 228' left
7,12,16, NA.ofRwys
centerline,
25,
BEALE AFB (KBAB)

C
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 7, 300-1 w/ min. climb of 30,34, 4000-2 or std. withMultiple
up to 65' AGL/225' MSL. polesofbeginning
a min. climb 949'
350' per NM to
MARYSVILLE,
385' per NM to CA.
2300,.or. 1100-3
. . . . .for.climb
.ORIG, 09155 from departure end of runway, 28' right of centerline, up

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010 A

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


in visual 9000.
to 42' AGL/103' MSL.
conditions. PROCEDURE: Rwy 15, Climb on a
DEPARTURE DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwys 25,30, turn right.

OR
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 7, climbingRwy 33,
left turn Rwy 34, turn left, climb northwestbound to 13000 via BIH
CHICO,
R-322CA
to NIKOL Int.

TF
DER.VOR/DME, then via MYV VOR/DME R-263 to
MYV CHICO MUNI
TAKE-OFF
YUBBA INT OBSTACLES: Rwy 33,
before proceeding on course, or for climb BYRON, CA PROCEDURE: Rwys 13L/R, climbing
DEPARTURE
in visual conditions: cross Auburn Muni airport at or right turn. Rwys 31L/R, climbing left turn. All aircraft,
BYRON

NO
climb via CIC
TAKE-OFF R-205 to JINGO
MINIMUMS: Rwy 23,Int.NA-obstacles.
Aircraft departing
MYV VOR/DME R-094 to MYV VOR/DME, then via Rwy 30, 200-1 or std. with a min. climb of 240' per NM to
BECKWOURTH,
MYV VOR/DME R-263 CA to YUBBA INT before

E
300. Alternatively, with standard take-off minimums and a
proceeding on course. Rwy 25, climbing right turn to

L
NERVINO inbound)
normal to depart
200'/NM JINGO
climb Int at or
gradient, above must
take-off 2800.occur no

P
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwys 7, 25, 3500-3 for climb in later than 2000' prior to departure end of runway.
MYV VOR/DME,
visual conditions. then via MYV VOR/DME R-263 to CLOVERDALE,
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE:CA Rwy 5, climbing right turn

AM
YUBBA INT before
DEPARTURE proceedingRwys
PROCEDURE: on course.
7, 25, for climb in
NOTE: Rwy 7, trees beginning 1117' from
CLOVERDALE MUNI
visual conditions: cross Nervino Airport at DER, 504'
or above proceedingon
TAKE-OFF course. Rwy
MINIMUMS: Rwy 12, climbing
14, left
400-2 or turn
std. viaa
with

S
right of
8300 centerline,
before up to 40'
proceeding AGL/1708' MSL. Pole 1365'
on course. min. climb of 280' per NM to 1500, then a min. climb of
from DER,
NOTE: Rwy600' right
7, road 58'offrom
centerline,
departure59'end
AGL/1679'
of runway,MSL. VORTAC before proceeding course. Rwy 30,
260' per NM to 3900. Rwy 32,on NA.
Treeright
469' 3791'offrom DER, 700'
centerline, right of centerline,
15' AGL/4920' MSL. Pole 40' AGL/
310' DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 14, climb direct STS
from MSL. Rwy
1639'departure 25,
end of tree 37' from
runway, 522'DER,
right of479' left of
centerline, R-250 to ECA VORTAC before proceeding on(NW
course.
VOR/DME. Continue climb in holding pattern
centerline,
49' AGL/4925'40' AGL/1528'
MSL. Pole 528'MSL.from
Tree 86' from DER,
departure end of461' NOTE: Rwy 5, bush 17' from departure end of runway, 67'

Figure 1-18. Examples of takeoff minimums obstacle clearance.

Takeoff distance Takeoff flight path Climb

1,500 ft

First Second Third Final


seg. segment segment segment
Regulatory
performance
reduction

35 ft

35 ft

35 ft

BR VEF V1 VR VLOF V2 Acceleration VFTO

N One engine inoperative

Figure 1-19. Part 25 turbine-powered, transport category airplane OEI actual (gross) takeoff flight path and OEI net takeoff flight path.

operated under Part 121 or Part 135 have additional takeoff Part 25 transport category and Part 23 commuter category
obstacle clearance requirements beyond the scope of the airplane certification rules define the one-engine-
IFR departure procedure requirements addressed by TERPS. inoperative (OEI) takeoff flight path, which is normally
constructed from a series of segments beginning from 35

1-19
feet above the runway surface at the end of the OEI takeoff also account for clearance of the low, close-in obstacles
distance and ending at a minimum height of 1,500 feet that are noted on the IFR departure procedure, but are not
above the runway elevation. However, the OEI net takeoff necessarily cleared when complying with the TERPS-based
flight path assessment may continue above 1,500 feet if IFR climb gradient.
necessary to ensure obstacle clearance.
The OEI net takeoff flight path is unique for each airplane
The actual, or gross, OEI flight path represents the vertical type and is assessed on each takeoff for the required
OEI climb profile that the airplane has been demonstrated obstacle clearance directly against those obstacles located
capable of achieving using takeoff procedures developed beneath the OEI flight track and within the prescribed
for line operations based on the airplanes weight, lateral distance from the flight path centerline. TERPS, on
configuration, and environmental conditions at the time the other hand, provides a required climb gradient that
of takeoff. The OEI net takeoff flight path represents the represents a surface that the aircrafts all-engines-operating
actual OEI takeoff flight path that has been degraded by climb profile must remain above throughout the IFR
an amount specified by the certification rules to provide climb until reaching the en route environment. These two
a safety margin for expected variations under operational methods of assessing obstacle clearance are necessarily
conditions. Subpart I of Part 121 and Part 135 require that quite different. TERPS is used by the procedure designer
the OEI net takeoff flight path be at least 35 feet above to determine a lateral path that is usable by a wide variety
obstacles that are located within the prescribed lateral of aircraft types, and establishes a clearance plane that
distance either side of the flight path The actual obstacle aircraft must be able to stay above to fly the procedure. A
clearance capability, under optimum conditions after Part 25 transport category and Part 23 commuter category
experiencing an engine failure on takeoff, is equal to the airplanes OEI takeoff flight path is established by or on
difference between gross and net flight path, plus the behalf of the operator for a particular aircraft type and then
additional 35 feet. [Figure 1-19] limit weights are determined that assure clearance of any
obstacles under that flight path (or within the prescribed
Advisory Circular (AC) 120-91, Airport Obstacle Analysis, lateral distance from the flight path centerline).
provides guidance and acceptable criteria for use in
determining the safe lateral clearance from obstacles, when It may be necessary for pilots and operators of these
developing takeoff and initial climb out airport obstacle categories of airplanes to use the services of an aircraft
analyses and engine out obstacle avoidance procedures to performance engineer or airport/runway analysis service
comply with the intent of these regulatory requirements. provider as means of compliance with the requirements
Pilots departing an airport under IFR and operating under of Part 121 subpart I, or Part 135 subpart I concerning
Part 121 or 135 are required by 14 CFR 91.175(f )(4) to OEI net takeoff flight obstacle clearance and takeoff field
use an engine-inoperative takeoff obstacle clearance length requirements. [Figure 1-20] Airport/runway analysis
or avoidance procedure that assures compliance with involves the complex, usually computerized, computations
the obstacle clearance requirements (subpart I) of those of aircraft performance, using extensive airport/obstacle
rules. The assessment of OEI takeoff obstacle clearance is databases and terrain information. This yields maximum
separate and independent of the IFR departure procedure allowable takeoff and landing weights for particular
and associated all-engines- operating climb gradient aircraft/engine configurations for a specific airport, runway,
requirements. While the Part 91 operating rules governing and range of temperatures. The computations also consider
large and turbine-powered airplanes and commuter flap settings, various aircraft characteristics, runway
category airplanes do not require the use of an OEI takeoff conditions, obstacle clearance, and weather conditions.
obstacle clearance or avoidance procedure, such use is Obstacle data also is available from these service providers
encouraged for Part 91 operators of these airplanes. for operators who desire to perform their own analysis
using the OEI climb performance and flight path data
Unlike TERPS, which assesses obstacle clearance beginning furnished in the Airplane Flight Manual or when using an
at the DER, the OEI net takeoff flight path obstacle aircraft electronic performance program supplied by the
assessment begins at the point where the aircraft reaches manufacturer or other service provider.
35 feet above the runway at the end of the OEI takeoff Airport/runway analysis is typically based on the
distance. Therefore, the OEI net takeoff flight path assumption that the pilot will fly a straight-out departure
assessment may begin before the DER allowing for the following an engine failure on takeoff. However, when a
use of a portion of the runway for the OEI climb. The OEI straight-out departure is not practical or recommended,
net takeoff flight path obstacle clearance assessment must a special OEI turn procedure can be developed for each

1-20
Sample Aircraft KAPA/APA
Runway Conditions: Dry Engine Type
Flaps 0 Denver - Centennial
Elevation = 5883 ft Max Structural Takeoff Weight Limit = 28000
Runways - lbs SEC.
OAT N1 A/1 SEG.
10 17L 17R 28 35L 35R
F C ON CLIMB
50 10 98.91 97.11 21880 R 29380 C 25250 R 21210 R 26690 R 29460 C 29000
52 11 98.73 21750 R 29340 C 25070 R 21090 R 26500 R 29460 C 29000
54 12 98.56 21620 R 29190 C 24900 R 20950 R 26310 R 29460 C 29000
55 13 98.47 21550 R 29100 C 24820 R 20890 R 26210 R 29460 C 29000
57 14 98.29 21420 R 28950 O 24650 R 20750 R 26020 R 29460 C 29000
59 15 98.11 21290 R 28790 O 24490 R 20620 R 25830 R 29460 C 29000
61 16 97.95 21160 R 28620 O 24320 R 20490 R 25650 R 29360 C 29000
63 17 97.80 21020 R 28450 O 24160 R 20360 R 25460 R 29210 C 29000
64 18 97.72 20960 R 28360 O 24080 R 20300 R 25370 R 29120 C 29000
66 19 97.56 20820 R 28170 O 23930 R 20170 R 25180 R 28870 R 29000
68 20 97.40 20670 R 27980 O 23770 R 20030 R 25000 R 28630 R 28930
70 21 97.20 20530 R 27720 O 23610 R 19880 R 24810 R 28380 R 28630
72 22 97.00 20380 R 27460 O 23420 O 19740 R 24630 R 28110 R 28330
73 23 96.90 20310 R 27370 R 23340 O 19670 R 24530 R 27970 R 28180
75 24 96.70 20170 R 27110 R 23170 O 19530 R 24350 R 27690 R 27870
77 25 96.50 20020 R 26860 R 22990 O 19390 R 24150 R 27390 R 27570
79 26 96.24 19880 R 26590 R 22810 O 19240 R 23960 R 27100 R 27230
81 27 95.97 19710 R 26330 R 22630 O 19070 R 23760 R 26800 R 26890
82 28 95.84 19630 R 26190 R 22540 O 18990 R 23660 R 26650 R 26720
84 29 95.58 19460 R 25920 R 22320 O 18820 R 23460 R 26350 R 26380
86 30 95.31 19290 R 25610 R 22120 O 18650 R 23260 R 26050 C 26040
88 31 95.04 19130 R 25300 R 21930 O 18490 R 23070 R 25740 C 25690
90 32 94.77 18980 R 24990 R 21730 O 0R 22870 R 25440 C 25350
91 33 94.64 18900 R 24840 R 21630 O 0R 22770 R 25290 C 25180
93 34 94.37 18740 R 24530 R 21440 O 0R 22570 R 24990 C 24830
95 35 94.10 18590 R 24220 R 21240 O 0R 22380 R 24690 C 24490
Length = ft 4800 10002 7000 4800 7000 10002 ---
RUNWAY DIM
Slope = % 0.62 0.9 0.93 0.62 0.93 0.9 ---
LVLOFF ALT ft 7383 7383 7383 7383 7383 7383 ---
lbs/kt hw 67 5 31 62 42 4 ---
WIND CORR
lbs/kt tw N/A 254 227 N/A 223 131 ---
lbs/.1"Hg > 29.92 75 10 85 0 88 5 0
QNH
lbs/.1"Hg < 29.92 87 127 99 86 113 114 123
ANTI-ICE lbs 1210 1400 1480 1180 1690 830 70
LIMIT CODES R = RUNWAY LIMIT O = OBSTACLE LIMIT B = BRAKE LIMIT C = CLIMB LIMIT

DATE: 07/01/2011
FOR SAMPLE USE ONLY
Figure 1-20. Airport/runway analysis example.

1-21
applicable runway. This OEI turn procedure may follow track of the OEI special procedure and the IFR departure
the path of a published IFR departure procedure or it may procedure are identical.
follow an independent path designed to avoid otherwise
onerous obstacles and thereby maximize the allowable Categories of Departure Procedures
takeoff weight and payload. Graphic depiction of the OEI There are two types of DPs: those developed to assist
procedure is often available to give the pilot a pictorial pilots in obstruction avoidance, known as ODPs, printed
representation of the special OEI procedure. An engine either textually or graphically, and those developed
failure during takeoff is a non-normal condition, and to communicate ATC clearances, SIDs, always printed
therefore the actions taken by the pilot including the use graphically.
of an OEI turn procedure takes precedence over noise
abatement, air traffic, SIDs, DPs, and other normal operating Obstacle Departure Procedures (ODPs)
considerations. The term ODP is used to define procedures that simply
provide obstacle clearance. ODPs are only used for
It must be understood that the airport/runway analysis obstruction clearance and do not include ATC related
assesses obstacle clearance using the OEI net takeoff flight climb requirements. In fact, the primary emphasis of ODP
path data provided in the Airplane Flight Manual and the design is to use the least restrictive route of flight to the
selected lateral obstacle assessment area. A takeoff weight en route structure or to facilitate a climb to an altitude
limit provided on the analysis does not necessarily ensure that allows random (diverse) IFR flight, while attempting
compliance with the all-engines-operating climb gradient to accommodate typical departure routes.
published on an IFR departure procedure even if the

E
L9

S
LU
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE PROCEDURES
10266

U A
CT
PUEBLO, CO RIFLE, CO

A
PUEBLO MEMORIAL (PUB) GARFIELD COUNTY RGNL (RIL)
AMDT 4 09295 (FAA) AMDT 8 08157

OR
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 35, 300-1 or standard w/ TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 8, std. w/ a min. climb of Obstacle departure procedure
369' per NM to 12400 or 5400-3 for climb in visual

F
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 8L, climb heading

T
conditions.
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 8, DME required.

O
PUB R-040 to PUB VORTAC, continue climb in PUB Climb via RIL R-081 to ZOBAK/10 DME, then climbing

N left turn direct RIL VOR/DME. Climb in RIL VOR/DME

PLE
inbound) to cross PUB VORTAC at or above MEA for
route of flight. Rwy 8R, cross RIL VOR/DME at or above MEA/MCA before
proceeding en route, or for climb in visual conditions

M
PUB VORTAC, continue climb in PUB VORTAC cross Garfield County Rgnl Airport at or above 10800

SA
before proceeding on course. Rwy 26, use SQUAT
cross PUB VORTAC at or above MEA for route of flight. RNAV DEPARTURE.
Rwy 17, NOTE: Rwy 8, transmission line towers beginning 1.2 NM
turn via heading 050 and PUB R-180 to PUB VORTAC, from departure end of runway, 437' right of centerline, up
continue climb in PUB VORTAC holding pattern (hold to 150' AGL/6069' MSL. Trees beginning 1.9 NM from
departure end of runway, 647' right of centerline, up to
Denotes either takeoff
at or above minimums
MEA for route of flight.orRwy
an26L,
obstacle
climb departure100'
procedure
AGL/5983' published in the front
MSL. Terrain beginning of the TPP.
124' from

N
departure end of runway, 287' right of centerline, up to

O
5863' MSL. Pole 1083' from departure end of runway,

I
in PUB VORTAC holding pattern (hold NE, right turns, 656' right of centerline, 28' AGL/5588' MSL.

AT
for route of flight. Rwy 26R, ROSWELL, NM

IG
ROSWELL INTL AIR CENTER
to PUB VORTAC, continue climb in PUB VORTAC

V
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 30, climb to 6000 via

A
runway heading to intercept CME R-323, upon reaching
cross PUB VORTAC at or above MEA for route of flight.
6000 proceed on course. Rwy 35, climbing left turn to

N
Rwy 35,
23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

R
reaching 6000 proceed on course.
continue climb in PUB VORTAC holding pattern (hold

O RUIDOSO, NM

TF
at or above MEA for route of flight.
NOTE: Rwy 8L, rising terrain 57' from DER, 123' left of SIERRA BLANCA RGNL
centerline, up to 4649' MSL. Rwy 8R, rising terrain 180' TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwys 6,24, 5200-3 or std. with a

NO
from DER, 58' left of centerline, up to 4659' MSL. min. climb of 420' per NM to 12,100'.
Rwy 26L, rising terrain 110' from DER, 182' right of DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 6, climb at 385' per
centerline, up to 4659' MSL, rising terrain 128' from NM to 9100' direct CEP NDB, continue climb in holding
DER, 122' left of centerline, up to 4659' MSL. Rwy 26R,
rising terrain 208' from DER, 446' right of centerline, up NDB at or above the MEA for direction of flight. *Do not
to 4679' MSL. Rwy 35, exceed 230 kts in holding pattern. Rwy 24, immediate
of centerline, up to 4749' MSL, rising terrain 196' from climbing left turn to 9100' direct CEP NDB, continue
DER, 11' right of centerline, up to 4793' MSL,

Figure 1-21. Graphic ODP/booklet front matter.

1-22
An ODP must be developed when obstructions penetrate the flight plan and initial headings. Considering the forecast
the 40:1 departure OCS, as described in Order 8260.3, weather, departure runways, and existing ODP, plan the
Volume 4 TERPS. Only one ODP will be established for flight route, climb performance, and fuel burn accordingly
a particular runway. This is considered the default IFR to compensate for the departure procedure.
departure procedure for a given runway and is intended
for pilot awareness and use in the absence of ATC radar Additionally, when close-in obstacles are noted in the
vectors or SID assignment. Text is not published to allow Takeoff Minimums and (Obstacle) Departure Procedures
an option to use a SID or alternate maneuver assigned by section, it may require the pilot to take action to avoid these
ATC (e.g., Climb runway heading to 1200 before turning obstacles. Consideration must be given to decreased climb
or use Manchester Departure or Turn right, climb direct performance from an inoperative engine or to the amount
ABC very high frequency (VHF) omnidirectional range of runway used for takeoff. Aircraft requiring a short takeoff
(VOR) or as assigned by ATC.). ODPs are textual in nature. roll on a long runway may have little concern. On the other
However, due to the complex nature of some procedures, hand, airplanes that use most of the available runway for
a visual presentation may be necessary for clarification and takeoff may not have the standard ROC when climbing at
understanding. If the ODP is charted graphically, the chart the normal 200 FPNM.
itself includes the word Obstacle in parentheses in the title.
Additionally, all newly-developed RNAV ODPs are issued in Another factor to consider is the possibility of an
graphical form. engine failure during takeoff and departure. During the
preflight planning, use the aircraft performance charts
All ODPs are listed in the front of the AeroNav Products to determine if the aircraft can still maintain the required
approach chart booklets under the heading Takeoff climb performance. For high performance aircraft, an
Minimums and Obstacle Departure Procedures. Each engine failure may not impact the ability to maintain the
procedure is listed in alphabetical order by city and state. prescribed climb gradients. Aircraft that are performance
The ODP listing in the front of the booklet includes a limited may have diminished capability and may be unable
reference to the graphic chart located in the main body of to maintain altitude, let alone complete a climb to altitude.
the booklet if one exists. [Figure 1-21] Based on the performance expectations for the aircraft,
construct an emergency plan of action that includes
ODP Flight Planning Considerations emergency checklists and the actions to take to ensure
ODPs are not assigned by ATC unless absolutely necessary safety in this situation.
to achieve aircraft separation. It is the pilots responsibility
to determine if there is an ODP published for that airport. If a Standard Instrument Departures (SIDs)
Part 91 pilot is not given a clearance containing an ODP, SID, A SID is an ATC-requested and developed departure route,
or radar vectors and an ODP exists, compliance with such typically used in busy terminal areas. It is designed at the
a procedure is the pilots choice. A graphic ODP may also request of ATC in order to increase capacity of terminal
be filed in an instrument flight plan by using the computer airspace, effectively control the flow of traffic with minimal
code included in the procedure title. As a technique, the communication, and reduce environmental impact
pilot may enter will depart (airport) (runway) via textual through noise abatement procedures.
ODP in the remarks section of the flight plan. Providing
this information to the controller clarifies the intentions While obstacle protection is always considered in SID
of the pilot and helps prevent a potential pilot/controller routing, the primary goal is to reduce ATC/pilot workload
misunderstanding. If the ODP is not included in the pilots while providing seamless transitions to the en route
clearance, the pilot should inform ATC when an ODP is structure. ATC clearance must be received prior to flying
used for departure from a runway so that ATC can ensure a SID. SIDs also provide additional benefits to both the
appropriate traffic separation. airspace capacity and the airspace users by reducing
radio congestion, allowing more efficient airspace use,
During planning, pilots need to determine whether or and simplifying departure clearances. All of the benefits
not the departure airport has an ODP. Remember, an ODP combine to provide effective, efficient terminal operations,
can only be established at an airport that has instrument thereby increasing the overall capacity of the NAS.
approach procedures (IAPs). An ODP may drastically affect If you cannot comply with a SID, if you do not possess the
the initial part of the flight plan. Pilots may have to depart charted SID procedure, or if you simply do not wish to
at a higher than normal climb rate, or depart in a direction use SIDs, include the statement NO SIDs in the remarks
opposite the intended heading and maintain that for a section of your flight plan. Doing so notifies ATC that they
period of time, any of which would require an alteration in cannot issue you a clearance containing a SID, but instead

1-23
1-24
SC-5, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

Figure 1-22. SID chart.


NO
T
SC-5, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010
FO
R
NA
VI
SC-5, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010
G
AT
IO
N
SC-5, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010
N
IO
AT
G
Departure code

VI
NA College Station Transition instructions
SC-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

SC-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


R

Basic departure computer code


FO
T

N
NO

IO
End of basic SID and beginning of transition route

AT
G
VI
NA
SC-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

SC-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


R
FO
T
NO

End of transition route

Figure 1-23. Transition routes as depicted on SID.

1-25
will clear you via your filed route to the extent possible, is not involved. The procedure sets forth an initial set of
or via a Preferential Departure Route (PDR). It should be departure instructions that typically include an initial
noted that SID usage not only decreases clearance delivery heading and altitude. ATC must have radar contact with
time, but also greatly simplifies your departure, easing you the aircraft to be able to provide vectors. ATC expects
into the IFR structure at a desirable location and decreases you to immediately comply with radar vectors, and they
your flight management load. While you are not required expect you to notify them if you are unable to fulfill their
to depart using a SID, it may be more difficult to receive request. ATC also expects you to make contact immediately
an as filed clearance when departing busy airports that if an instruction causes you to compromise safety due to
frequently use SID routing. obstructions or traffic.

SIDs are always charted graphically and are located in the It is prudent to review radar SID charts prior to use because
TPP after the last approach chart for an airport. The SID this type of procedure often includes nonstandard
may be one or two pages in length, depending on the size lost communication procedures. If you were to lose
of the graphic and the amount of space required for the radio contact while being vectored by ATC, you would
departure description. Each chart depicts the departure be expected to comply with the lost communication
route, navigational fixes, transition routes, and required procedure as outlined on the chart, not necessarily those
altitudes. The departure description outlines the particular procedures outlined in the AIM. [Figure 1-25]
procedure for each runway. [Figure 1-22]
SID Flight Planning Considerations
Transition Routes Take into consideration the departure paths included in
Charted transition routes allow pilots to transition from the the SIDs, and determine if you can use a standardized
end of the basic SID to a location in the en route structure. departure procedure. You have the opportunity to choose
Typically, transition routes fan out in various directions the SID that best suits your flight plan. During the flight
from the end of the basic SID to allow pilots to choose planning phase, you can investigate each departure,
the transition route that takes them in the direction of and determine which procedure allows you to depart
intended departure. A transition route includes a course, the airport in the direction of your intended flight. Also
a minimum altitude, and distances between fixes on the consider how a climb gradient to a specific altitude affects
route. When filing a SID for a specific transition route, the climb time and fuel burn portions of the flight plan.
include the transition in the flight plan, using the correct Notes giving procedural requirements are listed on the
departure and transition code. ATC also assigns transition graphic portion of a departure procedure, and they are
routes as a means of putting the flight on course to the mandatory in nature. [Figure 1-26] Mandatory procedural
destination. In any case, the pilot must receive an ATC notes may include:
clearance for the departure and the associated transition, Aircraft equipment requirements (DME, ADF, etc.)
and the clearance from ATC will include both the departure
name and transition (e.g., Joe Pool Nine Departure, College ATC equipment in operation (radar)
Station Transition). [Figure 1-23] Minimum climb requirements
Restrictions for specific types of aircraft (turbojet only)
The SID is designed to allow the pilot to provide his or
Limited use to certain destinations
her own navigation with minimal radio communication.

This type of procedure usually contains an initial set of
Cautionary statements may also be included on the
departure instructions followed by one or more transition
procedure to notify you of specific activity, but these are
routes. A SID may include an initial segment requiring
strictly advisory. [Figure 1-26] If you are unable to comply
radar vectors to help the flight join the procedure, but the
with a specific requirement, you must not file the procedure
majority of the navigation remains the pilots responsibility.
as part of your flight plan. If ATC assigns you a SID, you may
[Figure 1-24]
need to quickly recalculate your all-engines-operating
performance numbers. If you cannot comply with the
A radar SID usually requires ATC to provide radar vectors
climb gradient in the SID, you should not accept a clearance
from just after takeoff (ROC is based on a climb to 400 feet
for that SID and furthermore, you must not accept the
above the DER elevation before making the initial turn)
procedure if ATC assigns it.
until reaching the assigned route or a fix depicted on the
SID chart. Radar SIDs do not include departure routes or
transition routes because independent pilot navigation

1-26
N
I O
Initial departure instructions
A T
Specific lost communications
I G
V
procedure for this departure

N A
R
FO
Transition route instructions

SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


T
Communication frequencies
N O
SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010
Procedure computer code

Procedure name

N
Routing information including direction,
altitude, and distance to the next fix.

T I O
G A
V I
NA
O R
T F
NO SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

City and state location and airport name

Figure 1-24. Example of a common SID at Denver, Colorado.

1-27
Initial departure instructions

Lost communications procedure


specific to this departure

SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

O N
SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

TI

SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


En route chart reference

G A
V I
N A
R
Departure airport

F O
T
NO
SW-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

Figure 1-25. Example of a radar SID at Denver, Colorado.

ATC can assign SIDs or radar vectors as necessary for traffic required for the procedure.
management and convenience. To fly a SID, you must Possession of the charted SID procedure.
receive approval to do so in a clearance. In order to accept
a clearance that includes a SID, you must have the charted Personal understanding of the SID in its entirety.
SID procedure in your possession at the time of departure.
It is your responsibility as pilot in command to accept or When you accept a clearance to depart using a SID or
reject the issuance of a SID by ATC. You must accept or radar vectors, ATC is responsible for traffic separation.
reject the clearance based on: When departing with a SID, ATC expects you to fly the
procedure as charted because the procedure design
considers obstacle clearance. It is also expected that you
The ability to comply with the required performance. will remain vigilant in scanning for traffic when departing
The ability to navigate to the degree of accuracy in visual conditions. Furthermore, it is your responsibility

1-28
ION

ION
IGAT

IGAT
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

NAV

SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


SE-3, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

NAV

SE-3, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


FOR

O N
FOR T I
GA
V I
NOT

NA
CAUTION:
intensive

R
NOT

glider activity

F O
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2

T
O 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

N
Figure 1-26. Departure procedure notes and cautionary statements.

to notify ATC if your clearance would endanger your safety systems (FMS) are certified to fly a non-RNAV DP
or the safety of others. if the FMS unit accepts inputs from conventional
avionics sources, such as DME, VOR, and localizer
DPs are also categorized by equipment requirements (LOC). These inputs include radio tuning and may
as follows: be applied to a navigation solution one at a time or
Non-RNAV DPestablished for aircraft equipped in combination. Some FMS provide for the detection
with conventional avionics using ground-based and isolation of faulty navigation information.
NAVAIDs. These DPs may also be designed using dead RNAV DPestablished for aircraft equipped with
reckoning navigation. Some flight management

1-29
RNAV avionics (e.g., GPS, VOR/DME, DME/DME). future, there will be an increased dependence on the
Automated vertical navigation is not required, use of RNAV in lieu of routes defined by ground-based
and all RNAV procedures not requiring GPS must NAVAIDs. As a part of the evolving RNAV structure, the
be annotated with the note: RADAR REQUIRED. FAA has developed departure procedures for pilots flying
Prior to using TSO-C129 GPS equipment for RNAV aircraft equipped with some type of RNAV technology.
departures, approach receiver autonomous integrity RNAV allows for the creation of new departure routes
monitoring (RAIM) availability should be checked for that are independent of present fixes and NAVAIDs. RNAV
that location. routing is part of the National Airspace Redesign (NAR)and
Radar DPradar may be used for navigation is expected to reduce complexity and increase efficiency
guidance for SID design. Radar SIDs are established of terminal airspace.
when ATC has a need to vector aircraft on departure
to a particular ATS Route, NAVAID, or fix. A fix may When new RNAV departure procedures are designed,
be a ground-based NAVAID, a waypoint, or defined they will require minimal vectoring and communications
by reference to one or more radio NAVAIDs. Not all between pilots and ATC. Usually, each departure procedure
fixes are waypoints since a fix could be a VOR or VOR/ includes position, time, and altitude, which increase
DME, but all waypoints are fixes. Radar vectors may the ability to predict what the pilot will actually do.
also be used to join conventional or RNAV navigation RNAV departure procedures have the ability to increase
SIDs. SIDs requiring radar vectors must be annotated the capacity of terminal airspace by increasing on-
RADAR REQUIRED. time departures, airspace utilization, and improved
predictability.

Area Navigation (RNAV) Departures All public RNAV SIDs and graphic ODPs are RNAV 1. These
Historically, departure procedures were built around procedures generally start with an initial RNAV or heading
existing ground-based technology and were typically leg near the departure end runway. In addition, these
designed to accommodate lower traffic volumes. Often, procedures require system performance currently met
departure and arrival routes use the same NAVAIDs creating by GPS, DME/DME/Inertial Reference Unit (IRU) RNAV
interdependent, capacity diminishing routes. RNAV is a systems that satisfy the criteria discussed in AC 90-100, U.S.
method of navigation that permits aircraft operation on Terminal and En Route Area Navigation (RNAV) Operations.
any desired flight path within the coverage of ground- or RNAV departures are identifiable by the inclusion of the
spaced- based NAVAIDs or within the limits of the capability term RNAV in the title of the departure. From a required
of self-contained aids or a combination of these. In the navigation performance (RNP) standpoint, RNAV departure
2.0 NM
1.0 NM
1.0 NM

Path centerline
2.0 NM

Figure 1-27. RNP departure levels.

1-30
FAA Flight Plan Aircraft Suffixes ICAO Flight Plan Equipment Codes
Suffix Equipment Capability Radio communication, navigation and approach
NO DME aid equipment and capabilities

/X No transponder N if no COM/NAV/approach aid equipment for the route to be


/T Transponder with no Mode C flown is carried, or the equipment is unserviceable, OR S if
standard COM/NAV/ approach aid equipment for the route to be
/U Transponder with Mode C flown is carried and serviceable (see Note 1), AND/OR INSERT
DME one or more of the following letters to indicate the serviceable
/D No transponder COM/NAV/approach aid equipment and capabilities available:

/B Transponder with no Mode C A GBAS landing system


/A Transponder with Mode C B LPV (APV with SBAS)
TACAN ONLY C LORAN C
/M No transponder D DME
/N Transponder with no Mode C E1 FMC WPR ACARS
/P Transponder with Mode C E2 D-FIS ACARS
AREA NAVIGATION (RNAV) E3 PDC ACARS
/Y LORAN, VOR/DME, or INS with no transponder F ADF
/C LORAN, VOR/DME, or INS, transponder with no G GNSS (See Note 2)
Mode C H HF RTF
/I LORAN, VOR/DME, or INS, transponder with I Intertial Navigation
Mode C J1 CPDLC ATN VDL Mode 2 (See Note 3)
ADVANCED RNAV WITH TRANSPONDER AND J2 CPDLC FANS 1/A HFDL
MODE C (If an aircraft is unable to operate with a J3 CPDLC FANS 1/A VDL Mode 4
transponder and/or Mode C, it will revert to the J4 CPDLC FANS 1/A VDL Mode 2
appropriate code listed above under Area J5 CPDLC FANS 1/A SATCOM (INMARSAT)
Navigation.) J6 CPDLC FANS 1/A SATCOM (MTSAT)
/E Flight Management System (FMS) with DME/DME J7 CPDLC FANS 1/A SATCOM (Iridium)
and IRU position updating K MLS
/F Flight Management System (FMS) with DME/DME L ILS
position updating M1 OmegaATC RTF SATCOM
/G Global Navigation Satellite System (GNSS), M2 ATC RTF (MTSAT)
including GPS or WAAS, with en route and M3 ATC RTF (Iridium)
terminal capability. O VOR
/R Required Navigational Performance (RNP). The P1 - P9 Reserved for RCP
aircraft meets the RNP type prescribed for the R PBN approved (see Note 4)
route segment(s), route(s), and/or area concerned. T TACAN
Reduced Vertical Separation Minimum (RVSM). U UHF RTF
Prior to conducting RVSM operations within the V VHF RTF
U.S., the operator must obtain authorization from W RVSM approved
the FAA or from the responsible authority, as X MNPS approved
appropriate. Y VHF with 8.33 kHz channel spacing capability
/J /E with RVSM Z Other equipment carried or other capabilities
/K /F with RVSM (see Note 5)
/L /G with RVSM Any alphanumeric characters not indicated above are reserved.
/Q /R with RVSM Effective September 1, 2005
/W RVSM

Figure 1-28. Flight plan equipment codes (continued on next page).

1-31
ICAO Flight Plan Equipment Codes NOTE
Note 1 If the letter S is used, standard equipment is considered
Surveillance equipment and capabilities
to be VHF RTF, VOR and ILS, unless another combina-
INSERT N if no surveillance equipment for the route to be flown
is carried, or the equipment is unserviceable, OR INSERT one or tion is prescribed by the appropriate ATS authority.
more of the following descriptors, to a maximum of 20 characters, Note 2 If the letter G is used, the types of external GNSS
to describe the serviceable surveillance equipment carriedand/or
augmentation, if any, are specified in Item 18 following
capabilities on board:
the indicator NAV/ and separated by a space.
SSR Modes A and C
Note 3 See RTCA/EUROCAE Interoperability Requirements
A Transponder - Mode A (4 digits - 4,096 codes)
Standard For ATN Baseline 1 (ATN B1 INTEROP Standard
C Transponder - Mode A (4 digits - 4,096 codes) and
DO-280B/ED-110B) for data link services air traffic
Mode C
control clearance and information/air traffic control
SSR Modes S
communications management/air traffic control
E TransponderMode S, including aircraft identification,
microphone check.
pressure-altitude and extended squitter (ADS-B)
Note 4 Information on navigation capability is provided to
capability
ATC for clearance and routing purposes.
H TransponderMode S, including aircraft identification,
Note 5 If the letter Z is used, specify in Item 18 the other
pressure-altitude and enhanced surveillance capability
equipment carried or other capabilities, preceded
I TransponderMode S, including aircraft identification,
by COM/, NAV/ and/or DAT, as appropriate.
but no pressure-altitude capability
Note 6 If the letter R is used, the performance based naviga-
L TransponderMode S, including aircraft identification,
tion levels that can be met are specified in Item 18
pressure-altitude, extended squitter (ADS-B) and
following the indicator PBN/. Guidance material on the
enhanced surveillance capability
application of performance based navigation to a
P TransponderMode S, including pressure-altitude, but
specific route segment, route or area is contained in
no aircraft identification capability
the Performance-Based Navigation Manual (Doc 9613).
S TransponderMode S, including both pressure altitude
Note 7 RNAV equipped aircraft capable of flying RNAV SIDs,
and aircraft identification capability
putting NO SID in the remarks section will not always
X Transponder Mode S with neither aircraft
result in a clearance via a Preferential Departure Route
identification nor pressure-altitude capability
(PDR). The Pilot/Dispatcher must amend Field 18 NAV
Note: Enhanced surveillance capability is the ability of the aircraft from D1 to D0 and remove PBRN RNAV1 Code (D1-D4).
to down-link aircraft derived data via a Mode S transponder.
Note 8 If a RNAV DP is filed, an ICAO flight plan must be used.
ADS-B
In Field 18, Pilots/Dispatchers must file a D1 or D2
B1 ADS-B with dedicated 1090 MHz ADS-B out capability
depending on the RNAV DP. Additionally, Field 18
B2 ADS-B with dedicated 1090 MHz ADS-B out and in
should include PBN/D1-D4 depending on the naviga-
capability
tion update source. See AIM/PANS ATM 4444 for ICAO
U1 ADS-B out capability using UAT
filing procedures.
U2 ADS-B out and in capability using UAT
Note 9 RNAV Q-routes require en route RNAV 2, corresponding
V1 ADS-B out capability using VDL Mode 4
NAV/E2 code and PBN/C1-C4 based on navigation
V2 ADS-B out and in capability using VDL Mode 4
system update source.
D1 D1 ADS-C with FANS 1/A capabilities
Note 10 If an aircraft does not meet the requirements for RVSM,
G1 G1 ADS-C with ATN capabilities
then the W filed in ICAO flight plan Field 10A must be
Alphanumeric characters not indicated above are reserved.
removed and STS/NONRVSM must be annotated in
Example: ADE3RV/HB2U2V2G1 Field 18.
Note 11 Filing requirements for RNAV STARS. Field 18 of the
Note: Additional surveillance application should be listed in
Item 18 following the indicator SUR/ . ICAO flight plan must have a NAV/A1 or A2 assigned to
the RNAV STAR. Additionally, PBN/D1-D4 for RNAV1 or
C1-C4 for RNAV2 should be filed. If unable to accept the
RNAV STAR, the flight plan must be amended to change
the NAV/A1 or A2 to A0.

Figure 1-28. Flight plan equipment codes (continued).

1-32
routes are designed with 1 or 2 NM performance standards avoid premature manual deletion of waypoints from their
as listed below. This means you as the pilot and your aircraft active legs page to allow for rejoining procedures. While
equipment must be able to maintain the aircraft within 1 operating on RNAV segments, pilots operating /R aircraft
or 2 NM either side of route centerline. [Figure 1-27] should adhere to any flight manual limitation or operating
procedure required to maintain the RNP value specified for
RNAV 1 procedures require that the aircrafts total the procedure. In 2008, the FAA implemented the use of
system error remain bounded by 1 NM for 95 en route host automation ICAO flight plan (FP) processing
percent of the total flight time. for requesting assignment of RNAV SID, Standard Terminal
Arrivals (STARs), or RNAV routes U.S. domestic airspace.
RNAV 2 requires a total system error of not more than This is part of a risk reduction strategy for introduction of
2 NM for 95 percent of the total flight time. the En Route Automation Modernization (ERAM) system in
October 2008. ERAM also will use ICAO FP processing and as
RNP is RNAV with on-board monitoring and alerting; RNP is a result aircrews should be aware that as the FAA updates to
also a statement of navigation performance necessary for ERAM the standard FAA flight plan equipment suffix codes
operation within defined airspace. RNP-1 (in-lieu-of RNAV- will change to the ICAO flight plan equipment suffix codes.
1) is used when a DP that contains a constant radius to a
fix (RF) leg or when surveillance (radar) monitoring is not For procedures requiring GPS and/or aircraft approvals
desired for when DME/DME/IRU is used. These procedures requiring GPS, if the navigation system does not
are annotated with a standard note: RNP-1. automatically alert the flight crew of a loss of GPS, aircraft
operators must develop procedures to verify correct GPS
If unable to comply with the requirements of an RNAV operation. If not equipped with GPS, or for multi-sensor
or RNP procedure, pilots need to advise ATC as soon as systems with GPS that do not alert upon loss of GPS, aircraft
possible. For example, N1234, failure of GPS system, must be capable of navigation system updating using DME/
unable RNAV, request amended clearance. Pilots are not DME or DME/DME/ IRU for type 1 and 2 procedures. AC 90-
authorized to fly a published RNAV or RNP procedure unless 100 may be used as operational guidance for RNAV ODPs.
it is retrievable by the procedure name from the navigation Pilots of FMS- equipped aircraft who are assigned an RNAV
database and conforms to the charted procedure. No other DP procedure and subsequently receive a change of runway,
modification of database waypoints or creation of user- transition, or procedure, must verify that the appropriate
defined waypoints on published RNAV or RNP procedures changes are loaded and available for navigation.[Figures
is permitted, except to change altitude and/or airspeed 1-29 and 1-30]
waypoint constraints to comply with an ATC clearance/
instruction, or to insert a waypoint along the published Additionally, new waypoint symbols are used in conjunction
route to assist in complying with an ATC instruction. For with RNAV charts. There are two types of waypoints
example, Climb via the WILIT departure except cross 30 currently in use: fly-by (FB) and fly-over (FO). A FB waypoint
north of CHUCK at/ or above FL 210. This is limited only typically is used in a position at which a change in the course
to systems that allow along track waypoint construction. of procedure occurs. Charts represent them with four-
pointed stars. This type of waypoint is designed to allow
Pilots of aircraft utilizing DME/DME for primary navigation you to anticipate and begin your turn prior to reaching the
updating should ensure any required DME stations are in waypoint, thus providing smoother transitions. Conversely,
service as determined by NOTAM, ATIS, or ATC advisory. RNAV charts show a FO waypoint as a four-pointed star
DME/DME navigation system updating may require specific enclosed in a circle. This type of waypoint is used to denote
DME facilities to meet performance standards. Based on a missed approach point, a missed approach holding
DME availability evaluations at the time of publication, point, or other specific points in space that must be flown
current DME coverage is not sufficient to support DME/DME over. [Figure 1-31] Pilots should not change any database
RNAV operations everywhere without IRU augmentation or waypoint type from a FB to FO, or vice versa.
use of GPS. [Figure 1-28] DP chart notes may also include
operational information for certain types of equipment, There are specific requirements, however, that must be met
systems, and performance requirements, in addition to before using RNAV procedures. Every RNAV departure chart
the type of RNAV departure procedure. lists general notes and may include specific equipment and
performance requirements, as well as the type of RNAV
While operating on RNAV segments, pilots are encouraged departure procedure in the chart plan view. New aircraft
to use the flight director in lateral navigation mode. RNAV equipment suffix codes are used to denote capabilities for
terminal procedures may be amended by ATC issuing radar advanced RNAV navigation for flight plan filing purposes.
vectors and/or clearances direct to a waypoint. Pilots should [Figure 1-32]

1-33
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010
Initial departure descriptions from various runways to COWBY waypoint Transition route codes

Secondary departure instructions from COWBY waypoint


SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

O N
T I
G A
Minimum en route altitude (MEA)

I
and minimum obstacle clearance

V
altitude (MOCA)

N A
Departure route heading and distance between waypoint

R
Denotes RNAV
Fly-by (FB) waypoint departure

General notes

F O Minimum altitude restriction

O T
N SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

Figure 1-29. Examples of RNAV SID.

1-34
ON
L12

TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE PROCEDURES

TI
10266

TRAVIS AFB (KSUU) VISALIA, CA


FAIRFIELD, CA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10070 VISALIA MUNI (VIS)
All Rwy: Comply with assigned SID or ATC radar vectors. AMDT 3 09239 (FAA)
TAKE-OFF OBSTACLES: Rwy 3L, DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 12, climbing right

GA
Rwy 30,

right of centerline. Rwy 21L, V23.


NOTE: Rwy 12, tree 774' from DER, 618' right of
centerline, 46' AGL/340' MSL. Tree 1327' from DER,
823' left of centerline, 55' AGL/349' MSL. Rwy 30,
multiple trees beginning 179' from DER, 260' left of
centerline, up to 54' AGL/343' MSL. Antenna on building
285' from DER, 250' right of centerline, 16' AGL/305'
MSL. Truck on road 522' from DER, on centerline, 17'
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 3L, Climb on a AGL/342' MSL. Railroad 690' from DER, 549' left of

VI
Rwy 3R, centerline, 23' AGL/317' MSL. Multiple trees beginning
876' to 3029' from DER, 341' to 461' left of centerline, up
DER. to 90' AGL/379' MSL. Multiple trees beginning 1886'
Takeoff minimums for the departure and obstacles in the departure path from DER, 103' right of centerline, up to 58' AGL/347'
TRUCKEE, CA MSL.
TRUCKEE-TAHOE (TRK)
SW-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

AMDT 4 08269 (FAA) WATSONVILLE, CA


NA

SW-2, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwys 10, 19, NA-obstacles. WATSONVILLE MUNI
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwys 1, 28, use TRUCK TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 2, 1100-2 CAT A,B, 1900-
DEPARTURE. 2 CAT C,D or std. with a min. climb of: CAT A,B 330'
per NM to 2200; CAT C,D 460' per NM to 2400. Rwy 8,
TULARE, CA std. with a min. climb of 290' per NM to 2200. Rwy 20,
MEFFORD FIELD std. with a min. climb of 330' per NM to 2200. Rwy 26,
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 13, climbing right std. with a min. climb of 330' per NM to 2200.
turn. Rwy 31, climbing left turn. All aircraft climb direct DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 2 climbing right turn.
Rwy 20, climb runway heading. Rwy 26, climbing left
23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


to VIS VOR/DME. Aircraft departing VIS R-001 CW
R-140 continue climb in VIS holding pattern (E, right turn. All aircraft
NDB and climb to cross MOVER Int at or above 2200.
4000. All other aircraft climb on course. Climb in MOVER INT holding pattern (NE, right turns,
R

NOTE: Rwy 2, 40' AGL pole 17' from departure end of


UKIAH, CA runway, 340' left of centerline. Rwy 8, 189' AGL tower
UKIAH MUNI ODP charted graphically
4696' from departure end of runway, 1200' right of
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 15, NA. Rwy 33, 300-1 and centerline. Rwy 20,106' AGL tree 954' from departure
min. climb of 350' per NM to 4000. end of runway, 550' left of centerline. Rwy 26, 174' AGL
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Climb to 4000 via heading tree 625' from departure end of runway, 580' left of
FO

centerline.

N
VACAVILLE, CA WILLITS, CA

O
NUT TREE (VCB) ELLS FIELD-WILLITS MUNI

TI
AMDT 4 09127 (FAA) DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 16, use
General notes TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 20, std. w/ min. climb of MENDOCINO RNAV DEPARTURE. Rwy 34, use

A
424' per NM to 1600, or 1200-2 for climb in visual FLUEN RNAV DEPARTURE.
conditions.

VIG
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 2, climbing right turn WILLOWS, CA
to intercept SAC R-242 to SAC VORTAC, to 2000
WILLOWS-GLENN COUNTY (WLW)
before proceeding on course. Rwy 20, climbing left turn
to intercept SAC R-242 to SAC VORTAC, to 2000 AMDT 1A 10182 (FAA)
T

A
before proceeding on course, or, for climb in visual DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 13, climbing right
conditions: cross Nut Tree Airport eastbound at or above turn. Rwy 16, Rwys 31, 34, climbing

N
1300, then climb to 2000 via SAC R-242 to SAC left turn. All aircraft climb direct to MXW VORTAC.
VORTAC, proceed on course. Aircraft departing MXW Vortac R-330 CW R-220, climb
on course. All others continue climb in MXW holding

R
NOTE: Rwy 2, trees beginning 222' from DER, 514' left
NO

of centerline up to 106' AGL/225' MSL. Light pole 337'

FO
from DER, 534' left of centerline, 28' AGL/147' MSL.
Rwy 20, pole 161' from DER, 500' left of centerline, 120' NOTE: Rwy 34, 55' AGL pole 530' from DER, 430' right of
AGL/239' MSL. Trees beginning 269' from DER, 335' centerline. Pole 917' from DER, 404' right of centerline,
left of centerline, up to 117' AGL/236' MSL. Pole 777' 55' AGL/193' MSL.

T
from DER, 436' left of centerline, 119' AGL/238' MSL.

O
Windsock 6' from DER, 166' right of centerline, 8' AGL/
127' MSL. Fence 193' from DER, 202' right of

N
10266 centerline, 3' AGL/122' MSL.

TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE PROCEDURES


SW-2
L12
Departure instructions

Figure 1-30. Examples of RNAV ODP.

1-35
A fly-over (FO) waypoint precludes any turn until the waypoint is overflown.

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
A fly-by (FB) waypoint requires the use of turn
anticipation to avoid overshooting the next segment.

Figure 1-31. Fly-over and fly-by waypoints.

SID Altitudes laterally and vertically on the published SID route.


SID altitudes can be charted in four different ways. The
first are mandatory altitudes, the second, minimum Pilot Responsibility for Use of RNAV Departures
altitudes, the third, maximum altitudes and the fourth is a RNAV usage brings with it multitudes of complications
combination of minimum and maximum altitudes or also as it is being implemented. It takes time to transition,
referred to as block altitudes. Below are examples of how to disseminate information, and to educate current
each will be shown on a SID approach plate. and potential users. As a current pilot using the NAS,
you need to have a clear understanding of the aircraft
Mandatory altitudes 5500
equipment requirements for operating in a given RNP
Minimum altitudes 2300 environment. You must understand the type of navigation
Maximum altitudes 3300 system installed in your aircraft, and furthermore, you
must know how your system operates to ensure that
Combination of minimum and maximum 7000
you can comply with all RNAV requirements. Operational
4600 information should be included in your AFM or its
Some SIDs may still have (ATC) adjacent to a crossing supplements. Additional information concerning how
altitude as shown in Figure 1-33 which implies that the to use your equipment to its fullest capacity, including
crossing altitude is there to support an ATC requirement. how to training, may be gathered from your avionics
A new charting standard has begun a process to remove, manufacturer. If you are in doubt about the operation of
over a period of time, the ATC annotation. The Cowboy your avionics system and its ability to comply with RNAV
Four Departure (RNAV) shown in Figure 1-34 depicts the requirements, contact the FAA directly through your local
new charting standard without ATC annotations. When Flight Standards District Office (FSDO).RNAV departure
necessary, ATC may amend or delete SID crossing altitude procedures are being developed at a rapid pace to provide
restrictions; when doing so, ATC assumes responsibility RNAV capabilities at all airports. With every chart revision
for obstacle clearance until the aircraft is re-established cycle, new RNAV departures are being added for small
1-36
Aircraft system operation requirements

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
F
O T
N
Figure 1-32. Operation requirements for RNAV.

and large airports. These departures are flown in the same For all practical purposes, a radar departure is the easiest
manner as traditional navigation-based departures; pilots type of departure to use. It is also a good alternative to a
are provided headings, altitudes, navigation waypoint, published departure procedure, particularly when none of
and departure descriptions. RNAV SIDs are found in the the available departure procedures are conducive to your
TPP with traditional departure procedures. flight route. However, it is advisable to always maintain a
detailed awareness of your location while you are being
Radar Departures radar vectored by ATC. If for some reason radar contact is
A radar departure is another option for departing an airport lost, you will be asked to provide position reports in order
on an IFR flight. You might receive a radar departure if the for ATC to monitor your flight progress. Also, ATC may
airport does not have an established departure procedure, release you to resume own navigation after vectoring you
if you are unable to comply with a departure procedure, or off course momentarily for a variety of reasons, including
if you request No SIDs as a part of your flight plan. Expect weather or traffic.
ATC to issue an initial departure heading if you are being
radar vectored after takeoff, however, do not expect to Upon initial contact, state your aircraft or flight number,
be given a purpose for the specific vector heading. Rest the altitude you are climbing through, and the altitude
assured that the controller knows your flight route and will to which you are climbing. The controller will verify that
vector you into position. By nature of the departure type, your reported altitude matches that emitted by your
once you are issued your clearance, the responsibility for transponder. If your altitude does not match, or if you
coordination of your flight rests with ATC, including the do not have Mode C capabilities, you will be continually
tower controller and, after handoff, the departure controller required to report your position and altitude for ATC.
who will remain with you until you are released on course
and allowed to resume own navigation. The controller is not required to provide terrain and

1-37
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
SW-4, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

Figure 1-33. Crossing altitude is there to support an ATC requirement.

obstacle clearance just because ATC has radar contact [Figure 1-35]
with your aircraft. It remains your responsibility until the
controller begins to provide navigational guidance in Visual Climb Over Airport (VCOA)
the form of radar vectors. Once radar vectors are given, A visual climb over airport (VCOA) is a departure option for
you are expected to promptly comply with headings and an IFR aircraft, operating in VMC equal to or greater than the
altitudes as assigned. Question any assigned heading if you specified visibility and ceiling, to visually conduct climbing
believe it to be incorrect or if it would cause a violation of turns over the airport to the published "climb-to" altitude
a regulation, then advise ATC immediately and obtain a from which to proceed with the instrument portion of the
revised clearance. departure. A VCOA is a departure option developed when
obstacles farther than 3 SM from the airport require a CG
Diverse Vector Area of more than 200 FPNM.
ATC may establish a minimum vectoring altitude (MVA)
around certain airports. This altitude is based on terrain These procedures are published in the Take-Off
and obstruction clearance and provides controllers with Minimums and (Obstacle) Departure Procedures section
minimum altitudes to vector aircraft in and around a of the TPP. [Figure 1-36] Prior to departure, pilots are
particular location. However, it may be necessary to required to notify ATC when executing the VCOA.
vector aircraft below this altitude to assist in the efficient
flow of departing traffic. For this reason, an airport may Noise Abatement Procedures
have established a Diverse Vector Area (DVA). DVA design As the aviation industry continues to grow and air traffic
requirements are outlined in TERPS and allow for the increases, so does the population of people and businesses
vectoring of aircraft off the departure end of the runway around airports. As a result, noise abatement procedures
below the MVA. The presence of a DVA is not published have become commonplace at most of the nations airports.
for pilots in any form, so the use of a textual ODP in a DVA 14 CFR Part 150 specifies the responsibilities of the FAA to
environment could result in a misunderstanding between investigate the recommendations of the airport operator in
pilots and controllers. ATC instructions take precedence a noise compatibility program and approve or disapprove
over an ODP. Most DVAs exist only at the busiest airports. the noise abatement suggestions. This is a crucial step in
1-38
SW-4, XX XXX 2011 to XX XXX 2011

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
SW-4, XX XXX 2011 to XX XXX 2011

SW-4, XX XXX 2011 to XX XXX 2011

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
SW-4, XX XXX 2011 to XX XXX 2011

Figure 1-34. New charting standard without ATC annotations.

1-39
Diverse vector areas allow for the maneuvering
of aircraft below the established minimum
vectoring altitude for a particular airport.

MVA

Diverse Departure Criteria is used to


identify obstacles in the departure path.

3 NM

Figure 1-35. Diverse vector area establishment criteria.


normal 200'/NM climb gradient, take-off must occur no
later than 2000' prior to departure end of runway.
MYV VOR/DME, then via MYV VOR/DME R-263 to DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 5, climbing right turn
YUBBA INT before proceeding on course.
NOTE: Rwy 7, trees beginning 1117' from DER, 504' proceedingon course. Rwy 12, climbing left turn via
right of centerline, up to 40' AGL/1708' MSL. Pole 1365'
from DER, 600' right of centerline, 59' AGL/1679' MSL. VORTAC before proceeding on course. Rwy 30,
Tree 3791' from DER, 700' right of centerline, 40' AGL/ L2
1639' MSL. Rwy 25, tree 37' from DER, 479' left of
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS AND (OBSTACLE) DEPARTURE
Rwy 5, bush 17' from PROCEDURES
centerline, 40' AGL/1528' MSL. Tree 86' from DER, 461'
NOTE: departure end of runway, 67'
S E
R-250 to ECA VORTAC before proceeding on course.

U
10266 right of centerline, 40' AGL/1532' MSL. Fence 301' from right of centerline, 6' AGL/52' MSL. Rwy 12, multiple

L
DER, 244' right of centerline, 8' AGL/1508' MSL. Trees trees and bush beginning 240' from departure end of

A
beginning
AUBURN, 660' from DER, 249' right of centerline, up to
CA BISHOP,
runway,CA 286' right of centerline, up to 39' AGL/76' MSL.
40' AGL/1559' MSL.

U
AUBURN MUNI (AUN) Rwy 30, multiple
EASTERN SIERRA poles, building, and terrain beginning
RGNL

T
AMDT 1 10098 (FAA) 66' from departure
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: end of runway,
Rwys 228' left
7,12,16, NA.ofRwys
centerline,
25,
BEALE AFB (KBAB)

C
up
30,34, 4000-2 or std. withMultiple
to 65' AGL/225' MSL. polesofbeginning
a min. climb 949'
350' per NM to
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 7, 300-1 w/ min. climb of
MARYSVILLE,
385' per NM to CA.
2300,.or. 1100-3
. . . . .for.climb
.ORIG, 09155 from departure end of runway, 28' right of centerline, up

A
23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


in visual 9000.
to 42' AGL/103' MSL.
conditions. PROCEDURE: Rwy 15, Climb on a
DEPARTURE DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwys 25,30, turn right.
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 7, climbingRwy

R
33,
left turn Rwy 34, turn left, climb northwestbound to 13000 via BIH
CHICO,
R-322CA

O
to NIKOL Int.

F
DER.VOR/DME, then via MYV VOR/DME R-263 to
MYV CHICO MUNI
TAKE-OFF
YUBBA INT OBSTACLES: Rwy 33,
before proceeding on course, or for climb BYRON, CA PROCEDURE: Rwys 13L/R, climbing

OT
DEPARTURE
in visual conditions: cross Auburn Muni airport at or right turn. Rwys 31L/R, climbing left turn. All aircraft,
BYRON
climb via CIC
TAKE-OFF R-205 to JINGO
MINIMUMS: Rwy 23,Int.NA-obstacles.
Aircraft departing

N
MYV VOR/DME R-094 to MYV VOR/DME, then via Rwy 30, 200-1 or std. with a min. climb of 240' per NM to
BECKWOURTH,
MYV VOR/DME R-263 CA to YUBBA INT before

E
300. Alternatively, with standard take-off minimums and a
proceeding on course. Rwy 25, climbing right turn to

L
NERVINO inbound)
normal to depart
200'/NM JINGO
climb Int at or
gradient, above must
take-off 2800.occur no

P
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwys 7, 25, 3500-3 for climb in later than 2000' prior to departure end of runway.
MYV
visualVOR/DME,
conditions. then via MYV VOR/DME R-263 to CLOVERDALE,
DEPARTURE PROCEDURE:CA Rwy 5, climbing right turn

M
YUBBA INT before
DEPARTURE proceedingRwys
PROCEDURE: on course.
7, 25, for climb in CLOVERDALE MUNI

A
NOTE: Rwy 7, trees
visual conditions: beginning
cross Nervino 1117' from
Airport at DER, 504'
or above proceedingon course. Rwy 12, climbing left turn viaa
TAKE-OFF MINIMUMS: Rwy 14, 400-2 or std. with

S
right
8300of centerline,
before up to 40'
proceeding AGL/1708' MSL. Pole 1365'
on course. min. climb of 280' per NM to 1500, then a min. climb of
from DER,
NOTE: Rwy600' right
7, road 58'offrom
centerline,
departure59'end
AGL/1679'
of runway,MSL. VORTAC before proceeding on course. Rwy 30,
260' per NM to 3900. Rwy 32, NA.
Treeright
469' 3791'
offrom DER, 700'
centerline, right of centerline,
15' AGL/4920' MSL. Pole 40' AGL/
310' DEPARTURE PROCEDURE: Rwy 14, climb direct STS
1639' MSL. Rwy 25, tree 37' from DER, 479' left
from departure end of runway, 522' right of centerline, of R-250 to ECA VORTAC before proceeding on(NW
course.
VOR/DME. Continue climb in holding pattern
49' AGL/4925' MSL. Pole 528' from departure end of461'
centerline, 40' AGL/1528' MSL. Tree 86' from DER, NOTE: Rwy 5, bush 17' from departure end of runway, 67'

Figure 1-36. Examples of takeoff minimums obstacle clearance.

1-40
N
IO
AT
VIG
NE-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010

NE-1, 23 SEP 2010 to 21 OCT 2010


NA
OR

Procedure designed for noise abatement purposes


TF
NO

Figure 1-37. Noise abatement SID.

1-41
ensuring that the airport is not unduly inhibited by noise altitudes for IFR flight above the minimum IFR altitudes for
requirements and that air traffic workload and efficiency a specific area of controlled airspace, ensuring the pilot has
are not significantly impacted, all while considering the acknowledged the clearance or instructions, and ensuring
noise problems addressed by the surrounding community. the correct read back of instructions. Specifically related to
departures, ATC is responsible for specifying the direction
While most DPs are designed for obstacle clearance and of takeoff or initial heading when necessary, obtaining pilot
workload reduction, there are some SIDs that are developed concurrence that the procedure complies with local traffic
solely to comply with noise abatement requirements. patterns, terrain, and obstruction clearance, and including
Portland International Jetport is an example of an airport DP as part of the ATC clearance when pilot compliance for
where a SID was created strictly for noise abatement separation is necessary.
purposes as noted in the DP. [Figure 1-36] Typically, noise
restrictions are incorporated into the main body of the The pilot has a number of responsibilities when simply
SID. These types of restrictions require higher departure operating in conjunction with ATC or when using DPs under
altitudes, larger climb gradients, reduced airspeeds, and an IFR clearance:
turns to avoid specific areas. Noise restrictions may also Acknowledge receipt and understanding of an ATC
be evident during a radar departure. ATC may require you clearance.
to turn away from your intended course or vector you
around a particular area. While these restrictions may seem Read back any part of a clearance that contains hold
burdensome, it is important to remember that it is your short instructions.
duty to comply with written and spoken requests from ATC. Request clarification of clearances.

Request an amendment to a clearance if it is
Additionally, when required, departure instructions specify
unacceptable from a safety perspective.
the actual heading to be flown after takeoff, as is the case in
Figure 1-37 under the departure route description, Climb Promptly comply with ATC requests. Advise ATC
via heading 112 degrees... Some existing procedures specify, immediately if unable to comply with a clearance.
Climb runway heading. Over time, both of these departure You are required to contact ATC if you are unable to
instructions will be updated to read, Climb heading 112 comply with all-engines-operating climb gradients
degrees.... Runway heading is the magnetic direction that and climb rates. It is also expected that you are
corresponds with the runway centerline extended (charted capable of maintaining the climb gradient outlined
on the airport diagram), not the numbers painted on the in either a standard or non-standard DP. If you
runway. Pilots cleared to fly or maintain runway heading cannot maintain a standard climb gradient or the
are expected to fly or maintain the published heading that climb gradient specified in an ODP, you must wait
corresponds with the extended centerline of the departure until you can depart under VMC.
runway (until otherwise instructed by ATC), and are not to
apply drift correction (e.g., RWY 11, actual magnetic heading When planning for a departure, pilots should:
of the runway centerline 112.2 degrees, fly heading 112
Consider the type of terrain and other obstructions in
degrees). In the event of parallel departures, this prevents
the vicinity of the airport.
a loss of separation caused by only one aircraft applying a
wind drift. Determine if obstacle clearance can be maintained
visually, or if they need to make use of a DP.
Procedural Notes Determine if an ODP or SID is available for the
An important consideration to make during your flight departure airport.
planning is whether or not you are able to fly your chosen Determine what actions allow for a safe departure
departure procedure as charted. out of an airport that does not have any type of
affiliated DPs.
DP Responsibilities
Responsibility for the safe execution of DPs rests on the By simply complying with DPs in their entirety as published,
shoulders of both ATC and the pilot. Without the interest obstacle clearance is guaranteed. Depending on the type
and attention of both parties, the IFR system cannot work of departure used, responsibility for terrain clearance
in harmony, and achievement of safety is impossible. and traffic separation may be shared between pilots and
controllers.
ATC, in all forms, is responsible for issuing clearances
appropriate to the operations being conducted, assigning

1-42
Departures From Tower-Controlled Airports on your behalf and, in turn, relay your clearance from ATC.
Departing from a tower-controlled airport is relatively You are also allowed to depart the airport VFR, if conditions
simple in comparison to departing from non-towered permit, and contact the controlling authority to request
airport. Normally you request your IFR clearance through your clearance in the air. As technology improves, new
ground control or clearance delivery. Communication methods for delivery of clearances at non-towered airports
frequencies for the various controllers are listed on are being created.
departure, approach, and airport charts, as well as the
A/FD. At some airports, you may have the option of Ground Communication Outlet
receiving a pre-taxi clearance. This program allows you Ground Communication Outlets (GCO), have been
to call ground control or clearance delivery no more developed in conjunction with the FAA to provide pilots
than 10 minutes prior to beginning taxi operations and flying in and out of non-towered airports with the capability
receive your IFR clearance. A pre-departure clearance to contact ATC and AFSS via very high frequency (VHF)
(PDC) program that allows pilots to receive a clearance via radio to a telephone connection. This lets pilots obtain an
data link from a dispatcher or a data link communications instrument clearance or close a VFR/IFR flight plan. You can
service provider, e.g. ARINC, is available for Part 121 and use four key clicks on your VHF radio to contact the nearest
Part 135 operators. A clearance is given to the dispatcher, ATC facility and six key clicks to contact the local AFSS, but it
who in turn, relays it to the crew, enabling the crew to is intended to be used only as a ground operational tool. A
bypass communication with clearance delivery, thus GCO is an unstaffed, remote controlled ground-to-ground
reducing frequency congestion. Once you have received communication facility that is relatively inexpensive to
your clearance, it is your responsibility to comply with the install and operate. Installations of these types of outlets
instructions as given, and notify ATC if you are unable to are scheduled at instrument airports around the country.
comply with the clearance. If you do not understand the
clearance, or if you think that you have missed a portion GCOs are manufactured by different companies including
of the clearance, contact ATC immediately for clarification. ARINC and AVTECH, each with different operating
characteristics but with the ability to accomplish the same
Departures From Airports Without an goal. This latest technology has proven to be an incredibly
Operating Control Tower useful tool for communicating with the appropriate
There are hundreds of airports across the United States authorities when departing IFR from a non-towered airport.
that operate successfully every day without the benefit of The GCO should help relieve the need to use the telephone
a control tower. While a tower is certainly beneficial when to call ATC and the need to depart into marginal conditions
departing IFR, most other departures can be made with just to achieve radio contact. GCO information is listed on
few challenges. As usual, you must file your flight plan at airport charts and instrument approach charts with other
least 30 minutes in advance. During your planning phase, communications frequencies. Signs may also be located on
investigate the departure airports method for receiving an airport to notify you of the frequency and proper usage.
an instrument clearance. You can contact the Automated
Flight Service Station (AFSS) on the ground by telephone, See and Avoid Techniques
and they will request your clearance from ATC. Typically, Meteorological conditions permitting, you are required
when a clearance is given in this manner, the clearance to use see and avoid techniques to avoid traffic, terrain,
includes a void time. You must depart the airport before the and other obstacles. To avoid obstacles during a departure,
clearance void time; if you fail to depart, you must contact the takeoff minimums may include a non-standard ceiling
ATC by a specified notification time, which is within 30 and visibility minimum. These are given to pilots so they
minutes of the original void time. After the clearance void can depart an airport without being able to meet the
time, your reserved space within the IFR system is released established climb gradient. Instead, they must see and
for other traffic. avoid obstacles in the departure path. In these situations,
ATC provides radar traffic information for radar-identified
There are several other ways to receive a clearance at a non- aircraft outside controlled airspace, workload permitting,
towered airport. If you can contact the AFSS or ATC on the and safety alerts to pilots believed to be within an unsafe
radio, you can request your departure clearance. However, proximity to obstacles or aircraft.
these frequencies are typically congested, and they may
not be able to provide you with a clearance via the radio. VFR Departures
You also can use a Remote Communications Outlet (RCO) There may be times when you need to fly an IFR flight
to contact an AFSS if one is located nearby. Some airports plan due to the weather you will encounter at a later time
have licensed UNICOM operators that can also contact ATC

1-43
(or if you simply wish to fly IFR to remain proficient), but
the weather outside is clearly VFR. It may be that you can
depart VFR, but you need to get an IFR clearance shortly
after departing the airport. A VFR departure can be used as
a tool that allows you to get off the ground without having
to wait for a time slot in the IFR system, however, departing
VFR with the intent of receiving an IFR clearance in the air
can also present serious hazards worth considering.

A VFR departure dramatically changes the takeoff
responsibilities for you and for ATC. Upon receiving
clearance for a VFR departure, you are cleared to depart;
however, you must maintain separation between yourself
and other traffic. You are also responsible for maintaining
terrain and obstruction clearance, as well as remaining in
VFR weather conditions. You cannot fly in IMC without first
receiving your IFR clearance. Likewise, a VFR departure
relieves ATC of these duties and basically requires them
only to provide you with safety alerts as workload permits.

Maintain VFR until you have obtained your IFR clearance


and have ATC approval to proceed on course in accordance
with your clearance. If you accept this clearance and are
below the minimum IFR altitude for operations in the area,
you accept responsibility for terrain/obstruction clearance
until you reach that altitude.

1-44
Chapter 2

En Route Operations
Introduction
The en route phase of flight is defined as that segment of
flight from the termination point of a departure procedure
to the origination point of an arrival procedure. The
procedures employed in the en route phase of flight are
governed by a set of specific flight standards established by
Title 14 of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) [Figure
2-1], Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) Order 8260.3,
United States Standard for Terminal Instrument Procedures
(TERPS), and related publications. These standards establish
courses to be flown, obstacle clearance criteria, minimum
altitudes, navigation performance, and communications
requirements.

2-1
either fly along the centerline when on a Federal airway
or, on routes other than Federal airways, along the direct
course between NAVAIDs or fixes defining the route. The
regulation allows maneuvering to pass well clear of other
air traffic or, if in visual flight rules (VFR) conditions, to clear
the flightpath both before and during climb or descent.

Airways
Airway routing occurs along pre-defined pathways called
airways. [Figure 2-2] Airways can be thought of as three-
dimensional highways for aircraft. In most land areas of
the world, aircraft are required to fly airways between the
departure and destination airports. The rules governing
airway routing, Standard Instrument Departures (SID)
and Standard Terminal Arrival (STAR), are published flight
procedures that cover altitude, airspeed, and requirements
for entering and leaving the airway. Most airways are eight
nautical miles (14 kilometers) wide, and the airway flight
levels keep aircraft separated by at least 500 vertical feet
Figure 2-1. Code of Federal Regulations, Title 14 Aeronautics and Space. from aircraft on the flight level above and below when
operating under VFR. When operating under IFR, between
En Route Navigation the surface and an altitude of Flight Level (FL) 290,no
En route instrument flight rules (IFR) navigation is evolving aircraft should come closer vertically than 1,000 feet.
from the ground-based navigational aid (NAVAID) airway Above FL290 , no aircraft should come closer than 2,000
system to a sophisticated satellite and computer-based feet except in airspace where Reduced Vertical Separation
system that can generate courses to suit the operational Minima (RVSM) can be applied in which case the vertical
requirements of almost any flight. The FAA Global separation is reduced to 1,000 ft. Airways usually intersect
Navigation Satellite System (GNSS) provides satellite-based at NAVAIDs that designate the allowed points for changing
positioning, navigation, and timing services in the United from one airway to another. Airways have names consisting
States to enable performance-based operations for all of one or more letters followed by one or more digits (e.g.,
phases of flight, to include en route navigation. V484 or UA419).

14 CFR Part 91, section 91.181, is the basis for the course The en route airspace structure of the National Airspace
to be flown. Unless authorized by ATC, to operate an System (NAS) consists of three strata. The first stratum low
aircraft within controlled airspace under IFR, pilots must altitude airways in the United States can be navigated

Figure 2-2. Airways depicted on an aeronautical chart.

2-2
using NAVAIDs, have names that start with the letter V, and Air Route Traffic Control Centers
are called Victor Airways. [Figure 2-3] They cover altitudes The FAA defines an Air Route Traffic Control Center (ARTCC)
from approximately 1,200 feet above ground level (AGL) as a facility established to provide air traffic control (ATC)
up to, but not including 18,000 feet above mean sea level service to aircraft operating on IFR flight plans within
(MSL). The second stratum high altitude airways in the controlled airspace, principally during the en route phase
United States all have names that start with the letter J, of flight. When equipment capabilities and controller
and are called Jet Routes. [Figure 2-4] These routes run workload permit, certain advisory/assistance services may
from 18,000 feet to 45,000 feet. The third stratum allows be provided to VFR aircraft.
random operations above flight level (FL) 450. The altitude
separating the low and high airway structure varies from ARTCCs, usually referred to as Centers, are established
county to country. For example, in Switzerland it is 19,500 primarily to provide air traffic service to aircraft operating
feet and 25,000 feet in Egypt. on IFR flight plans within the controlled airspace, and
principally during the en route phase of flight. There are

Figure 2-3. Victor airways. Figure 2-4. Jet routes.

Seattle Center

ZSE ZMP
Minneapolis Center Boston Center
ZLC ZBW
Salt Lake City Center
ZAU ZOB
Chicago Center Cleveland Center ZNY
ZDV
Denver Center
ZKC ZNY
ZOA Kansas City Center
ZID New York
Oakland Center Indianapolis Center
Center ZDC
Washington
Memphis Center Center (DC)
Atlanta Center
ZLA ZME
Los Angeles Center ZTL
ZAB
Albuquerque Center ZFW
Fort Worth Center

ZJX
Houston Center Jacksonville Center

ZHU
ZAN Miami Center
Anchorage
Center
ZHN ZMA
Honolulu
Center

Figure 2-5. Air Route Traffic Control Centers.

2-3
21 ARTCCs in the United States. [Figure 2-5] Any aircraft Vertically
operating under IFR within the confines of an ARTCCs 1,000 feet (if the aircraft is below FL290, or
airspace is controlled by air traffic controllers at the Center. between FL290 and FL410 for RVSM compliant
This includes all sorts of different types of aircraft: privately aircraft)
owned single engine aircraft, commuter airlines, military
jets, and commercial airlines. 2,000 feet (if the aircraft is at FL290 or above)

The largest component of the NAS is the ARTCC. Each The controllers can accomplish this separation by issuing
ARTCC covers thousands of square miles encompassing instructions to the pilots of the aircraft involved. Altitude
all or part of several states. ARTCCs are built to ensure safe assignments, speed adjustments, and radar vectors are
and expeditious air travel. All Centers operate 7-days a examples of instructions that might be issued to aircraft.
week, 24-hours a day, and employ a combination of several
hundred ATC specialists, electronic technicians, computer En route control is handled by pinpointing aircraft positions
system specialists, environmental support specialists, and through the use of flight progress strips. These strips are
administrative staff. Figure 2-6 is an example of the Boston pieces of printed paper containing pertinent information
extracted from the pilots flight plan. These strips are
printed 20 minutes prior to an aircraft reaching each
Centers sector. A flight progress strip tells the controller
everything needed to direct that aircraft. If the flight
progress strips of each aircraft approaching a sector are
arranged properly, it is possible to determine potential
conflicts long before the aircraft are even visible on the
Center controllers display. In areas where radar coverage
is not available, this is the sole means of separating aircraft.

The strips, one for each en route point from which the
pilot reports his or her position, are posted on a slotted
board in front of the air traffic controller. [Figure 2-7] At a
glance, he or she is able to see certain vital data: the type
of airplane and who is flying it (airline, business, private,
or military pilot), aircraft registration number or flight

Figure 2-6. Boston Air Route Traffic Control Center.

ARTCC. The green lines mark the boundaries of the Boston


Center area, and the red lines mark the boundaries of
Military Operations Areas (MOAs), Prohibited, Restricted,
Alert, and Warning Areas.

Safe Separation Standards


The primary means of controlling aircraft is accomplished
Figure 2-7. Flight progress strips.
by using highly sophisticated computerized radar systems.
In addition, the controller maintains two-way radio
communication with aircraft in his or her sector. In this number, route, speed, altitude, airway designation, and the
way, the specialist ensures that the aircraft are separated estimated time of arrival (ETA) at destination. As the pilot
by the following criteria: calls in the aircrafts position and time at a predetermined
Laterally5 miles location, the strips are removed from their slots and filed.
Any change from the original flight plan is noted on the

2-4
Figure 2-8. Fort Worth Air Route Traffic Control Center.
Figure 2-10. Intermediate altitude sectors.
strips as the flight continues. Thus, from a quick study of
the flight progress board, a controller can assess the overall
traffic situation and can avoid possible conflicts.

Figure 2-8 shows the Fort Worth, Texas Air Route Traffic
Control Center (ZFW) and the geographical area that it
covers. The Center has approximately 350 controllers. Most
are certified and some are in on-the-job training.

Sectors
The airspace controlled by a Center may be further
administratively subdivided into smaller, manageable
pieces of airspace called sectors. A few sectors extend from
the ground up, but most areas are stratified into various
levels to accommodate a wide variety of traffic. Each sector
is staffed by a set of controllers and has a unique radio
frequency that the controller uses to communicate with Figure 2-11. High altitude sectors.
the pilots. As aircraft transition from one sector to another,
they are instructed to change to the radio frequency used
by the next sector. Each sector also has secure landline
communications with adjacent sectors, approach controls,

Figure 2-12. Ultra high altitude sectors.

areas, ARTCCs, flight service centers, and military aviation


control facilities.
Figure 2-9. Low altitude sectors.

2-5
The ARTCC at Fort Worth, Texas is subdivided into sectors routes pass safely within the separation standard, or if they
that are categorized as follows: conflict with each other. In addition to vector lines, the
Eighteen low altitude sectors. [Figure 2-9] controller can also display a route line for any given aircraft
on his or her radar screen. This tells the controller where
Seven intermediate altitude sectors. [Figure 2-10] a particular aircraft is in specified number of minutes, as
Sixteen high altitude sectors. [Figure 2-11] well as the path the aircraft will fly to get there. Decision
One ultra high altitude sector. [Figure 2-12] support tools such as these help each controller look ahead
and avoid conflicts.
From one to three controllers may work a sector, depending
In-flight Requirements and Instructions
upon the amount of air traffic. Each controller is assigned
to work the positions within an area of specialization. The CFRs require the pilot in command under IFR in
Controllers have direct communication with pilots, with controlled airspace to continuously monitor an appropriate
surrounding sectors and Centers, plus the towers and Flight Center or control frequency. When climbing after takeoff,
Service Stations (FSS) under their jurisdiction. Each control an IFR flight is either in contact with a radar-equipped local
position is equipped with computer input and readout departure control or, in some areas, an ARTCC facility. As
devices for aircraft flight plan data. a flight transitions to the en route phase, pilots typically
expect a handoff from departure control to a Center
The Center controllers have many decision support frequency if not already in contact with the Center.
tools (computer software programs) that provide vital
information to assist the controllers in maintaining safe The FAA National Aeronautical Navigation Products
separation distances for all aircraft flying through their (AeroNav Products), formerly known as the National
sector. For example, one tool available allows the controller Aeronautical Charting Office (NACO), publishes en route
to display the extended route of any aircraft on the radar charts depicting Centers and sector frequencies. [Figure
screen called a vector line. This line projects where the 2-13] During handoff from one Center to another, the
aircraft will be within a specified number of minutes, previous controller assigns a new frequency. In cases where
assuming the aircraft does not change its course. This is flights may be out of range, the Center frequencies on the
a helpful tool to determine if aircraft flying intersecting face of the chart are very helpful. In Figure 2-13, notice
the boundary between Memphis, Tennessee and Atlanta,

O N
A TI
V IG
N A
O R ATLANTA
Chattanooga

F
132.05 353.8

O T MEMPHIS
Huntsville

N
120.8 307.0
HIS
TA
MEMP
ATLAN

Figure 2-13. Air Route Traffic Control Centers and sector frequencies.

2-6
Georgia Centers, and the remote sites with discrete very and southern ARTCCs. The airspace includes Minneapolis
high frequency (VHF) and ultra high frequency (UHF) for (ZMP), Chicago (ZAU), Kansas City (ZKC), Denver (ZDV),
communicating with the appropriate ARTCC. These Center Salt Lake City (ZLC), Oakland (ZOA), Seattle Centers (ZSE),
frequency boxes can be used for finding the nearest Los Angeles (ZLA), Albuquerque (ZAB), Fort Worth (ZFW),
frequency within the aircraft range. They also can be used Memphis (ZME), and Houston (ZHU). Jacksonville (ZJX)
for making initial contact with the Center for clearances. and Miami (ZMA) are included for east-west routes only. To
The exact location for the Center transmitter is not shown, develop a flight plan, select pitch and catch points which
although the frequency box is placed as close as possible can be found in the Airport/Facility Directory (A/FD) based
to the known location. upon your desired route across the Phase I airspace. Filing
requirements to pitch points, and from catch points, remain
During the en route phase, as a flight transitions from one unchanged from current procedures. For the portion of the
Center facility to the next, a handoff or transfer of control route between the pitch and catch points, NRR is permitted.
is required as previously described. The handoff procedure Where pitch points for a specific airport are not identified,
is similar to the handoff between other radar facilities, such aircraft should file an appropriate departure procedure (DP),
as departure or approach control. During the handoff, or any other user preferred routing prior to the NRR portion
the controller whose airspace is being vacated issues of their routing. Where catch points for a specific airport
instructions that include the name of the facility to contact, are not identified aircraft should file, after the NRR portion
appropriate frequency, and other pertinent remarks. of their routing, an appropriate arrival procedure or other
user preferred routing to their destination.
Accepting radar vectors from controllers does not relieve
pilots of their responsibility for safety of flight. Pilots must Additionally, information concerning the location and
maintain a safe altitude and keep track of their position, schedule of special use airspace (SUA) and Air Traffic
and it is their obligation to question controllers, request Control Assigned Airspace (ATCAA) can be found at http://
an amended clearance, or, in an emergency, deviate from sua.faa.gov. ATCAA refers to airspace in the high altitude
their instructions if they believe that the safety of flight structure supporting military and other special operations.
is in doubt. Keeping track of altitude and position when Pilots are encouraged to file around these areas when they
climbing, and during all other phases of flight, are basic are scheduled to be active, thereby avoiding unplanned
elements of situational awareness (SA). Aircraft equipped reroutes around them.
with an enhanced ground proximity warning system
(EGPWS), terrain awareness and warning system (TAWS), In conjunction with the HAR program, area navigation
or traffic alert and collision avoidance system (TCAS) help (RNAV) routes have been established to provide for a
pilots detect and/or correct for potential unsafe proximities systematic flow of air traffic in specific portions of the en
to other aircraft and increases pilot(s) situational awareness. route flight environment. The designator for these RNAV
Regardless of equipment, pilots must always maintain SA routes begin with the letter Q, for example, Q-501. Where
regarding their location and the location of traffic in their those routes aid in the efficient orderly management of air
vicinity. traffic, they are published as preferred IFR routes.

High Altitude Area Navigation Routing Preferred IFR Routes


Special high altitude routes allow pilots routing options for Preferred IFR routes are established between busier airports
flight within the initial high altitude routing (HAR) Phase to increase system efficiency and capacity. They normally
I expansion airspace. Pilots are able to fly user-preferred extend through one or more ARTCC areas and are designed
routes, referred to as non-restrictive routing (NRR), between to achieve balanced traffic flows among high density
specific fixes described by pitch (entry into) and catch (exit terminals. IFR clearances are issued on the basis of these
out of) fixes in the HAR airspace. Pitch points indicate an routes except when severe weather avoidance procedures
end of departure procedures, preferred IFR routings, or or other factors dictate otherwise. Preferred IFR routes are
other established routing programs where a flight can listed in the A/FD and can also be found on www.fly.faa.
begin a segment of NRR. The catch point indicates where gov, which requires entering the following data: departure
a flight ends a segment of NRR and joins published arrival airport designator, destination, route type, area, aircraft
procedures, preferred IFR routing, or other established types, altitude, route string, direction, departure ARTCC,
routing programs. and arrival ARTCC. [Figure 2-14] If a flight is planned to or
from an area having such routes but the departure or arrival
The HAR Phase I expansion airspace is defined as that point is not listed in the A/FD, pilots may use that part of a
airspace at and above FL 350 in fourteen of the western preferred IFR route that is appropriate for the departure or

2-7
(DME), or any combinations thereof.

Preferred IFR routes are published in the A/FD for the


low and high altitude stratum. If they begin or end with
an airway number, it indicates that the airway essentially
overlies the airport and flights normally are cleared directly
on the airway. Preferred IFR routes beginning or ending with
a fix indicate that pilots may be routed to or from these fixes
via a SID route, radar vectors, or a STAR. Routes for major
terminals are listed alphabetically under the name of the
departure airport. Where several airports are in proximity,
they are listed under the principal airport and categorized as
a metropolitan area (e.g., New York Metro Area). One way
preferred IFR routes are listed is numerically, showing the
segment fixes and the direction and times effective. Where
more than one route is listed, the routes have equal priority
for use. Official location identifiers are used in the route
description for very high frequency omnidirectional ranges
(VORs) and very high frequency omnidirectional ranges/
tactical air navigation (VORTACs), and intersection names
are spelled out. The route is direct where two NAVAIDs, an
intersection and a NAVAID, a NAVAID and a NAVAID radial
and distance point, or any navigable combination of these
Figure 2-14. Airport/Facility Directory. route descriptions follow in succession.
arrival point listed. Preferred IFR routes are correlated with
A system of preferred IFR routes helps pilots, flight crews,
departure procedures (DPs) and STARs and may be defined
and dispatchers plan a route of flight to minimize route
by airways, jet routes, direct routes between NAVAIDs,
changes, and to aid in the efficient, orderly management
waypoints, NAVAID radials/ distance measuring equipment

Figure 2-15 Preferred IFR routes.

2-8
of air traffic using Federal airways. Preferred IFR routes certification, and final approval of substitute routes.
are designed to serve the needs of airspace users and
to provide for a systematic flow of air traffic in the major Substitute Airway En Route Flight Procedures
terminal and en route flight environments. Cooperation by A schedule of proposed facility shutdowns within the region
all pilots in filing preferred routes results in fewer air traffic is maintained and forwarded as far in advance as possible
delays and better efficiency for departure, en route, and to enable the substitute routes to be published. Substitute
arrival air traffic service. [Figure 2-15] routes are normally based on VOR/VORTAC facilities
established and published for use in the appropriate
Substitute Airway or Route Structures altitude strata. In the case of substitute routes in the upper
ARTCCs are responsible for specifying essential substitute airspace stratum, it may be necessary to establish routes by
airway or route segments (sub-routes) and fixes for use reference to VOR/VORTAC facilities used in the low altitude
during scheduled or unscheduled VOR/VORTAC shutdowns. system. Non-directional (radio) beacon (NDB) facilities may
Scheduled shutdowns of navigational facilities require only be used where VOR/VORTAC coverage is inadequate
planning and coordination to ensure an uninterrupted flow and ATC requirements necessitate use of such NAVAIDs.
of air traffic. Aeronautical Navigation Products (AJV-3), in Where operational necessity dictates, NAVAIDs may be
coordination with the ARTCCs, determine when the length used beyond their standard service volume (SSV) limits that
of outages or other factors require publication of sub- define the reception limits of unrestricted NAVAIDs, which
routes and Flight Instpection Services (AJW-3) provides are usable for random/unpublished route navigation,
flight inspection services, obstacle clearance verification,

Uncontrolled airspace

Sub-route V-98

CDE vortac

ABC vortac
V- 8
98
V-9 Obstacle study and flight
inspection of sub-route required

(Centerline must be in
controlled airspace) BCD vortac (shutdown)

Figure 2-16 14 CFR Part 95 sub-routes.

Uncontrolled airspace

Off-airway sub-route

CDE vortac

ABC vortac
V- 8
98
V-9 Obstacle study and flight
inspection of sub-route required

BCD vortac (shutdown)

Figure 2-17 Non-Part 95 sub-routes.

2-9
GHI vortac HIJ vortac IJK vortac (L)

30

V-204 V-204

70

Obstacle study flight


inspection and ESVs
required

GHI vortac IJK vortac (L)

60*

SUB-ROUTE V-204

90
HIJ vortac (shutdown)

Figure 2-18 Sub-route wider than existing route.

provided that the routes can be given adequate frequency it possible to fly an IFR flight without leaving approach
protection. control airspace. [Figure 2-19] This service is designed
to help expedite air traffic and reduces ATC and pilot
The centerline of substitute routes must be contained communication requirements. The program is generally
within controlled airspace [Figure 2-16], although substitute used by non-turbojet aircraft operating at and below
routes for off-airway routes may not be in controlled air- 10,000 feet but a few facilities, such as Milwaukee and
space. [Figure 2-17] Substitute routes are flight inspected Chicago, have allowed turbojets to proceed between
to verify clearance of controlling obstacles and to check for city pairs. Participating flights are relatively short with a
satisfactory facility performance. If substitute routes do not duration of 2 hours or less.
overlie existing routes, or are wider than existing routes,
map studies are required to identify controlling obstacles. TEC is referred to as tower en route, or tower-to-tower, and
[Figure 2-18] The format for describing substitute routes allows flight beneath the en route structure. TEC reallocates
is from navigational fix to navigational fix. A minimum en airspace both vertically and geographically to allow flight
route altitude (MEA) and a maximum authorized altitude planning between city pairs while remaining with approach
(MAA) are provided for each route segment. Temporary control airspace. All users are encouraged to use the TEC
reporting points may be substituted for the out-of-service route descriptions located in the A/FD when filing flight
facility and only those other reporting points that are plans. [Figure 2-20] All published TEC routes are designed
essential for ATC. Normally, temporary reporting points to avoid en route airspace, and the majority is within radar
over intersections are not necessary where Center radar coverage.
coverage exists. A minimum reception altitude (MRA) is
established for each temporary reporting point. Tower En Route Control Route Descriptions
The graphic depiction of TEC routes located in the A/FD is
Tower En Route Control not to be used for navigation or for detailed flight planning
Tower en route control (TEC) is an ATC program available because not all city pairs are depicted. The information is
to pilots that provides a service to aircraft proceeding to intended to show geographic areas connected by TEC.
and from metropolitan areas. It links designated approach [Figure 2-19] Pilots should refer to the route descriptions
control areas by a network of identified routes made up for specific flight planning.
of the existing airway structure of the NAS, which makes

2-10
TOWER EN ROUTE CONTROL (TEC)
Northeast U.S. (Eastern)
BUF
(Lines connecting airports
depict adjacent approach
control facilities) BGM
ELM

ERI
AVP
YNG
CLE
ABE
CAK PENNSYLVANIA RDG NYC

PIT
HAR
PHL WRI
NEW JERSEY
MARYLAND ACY
CKB BWI
DOV
IAD
WEST VIRGINIA DC DCA DELAWARE
HTS
PXT
CRW

VIRGINIA
RIC
ROA

ORF

GSO
LEGEND
Radar approach control area

Figure 2-19. Tower En Route Control (TEC) Northeast U.S. (Eastern).

assigned is below the MEA.


As shown in Figure 2-20, the route description contains four
columns of information. The first column is the approach Shown in Figure 2-21, under the second column, the word
control area within which the departure airport is located, Direct appears as the route when radar vectors are used
which are listed alphabetically. The second column shows or no airway exists. This also indicates that a SID or STAR
the specific route, airway, or radial that is to be used. may be assigned by ATC. When a NAVAID or intersection
The third column shows the highest altitude allowed for identifier appears with no airway immediately preceding
the route, and the fourth shows the destination airport, or following the identifier, the routing is understood to be
which are also listed alphabetically. When flight planning, direct to or from that point unless otherwise cleared by ATC.
it is important to always check current publications for Routes beginning and ending with an airway indicate that
information about the departure and destination airport. the airway essentially overflies the airport, or radar vectors
Routes are effective only during each respective terminal are issued. [Figure 2-21] Where more than one route is listed
facilities normal operating hours. Always check NOTAMs to the same destination, ensure that the correct route for
to ensure that appropriate terminal facilities are operating the type of aircraft classification has been filed. These are
for the planned flight time. Altitudes are always listed in denoted after the route in the altitude column using J (jet
thousands of feet. ATC may request that the pilot changes powered), M (turbo props/special, cruise speed 190 knots
altitude while in flight in order to maintain the flight within or greater), P (non-jet, cruise speed 190 knots or greater),
approach control airspace. ATC provides radar monitoring or Q (non-jet, cruise speed 189 knots or less). [Figure 2-22]
and, if necessary, course guidance if the highest altitude Although all airports are not listed under the destination

2-11
OL
RO UTE CONTR
TOWER EN Highest
estination
Altitude D
Allentown
ontrol Area Route 7000
Atlantic City
Approach C 7000
Bangor
g S atellites) LRP V39 E
TX 7000
(Includin ............ V93 e
EAH V229 WW (Singl
Baltimore ............ V 26 8 LE
V 16 JFK V22
9 HFD CLO Bar Harbor
8 E N O 7000
............ V26 /E, /F. /G on
ly) ingle
engine and CLOWW (S n
V 16 JF K V229 HFD Binghamto
8 EN O 7000 th)
............ V26 /E, /F. /G on
ly) Boston (Nor
engine and 7000
LRP V49 9
............ V93 JFK V229 ly) Boston
8 ENO V16 e engine on 7000
... ... ... ... V 26
O 53 D R EEM (Singl 3 W O O N S
HFD HFD V229 HFD
V
Boston
V 26 8 E N O V16 JFK 7000
............ ne only) 4
(Single engi DR BDR01
E N O V 16 JFK V229 B 7000 Bradley
8 only)
............ V26 gle engine
JUDDS (Sin (Single
V 16 JF K V229 BDR Bridgeport
V 26 8 E N O 7000
............ ) gle
engine only 9 BDR (Sin Capital City
8 E N O V 16 JFK V22 7000
............ V26 ) Dover AFB
engine only 7000
Dulles
V 31 H A R 6000
............ 7000 Groton
8 ENO
............ V26 RB
M D MAD
... ... ... ... V 44 K V229 BR
... ... V 26 8 ENO V16 JF gl e en gi ne only)
...... ONDI (Sin
MAD126 M

Figure 2-20. Baltimore Airport/Facility Directory, Tower En Route Control route descriptions.

ROUTE C ONTROL
TOWER EN Highest
Altitude
Destinati
on

Albany
8000
ontrol Area
Route 8000
Albany
Approach C Atlantic C
ity
S atellites) V149 LHY 5000
(Including ............ EJC 8000
Baltimore
to w n T X LHY Baltimore
Allen ............ E RD CYN 6000
9 MAZIE A Baltimore
............ V14 P 8000
LR
............ V93 162 DUMMR V93 LR
P Bradley
10000
......... ... E X T V Bradley
LRP 10000
............ V39 Caldwell
5000 ale
............ V13
0 Farmingd
5000
............ D
irect Harrisburg
8000
......... ... F JC STW Hartford
) EXT V30
SBJ 10000
............ (2 Hazleton
2 HAR 4000
............ E T X V 16 Lancaster
4000
irect
............ D 4 WEISS
...... ... ... E XT ETX00
T V39
............ EX

Figure 2-21. Allentown Airport/Facility Directory, Tower En Route Control route descriptions.

2-12
Highest
L estination
EN ROU TE CONTRO Altitude D
TOWoEuR
te 6000 Allentown
R Allentown
6000 FB
6 ARD ) Andrews, A
9 DIXIE V27 engine only 4000
trol Area ............ V22 6 A RD (Single Baltimore
Approach Con es) 1 D IX IE V 27 4000
............ V TT Bangor
(Includin g S at el lit ATR V308 O 6000
............ V1 A L and
AH V 26 8 B gle engine
Atlant ic C ity ............ LEE 9 H FD C LOWM (Sin Bar Harbor
JFK V22 6000
............ V1 ly) and
/E, /F, /G on ingle engine th)
22 9 H FD CLOWM (S Boston (Nor
JFK V 6000
............ V1 e
/E, /F, /G on
ly) EEM (Singl
22 9 H FD HFD053 DR Boston
JFK V 6000
............ V1 ne only) e engine
(Single engi FD V3 WOONS (Singl
K V 22 9 H 6000 Boston
JF
............ V1 ingle
only WOONS (S
JF K V 22 9 HFD FOSTY 6000 Bradley
............ V1
engine only
) S (Single
DR14 JUDD Bridgeport
V 1 JF K V 229 BDR B 6000
............
engine only
) BDR (Twins
G I JF K 21 0 JFK V229 Bridgeport
4 ZIG -2100) 6000
............ V18 tween 1400 gine only) Capital City
only, n/a be V 22 9 B D R (Single en 4000
W IE V 1 JF K
............ HO V469 HAR
4 00D DQO
............ V18

Figure 2-22. Atlantic City Airport/Facility Directory, Tower En Route Control route descriptions.

column, IFR flights may be planned to satellite airports in


the proximity of major airports via the same routing. When
filing flight plans, the coded route identifier (i.e., BURL 1,
VTUL4, or POML3) may be used in lieu of the route of flight.

Airway and Route System


There are three fixed route systems established for
air navigation purposes. They are the Federal airway
consisting of VOR (low victor airways, high jet routes),
NDB (low or medium frequency) and the RNAV route
system. To the extent possible, these route systems are
aligned in an overlying manner to facilitate transition
between each. The majority of the airways are made up
of victor airways, jet routes, and RNAV, but some low/
medium frequency (L/MF) airways and routes are still
being used in Alaska and one other that is located off
the coast of North Carolina and is called Green 13 (G13).
[Figure 2-23]

Airway/Route Depiction
IFR en route charts show all IFR radio NAVAIDs that have
been flight-checked by the FAA and are operational.
Figure 2-23. Low frequency airway G13.
The FAA, AeroNav Products publishes and distributes
U.S. Government Civil Aeronautical Charts and flight
information publications. IFR en route navigation
information is provided on three charts: IFR en route low
altitude chart, IFR en route high altitude chart, and Terminal

2-13
Figure 2-24. IFR en route low altitude (left) and high altitude (right) charts.

Area Chart (TAC). [Figure 2-24A and B] charted as A1). Green and red airways are plotted east and
west, and amber and blue airways are plotted north and
IFR En Route Low Altitude Chart south. Regardless of their color identifier, LF/MF airways
En route low altitude charts provide aeronautical information are depicted in brown. [Figure 2-27]
for navigation under IFR conditions below 18,000 feet MSL.
Low altitude charts [Figure 2-25] include the following Airway/route data, such as the airway identifications,
information: bearings or radials, mileages, and altitude (e.g., MEA),
minimum obstacle clearance altitude (MOCA), and MAA,
Airways [Figure 2-25A]
are shown aligned with the airway and in the same color
RNAV routes [Figure 2-25B] as the airway. [Figure 2-26]
Limits of controlled airspace [Figure 2-25C]
All airways/routes that are predicated on VOR or VORTAC
VHF radio aids to navigation (frequency, identification, NAVAIDs are defined by the outbound radial from the
channel, geographic coordinates) [Figure 2-25D] NAVAID. Airways/routes that are predicated on LF/MF
Airports that have an instrument approach procedure NAVAIDs are defined by the inbound bearing.
or a minimum 3,000 foot hard surface runway
[Figure 2-25E] New low altitude RNAV routes have been created by the
Off-route obstruction clearance altitudes (OROCA) FAA. RNAV routes provide more direct routing for IFR
[Figure 2-25F] aircraft and enhance the safety and efficiency of the NAS. In
order to utilize these routes, aircraft must be equipped with
Reporting points [Figure 2-25G] IFR approved GNSS. In Alaska, when using RNAV routes, the
Special use airspace areas [Figure 2-25H] aircraft must be equipped with Technical Standing Order
(TSO)-145a and 146a equipment.
Military training routes [Figure 2-25I]
Low altitude RNAV only routes are identified by the letter
IFR aeronautical charts depict VOR airways (airways based
T prefix, followed by a three digit number (T-200 to T-500).
on VOR or VORTAC NAVAIDs) in black, identified by a V
RNAV routes are depicted in aeronautical blue, as well as the
(Victor) followed by the route number (e.g., V12). [Figure
RNAV route data, which includes the following [Figure 2-28]:
2-26] LF/MF airways (airways based on LF/MF NAVAIDs)
are sometimes referred to as colored airways because they Route line
are identified by color name and number (e.g., Amber One,

2-14
A S 50 0 B
Magnetic reference bearing
3 50 0G
*35 00 GRANT
6000G
V4 NGOZI *5400 269
30 310 088 T270
5000G 268
087 67
T270
Victor Route (with RNAV/GPS 70 Waypoint
MEA shown in blue)

C D 122.4 E VALENTINE
Miller Fld
H
AINSWORTH (VTN)
112.7 ANW 74 2596 L 47
N4234.15' W9959.38'
COLUMBUS

+ VALENTINE
314 VTN

248

086 Hot Springs Muni


(HSR)
90 53 D
F V1 0 G 3150 L 45
00

15
35 10 V60 83
L
3 29 28.55
x
H
Exclusion area and note
SPECIAL USE AIRSPACE

P-00
R-000 Line delimits
W-000 WALL 1 internal separation
2 MOA
23
of same special
154
A-000
TAFOY WALL 2
27 26 CYR-000
CYA-000 MOA use area or
exclusion areas
(MU) D-000
122.4
152

H
9

I AINSWORTH
114.0 MAI 87
N3047.17' W8507.47'
7 GAINESVILLE
IR-15-1

Figure 2-25. Information found on en route low altitude charts.

Figure 2-27. LF/MF airways.

Figure 2-26. Victor airways.

2-15
Figure 2-28. Low altitude RNAV routes.

Identification boxes each segment is established to ensure obstacle clearance


Mileages and communications reception. All MEAs are identified
with a G suffix. [Figure 2-29]
Waypoints
Waypoint names Joint Victor/RNAV routes are depicted using black for
Magnetic reference bearings the victor airways and blue for the RNAV routes, and the
identification boxes for each are shown adjacent to one
MEAs another. Magnetic reference bearings are not shown. MEAs
are stacked in pairs or in two separate columns, GNSS and
Magnetic reference bearings are shown originating from a Victor. On joint routes, RNAV specific information is printed
waypoint, fix/reporting point, or NAVAID. A GNNS MEA for in blue. [Figure 2-30]

Magnetic reference bearing


GRANT
6000G
NGOZI *5400 269
088 T270
5000G 268
087 67
T270
70
Waypoint

Figure 2-29. Low altitude RNAV route data.

10000 10000
7000G 8000G VAL
JES 7000G BILLY TOMMY *6700 YATES
*6700
4400 332
333 T228 V333
10 10 49 109 40

Figure 2-30. Joint Victor/RNAV airway.

2-16
6
KIDER J2
ROBINSON 237

57

9
40

21
108.2 RBA[L] 19
ST JOSEPH
Rosaceach Mem FONIX
[STJ] 35 27 83
060 260
HUGIN

92
080 38
111 263
AGENT
085 31 34

002
CORIM
6
J2

51
BRAYMER
2
11

21
111.2 BQS[L] 49
Kansas City Intl
SAAGS

016

M 106
333
J96 244 (MCI) J80

2
68

14
Sherman AAF
133 057

115.9 SU
(FLV) MOSBY

7
J8
075 Midwest National

21
66 266 Air Control
091
257 J2
4 (GPH)
DRIVL
1 KANSAS CITY 55
23 Charles B Wheeler
TOPEKA NAPOLEON
Downtown 114.0 ANX[L] 87

190
Philip Billard Muni
(TOP) (MKC)

70
Marshall Mem Muni

14
Lawrence Muni COLUMBIA 122.6 (MHI)

5
N39'
(LWC)

7
J8
Figure 2-31. IFR en route high altitude chart.

134
Waypoint

1300-06002
Q3
Redding Mun

IFR En Route High Altitude Chart


i
(RDD)

110

1300-06002
MEA-24000D 203

Q5
En route high altitude charts provide aeronautical
KO63E

MEA-26000D
information for navigation under IFR conditions at and 122.4

MEA-22000
RED BLUFF H

above FL180 . [Figure 2-31] High altitude charts include

J501
115.7 RBA 104

135

330
1300-06002

352
Q1
N4005.93'

0
W12214.18'

01
the following information:
RANCHO MURIETA
MEA-24000D
Red Bluff Mun
i

264
(RBL)

Jet route structure

J189
247
KO60E
N40
RNAV Q-routes

144
MEA CAP

162

W122
Chico Muni
Waypoint
VHF radio aids to navigation (frequency, ID, channel, (CIC)

geographic coordinates)
Selected airports Figure 2-32. Navigation reference system (NRS) waypoints.

Reporting points VORTAC NAVAIDs. [Figure 2-33] RNAV Q Route MEAs are
shown when other than 18,000 feet. [Figure 2-34] MEAs
Navigation reference system (NRS) waypoints
for GNSS RNAV aircraft are identified with a G suffix.
[Figure 2-32]
MEAs for DME/DME/IRU RNAV aircraft do not have a G
suffix. All RNAV routes and associated data is charted in
Jet routes are depicted in black with a J identifier followed aeronautical blue and magnetic reference bearings are
by the route number (e.g., J12) and are based on VOR or

J80
Green River Muni 71
96 (U34)

CEDAR CITY 111.2


J1 MOAB
Camyonlands Fld
(CNY)
(OFTEC)
X SAKES

R-6413
153 J80 203 00
30
156

132 52
-3 6 2
EA J19 9 055 J28
M 15
50
073
254
J28
Honksville

Figure 2-33. High altitude jet routes.

2-17
radar monitoring capabilities. For aircraft that have DME/
DME/IRU RNAV equipment, refer to the A/FD for specific

149
DME information.
W123

VHF Airways

1300-06002
Victor airways are a system of established routes that

69
Q3
run along specified VOR radials, from one VOR station to
another. The purpose is to make flight planning easier
1300-06002
69
Q1

and they help ATC to organize and regulate the air traffic

69

1300-06002
Q5
flow. Almost all commercial flights are routed along these
airways but they are available for use by any pilot provided
MEA-24000D

115.9 SUM 106


that the proper altitudes are employed.

MEA-24000D Victor Airway Navigation Procedures


MEA-26000D

The procedure for getting established on a victor airway


is to either fly directly to a nearby VOR or to intercept
an airway radial along the route of flight. Once the pilot
is established on an airway, it is important to follow the
150

procedures and guidelines put in place to ensure air traffic


separation and optimal safety on the airway. When using
150

victor airways for navigation, procedures do not allow the


pilot to jump from one VOR to another, but must navigate
113

from one to the next by using the alternating outbound/


343

343

inbound procedure of linking VORs. For example, when


343

ENVIE OTTOO
departing from Zanesville VOR on V-214, the pilot selects
HOMEG the 090 radial with a FROM indication on the course
deviation indicator (CDI) and should correct as necessary
163

FINER
163

162

to continuously maintain track on the centerline of the


airway. [Figure 2-36] The pilot should continue on this
course until it is time to change over to the inbound course
to the Bellaire VOR.

LF/MF Airways
The basic LF/MF airway width is 4.34 nautical miles (NM)
Figure 2-34. MEAs on RNAV (Q) routes. on each side of the centerline; the width expands by five
degrees when the distance from the facility providing
course guidance is greater than 49.66 NM. [Figure 2-37]

MEA - 27000 En Route Obstacle Clearance Areas


MEA - 23000G All published routes in the NAS are based on specific
J12 Q7 obstacle clearance criteria. An understanding of en route
300 obstacle clearance areas helps with SA and may help avoid
JointJet/RNAV Route controlled flight into terrain (CFIT). Obstacle clearance
areas for the en route phase of flight are identified as
primary, secondary, and turning areas.
Figure 2-35. Joint jet/RNAV routes.
The primary and secondary area obstacle clearance
shown originating from a waypoint, fix/reporting point, criteria, airway and route widths, and the ATC separation
or NAVAID. When joint Jet/RNAV routes are depicted, the procedures for en route segments are a function of
route identification boxes are located adjacent to each safety and practicality in flight procedures. These flight
other with the route charted in black. [Figure 2-35] With procedures are dependent upon the pilot, the aircraft, and
the exception of Q routes in the Gulf of Mexico, GNSS or the navigation system being used, resulting in a total VOR
DME/DME/IRU RNAV equipment is required along with system accuracy factor along with an associated probability

2-18
59-115

17
122.5 122.2 122.1R

V1 30
[2P7]

33
3000
2500

3
A 1187 L*28

15

4
ZANESVILLE
111.4 ZZV 51 CLEVELAND
N4234.15' W9959.38' Bolonl 300
Barnesville Brodfield 120.4 257.975
347
CLEVELAND (6G5)
ZANDR 33 1312 L 4D
276 272
3000 N40
LORES
SABGE
V214
29 50
090 9 21
12

4
Cambridge Muni

22

15
Zoneville Muni 109 (CDI)

15
209

8
(ZZV)
263
799 L 43
900 L 50 12 MUNCE 122.1R
A
5
HISOM 34 BELLAIRE
117.1AIR 118
14

17

43
V1 000
7

22
183

N4031.00' W9949.04'

17 7
CLEVELAND

1
3
Figure 2-36. Zanesville VOR/Victor Airway 214.

49.66 NM

4.34 NM 5 5

NBD 5 5 NBD

Figure 2-37. LF/MR airway width.

factor. The pilot/aircraft information component of these Primary and Secondary En Route Obstacle
criteria includes pilot ability to track the radial and the flight Clearance Areas
track resulting from turns at various speeds and altitudes The primary obstacle clearance area has a protected width
under different wind conditions. The navigation system of 8 NM with 4 NM on each side of the centerline. The
information includes navigation facility radial alignment primary area has widths of route protection based upon
displacement, transmitter monitor tolerance, and receiver system accuracy of a 4.5 angle from the NAVAID. These
accuracy. All of these factors were considered during 4.5 lines extend out from the NAVAID and intersect the
development of en route criteria. From this analysis, the boundaries of the primary area at a point approximately
computations resulted in a total system accuracy of 4.5 51 NM from the NAVAID. Ideally, the 51 NM point is where
95 percent of the time and 6.7 99 percent of the time. pilots would change over from navigating away from the
The 4.5 figure became the basis for primary area obstacle facility, to navigating toward the next facility, although this
clearance criteria, airway and route widths, and the ATC ideal is rarely achieved. [Figure 2-38]
separation procedures. The 6.7 value provides secondary
obstacle clearance area dimensions. If the distance from the NAVAID to the change-over point
(COP) is more than 51 NM, the outer boundary of the
primary area extends beyond the 4 NM width along the

4 NM 51
4.5 4.5
V214
4.5 4.5
4 NM 51

Primary obstacle clearance area

Figure 2-38. Primary obstacle clearance area.

2-19
Nonmountainous Mountainous

Primary en route obstacle clearance area Total width of secondary area

Primary Area

Secondary Area
1,000 feet above highest obstacle

500 feet

Figure 2-41. Primary and secondary obstacle clearance area.

from the NAVAID to the COP is more than 51 NM, the


secondary area extends along the 6.7 line when the COP
is at mid-point. [Figure 2-40] In all areas, mountainous and
non-mountainous, obstacles that are located in secondary
areas are considered as obstacles to air navigation if they
extend above the secondary obstacle clearance plane.
This plane begins at a point 500 feet above the obstacles
Figure 2-39. Non-mountainous obstacle clearance in the primary (natural or man-made) upon which the primary obstacle
area. clearance area is based, and slants upward at an angle that
causes it to intersect the outer edge of the secondary area
4.5 line when the COP is at midpoint. This means the at a point 500 feet higher. [Figure 2-41]
primary area, along with its obstacle clearance criteria, is
extended out into what would have been the secondary Changeover Points
area. Additional differences in the obstacle clearance area When flying airways, pilots normally change frequencies
result in the case of the effect of an offset COP or dogleg midway between NAVAIDs, although there are times
segment. For protected en route areas, the minimum when this is not practical. If the navigation signals cannot
obstacle clearance in the primary area, not designated as be received from the second VOR at the midpoint of the
mountainous under 14 CFR Part 95IFR altitude, is 1,000 route, a COP is depicted and shows the distance in NM to
feet over the highest obstacle. [Figure 2-39] The secondary each NAVAID. [Figure 2-42] COPs indicate the point where a
obstacle clearance area extends along a line 2 NM on each frequency change is necessary to receive course guidance
side of the primary area. Navigation system accuracy in from the facility ahead of the aircraft instead of the one
the secondary area has widths of route protection of a behind. These COPs divide an airway or route segment and
6.7 angle from the NAVAID. These 6.7 lines intersect the ensure continuous reception of navigation signals at the
outer boundaries of the secondary areas at the same point prescribed minimum en route IFR altitude. They also ensure
as primary lines, 51 NM from the NAVAID. If the distance that other aircraft operating within the same portion of

2 NM

4 NM 6.7 51 6.7
V214
6.7 51 6.7
4 NM

2 NM

Secondary obstacle clearance area

Figure 2-40. Secondary obstacle clearance area.

2-20
22

V344
13,000 45

13,000 ft

Figure 2-42. Changeover points.

an airway or route segment receive consistent azimuth also result in a flare at the COP.
signals from the same navigation facilities regardless of
the direction of flight. Direct Route Flights
Direct route flights are flights that are not flown on the
Where signal coverage from two VORs overlaps at the MEA, radials or courses of established airways or routes. Direct
the COP normally is designated at the midpoint. Where route flights must be defined by indicating the radio fixes
radio frequency interference or other navigation signal over which the flight passes. Fixes selected to define the
problems exist, the COP is placed at the optimum location, route should be those over which the position of the aircraft
taking into consideration the signal strength, alignment can be accurately determined. Such fixes automatically
error, or any other known condition that affects reception. become compulsory reporting points for the flight, unless
The COP has an effect on the primary and secondary advised otherwise by ATC. Only those NAVAIDs established
obstacle clearance areas. On long airway or route segments, for use in a particular structure (i.e., in the low or high
if the distance between two facilities is over 102 NM and the structures) may be used to define the en route phase of a
COP is placed at the midpoint, the system accuracy lines direct flight within that altitude structure.
extend beyond the minimum widths of 8 and 12 NM, and a
flare or spreading outward results at the COP. [Figure 2-43] Figure 2-44 shows a straight line on a magnetic course
Offset COP and dogleg segments on airways or routes can from SCRAN intersection of 270 direct to the Fort Smith

Flare

2 NM

4 NM 70 6.7
4.5
V214
4.5
4 NM 6.7 70

2 NM

Secondary areas
Flare
Primary areas

Figure 2-43. Changeover point effect on long airway or route segment.

2-21
T I O
IG A
AV
R N AT I O N

FO AV IG
R N
F O
OT
N
Figure 2-44. Direct route navigation.

Regional Airport in Arkansas that passes just north of operational service volume limits, pilot use of such aids
restricted areas R-2401A and B and R-2402. Since the airport for defining a direct route of flight in controlled airspace
and the restricted areas are precisely plotted, there is an should not exceed the following:
assurance that you will stay north of the restricted areas. 1. Operations above FL 450use NAVAIDs not more
From a practical standpoint, it might be better to fly direct than 200 NM apart. These aids are depicted on en
to the Wizer NDB. This route goes even further north of the route high altitude charts.
restricted areas and places you over the final approach fix
to Runway 25 at Fort Smith. 2. Operation off established routes from 18,000 feet
MSL to FL 450use NAVAIDs not more than 260
The azimuth feature of VOR aids and the azimuth and NM apart. These aids are depicted on en route high
distance (DME) features of VORTAC and TACAN aids are altitude charts.
assigned certain frequency protected areas of airspace that 3. Operation off established airways below 18,000 feet
are intended for application to established airway and route MSLuse NAVAIDs not more than 80 NM apart.
use and to provide guidance for planning flights outside These aids are depicted on en route low altitude charts.
of established airways or routes. These areas of airspace
4. Operation off established airways between 14,500
are expressed in terms of cylindrical service volumes of
feet MSL and 17,999 feet MSL in the conterminous
specified dimensions called class limits or categories.
United States(H) facilities not more than 200NM
apart may be used.
An operational service volume has been established
for each class in which adequate signal coverage and
Increasing use of self-contained airborne navigational
frequency protection can be assured. To facilitate use
systems that do not rely on the VOR/VORTAC/TACAN
of VOR, VORTAC, or TACAN aids, consistent with their

2-22
system has resulted in pilot requests for direct routes that for information changes, and you may find some differences
exceed NAVAID service volume limits. These direct route between charts.
requests are approved only in a radar environment with
approval based on pilot responsibility for navigation on the Basic designators for air traffic service (ATS) routes and
authorized direct route. Radar flight following is provided their use in voice communications have been established.
by ATC for ATC purposes. At times, ATC initiates a direct One of the main purposes of a system of route designators
route in a radar environment that exceeds NAVAID service is to allow both pilots and ATC to make unambiguous
volume limits. In such cases, ATC provides radar monitoring reference to RNAV airways and routes. Basic designators
and navigational assistance as necessary. for ATS routes consist of a maximum of five, and in no
case to exceed six, alpha/numeric characters in order to be
When filing for a direct route flight, airway or jet route usable by both ground and airborne automation systems.
numbers, appropriate to the stratum in which operation The designator indicates the type of the route, such as
is conducted, may also be included to describe portions high/low altitude, specific airborne navigation equipment
of the route to be flown. The following is an example of requirements, such as RNAV, and the aircraft type using the
how a direct route flight would be written. route primarily and exclusively. The basic route designator
consists of one or two letter(s) followed by a number from
MDW V262 BDF V10 BRL STJ SLN GCK 1 to 999.

Spelled out: from Chicago Midway Airport via Victor Composition of Designators
262 to Bradford, Victor 10 to Burlington, Iowa, direct St. The prefix letters that pertain specifically to RNAV
Joseph, Missouri, direct Salina, Kansas, direct Garden designations are included in the following list:
City, Kansas.
1. The basic designator consists of one letter of the
NOTE: When route of flight is described by radio fixes, alphabet followed by a number from 1 to 999. The
the pilot is expected to fly a direct course between the letters may be:
points named. a. A, B, G, Rfor routes that form part of the
regional networks of ATS route and are not
Pilots should keep in mind that they are responsible RNAV routes;
for adhering to obstruction clearance requirements b. L, M, N, Pfor RNAV routes that form part of
on those segments of direct routes that are outside of
the regional networks of ATS routes;
controlled airspace. The MEAs and other altitudes shown
on low altitude IFR en route charts pertain to those route c. H, J, V, Wfor routes that do not form part of
segments within controlled airspace, and those altitudes the regional networks of ATS routes and are not
may not meet obstruction clearance criteria when RNAV routes;
operating off those routes. d. Q, T, Y, Zfor RNAV routes that do not form
part of the regional networks of ATS routes.
Published RNAV Routes
2. Where applicable, one supplementary letter must be
Published RNAV routes are fixed, permanent routes that
added as a prefix to the basic designator as follows:
can be flight planned and flown by aircraft with RNAV
capability. These are being expanded worldwide as a. Kto indicate a low level route established for
new RNAV routes are developed, and existing charted, use primarily by helicopters;
conventional routes are being designated for RNAV use. It b. Uto indicate that the route or portion thereof
is important to be alert to the rapidly changing application is established in the upper airspace;
of RNAV techniques being applied to conventional en
route airways. Published RNAV routes may potentially be c. Sto indicate a route established exclusively for
found on any en route chart. The published RNAV route use by supersonic airplanes during acceleration/
designation may be obvious, or, on the other hand, RNAV deceleration and while in supersonic flight.
route designations may be less obvious, as in the case 3. Where applicable, a supplementary letter may be
where a published route shares a common flight track with added after the basic designator of the ATS route as
a conventional airway. a suffix as follows:
a. Fto indicate that on the route or portion thereof
NOTE: The use of RNAV is dynamic and rapidly changing, advisory service only is provided;
therefore, en route charts are continuously being updated

2-23
b. Gto indicate that on the route or portion thereof prefixes K, U, or S, previously mentioned, are used in voice
flight information services only is provided; communications, they should be pronounced as:
c. Yfor RNP 1 routes at and above FL 200 to KKopter
indicate that all turns on the route between 30
UUpper, as in the English language
and 90 must be made within the tolerance of a
tangential arc between the straight leg segments SSupersonic
defined with a radius of 22.5 NM;
Where suffixes F, G, Y or Z specified in above, are used, the
d. Zfor RNP 1 routes at and below FL 190 to
flight crew should not be required to use them in voice
indicate that all turns on the route between 30
communications. Below is an example of how the letters
and 90 should be made within the tolerance
and numbers are spoken.
of a tangential arc between the straight leg
segments defined with a radius of 15 NM. A11Alpha Eleven
UR5Upper Romeo Five
NOTE: RNAV Q-routes require en route RNAV 2,
KB34Kopter Bravo Thirty Four
corresponding NAV/E2 code and PBN/C1-C4 based on
navigation system update source. UW456Upper Whiskey Four Fifty Six

Use of Designators in Communications The en route chart excerpt depicts three published RNAV jet
In voice communications, the basic letter of a designator routes: J804R, J888R, and J996R. [Figure 2-45] The R suffix
should be spoken in accordance with the International Civil is a supplementary route designator denoting an RNAV
Aviation Organization (ICAO) spelling alphabet. Where the route. The overlapping symbols for the AMOTT intersection

O N
I
AMOTT
N6053.97 W 1512163

T
114.3 ANC 221.3-37.0
280

A
22

G
61

I
MEA-28000 AMOTT
J888R 246
2376 10 J8

V
346

2 37 0
61 4R
2
.2

J99
6R

N A
O R
T F
N O
Figure 2-45. Published RNAV jet routes.

2-24
and waypoint indicate that AMOTT can be identified by 8. Plan additional route description waypoints as
conventional navigation or by latitude and longitude required to ensure accurate navigation via the filed
coordinates. Although coordinates were originally included route of flight. Navigation is the pilots responsibility
for aircraft equipped with an inertial navigation system unless ATC assistance is requested.
(INS), they are now a good way to cross check between 9. Plan the route of flight so as to avoid prohibited and
the coordinates on the chart and in the flight management restricted airspace by 3 NM unless permission has
system (FMS) or global positioning system (GPS) databases been obtained to operate in that airspace and the
to ensure you are tracking on your intended en route appropriate ATC facilities are advised.
course. The AMOTT RNAV waypoint includes bearing and
distance from the Anchorage VORTAC.
NOTE: To be approved for use in the NAS, RNAV equipment
must meet the appropriate system availability, accuracy,
Random RNAV Routes
and airworthiness standards. For additional guidance on
Random RNAV routes are direct routes that are based on
equipment requirements, see AC 20-130, Airworthiness
RNAV capability between waypoints defined in terms of
Approval of Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Systems for use in
latitude or longitude coordinates, degree-distance fixes,
the U.S. NAS and Alaska, or Advisory Circular (AC)
or offsets from established routes or airways at a specified
20-138, Airworthiness Approval of Positioning and
distance and direction. Radar monitoring by ATC is required
Navigation Systems. For airborne navigation database,
on all random RNAV routes. Random RNAV routes can
see AC 90-105, Approval Guidance for RNP Operations
only be approved in a radar environment. Factors that
and Barometric Vertical Navigation in the U.S. National
are considered by ATC when approving random RNAV
Airspace System.
routes include the capability to provide radar monitoring
and compatibility with traffic volume and flow. ATC radar
Pilots flying aircraft that are equipped with latitude/
monitor each flight; however, navigation on the random
longitude coordinate navigation capability, independent
RNAV route is the responsibility of the pilot.
of VOR/ TACAN references, may file for random RNAV routes
at and above FL 390 within the conterminous United States
Pilots flying aircraft that are equipped with approved area
using the following procedures:
navigation equipment may file for RNAV routes throughout
the NAS and may be filed for in accordance with the 1. File airport-to-airport flight plans prior to departure.
following procedures: 2. File the appropriate RNAV capability certification
1. File airport-to-airport flight plans. suffix in the flight plan.
2. File the appropriate RNAV capability certification 3. Plan the random route portion of the flight to
suffix in the flight plan. begin and end over published departure/arrival
transition fixes or appropriate NAVAIDs for airports
3. Plan the random route portion of the flight plan
without published transition procedures. The use of
to begin and end over appropriate arrival and
preferred departure and arrival routes, such as DP
departure transition fixes or appropriate NAVAIDs
and STAR where established, is recommended.
for the altitude stratum within which the flight is
conducted. The use of normal preferred DPs and 4. Plan the route of flight so as to avoid prohibited and
STAR, where established, is recommended. restricted airspace by 3 NM unless permission has
been obtained to operate in that airspace and the
4. File route structure transitions to and from the
appropriate ATC facility is advised.
random route portion of the flight.
5. Define the route of flight after the departure fix,
5. Define the random route by waypoints. File route
including each intermediate fix (turnpoint) and
description waypoints by using degree distance fixes
the arrival fix for the destination airport in terms
based on navigational aids that are appropriate for
of latitude/longitude coordinates plotted to the
the altitude stratum.
nearest minute or in terms of Navigation Reference
6. File a minimum of one route description waypoint System (NRS) waypoints. For latitude/longitude
for each ARTCC through whose area the random filing, the arrival fix must be identified by both the
route is flown. These waypoints must be located latitude/ longitude coordinates and a fix identifier
within 200 NM of the preceding centers boundary. as shown in the example below.
7. File an additional route description waypoint for MIA1 SRQ2 3407/106153 3407/11546 TNP4 LAX5
each turnpoint in the route.

2-25
1Departure airport 9. Make any in-flight requests for random RNAV
2Departure fix clearances or route amendments to an en route ATC
facility.
3Intermediate fix (turning point)
4Arrival fix Off-Airway Routes
5Destination airport 14 CFR Part 95 prescribes altitudes governing the operation
of aircraft under IFR on Federal airways, jet routes, RNAV low
Or: or high altitude routes, and other direct routes for which a
MEA is designated. In addition, it designates mountainous
areas and COPs. Off-airway routes are established in the
ORD 1 IOW 2 KP49G 3 KD34U 4 KL16O 5 OAL 6 same manner and in accordance with the same criteria
MOD27 SFO8 as airways and jet routes. If a pilot flies for a scheduled air
1Departure airport carrier or operator for compensation or hire, any requests for
2Transition fix (pitch point) the establishment of off-airway routes are initiated by the
company through the principal operations inspector (POI)
3Minneapolis ARTCC waypoint who works directly with the company and coordinates FAA
4Denver ARTCC waypoint approval. Air carrier authorized routes should be contained
5Los in the companys Operations Specifications (OpSpecs) under
Angeles ARTCC waypoint (catch point)
the auspices of the air carrier operating certificate. [Figure
6Transition fix 2-46]
7Arrival

8Destination Off-airway routes predicated on public navigation


airport
facilities and wholly contained within controlled airspace
are published as direct Part 95 routes. Off-airway routes
6. Record latitude/longitude coordinates by four predicated on privately owned navigation facilities or
figures describing latitude in degrees and minutes not contained wholly within controlled airspace are
followed by a solidus and five figures describing published as off-airway non- Part 95 routes. In evaluating
longitude in degrees and minutes. the adequacy of off-airway routes, the following items are
7. File at FL 390 or above for the random RNAV portion considered: the type of aircraft and navigation systems
of the flight. used; proximity to military bases, training areas, low level
military routes; and the adequacy of communications
8. Fly all routes/route segments on Great Circle tracks. along the route.

Commercial operators planning to fly off-airway routes


should have specific instructions in the companys
Authorized areas of Limitations, provisions, OpSpecs that address en route limitations and provisions
en route operation and reference paragraphs
regarding en route authorizations to use the GPS or other
The 48 contiguous United

O
States and the District of
R Note 1 RNAV systems in the NAS. The companys manuals and
Columbia
F checklists should include practices and procedures for

T
long-range navigation and training on the use of long

O S E
Canada, excluding Canadian Note 3 range navigation equipment. Minimum equipment lists

N U (MELs) and maintenance programs must address the long


MNPS airspace and the areas
of magnetic unreliability as

E AL
range navigation equipment. Examples of other selected
established in the Canadian
AIP
L
P U
areas requiring specialized en route authorization include
the following:

M T
SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS:

A
Note 1 - B-737 Class II navigation operations with a single long- Class I navigation in the United States Class A

S A
operation. C
range system is authorized only within this area of en route
airspace using area of long range navigation system.
Note 3 - Only B-747 and DC-10 operations authorized in these Class II navigation using multiple long range
areas.
navigation systems.
Figure 2-46. Excerpt of authorized areas of en route operation. Operations in central East Pacific airspace.

2-26
North Pacific operations. Off-Route Obstruction Clearance Altitude
Operations within North Atlantic (NAT) minimum An off-route obstruction clearance altitude (OROCA) is
navigation performance specifications (MNPS) an off-route altitude that provides obstruction clearance
airspace. with a 1,000 foot buffer in non-mountainous terrain areas
and a 2,000 foot buffer in designated mountainous areas
Operations in areas of magnetic unreliability.
within the United States. This altitude may not provide
North Atlantic operation (NAT/OPS) with two engine signal coverage from ground-based NAVAIDs, ATC radar,
airplanes under 14 CFR Part 121. or communications coverage. OROCAs are intended
Extended range operations (ER-OPS) with two primarily as a pilot tool for emergencies and SA. OROCAs
engine airplanes under 14 CFR Part 121. depicted on en route charts do not provide the pilot with
an acceptable altitude for terrain and obstruction clearance
Special fuel reserves in international operations.
for the purposes of off-route, random RNAV direct flights
Planned in-flight re-dispatch or re-release en route. in either controlled or uncontrolled airspace. OROCAs
Extended over water operations using a single long- are not subject to the same scrutiny as MEAs, minimum
range communication system. vectoring altitude (MVAs), MOCAs, and other minimum IFR
altitudes. Since they do not undergo the same obstruction
Operations in reduced vertical separation minimum evaluation, airport airspace analysis procedures, or
(RVSM) airspace. flight inspection, they cannot provide the same level of
confidence as the other minimum IFR altitudes.

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
Figure 2-47. Off-route obstacle clearance altitude.

2-27
GPS

COM PGA WPT


127.550 MIRAJ
134.650 DTK
134T/131kts 60 nm
VLOC 259M
113.50 TBC TRK

116.90 259M

N
PGA 30 nm DIS
ENR 100nm -1

O
193nm

I
no map
VLOC MSG NAV

A T
FMS map mode navigation display

G
TBC

GCN

V I
A
FMS

N
O R
T F
N O

Figure 2-48. Random RNAV route.

When departing an airport VFR intending to or needing to waypoint in each ARTCC area through which you intend
obtain an IFR clearance en route, you must be aware of the to fly. One of the biggest problems in creating an RNAV
position of your aircraft relative to terrain and obstructions. direct route is determining if the route goes through special
When accepting a clearance below the MEA, MIA, MVA, use airspace. For most direct routes, the chances of going
or the OROCA, you are responsible for your own terrain/ through prohibited, restricted, or special use airspace
obstruction clearance until reaching the MEA, MIA, or MVA. are good. In the United States, all direct routes should be
If unable to visually maintain terrain/obstruction clearance, planned to avoid prohibited or restricted airspace by at
pilots should advise ATC and state intentions of the flight. least 3 NM. If a bend in a direct route is required to avoid
[Figure 2-47] special use airspace, the turning point needs to be part
of the flight plan. Two of the most prominent long range
For all random RNAV flights, there needs to be at least one navigation systems today include FMS with integrated GPS

2-28
and stand-alone GPS. The following example is a simplified service stations (AFSSs) and ARTCCs/sectors, are usually
overview showing how the RNAV systems might be used the control point for NAVAID facility status. Pilots can query
to fly a random RNAV route. the appropriate FAA facility if they have questions in flight
regarding NAVAID status, in addition to checking NOTAMs
Shown in Figure 2-48, the aircraft is northeast of Tuba City prior to flight, since NAVAIDs and associated monitoring
VORTAC at FL 200 using RNAV (showing both GPS and equipment are continuously changing.
FMS), RNAV direct on a southwesterly heading to Lindbergh
Regional Airport in Winslow. As the pilot is monitoring his Navigational Gaps
or her position and cross-checking the avionics against the A navigational course guidance gap, referred to as an
high altitude en route chart, he or she receives a company MEA gap, describes a distance along an airway or route
message instructing to divert to Las Vegas, requiring a segment where a gap in navigational signal coverage
change in the flight plan as highlighted on the depicted exists. The navigational gap may not exceed a specific
chart excerpt. distance that varies directly with altitude, from 0 NM at
sea level to 65 NM at 45,000 feet MSL and not more than
During the flight deck review of the high and low altitude one gap may exist in the airspace structure for the airway
en route charts, the pilot determines that the best course or route segment. Additionally, a gap usually does not
of action is to fly direct to the MIRAJ waypoint, 28 DME occur at any airway or route turning point. To help ensure
northeast of the Las Vegas VORTAC on the 045 radial. This the maximum amount of continuous positive course
guidance available when flying, there are established
places the aircraft 193 NM out on a 259 magnetic course
en route criteria for both straight and turning segments.
inbound, and may help to avoid diverting north, allowing to
Where large gaps exist that require altitude changes, MEA
bypass the more distant originating and intermediate fixes
steps may be established at increments of not less than
feeding into Las Vegas. The pilot requests an RNAV random
2,000 feet below 18,000 feet MSL, or not less than 4,000
route clearance direct MIRAJ to expedite the flight. Denver feet at 18,000 MSL and above, provided that a total gap
Center comes back with the following amended flight plan does not exist for the entire segment within the airspace
and initial clearance into Las Vegas: structure. MEA steps are limited to one step between any
two facilities to eliminate continuous or repeated changes
Marathon five sixty four, turn right heading two six zero, of altitude in problem areas. The allowable navigational
descend and maintain one six thousand, cleared present gaps pilots can expect to see are determined, in part, by
position direct MIRAJ. reference to the graph depicted in Figure 2-49. Notice
the en route chart excerpt depicting that the MEA is
The latitude and longitude coordinates of the aircrafts established with a gap in navigation signal coverage
present position on the high altitude chart is N36 19.10 northwest of the Carbon VOR/DME on V134 . At the MEA
and W110 40.24 as the course is changed. Notice the GPS of 13,000, the allowable navigation course guidance gap
moving map (upper left), the FMS control display unit is approximately 18.5 NM, as depicted in Figure 2-49.
(below the GPS), and FMS map mode navigation displays The navigation gap area is not identified on the chart
(to the right of the GPS) as the flight is rerouted to Las Vegas. by distances from the navigation facilities. Proper flight
For SA, the pilot makes note that the altitude is well above planning will help pilots prepare for MEA gaps by insuring
any of the OROCAs on the direct route as the flight arrives that appropriate maps are available as they may need
in the Las Vegas area using the low altitude chart. to dead reckon through the gap. Calculating the ground
track (with adjustments for winds) before and after the
Monitoring of Navigation Facilities gap will also help to stay on course when navigational
course guidance is not available.
VOR, VORTAC, and instrument landing system (ILS) facilities,
as well as most NDBs and marker beacons installed by the
FAA, are provided with an internal monitoring feature. NAVAID Accuracy Check
Internal monitoring is provided at the facility through The CFRs and good judgment dictate that the equipment
the use of equipment that causes a facility shutdown if of aircraft flying under IFR be within a specified tolerance
performance deteriorates below established tolerances. before taking off. When approved procedures are available,
A remote status indicator also may be provided through they should be used for all equipment inspections.
the use of a signal- sampling receiver, microwave link, or
telephone circuit. Older FAA NDBs and some non-Federal VOR Accuracy
NDBs do not have the internal feature, and monitoring is VOR accuracy can be checked by using any of the following
accomplished by manually checking the operation at least methods: VOR test facility signal (VOT), VOR checkpoint
once each hour. FAA facilities, such as automated flight signs, dual VOR check, or airborne VOR check.

2-29
NOT FOR
60
NAVIGATION
55
MEA of airway or route segment (thousands of feet)
50

45

40

35

30

25

20

15

10 Sample: Enter with MEA of 13,000 feet. Read allowable gap 18.5 NM.

0
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95
Allowable navigation course guidance gap (NM)

Figure 2-49. Navigational course guidance gaps.

VOR test facilities (VOT)


VOT
Facility Name .............................. Type VOT
(Airport Name) ...........Frequency Facility Remarks
The VOT is an approved test signal and is located on an
airport. This enables the pilot to check the VOR accuracy
Bradlay Intl .................... 111.40 G from the flight deck before takeoff. Listed below are the
Bridgeport ..................... 109.25 G
Groton ........................... 110.25 G
steps used for a VOT:
Hartford ......................... 108.20 G 1. Tune the VOR receiver to the VOT frequency. VOT
frequencies can be found in the A/FD. [Figure 2-50]
Figure 2-50. VOR test facilities (VOT) frequencies.
These frequencies are coded with a series of Morse
code dots or a continuous 1020-cycle tone.
2. On the VOR, set the course selector to 0 and the
VOR 116.4 track bar (TB) indicator should read center. The TO-
FROM indicator should read FROM.

147 4.1 NM 3. Set the course selector to 180 and the TO-FROM
indicator should read TO and the TB should then be
DME and VOR check radial centered.
Figure 2-51. VOR checkpoint signs.

2-30
NOTE: Determining the exact error in the receiver is done 7. The maximum permissible difference between aircraft
by turning the track selector until the TB is centered and equipment and the designated radial is 4 and 0.5 NM
noting the degrees difference between 180 or 0. The of the posted distance.
maximum bearing error with the VOT system check is plus
or minus 4 and apparent errors greater than 4 indicate Dual VOR Check
that the VOR receiver is beyond acceptable tolerance. If a VOT or VOR checkpoint is not available and the aircraft is
equipped with dual VORs, the equipment may be checked
VOR Checkpoint Signs against one another by tuning both sets to the VOR facility
Many aerodromes have VOR checkpoint signs that are at the same time and noting the indicated bearings to that
located beside the taxiways. [Figure 2-51] These signs station. [Figure 2-52] A difference greater than 4 between
indicate the exact point on the aerodrome that there is the two VORs indicates that one of the receivers may be
sufficient signal strength from a VOR to check the aircrafts out of tolerance.
VOR receiver against the radial designated on the sign.
Listed below are the steps to use at a VOR checkpoint: Airborne VOR Check
1. Tune the proper VOR frequency. VOR equipment can also be checked for accuracy while in
flight by flying over a fix or landmark located on a published
2. Identify the VOR frequency.
radial and noting the indicated radial. Variances of more
3. Set the published radial on the course deviation than 6 from the published radial should be considered out
indicator (CDI). of tolerance and not be used for IFR navigation.
4. Confirm that the TB is centered.
NDB Accuracy Check
5. Check the needle sensitivity by changing the
The pilot must identify an NDB before using it for
omnibearing select (OBS) 10 each way.
navigation, and continuously monitor it while using it
6. Set the reciprocal of the radial and check the TO- for an instrument approach. The lack of an IDENT may
FROM flag change. indicate that the NDB is out of service, even though it may

Figure 2-52. Instrument panel with dual VORs.

2-31
still be transmitting (for instance for maintenance or test fixes, used to define an RNAV route or the flight path of
purposes). If an incorrect IDENT is heard, then the NDB an aircraft employing RNAV. Waypoints may be a simple
should not be used. named point in space or may be associated with existing
NAVAIDs, intersections, or fixes. A waypoint is most often
RNAV Accuracy Check used to indicate a change in direction, speed, or altitude
RNAV accuracy checks may differ depending on the different along the desired path. Aviation RNAV procedures make
type of equipment and manufacturer. When available, all use of both fly-over and fly-by waypoints. A fly-over
written procedures should be followed. Below is a list of waypoint is a waypoint that must be crossed vertically by
generic checks that should be used when checking the an aircraft. A fly-by waypoint is a waypoint that marks the
intersection of two straight paths, with the transition from
one path to another being made by the aircraft using a
Alpha precisely calculated turn that flies by but does not vertically
cross the waypoint. [Figure 2-53]
Fly-by waypoint
User-Defined Waypoints
Pilots typically create user-defined waypoints for use in
their own random RNAV direct navigation. They are newly
established, unpublished airspace fixes that are designated
geographic locations/positions that help provide positive
course guidance for navigation and a means of checking
Alpha
Fly-over waypoint progress on a flight. They may or may not be actually
Bravo plotted by the pilot on en route charts, but would normally
be communicated to ATC in terms of bearing and distance
or latitude/longitude. An example of user-defined
waypoints typically includes those generated by various
means including keyboard input, and even electronic map
mode functions used to establish waypoints with a cursor
on the display.
Bravo
Another example is an offset phantom waypoint, which is
Figure 2-53. Fly-by and fly-over waypoints. a point-in-space formed by a bearing and distance from
NAVAIDs, such as VORTACs and tactical air navigation
accuracy of the system prior to flight. (TACAN) stations, using a variety of navigation systems.
When specifying unpublished waypoints in a flight plan,
1. System initializationpilots should confirm that
they can be communicated using the frequency/bearing/
the navigation database is current and verify that the
distance format or latitude and longitude, and they
aircrafts present position has been entered correctly.
automatically become compulsory reporting points unless
2. Active flight plan checkthe active flight plan should otherwise advised by ATC. All airplanes with latitude and
be checked by comparing the aeronautical charts, longitude navigation systems flying above FL 390 must use
departure and arrival procedures, and other applicable latitude and longitude to define turning points.
documents with the map display.
3. Prior to takeoffensure that the RNAV system is Floating Waypoints
available. If possible, check to see that the system is Floating waypoints, or reporting points, represent
updating when aircraft position is changing. airspace fixes at a point in space not directly associated
with a conventional airway. In many cases, they may be
NOTE: While in flight, continue to verify system accuracy established for such purposes as ATC metering fixes,
by displaying bearing/range to a VOR/DME on the RNAV holding points, RNAV-direct routing, gateway waypoints,
system and compare it to the actual RMI reading of that STAR origination points leaving the en route structure,
particular NAVAID. and SID terminating points joining the en route structure.
In the top example of Figure 2-54, a low altitude en
Waypoints route chart depicts three floating waypoints that have
been highlighted: SCORR, FILUP, and CHOOT. Notice that
Waypoints are predetermined geographical locations that
waypoints are named with five-letter identifiers that are
are defined in terms of latitude/longitude coordinates or
unique and pronounceable. Pilots must be careful of

2-32
Figure 2-54. Floating waypoints.

similar waypoint names. Notice on the high altitude en name is published for an approach waypoint or fix, it has
route chart excerpt in the bottom example, the similar been given a database identifier consisting of letters and
sounding and spelled floating waypoint named SCOOR, numbers. These points appear in the list of waypoints in the
rather than SCORR. This emphasizes the importance approach procedure database, but may not appear on the
of correctly entering waypoints into database-driven approach chart. A point used for the purpose of defining
navigation systems. One waypoint character incorrectly the navigation track for an airborne computer system (i.e.,
entered into your navigation system could adversely affect GPS or FMS) is called a Computer Navigation Fix (CNF). CNFs
your flight. The SCOOR floating reporting point also is include unnamed DME fixes, beginning and ending points
depicted on a Severe Weather Avoidance Plan (SWAP) en of DME arcs, and sensor final approach fixes (FAFs) on some
route chart. These waypoints and SWAP routes assist pilots GPS overlay approaches.
and controllers when severe weather affects the East Coast.
To aid in the approach chart/database correlation process,
Computer Navigation Performance the FAA has begun a program to assign five-letter names
to CNFs and to chart CNFs on various National Oceanic
An integral part of RNAV using en route charts typically
Service aeronautical products. [Figure 2-55] These CNFs
involves the use of airborne navigation databases.
are not to be used for any ATC application, such as holding
Because GPS receivers are basically to-to navigators,
for which the fix has not already been assessed. CNFs are
they must always be navigating to a defined point. On
charted to distinguish them from conventional reporting
overlay approaches, if no pronounceable five-character
2-33
O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
Figure 2-55. Computer navigation fix.

points, fixes, intersections, and waypoints. A CNF name is Required Navigation Performance
enclosed in parenthesis, e.g., (MABEE) and is placed next
Required navigation performance (RNP) is RNAV with
to the CNF it defines. If the CNF is not at an existing point
onboard navigation monitoring and alerting. RNP is also
defined by means such as crossing radials or radial/DME,
a statement of navigation performance necessary for
the point is indicated by an X. The CNF name is not used in
operation within a defined airspace. A critical component
filing a flight plan or in aircraft/ATC communications. Use
of RNP is the ability of the aircraft navigation system to
current phraseology (e.g., facility name, radial, distance) to
monitor its achieved navigation performance, and to
describe these fixes.
identify for the pilot whether the operational requirement
is, or is not being met during an operation. This onboard
Many of the RNAV systems available today make it all too
performance monitoring and alerting capability,
easy to forget that en route charts are still required and
therefore, allows a lessened reliance on ATC intervention
necessary for flight. As important as databases are, they
(via radar monitoring, automatic dependent surveillance-
really are onboard the airplane to provide navigation
broadcast (ADS-B), multilateration, communications),
guidance and SA; they are not intended as a substitute
and/or route separation to achieve the overall safety of
for paper charts. When flying with GPS, FMS, or planning
the operation. RNP capability of the aircraft is a major
a flight with a computer, it is critical to understand the
component in determining the separation criteria to
limitations of the system you are using, for example,
ensure that the overall containment of the operation is
incomplete information, unloadable procedures, complex
met.
procedures, and database storage limitations.

RNP Level Typical Application Primary Route Width (NM) - Centerline to Boundary
0.1 to 1.0 RNP AR Approach Segments 0.1 to 1.0
0.3 to 1.0 RNP Approach Segments 0.3 to 1.0
1 Terminal and En Route 1.0
2 En Route 2.0

Figure 2-56. U.S. standard RNP levels.

2-34
The RNP capability of an aircraft varies depending upon horizontal distance of 4 NM from the course to be flown. In
the aircraft equipment and the navigation infrastructure. any other case, an altitude of 1,000 feet above the highest
For example, an aircraft may be equipped and certified obstacle within a horizontal distance of 4 NM from the
for RNP 1.0, but may not be capable of RNP 1.0 operations course to be flown must be maintained as a minimum
due to limited NAVAID coverage. altitude. If both a MEA and a MOCA are prescribed for a
particular route or route segment, pilots may operate an
RNP Levels aircraft below the MEA down to, but not below, the MOCA,
An RNP level or type is applicable to a selected airspace, only when within 22 NM of the VOR. When climbing to
route, or procedure. As defined in the Pilot/Controller a higher minimum IFR altitude (MIA), pilots must begin
Glossary, the RNP level or type is a value typically expressed climbing immediately after passing the point beyond
as a distance in nautical miles from the intended centerline which that minimum altitude applies, except when ground
of a procedure, route, or path. RNP applications also obstructions intervene, the point beyond which that higher
account for potential errors at some multiple of RNP level minimum altitude applies must be crossed at or above the
(e.g., twice the RNP level). applicable MCA for the VOR.

Standard RNP Levels If on an IFR flight plan, but cleared by ATC to maintain VFR
United States standard values supporting typical RNP conditions on top, pilots may not fly below minimum en
airspace are shown in Figure 2-56. Other RNP levels as route IFR altitudes. Minimum altitude rules are designed to
identified by ICAO, other states, and the FAA may also be ensure safe vertical separation between the aircraft and the
used. terrain. These minimum altitude rules apply to all IFR flights,
whether in IFR or VFR weather conditions, and whether
Application of Standard RNP Levels assigned a specific altitude or VFR conditions on top.
United States standard levels of RNP typically used for
Minimum En Route Altitude (MEA)
various routes and procedures supporting RNAV operations
The MEA is the lowest published altitude between radio
may be based on use of a specific navigational system
fixes that assures acceptable navigational signal coverage
or sensor, such as GPS, or on multi-sensor RNAV systems
and meets obstacle clearance requirements between those
having suitable performance.
fixes. The MEA prescribed for a Federal airway or segment,
RNAV low or high route, or other direct route applies to the
NOTE: The performance of navigation in RNP refers not only
entire width of the airway, segment, or route between the
to the level of accuracy of a particular sensor or aircraft
radio fixes defining the airway, segment, or route. MEAs
navigation system, but also to the degree of precision
for routes wholly contained within controlled airspace
with which the aircraft is flown. Specific required flight
normally provide a buffer above the floor of controlled
procedures may vary for different RNP levels.
airspace consisting of at least 300 feet within transition
IFR En Route Altitudes areas and 500 feet within control areas. MEAs are established
based upon obstacle clearance over terrain and manmade
MEAs, minimum reception altitudes (MRA), maximum objects, adequacy of navigation facility performance, and
authorized altitudes (MAA), MOCA, minimum turning communications requirements.
altitudes (MTA) and minimum crossing altitudes (MCA) are
established by the FAA for instrument flight along Federal RNAV Minimum En Route Altitude
airways, as well as some off-airway routes. The altitudes are RNAV MEAs are depicted on some IFR en route low altitude
established after it has been determined that the NAVAIDs charts, allowing both RNAV and non-RNAV pilots to use the
to be used are adequate and so oriented on the airways or same chart for instrument navigation.
routes that signal coverage is acceptable, and that flight
can be maintained within prescribed route widths. Minimum Reception Altitude (MRA)
MRAs are determined by FAA flight inspection traversing
For IFR operations, regulations require that pilots operate an entire route of flight to establish the minimum altitude
their aircraft at or above minimum altitudes. Except when the navigation signal can be received for the route and for
necessary for takeoff or landing, pilots may not operate an off-course NAVAID facilities that determine a fix. When the
aircraft under IFR below applicable minimum altitudes, or MRA at the fix is higher than the MEA, an MRA is established
if no applicable minimum altitude is prescribed, in the case for the fix and is the lowest altitude at which an intersection
of operations over an area designated as mountainous, an can be determined.
altitude of 2,000 feet above the highest obstacle within a

2-35
Figure 2-57. Minimum authorized altitude (MAA).

Minimum obstacle clearance altitude

Figure 2-58. Minimum obstacle clearance altitude (MOCA).

Maximum Authorized Altitude (MAA) Minimum Obstruction Clearance Altitude


An MAA is a published altitude representing the maximum (MOCA)
usable altitude or flight level for an airspace structure The MOCA is the lowest published altitude in effect between
or route segment. [Figure 2-57] It is the highest altitude fixes on VOR airways, off-airway routes, or route segments
on a Federal airway, jet route, RNAV low or high route, that meets obstacle clearance requirements for the entire
or other direct route for which an MEA is designated at route segment. [Figure 2-58] This altitude also assures
which adequate reception of navigation signals is assured. acceptable navigational signal coverage only within 22 NM
MAAs represent procedural limits determined by technical of a VOR. The MOCA seen on the en route chart may have
limitations or other factors, such as limited airspace or been computed by adding the required obstacle clearance
frequency interference of ground-based facilities. (ROC) to the controlling obstacle in the primary area or
computed by using a TERPS chart if the controlling obstacle
is located in the secondary area. This figure is then rounded

2-36
MTA
V330 E to V520 W 16000
V465 NE to 330 W or V520 W 16000

Figure 2-59. Minimum turning altitude (MTA).

Fix displacement area Primary area


Secondary area

3.6


4.5

Centerline

Fac
ility
pro
vid
ing
inte
ity

rse
cil

ctio
fa

n ra
te

dia
u

l
ro
En

Figure 2-60. Turning area at the intersection fix with NAVAID distance less than 51 NM.

2-37
to the nearest 100 foot increment (i.e., 2,049 feet becomes route protected airspace by leading turns early before a
2,000, and 2,050 feet becomes 2,100 feet). An extra 1,000 fix. The turn area provides obstacle clearance for both turn
feet is added in mountainous areas, in most cases. anticipation (turning prior to the fix) and flyover protection
(turning after crossing the fix). This does not violate the
ATC controllers have an important role in helping pilots requirement to fly the centerline of the airway. Many factors
remain clear of obstructions. Controllers are instructed to enter into the construction and application of the turning
issue a safety alert if the aircraft is in a position that, in their area to provide pilots with adequate obstacle clearance
judgment, places the pilot in unsafe proximity to terrain, protection. These may include aircraft speed, the amount
obstructions, or other aircraft. Once pilots inform ATC of of turn versus NAVAID distance, flight track, curve radii,
action being taken to resolve the situation, the controller MEAs, and MTA. [Figure 2-60]
may discontinue the issuance of further alerts. A typical
terrain/obstruction alert may sound like this: (Aircraft call Due to increased airspeeds at 10,000 feet MSL or above, an
sign ), Low altitude alert. Check your altitude immediately. expanded area in the vicinity of the turning fix is examined
The MOCA in your area is 12,000. to ensure the published MEA is sufficient for obstacle
clearance. In some locations (normally mountainous),
Minimum Turning Altitude (MTA) terrain/obstacles in the expanded search area may obviate
Minimum turning altitude (MTA) is a charted altitude the published MEA and necessitate a higher minimum
providing vertical and lateral obstruction clearance based altitude while conducting the turning maneuver. Turning
on turn criteria over certain fixes, NAVAIDs, waypoints, fixes requiring a higher MTA are charted with a flag along
and on charted route segments. [Figure 2-59] When a with accompanying text describing the MTA restriction.
VHF airway or route terminates at a NAVAID or fix, the [Figure 2-59]
primary area extends beyond that termination point.
When a change of course on VHF airways and routes is An MTA restriction normally consists of the ATS route
necessary, the en route obstacle clearance turning area leading to the turning fix, the ATS route leading from the
extends the primary and secondary obstacle clearance turning fix, and an altitude (e.g., MTA V330 E TO V520
areas to accommodate the turn radius of the aircraft. Since W 16000). When an MTA is applicable for the intended
turns at or after fix passage may exceed airway and route route of flight, pilots must ensure they are at or above the
boundaries, pilots are expected to adhere to airway and charted MTA prior to beginning the turn and maintain at

Transmittal of Airways/Route Data

Airway From Routine Controlling @ MRA MAA Flight


GNSS Change Fix
number or docket terrain/Obstruction Remarks inspection
To MOCA MEA MEA over point MRA/MCA
or route number and coordinates dates
Idaho Falls, ID VOR/DME Tree 6177 @ 8000 17500 300 MTN ROC RED
432912.00N/1114118.00W DEL MCA ATIDA
V330 Terrain 6077 *9500E COME ADD MCA
*Osity, ID 432912.00N/1114118.00W --7900-- 8000 AT OSITY DEC MOCA

DEL directional MEA


MEA CARONIAL ALT

Osity, ID AAO 12138 (SEC) @


434118.30N/1104858.30W
14000 17500 INC MCA PRECIP
# MTA
V330 Terrain 11132 JAC 10 TER DEC MOCA
* 13400W MEA CARDINAL ALT
# Jackson, WY VOR/DME 433900.00N/1105057.00W --13600-- 14000

JAC R-251 UNUSABLE


BYD 10 # CHART:
MTA V330 E TO
VS20W 16000

Date Office Title Signature


AJW-3773 Manager Ray Nussear

Figure 2-61. Minimum turning altitude information located in the remarks section of FAA Form 8260-16 Transmittal of Airways/Route Data.

2-38
SQWID X
V 361 5900 E 5900
V361

5200
V361

Figure 2-62. Minimum crossing altitude (MCA).

or above the MTA until joining the centerline of the ATS using the following format [Figure 2-61]:
route following the turn. Once established on the centerline #CHART: MTA V330 E TO V520 W 16000
following the turning fix, the MEA/MOCA determines the (Document on V330 FAA Form 8260-16)
minimum altitude available for assignment.
#CHART: MTA V465 NE TO V330 W OR V520 W 16000
An MTA may also preclude the use of a specific altitude or (Document on V465 FAA Form 8260-16)
a range of altitudes during a turn. For example, the MTA
may restrict the use of 10,000 through 11,000 feet MSL. When an MTA is required by TERPS, Volume 1, paragraph
In this case, any altitude greater than 11,000 feet MSL is 1714(c), enter the MTA information in the REMARKS section
unrestricted, as are altitudes less than 10,000 feet MSL of FAA Form 8260-2, Radio Fix and Holding Data Record, as
provided MEA/MOCA requirements are satisfied. specified on the appropriate FAA Form 8260-16, Transmittal
of Airways/Route Data, using the following format:
All MTA information associated with the airway/route MTA: V330 E TO V520 W 16000
inbound to the turn fix/facility is put in the remarks section MTA: V465 NE TO V330 W OR V520 W 16000
of FAA Form 8260-16, Transmittal of Airways/Route Data,

Obstruction height 4,620'


Required clearance +2000'
MOCA at obstruction =6,620'
Climb value* 720'
MCA required =5,900'
* Based upon 6 NM @ 120 feet per NM ired feet
MCA 5900' E requ 720
' p e r NM 6 N M
120 iply b
y
X Mult
MEA 5200'
4620' MSL

' 700'
2000
2000'
6 NM
Obstacle Line Maximum Displacement

3200'

MSL

Figure 2-63. Minimum crossing altitude (MCA) determination point.

2-39
Minimum Crossing Altitude (MCA) from the fix. [Figure 2-63] When a change of altitude is
An MCA is the lowest altitude at certain fixes at which the involved with a course change, course guidance must be
aircraft must cross when proceeding in the direction of a provided if the change of altitude is more than 1,500 feet
higher minimum en route IFR altitude. [Figure 2-62] When and/or if the course change is more than 45, although
applicable, MCAs are depicted on the en route chart. [Figure there is an exception to this rule. In some cases, course
2-59] MCAs are established in all cases where obstacles changes of up to 90 may be approved without course
intervene to prevent pilots from maintaining obstacle guidance provided that no obstacles penetrate the
clearance during a normal climb to a higher MEA after established MEA requirement of the previous airway or
passing a point beyond which the higher MEA applies. The route segment. Outside United States airspace, pilots may
same protected en route area vertical obstacle clearance encounter different flight procedures regarding MCA and
requirements for the primary and secondary areas are transitioning from one MEA to a higher MEA. In this case,
considered in the determination of the MCA. The standard pilots are expected to be at the higher MEA crossing the
for determining the MCA is based upon the following climb fix, similar to an MCA. Pilots must thoroughly review flight
gradients and is computed from the flight altitude: procedure differences when flying outside United States
airspace. On IFR en route low altitude charts, routes and
Sea level through 5,000 feet MSL150 feet per NM
associated data outside the conterminous United States
5000 feet through 10,000 feet MSL120 feet per are shown for transitional purposes only and are not part
NM of the high altitude jet route and RNAV route systems.
10,000 feet MSL and over100 feet per NM [Figure 2-64]

To determine the MCA seen on an en route chart, the Minimum IFR Altitude (MIA)
distance from the obstacle to the fix is computed from The MIA for operations is prescribed in 14 CFR Part 91. These
the point where the centerline of the en route course in MIAs are published on aeronautical charts and prescribed
the direction of flight intersects the farthest displacement in 14 CFR Part 95 for airways and routes, and in
14 CFR Part 97 for standard instrument approach

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F DA CRO
H FIX AT
OR
SS EAC IMUM EN ROU
IN
IN CANATHE HIGHER M BLE TO FLIGHT.
ABOVE UDE APPLICA
TE

O
IFR ALTIT

N
Figure 2-64. En route chart minimum crossing altitude data (outside of the U.S.).

2-40
10,000

RIW

R
KS
15,800

32
5
12,000

RKS 003
T
14,500

E
0
07

O
CKW
13,700

N U S 10,700

E L
080
06
5 RKS

L
RKS

P A
RKS 269
3
24
11,000

12,000
A M T U 12,400
14
2

S AC
FBR 20 14,500
1
21

40

R
FO
60
001

15,500
14,200 80
270
VEL 065 0
13,800 10
RK

11
0
11,000
S1

13,300 0
180

12
60

12,300

Figure 2-65. MVA chart.

procedures. If no applicable minimum altitude is prescribed exercised. The MVA provides 1,000 feet of clearance above
in 14 CFR Parts 95 or 97, the following MIA applies: In the highest obstacle in non-mountainous areas and 2,000
designated mountainous areas, 2,000 feet above the feet above the highest obstacle in designated mountainous
highest obstacle within a horizontal distance of 4 NM areas. Because of the ability to isolate specific obstacles,
from the course to be flown; or other than mountainous some MVAs may be lower than MEAs, MOCAs, or other
areas, 1,000 feet above the highest obstacle within a minimum altitudes depicted on charts for a given location.
horizontal distance of 4 NM from the course to be flown; or While being radar vectored, IFR altitude assignments by
as otherwise authorized by the Administrator or assigned ATC are normally at or above the MVA.
by ATC. MIAs are not flight checked for communication.
Air traffic controllers use MVAs only when they are assured
Minimum Vectoring Altitudes (MVA) an adequate radar return is being received from the aircraft.
MVAs are established for use by ATC when radar ATC is Charts depicting MVAs are normally available to controllers
but not available to pilots. SA is always important, especially

2-41
18,000' MSL to flight level 290 CRUISING ALTITUDES Flight level 290 and above
IFR within controlled airspace as assigned by ATC

IFR 0 0
IFR
EVEN IFR 17 EVEN IFR 17
2,000' ODD 4,000' 4,000'

9
Intervals
2,000' Intervals

M
begin at Intervals
Intervals begin at
18,000' MSL
begin at
NO VFR FLIGHTS WITHIN FL 310
begin at
VFR or FL 190 CLASS A AIRSPACE VFR or VFR or
FL 290
VFR-ON-TOP VFR or VFR-ON-TOP VFR-ON-TOP
EVEN VFR-ON-TOP 4,000' 4,000'
2,000' ODD Intervals
Intervals Intervals
35

35
2,000' VFR above 3000' AGL unless otherwise begin at
begin at
9

9
begin at authorized by ATC IFR outside controlled
Intervals FL 320
M

M
FL 185 airspace all courses are magnetic FL 300
begin at
180 FL 195 180
Cruising altitudes - U.S.
IFR within controlled airspace as assigned by ATC

0
IFR 17
EVEN IFR

9
thousands

M
ODD
thousands
VFR or
ON-TOP VFR or
EVEN ON-TOP
thousands
ODD
plus
thousands
35

500'
plus
9

500'
M

VFR above 3,000' AGL unless otherwise


For additional symbol information 180 authorized by ATC IFR outside controlled
refer to the chart users guide. airspace all courses are magnetic

Figure 2-66. IFR cruising altitude or flight level.

when being radar vectored during a climb into an area with holding pattern of two minutes or less or while turning) if
progressively higher MVA sectors, similar to the concept operating an aircraft under IFR in level cruising flight, an
of MCA. Except where diverse vector areas have been appropriate altitude as depicted in the legend of IFR en
established, when climbing, pilots should not be vectored route high and low altitude charts must be maintained.
into a sector with a higher MVA unless at or above the next [Figure 2-66]
sectors MVA. Where lower MVAs are required in designated
mountainous areas to achieve compatibility with terminal When operating on an IFR flight plan below 18,000 feet
routes or to permit vectoring to an instrument approach MSL in accordance with a VFR-on-top clearance, any VFR
procedure, 1,000 feet of obstacle clearance may be cruising altitude appropriate to the direction of flight
authorized with the use of Airport Surveillance Radar between the MEA and 18,000 feet MSL may be selected that
(ASR). The MVA provides at least 300 feet above the floor of allows the flight to remain in VFR conditions. Any change in
controlled airspace. The MVA charts are developed to the altitude must be reported to ATC, and pilots must comply
maximum radar range. Sectors provide separation from with all other IFR reporting procedures. VFR-on-top is not
terrain and obstructions. Each MVA chart has sectors large authorized in Class A airspace. When cruising below 18,000
enough to accommodate vectoring of aircraft within the feet MSL, the altimeter must be adjusted to the current
sector at the MVA. [Figure 2-65] setting, as reported by a station within 100 NM of your
position. In areas where weather-reporting stations are
IFR Cruising Altitude or Flight Level more than 100 NM from the route, the altimeter setting of
In controlled airspace, pilots must maintain the altitude or a station that is closest may be used.
flight level assigned by ATC, although if the ATC clearance
assigns VFR conditions on-top, an altitude or flight level During IFR flight, ATC advises flights periodically of the
as prescribed by 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.159 must be current altimeter setting, but it remains the responsibility
maintained. In uncontrolled airspace (except while in a of the pilot or flight crew to update altimeter settings in a

2-42
timely manner. Altimeter settings and weather information specific approval from the aircrafts state of registry in
are available from weather reporting facilities operated or order to conduct operations in RVSM airspace. Non-RVSM
approved by the U.S. National Weather Service, or a source approved aircraft may transit through RVSM airspace
approved by the FAA. Some commercial operators have provided they are given continuous climb throughout the
the authority to act as a government-approved source of designated airspace, and 2,000 feet vertical separation is
weather information, including altimeter settings, through provided at all times between the non-RVSM flight and all
certification under the FAAs Enhanced Weather Information others for the duration of the climb/descent.
System.
Critics of the change were concerned that by reducing
Flight level operations at or above 18,000 feet MSL require the space between aircraft, RVSM may increase the
the altimeter to be set to 29.92 inches of mercury (" Hg). A number of mid-air collisions and conflicts. In the ten
flight level (FL) is defined as a level of constant atmospheric years since RVSM was first implemented, not one
pressure related to a reference datum of 29.92 " Hg. Each collision has been attributed to RVSM. In the United
flight level is stated in three digits that represent hundreds of States, this program was known as the Domestic
feet. For example, FL 250 represents an altimeter indication Reduced Vertical Separation Minimum (DRVSM).
of 25,000 feet. Conflicts with traffic operating below 18,000
feet MSL may arise when actual altimeter settings along the Cruise Clearance
route of flight are lower than 29.92 " Hg. Therefore, 14 CFR The term cruise may be used instead of maintain to
Part 91, section 91.121 specifies the lowest usable flight assign a block of airspace to an aircraft. The block extends
levels for a given altimeter setting range. from the minimum IFR altitude up to and including the
altitude that is specified in the cruise clearance. On a cruise
Reduced Vertical Separation Minimums (RSVM) clearance, you may level off at any intermediate altitude
Reduced vertical separation minimums (RVSM) is a term within this block of airspace. You are allowed to climb or
used to describe the reduction of the standard vertical descend within the block at your own discretion. However,
separation required between aircraft flying at levels once you start descent and verbally report leaving an
between FL 290 (29,000 feet) and FL 410 (41,000 feet) altitude in the block to ATC, you may not return to that
from 2,000 feet to 1,000 feet. The purpose, therefore, altitude without an additional ATC clearance. A cruise
increases the number of aircraft that can safely fly in a clearance also authorizes you to execute an approach at
particular volume of airspace. Historically, standard vertical the destination airport.
separation was 1,000 feet from the surface to FL 290, 2,000
feet from FL 290 to FL 410 and 4,000 feet above this. This Lowest Usable Flight Level
was because the accuracy of the pressure altimeter (used When the barometric pressure is 31.00 " Hg or less and
to determine altitude) decreases with height. Over time, pilots are flying below 18,000 feet MSL, use the current
air data computers (ADCs) combined with altimeters reported altimeter setting. When an aircraft is en route
have become more accurate and autopilots more adept on an instrument flight plan, air traffic controllers furnish
at maintaining a set level; therefore, it became apparent this information at least once while the aircraft is in the
that for many modern aircraft, the 2,000 foot separation controllers area of jurisdiction. When the barometric
was not required . It was therefore proposed by ICAO that pressure exceeds 31.00 " Hg, the following procedures are
this be reduced to 1,000 feet. placed in effect by NOTAM defining the geographic area
affected: Set 31.00 " Hg for en route operations below
Between 1997 and 2005, RVSM was implemented in all of 18,000 feet MSL and maintain this setting until beyond
Europe, North Africa, Southeast Asia, North America, South the affected area. ATC issues actual altimeter settings and
America, and over the North Atlantic, South Atlantic, and advises pilots to set 31.00 " Hg in their altimeter, for en route
Pacific Oceans. The North Atlantic implemented initially in operations below 18,000 feet MSL in affected areas. If an
March 1997, at FL 330 through FL 370. The entire western aircraft has the capability of setting the current altimeter
hemisphere implemented RVSM FL 290FL 410 on January setting and operating into airports with the capability of
20, 2005. measuring the current altimeter setting, no additional
restrictions apply. At or above 18,000 feet MSL, altimeters
Only aircraft with specially certified altimeters and should be set to 29.92 " Hg (standard setting). Additional
autopilots may fly in RVSM airspace, otherwise the aircraft procedures exist beyond the en route phase of flight.
must fly lower or higher than the airspace, or seek special
exemption from the requirements. Additionally, aircraft The lowest usable flight level is determined by the
operators (airlines or corporate operators) must receive atmospheric pressure in the area of operation. As local

2-43
O N
T I
TO
N FIR
CRABB

G A
I
N42 13.00
NC M .00
MO CZQ TER W65 44
M E H
I
T QN QNE

V
AL

N A
O R
T F
N O FAA AIR SERVICE
OUTSIDE U.S. AIRSPA
IS PROVIDED IN ACC
ARTICLE 12 AND ANN
CONVENTION. ICA
APPLICABLE TO STA
ORDANCE WITH
EX 11 OF ICAO
O CONVENTION NO
TE AIRCRAFT BUT
T
CE

COMPLIANCE WIT
H ICAO STANDARD
AND PRACTICES IS S
ENCOURAGED.

Figure 2-67. Altimeter setting changes.

altimeter settings fall below 29.92 " Hg, pilots operating Altimeter Setting Correction Factor
in Class A airspace must cruise at progressively higher
29.92 or higher
indicated altitudes to ensure separation from aircraft
operating in the low altitude structure as follows: 29.91 to 29.42 500 feet
29.41 to 28.92 1,000 feet
Current Altimeter Setting Lowest Usable Flight Level 28.91 to 28.42 1,500 feet
29.92 or higher 180 28.41 to 27.91 2,000 feet
29.91 to 29.42 185 27.91 to 27.42 2,500 feet
29.41 to 28.92 190
Operations in Other Countries
28.91 to 28.42 195
When flight crews transition from the U.S. NAS to another
28.41 to 27.91 200 countrys airspace, they should be aware of differences not
only in procedures but also airspace. For example, when
When the minimum altitude, as prescribed in 14 CFR Part flying into Canada as depicted in Figure 2-67, notice the
91, sections 91.159 and 91.177, is above 18,000 feet MSL, change from transition level (QNE) to transition altitude
the lowest usable flight level is the flight level equivalent (QNH) when flying north-bound into the Moncton flight
of the minimum altitude plus the number of feet specified information region (FIR).
according to the lowest flight level correction factor as
follows:

2-44
RADAR/NON-RADAR REPORTS
These reports should be made at all times without a specific ATC request.
REPORTS EXAMPLE

Leaving one assigned flight altitude or flight level for another "Marathon 564, leaving 8,000, climb to 10,000."
VFR-on-top change in altitude "Marathon 564, VFR-on-top, climbing to 10,500."
Leaving any assigned holding fix or point "Marathon 564, leaving FARGO Intersection."
Missed approach "Marathon 564, missed approach, request clearance to Chicago."
Unable to climb or descend at least 500 feet per minute "Marathon 564, maximum climb rate 400 feet per minute."
TAS variation from filed speed of 5% or 10 knots, whichever "Marathon 564, advises TAS decrease to140 knots."
is greater

Time and altitude or flight level upon reaching a holding fix "Marathon 564, FARGO Intersection at 05, 10,000, holding east."
or clearance limit

Loss of Nav/Comm capability (required by Part 91.187) "Marathon 564, ILS receiver inoperative."
Unforecast weather conditions or other information relating "Marathon 564, experiencing moderate turbulence at 10,000."
to the safety of flight (required by Part 91.183)

NON-RADAR REPORTS
When you are not in radar contact, these reports should be made without a specific request from ATC.
REPORTS EXAMPLE

Leaving FAF or OM inbound on final approach "Marathon 564, outer marker inbound, leaving 2,000."

Revised ETA of more than three minutes "Marathon 564, revising SCURRY estimate to 55."

Figure 2-68. ATC reporting procedures.

Operations in international airspace demand that pilots Barometric Pressure for Local Altimeter Setting
are aware of, and understand the use of, the three types (QNH)
of altimeter settings. Most overseas airports give altimeter A local altimeter setting equivalent to the barometric
settings in hectopascals (hPa) (millibars). Therefore, it is pressure measured at an airport altimeter datum and
imperative that pilots or on-board equipment are able corrected to sea level pressure. At the airport altimeter
to accurately convert inches of mercury to hPa, or hPa to datum, an altimeter set to QNH indicates airport elevation
inches of mercury. above mean sea level (MSL). Altimeters are set to QNH
while operating at and below the transition altitude and
Altitude Above Ground (QFE) below the transition level.
A local altimeter setting equivalent to the barometric
pressure measured at an airport altimeter datum, usually For flights in the vicinity of airports, express the vertical
signifying the approach end of the runway is in use. At the position of aircraft in terms of QNH or QFE at or below the
airport altimeter datum, an altimeter set to QFE indicates transition altitude and in terms of QNE at or above the
zero altitude. If required to use QFE altimetry, altimeters transition level. While passing through the transition layer,
are set to QFE while operating at or below the transition express vertical position in terms of FLs when ascending
altitude and below the transition level. On the airport, the and in terms of altitudes when descending.
altimeter will read 0 feet.
When an aircraft that receives a clearance as number one
Barometric Pressure for Standard Altimeter to land completes its approach using QFE, express the
Setting (QNE) vertical position of the aircraft in terms of height above
Use the altimeter setting (en route) at or above the the airport elevation during that portion of its flight for
transition altitude (FL 180 in the United States). The which you may use QFE.
altimeter setting is always 29.92 inches of mercury/1013.2
hPa for a QNE altitude. Transition levels differ from country It is important to remember that most pressure altimeters
to country and pilots should be particularly alert when are subject to mechanical, elastic, temperature, and
making a climb or descent in a foreign area. installation errors. In addition, extremely cold temperature
differences may also require altimeter correction factors
as appropriate.

2-45
En Route Reporting Procedures or radar service terminated. ATC informs pilots that they
are in radar contact:
In addition to acknowledging a handoff to another Center
en route controller, there are reports that should be made 1. When their aircraft is initially identified in the ATC
without a specific request from ATC. Certain reports should system; and
be made at all times regardless of whether a flight is in radar 2. When radar identification is reestablished after radar
contact with ATC, while others are necessary only if radar service has been terminated or radar contact lost.
contact has been lost or terminated. [Figure 2-68]
Subsequent to being advised that the controller has
Non-Radar Position Reports established radar contact, this fact is not repeated to the
If radar contact has been lost or radar service terminated, pilot when handed off to another controller. At times, the
the CFRs require pilots to provide ATC with position reports aircraft identity is confirmed by the receiving controller;
over designated VORs and intersections along their route however, this should not be construed to mean that
of flight. These compulsory reporting points are depicted radar contact has been lost. The identity of transponder
on IFR en route charts by solid triangles. Position reports equipped aircraft is confirmed by asking the pilot to ident,
over fixes indicated by open triangles are noncompulsory squawk standby, or to change codes. Aircraft without
reporting points and are only necessary when requested by transponders are advised of their position to confirm
ATC. If on a direct course that is not on an established airway, identity. In this case, the pilot is expected to advise the
report over the fixes used in the flight plan that define controller if in disagreement with the position given. Any
the route, since they automatically become compulsory pilot who cannot confirm the accuracy of the position given
reporting points. Compulsory reporting points also apply
when conducting an IFR flight in accordance with a VFR-
on-top clearance.

Whether a route is on an airway or direct, position reports


are mandatory in a non-radar environment, and they
must include specific information. A typical position
report includes information pertaining to aircraft position,
expected route, and ETA. When a position report is to be
made passing a VOR radio facility, the time reported should
be the time at which the first complete reversal of the TO/
FROM indicator is accomplished. When a position report is
made passing a facility by means of an airborne ADF, the When an aircraft squawks code 7600 during a two-way radio
time reported should be the time at which the indicator communication failure, the information block on the radar
makes a complete reversal. When an aural or a light panel screen flashes RDOF (radio failure) to alert the controller.
indication is used to determine the time passing a reporting
Figure 2-69. Two-way radio communications failure transponder code.
point, such as a fan marker, Z marker, cone of silence or
intersection of range courses, the time should be noted
when the signal is first received and again when it ceases. because of not being tuned to the NAVAID referenced by
The mean of these two times should then be taken as the the controller should ask for another radar position relative
actual time over the fix. If a position is given with respect to to the tuned in NAVAID.
distance and direction from a reporting point, the distance
and direction should be computed as accurately as possible. Position Report Items
Except for terminal area transition purposes, position Position reports should include the following items:
reports or navigation with reference to aids not established
for use in the structure in which flight is being conducted 1. Aircraft identification
are not normally required by ATC. 2. Position
3. Time
Flights in a Radar Environment
When informed by ATC that their aircraft are in Radar 4. Altitude or flight level (include actual altitude or flight
Contact, pilots should discontinue position reports over level when operating on a clearance specifying VFR-
designated reporting points. They should resume normal on-top)
position reporting when ATC advises radar contact lost 5. Type of flight plan (not required in IFR position reports
made directly to ARTCCs or approach control)
6. ETA and name of next reporting point
2-46
7. The name only of the next succeeding reporting point Communication Failure
along the route of flight
Two-way radio communication failure procedures for IFR
8. Pertinent remarks operations are outlined in 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.185.
Unless otherwise authorized by ATC, pilots operating under
Additional Reports IFR are expected to comply with this regulation. Expanded
The following reports should be made at all times to ATC or procedures for communication failures are found in the
FSS facilities without a specific ATC request: Aeronautical Information Manual (AIM). Pilots can use the
transponder to alert ATC to a radio communication failure by
1. When vacating any previously assigned altitude or
squawking code 7600. [Figure 2-69] If only the transmitter
flight level for a newly assigned altitude or flight level.
is inoperative, listen for ATC instructions on any operational
2. When an altitude change is made if operating on a receiver, including the navigation receivers. It is possible ATC
clearance specifying VFR-on-top. may try to make contact with pilots over a VOR, VORTAC,
3. When unable to climb/descend at a rate of a least 500 NDB, or localizer frequency. In addition to monitoring
feet per minute (fpm). NAVAID receivers, attempt to reestablish communications
by contacting ATC on a previously assigned frequency or
4. When approach has been missed. (Request clearance
calling an FSS.
for specific action (i.e., to alternative airport, another
approach).
The primary objective of the regulations governing
5. Change in the average true airspeed (at cruising communication failures is to preclude extended IFR
altitude) when it varies by 5 percent or 10knots no-radio operations within the ATC system since these
(whichever is greater) from that filed in the flight plan. operations may adversely affect other users of the airspace.
6. The time and altitude or flight level upon reaching a If the radio fails while operating on an IFR clearance, but
holding fix or point to which cleared. in VFR conditions, or if encountering VFR conditions at
any time after the failure, continue the flight under VFR
7. When leaving any assigned holding fix or point.
conditions, if possible, and land as soon as practicable. The
NOTE: The reports stated in subparagraphs 6 and requirement to land as soon as practicable should not be
7 may be omitted by pilots of aircraft involved in construed to mean as soon as possible. Pilots retain the
instrument training at military terminal area facilities prerogative of exercising their best judgment and are not
when radar service is being provided. required to land at an unauthorized airport, at an airport
8. Any loss, in controlled airspace, of VOR, TACAN, unsuitable for the type of aircraft flown, or to land only
ADF, low frequency navigation receiver capability, minutes short of their intended destination. However, if
GPS anomalies while using installed IFR-certified IFR conditions prevail, pilots must comply with procedures
GPS/GNSS receivers, complete or partial loss of ILS designated in the CFRs to ensure aircraft separation.
receiver capability or impairment of air/ground
communications capability. Reports should include If pilots must continue their flight under IFR after
aircraft identification, equipment affected, degree experiencing two-way radio communication failure, they
to which the capability to operate under IFR in the should fly one of the following routes:
ATC system is impaired, and the nature and extent The route assigned by ATC in the last clearance
of assistance desired from ATC. received.
9. Any information relating to the safety of flight. If being radar vectored, the direct route from the point
of radio failure to the fix, route, or airway specified in
Other equipment installed in an aircraft may effectively the radar vector clearance.
impair safety and/or the ability to operate under IFR. If such
In the absence of an assigned route, the route ATC
equipment (e.g., airborne weather radar) malfunctions and
has advised to expect in a further clearance.
in the pilots judgment either safety or IFR capabilities are
affected, reports should be made as stated above. When In the absence of an assigned or expected route, the
reporting GPS anomalies, include the location and altitude route filed in the flight plan.
of the anomaly. Be specific when describing the location
and include duration of the anomaly if necessary. It is also important to fly a specific altitude should two-way
radio communications be lost. The altitude to fly after a
communication failure can be found in 14 CFR Part 91,
section 91.185 and must be the highest of the following
altitudes for each route segment flown.

2-47
The altitude or flight level assigned in the last ATC NOTE: The exchange of information between an aircraft
clearance. and an ARTCC through an FSS is quicker than relay via
The minimum altitude or flight level for IFR company radio because the FSS has direct interphone
operations. lines to the responsible ARTCC sector. Accordingly,
when circumstances dictate a choice between the two
The altitude or flight level ATC has advised to expect during an ARTCC frequency outage relay via FSS radio is
in a further clearance. recommended.

In some cases, the assigned or expected altitude may not be as Climbing and Descending En Route
high as the MEA on the next route segment. In this situation,
When ATC issues a clearance or instruction, pilots are
pilots normally begin a climb to the higher MEA when they
expected to execute its provisions upon receipt. In some
reach the fix where the MEA rises. If the fix also has a published
cases, ATC includes words that modify their expectation.
MCA, they start the climb so they are at or above the MCA
For example, the word immediately in a clearance or
when reaching the fix. If the next succeeding route segment
instruction is used to impress urgency to avoid an imminent
has a lower MEA, descend to the applicable altitude either
situation, and expeditious compliance is expected and
the last assigned altitude or the altitude expected in a further
necessary for safety. The addition of a climb point or time
clearancewhen reaching the fix where the MEA decreases.
restriction, for example, does not authorize pilots to deviate
ARTCC Radio Frequency Outage from the route of flight or any other provision of the ATC
clearance. If the pilot receives the term climb at pilots
ARTCCs normally have at least one back-up radio receiver
discretion in the altitude information of an ATC clearance,
and transmitter system for each frequency that can usually
it means that the pilot has the option to start a climb when
be placed into service quickly with little or no disruption of
they desire and are authorized to climb at any rate, and to
ATC service. Occasionally, technical problems may cause a
temporarily level off at any intermediate altitude as desired,
delay but switchover seldom takes more than 60 seconds.
although once you vacate an altitude, you may not return to
When it appears that the outage is not quickly remedied,
that altitude. When ATC has not used the term nor imposed
the ARTCC usually requests a nearby aircraft, if there is
any climb restrictions, pilots should climb promptly on
one, to switch to the affected frequency to broadcast
acknowledgment of the clearance. Climb at an optimum
communications instructions. It is important that the pilot
rate consistent with the operating characteristics of the
wait at least 1 minute before deciding that the ARTCC has
aircraft to 1,000 feet below the assigned altitude, and then
actually experienced a radio frequency failure. When such
attempt to climb at a rate of between 500 and 1,500 fpm
an outage does occur, the pilot should, if workload and
until the assigned altitude is reached. If at any time the
equipment capability permit, maintain a listening watch
pilot is unable to climb at a rate of at least 500 fpm, advise
on the affected frequency while attempting to comply with
ATC. If it is necessary to level off at an intermediate altitude
the following recommended communications procedures:
during climb, advise ATC.
1. If two-way communications cannot be established
with the ARTCC after changing frequencies, a pilot When ATC issues the instruction, Expedite climb, this
should attempt to re-contact the transferring normally indicates that the pilot should use the approximate
controller for the assignment of an alternative best rate of climb without an exceptional change in aircraft
frequency or other instructions. handling characteristics. Normally controllers inform pilots of
2. When an ARTCC radio frequency failure occurs after the reason for an instruction to expedite. If flying a turbojet
two-way communications have been established, airplane equipped with afterburner engines, such as a
the pilot should attempt to reestablish contact with military aircraft, pilots should advise ATC prior to takeoff if
the center on any other known ARTCC frequency, intending to use afterburning during the climb to the en
preferably that of the next responsible sector when route altitude. Often, the controller may be able to plan
practicable, and ask for instructions. However, traffic to accommodate a high performance climb and allow
when the next normal frequency change along the pilot to climb to the planned altitude without expedite
the route is known to involve another ATC facility, clearance from restriction. If you receive an ATC instruction,
the pilot should contact that facility, if feasible, and your altitude to maintain is subsequently changed
for instructions. If communications cannot be or restated without an expedite instruction, the expedite
reestablished by either method, the pilot is expected instruction is canceled.
to request communication instructions from the FSS
appropriate to the route of flight. During en route climb, as in any other phase of flight,
it is essential that you clearly communicate with ATC
regarding clearances. In the following example, a flight crew
2-48
experienced an apparent clearance readback/hearback 29.92 inches of mercury and announce 2992 inches (or
error, that resulted in confusion about the clearance and, standard, on some airplanes) and the flight level passing.
ultimately, to inadequate separation from another aircraft. For example, 2992 inches (standard), flight level one
Departing IFR, clearance was to maintain 5,000 feet, eight zero. The second officer on three pilot crews may
expect 12,000 in 10 minutes. After handoff to Center, the ensure that both pilots have inserted the proper altimeter
pilot understood and read back, Leaving 5,000 turn left setting. On international flights, pilots must be prepared
heading 240 for vector on course. The pilot turned to the to differentiate, if necessary, between barometric pressure
assigned heading climbing through 5,000 feet. At 5,300 feet, equivalents with inches of mercury, and millibars or
Center advised assigned altitude was 5,000 feet. The pilot hectopascals, to eliminate any potential for error. For
immediately descended to 5,000. Center then informed example, 996 millibars erroneously being set as 2996.
the pilot that there was traffic at 12 oclock and a mile at
6,000. After passing traffic, a higher altitude was assigned For a typical IFR flight, the majority of in-flight time often
and climb resumed. The pilot then believed the clearance is flown in level flight at cruising altitude from top of climb
was probably "reaching" 5,000, etc. Even the readback to the (TOC) to top of descent (TOD). Generally, TOD is used in
controller with "leaving" did not catch the different wording. airplanes with a FMS and represents the point at which
Reaching and leaving are commonly used ATC terms descent is first initiated from cruise altitude. FMS also
having different usages. They may be used in clearances assist in level flight by cruising at the most fuel saving
involving climbs, descents, turns, or speed changes. In the speed, providing continuing guidance along the flight plan
flight deck, the words reaching and leaving sound much route including great circle direct routes, and continuous
alike. evaluation and prediction of fuel consumption along with
changing clearance data.
For altitude awareness during climb, pilots often call out
altitudes on the flight deck. The pilot monitoring may call Aircraft Speed and Altitude
2,000 and 1,000 feet prior to reaching an assigned altitude. During the en route descent phase of flight, an additional
The callout may be, two climbing through the transit benefit a FMS is that it provides fuel saving idle thrust
to go altitude (QNH), both pilots set their altimeters to descent to your destination airport. This allows an

Facility

Secondary area

Facility

Fix displacement area


Primary area holding pattern airspace area

Figure 2-70. Holding pattern design criteria template.

2-49
There are at least three items in a clearance for a charted holding pattern:
Direction to hold from the holding fix "...Hold southeast
Holding fix of PINNE Intersection as published.
Expect further clearance time Expect further clearance at 1645."

A T I O N
N A V I G
T FO R
NO
A clearance for an uncharted holding pattern contains additional information:

Direction to hold from holding fix


Holding fix "...Hold west
The holding course (a specified radial, of Horst Intersection
magnetic bearing, airway or route number) on Victor 8
The outbound leg length in minutes or 5 mile legs
nautical miles when DME is used
left turns
Nonstandard pattern, if used
expect further clearance at 1430."
Expect further clearance time

Figure 2-71. ATC holding instructions.

uninterrupted profile descent from level cruising altitude traffic.


to an appropriate MIA, except where level flight is required
for speed adjustment.. Controllers anticipate and plan that ATC issues speed adjustments if the flight is being radar
the pilot may level off at 10,000 feet MSL on descent to controlled to achieve or maintain required or desired
comply with the 14 CFR Part 91 indicated airspeed limit of spacing. They express speed adjustments in terms of knots
250 knots. Leveling off at any other time on descent may based on indicated airspeed in 10 knot increments except
seriously affect air traffic handling by ATC. It is imperative that at or above FL 240 speeds may be expressed in terms
that pilots make every effort to fulfill ATC expected actions of Mach numbers in 0.01 increments. The use of Mach
on descent to aid in safely handling and expediting air numbers by ATC is restricted to turbojets. If complying
with speed adjustments, pilots are expected to maintain
that speed within plus or minus 10 knots or 0.02 Mach.

CHERRELYN
D Speed and altitude restrictions in clearances are subject
( H )117.2 CHL
to misinterpretation, as evidenced in this case where a
331

corporate flight crew treated instructions in a published


procedure as a clearance. The aircraft was at FL 310 and


269 had already programmed the expect-crossing altitude of
V214 12
6 17,000 feet at the VOR. When the altitude alerter sounded,
the pilot advised Center that we were leaving FL 310. ATC
1
22

acknowledged with a Roger. At FL 270, Center questioned


the pilot about the aircrafts descent. The pilot told the
controller that the reason for the descent was to cross the
VOR at 17,000 feet. ATC advised the pilot that he did not
Figure 2-72. Clearance limit holding.

2-50
ATC Holding Instructions
When controllers anticipate a delay at a clearance limit or
fix, pilots are usually issued a holding clearance at least
5 minutes before the ETA at the clearance limit or fix. If
14,001' the holding pattern assigned by ATC is depicted on the
Maximum Holding Airspeed: 2 6 5 KIAS MSL appropriate aeronautical chart, pilots are expected to hold
as charted. In the following example, the controller issues a
14,000' holding clearance that includes the name of the fix, directs
MSL the pilot to hold as charted, and includes an expect further
clearance (EFC) time.
6,001'
Maximum Holding Airspeed: 2 3 0 KIAS MSL Marathon five sixty four, hold east of MIKEY Intersection
as published, expect further clearance at 1521.
6,000'
MSL
When ATC issues a clearance requiring you to hold at a fix
Minimum where a holding pattern is not charted, pilots are issued
Holding
Altitude complete holding instructions. The holding instructions
Maximum Holding Airspeed: 2 0 0 KIAS
(MHA) include the direction from the fix, name of the fix, course,
leg length, if appropriate, direction of turns (if left turns
Figure 2-73. Maximum holding speeds for different altitudes. are required), and the EFC time. Pilots are required to
have clearance to descend. What the pilot thought was a maintain the last assigned altitude unless a new altitude is
clearance was in fact an expect clearance. Whenever pilots specifically included in the holding clearance and should
are in doubt about a clearance it is imperative they request fly right turns unless left turns are assigned. Note that all
clarity from ATC. Also, the term Roger only means that ATC holding instructions should include an EFC time. In the
received the transmission, not that they understood the event that two-way radio communication is lost, the EFC
transmission. Expect altitudes are published for planning allows the pilot to depart the holding fix at a definite time.
purposes and are not considered crossing restrictions until Pilots should plan the last lap of the holding pattern to
verbally issued by ATC. leave the fix as close as possible to the exact time. [Figure
2-71]
En Route Holding Procedures
When approaching the clearance limit and you have
The criteria for holding pattern airspace is developed not received holding instructions from ATC, pilots are
both to provide separation of aircraft, as well as obstacle expected to follow certain procedures. First, call ATC
clearance. The alignment of holding patterns typically and request further clearance before reaching the fix. If
coincides with the flight course you fly after leaving the further clearance cannot be obtained, pilots are expected
holding fix. For level holding, a minimum of 1,000 feet to hold at the fix in compliance with the charted holding
obstacle clearance is provided throughout the primary pattern. If a holding pattern is not charted at the fix, pilots
area. In the secondary area, 500 feet of obstacle clearance are expected to hold on the inbound course using right
is provided at the inner edge, tapering to zero feet at the turns. This procedure ensures that ATC provides adequate
outer edge. Allowance for precipitous terrain is considered, separation. [Figure 2-72] For example, the aircraft is heading
and the altitudes selected for obstacle clearance may be eastbound on V214 and the Cherrelyn VORTAC is the
rounded to the nearest 100 feet. When criteria for a climb clearance limit and the pilot has not been able to obtain
in hold are applied, no obstacle penetrates the holding further clearance and has not received holding instructions,
surface. [Figure 2-70] plan to hold southwest on the 221 radial using left-hand
turns, as depicted. If this holding pattern is not charted,
There are many factors that affect aircraft during holding hold west of the VOR on V214 using right-hand turns.
maneuvers, including navigational aid ground and airborne
tolerance, effect of wind, flight procedures, application of Where required for aircraft separation, ATC may request
ATC, outbound leg length, maximum holding airspeeds, that the pilot hold at any designated reporting point in a
fix to NAVAID distance, DME slant range effect, holding standard holding pattern at the MEA or the MRA, whichever
airspace size, and altitude holding levels. altitude is the higher at locations where a minimum holding
altitude has not been established. Unplanned holding at
en route fixes may be expected on airway or route radials,

2-51
bearings, or courses. If the fix is a facility, unplanned than one hour, the pilot may record the time and fuel
holding could be on any radial or bearing and there may remaining shortly after TOC and at selected waypoints
be holding limitations required if standard holding cannot listed in the flight plan, conveniently spaced approximately
be accomplished at the MEA or MRA. one hour apart. The actual fuel burn is then compared to
the planned fuel burn. Each fuel tank must be monitored
Maximum Holding Speed to verify proper burn off and appropriate fuel remaining.
The size of the holding pattern is directly proportional For two-pilot airplanes, the pilot monitoring (PM) keeps
to the speed of the airplane. In order to limit the amount the flight plan record. On three-pilot airplanes, the second
of airspace that must be protected by ATC, maximum officer and PM coordinate recording and keeping the flight
holding speeds in knots indicated airspeed (KIAS) have plan record. In all cases, the crew member(s) making the
been designated for specific altitude ranges. [Figure 2-73] recording communicates the information to the pilot flying.
Even so, some holding patterns may have additional speed
restrictions to keep faster airplanes from flying out of the Diversion Procedures
protected area. If a holding pattern has a nonstandard OpSpecs for commercial operators include provisions for en
speed restriction, it is depicted by an icon with the limiting route emergency diversion airport requirements. Operators
airspeed. If the holding speed limit is less than the pilot feels are expected to develop a sufficient set of emergency
necessary, advise ATC of the revised holding speed. Also, if diversion airports, so that one or more can be reasonably
the indicated airspeed exceeds the applicable maximum expected to be available in varying weather conditions.
holding speed, ATC expects the pilot to slow to the speed The flight must be able to make a safe landing, and the
limit within three minutes of the ETA at the holding fix. airplane maneuvered off of the runway at the selected
Often pilots can avoid flying a holding pattern, or reduce diversion airport. In the event of a disabled airplane
the length of time spent in the holding pattern, by slowing following landing, the capability to move the disabled
down on the way to the holding fix. airplane must exist so as not to block the operation of any
recovery airplane. In addition, those airports designated
High Performance Holding for use must be capable of protecting the safety of all
When operating at higher airspeeds, there are certain personnel by being able to:
limitations that must be adhered to. For example, aircraft do
not make standard rate turns in holding patterns if the bank
Offload the passengers and flight crew in a safe
angle exceeds 30. If your aircraft is using a flight director
manner during possible adverse weather conditions.
system, the bank angle is limited to 25. The aircraft must
be traveling over 210 knots true airspeed (TAS) for the bank Provide for the physiological needs of the passengers
angle in a standard rate turn to exceed 30, therefore this and flight crew for the duration until safe evacuation.
limit applies to relatively fast airplanes. An aircraft using Be able to safely extract passengers and flight crew
a flight director would have to be holding at more than as soon as possible. Execution and completion of the
170 knots TAS to come up against the 25 limit. These true recovery is expected within 12 to 48 hours following
airspeeds correspond to indicated airspeeds of about 183 diversion.
and 156 knots, respectively, at 6,000 feet in a standard
atmosphere. Part 91 operators also need to be prepared for a diversion.
Designation of an alternate on the IFR flight plan is a good
En Route Safety Considerations first step; but changing weather conditions or equipment
Fuel State Awareness issues may require pilots to consider other options.
In order to increase fuel state awareness, pilots are required
to record the time and fuel remaining during an IFR flight.
For example, on a flight scheduled for one hour or less, the
flight crew may record the time and fuel remaining at the
top of climb (TOC) and at one additional waypoint listed in
the flight plan. Generally, TOC is used in airplanes with an
FMS, and represents the point at which cruise altitude is
first reached. TOC is calculated based on current airplane
altitude, climb speed, and cruise altitude. The pilot may elect
to delete the additional waypoint recording requirement
if the flight is so short that the record will not assist in the
management of the flight. For flights scheduled for more

2-52
Chapter 3

Arrivals
Introduction
Preparation for the arrival and approach begins long
before the descent from the en route phase of flight.
Planning early, while there are fewer demands on the
pilots attention, leaves the pilot free to concentrate on
precise control of the aircraft and better equipped to deal
with problems that might arise during the last segment
of the flight.

3-1
This chapter focuses on the current procedures pilots and The concept of navigation performance, previously
air traffic control (ATC) use for instrument flight rule (IFR) discussed in this book, involves the precision that must
arrivals in the National Airspace System (NAS). The objective be maintained for both the assigned route and altitude.
is to provide pilots with an understanding of ATC arrival Required levels of navigation performance vary from area
procedures and pilot responsibilities as they relate to the to area depending on traffic density and complexity of
transition between the en route and approach phases of the routes flown. The level of navigation performance
flight. This chapter emphasizes standard terminal arrival must be more precise in domestic airspace than in
routes (STARs), descent clearances, descent planning, and oceanic and remote land areas since air traffic density in
ATC procedures, while the scope of coverage focuses on domestic airspace is much greater. For example, there are
transitioning from the en route phase of flight, typically three million flight operations conducted within Chicago
the origination point of a STAR to the STAR termination fix. Centers airspace each year. The minimum lateral distance
permitted between co-altitude aircraft in Chicago Centers
Optimum IFR arrival options include flying directly from the airspace is 8 nautical miles (NM) (3 NM when radar is used).
en route structure to an approach gate or initial approach The route ATC assigns an aircraft has protected airspace
fix (IAF), a visual arrival, STARs, and radar vectors. Within on both sides of the centerline, equal to one-half of the
controlled airspace, ATC routinely uses radar vectors for lateral separation minimum standard. For example, the
separation purposes, noise abatement considerations overall level of lateral navigation performance necessary for
when it is an operational advantage, or when requested by flight safety must be better than 4 NM in Center airspace.
pilots. Vectors outside of controlled airspace are provided When STARs are reviewed subsequently in this chapter, it is
only on pilot request. The controller tells the pilot the demonstrated how the navigational requirements become
purpose of the vector when the vector is controller-initiated more restrictive in the arrival phase of flight where air traffic
and takes the aircraft off a previously assigned non-radar density increases and procedural design and obstacle
route. Typically, when operating on area navigation clearance become more limiting.
(RNAV) routes, pilots are allowed to remain on their own
navigation. The concept of navigational performance is fundamental to
the code of federal regulations and is best defined in Title
Navigation in the Arrival Environment 14 of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) Part 121,
The most significant and demanding navigational sections 121.103 and 121.121, which state that each
requirement is the need to safely separate aircraft. In a aircraft must be navigated to the degree of accuracy
non-radar environment, ATC does not have an independent required for ATC. The requirements of 14 CFR Part 91,
means to separate air traffic and must depend entirely on section 91.123 related to compliance with ATC clearances
information relayed from flight crews to determine the and instructions also reflect this fundamental concept.
actual geographic position and altitude. In this situation, Commercial operators must comply with their Operations
precise navigation is critical to ATCs ability to provide Specifications (OpSpecs) and understand the categories
separation. of navigational operations and be able to navigate to the
degree of accuracy required for the control of air traffic.
Even in a radar environment, precise navigation and
position reports, when required, are still a primary means In the broad concept of air navigation, there are two major
of providing separation. In most situations, ATC does not categories of navigational operations consisting of Class
have the capability or the responsibility for navigating I navigation and Class II navigation. Class I navigation is
an aircraft. Because they rely on precise navigation by any en route flight operation conducted in controlled or
the flight crew, flight safety in all IFR operations depends uncontrolled airspace that is entirely within operational
directly on the pilots ability to achieve and maintain service volumes of International Civil Aviation Organization
certain levels of navigational performance. ATC uses radar (ICAO) standard navigational aids (NAVAIDs) (very high
to monitor navigational performance, detect possible frequency (VHF) omnidirectional radio range (VOR), VOR/
navigational errors, and expedite traffic flow. In a non- distance measuring equipment (DME), non-directional
radar environment, ATC has no independent knowledge beacon (NDB), etc.).
of the actual position of the aircraft or its relationship to
other aircraft in adjacent airspace. Therefore, ATCs ability Class II navigation is any en route operation that is not
to detect a navigational error and resolve collision hazards categorized as Class I navigation and includes any operation
is seriously degraded when a deviation from a clearance or portion of an operation that takes place outside the
occurs. operational service volumes of ICAO standard NAVAIDs.
For example, aircraft equipped only with VORs conducts

3-2
Class II navigation when the flight operates in an area at the approach gate properly configured. Descending early
outside the operational service volumes of federal VORs. results in more flight at low altitudes with increased fuel
Class II navigation does not automatically require the consumption, and starting down late results in problems
use of long-range, specialized navigational systems if controlling both airspeed and descent rates on the
special navigational techniques are used to supplement approach. Prior to flight, pilots need to calculate the fuel,
conventional NAVAIDs. Class II navigation includes time, and distance required to descend from the cruising
transoceanic operations and operations in desolate and altitude to the approach gate altitude for the specific
remote land areas, such as the Arctic. The primary types instrument approach at the destination airport. While
of specialized navigational systems approved for Class II in flight prior to the descent, it is important for pilots to
operations include inertial navigation system (INS), Doppler, verify landing weather to include winds at their intended
and global positioning system (GPS). Figure 3-1 provides destination. Inclimate weather at the destination airport can
several examples of Class I and II navigation. cause slower descents and missed approaches that require
a sufficient amount of fuel that should be calculated prior to
Descent Planning starting the descent. In order to plan the descent, the pilot
Planning the descent from cruise is important because of needs to know the cruise altitude, approach gate altitude
the need to dissipate altitude and airspeed in order to arrive or initial approach fix altitude, descent groundspeed, and

VORTAC A VORTAC B

CLASS
CLASS I
Route 1
I

CLASS II
Route 2
CLASS I 1 hour or less CLAS
SI

CLASS II
Route 3
CLASS I more than 1 hour CLAS
SI

NOTE:

The area encompassed by the cylinders represents the volume of airspace within the operational service volume
(OSV) of ICAO standard NAVAIDs. The altitude of your aircraft with respect to the location of the NAVAID is a
primary factor in determining OSV range.

Route 1 Your aircraft navigating from A to B is conducting Class I navigation because you remain within the OSV of
ICAO standard NAVAIDs during your entire flight.

Route 2 Your aircraft navigating from A to B is conducting Class I navigation while within the OSV of the NAVAIDs.
You are conducting Class II navigation during the portion of your route outside the OSV of the NAVAIDs.
Because the duration of the Class II navigation is 1 hour or less, long-range navigation equipment or a flight
navigator may not be required.

Route 3 Your aircraft navigating from A to B is conducting Class I navigation while within the OSV of the NAVAIDs.
You are conducting Class II navigation when outside the OSV of the NAVAIDs. The duration of the Class II
navigation is more than 1 hour. Therefore, long-range navigation equipment or a flight navigator is required.

Figure 3-1. Example of Class I and II navigation.

3-3
descent rate. This information must be updated while a descent should be initiated at 20 NM to lose 6,000 feet.
in flight for changes in altitude, weather, and wind. The If the groundspeed is 120 knots, that means the aircraft is
approach gate is an imaginary point used by ATC to vector moving along at 2 NM per minute. So to go 20 NM, it takes
aircraft to the final approach course. The approach gate 10 minutes. Ten minutes at 600 feet per minute means you
is established along the final approach course 1 NM from will lose 6,000 feet.
the final approach fix (FAF) on the side away from the
airport and is located no closer than 5 NM from the landing The calculations should be made before the flight and rules
threshold. Flight manuals or operating handbooks may also of thumb updates should be applied in flight. For example,
contain a fuel, time, and distance to descend chart that from the charted STAR pilots might plan a descent based on
contains the same information. an expected clearance to cross 40 DME West of Brown VOR
at 6,000 and then apply rules of thumb for slowing down
One technique that is often used is the descent rule of from 250 knots. These might include planning airspeed at 25
thumb, which is used to determine when you need to NM from the runway threshold to be 250 knots, 200 knots at
descend in terms of the number of miles prior to the point 20 NM, and 150 knots at 15 NM until gear and flap speeds
at which you desire to arrive at your new altitude. First, are reached, never to fall below approach speed.
divide the altitude needed to be lost by 300. For example,
if cruising altitude is 7,000 feet and you want to get down Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Planning
to a pattern altitude of 1,000 feet. The altitude you want to Vertical navigation (VNAV) is the vertical component of
lose is 6,000 feet, which when divided by 300 results in 20. the flight plan. This approach path is computed from the
Therefore, you need to start your descent 20 NM out and top-of- descent (TOD) point down to the end-of-descent
leave some extra room so that you are at pattern altitude waypoint (E/D), which is generally the runway or missed
prior to the proper entry. It is also necessary to know what approach point, which is slightly different than to the
rate-of-descent (ROD) to use. approach gate for non-flight management system (FMS)
equipped aircraft. [Figure 3-2] The VNAV path is computed
To determine ROD for a three-degree path, simply multiply based upon the aircraft performance, approach constraints,
your groundspeed by 5. If you are going 120 knots, your ROD weather data (winds, temperature, icing conditions, etc.)
to fly the desired path would be 600 feet per minute (120 and aircraft weight.
5 = 600). It was determined in the previous example that

Top-of-descent

Between 12,000' and 10,000'

At or below 8,000' 220 kt max


4
From last Instrument approach vertical angle
constraint to T/D, At 4,000' coded in the navigation database
path is computed
using available
performance data At or above 2,200'
to achieve an 3
ECON efficient VNAV plans for
path. decelerations to
honor speed
restrictions, e.g.
250 knots below
3
10,000' 2
(monotonic The path is computed beginning
decelerations). from the E/D constraint (and
vertical angle) to the next 1
constraint that gets in the way VNAV begins at the runway
(at 4,000' in this drawing) and waypoint constraint altitude
then to the next constraint, and (E/D) and then follows the
so on. vertical angle upstream.

Figure 3-2. VNAV path construction.

3-4
Performance Path
Top-of-descent Computed descent path at idle (or near-idle) power
from top-of-descent to the first constrained waypoint

NEEAL
5000
BUCKK
2200
Idle descent path at ECON speed

Figure 3-3. VNAV performance path.

Geometric Path
Computed 3-D point-to-point descent path between
Top-of-descent
two constrained waypoints or when tracking a
prescribed vertical angle

The geometric path is a shallower descent and


typically a non-idle path.
OLM
12,000

NEEAL
5000
Idle descent path at ECON speed BUCKK
2200

Geometric paths at VNAV target speed 3

Figure 3-4. VNAV geometric path.

3-5
The two types of VNAV paths that the FMS use is either a installed in an aircraft, and what it is approved to do. It is
performance path or a geometric path. The performance also important to understand that the VNAV function of
path is computed using at idle or near idle power from non-WAAS capable or non-WAAS equipped IFR-approved
the TOD to the first constrained waypoint. [Figure 3-3] GPS receivers does not make the aircraft capable of flying
The geometric path is computed from point to point approaches to LNAV/VNAV minimums.
between two constrained waypoints or when on an
assigned vertical angle. The geometric path is shallower FMS are the primary tool for most modern aircraft, air
than the performance path and is typically a non-idle carriers, and any operators requiring performance based
path. [Figure 3-4] navigation. Most of the modern FMS are fully equipped
with LNAV/VNAV and WAAS. The FMS provides flight control
LNAV/VNAV Equipment steering and thrust guidance along the VNAV path. Some
Lateral navigation/vertical navigation (LNAV/VNAV) less integrated systems may only advise the flight crew
equipment is similar to an instrument landing system (ILS) of the VNAV path but have no auto-throttle capability.
in that it provides both lateral and vertical approach course These less integrated systems require an increase in pilot
guidance. Since precise vertical position information is workload during the arrival/approach phase in order to
beyond the current capabilities of the GPS, approaches with maintain the descent path.
LNAV/VNAV minimums make use of certified barometric
VNAV (baro-VNAV) systems for vertical guidance and/or Descent Planning for High Performance Aircraft
the wide area augmentation system (WAAS) to improve The need to plan the IFR descent into the approach gate
GPS accuracy for this purpose. and airport environment during the preflight planning
NOTE: WAAS makes use of a collection of ground stations stage of flight is particularly important for turbojet
that are used to detect and correct inaccuracies in the powered airplanes. TOD from the en route phase of flight
for high performance airplanes is often used in this process
and is calculated manually or automatically through a FMS
This GPS/RNAV provides lateral and vertical
guidance during an RNAV approach. based upon the altitude of the approach gate. A general
rule of thumb for initial IFR descent planning in jets is the
A
C n TRK 332 332
119.000 9.74 m
3 to 1 formula. This means that it takes 3 nautical miles
T
S
B
Y 121.600 DIST BRG
DTK
(NM) to descend 1,000 feet. If an airplane is at flight level
114.10
A

346 (FL) 310 and the approach gate or initial approach fix is at
C
T
--.- vor

S
B
Y 116.00 6,000 feet, the initial descent requirement equals 25,000
1200 GS ETE
S

feet (31,0006,000). Multiplying 25 times 3 equals 75;


B

120kt Lnav/Vnav 04:52


Y

FLAGGED
GPS ENR C345 SUNOL
MSG PROC FPL
RW34Lm
NAV therefore begin descent 75 NM from the approach gate,
based on a normal jet airplane, idle thrust, speed Mach
0.74 to 0.78, and vertical speed of 1,8002,200 feet per
minute (fpm). For a tailwind adjustment, add 2 NM for each
10 knots of tailwind. For a headwind adjustment, subtract
Figure 3-5. WAAS data provide lateral and vertical guidance. 2 NM for each 10 knots of headwind. During the descent
planning stage, try to determine which runway is in use at
the destination airport, either by reading the latest aviation
position information derived from the GPS. Using WAAS, routine weather report (METAR) or checking the automatic
the accuracy of vertical position information is increased terminal information service (ATIS) information. There can
to within three meters. be big differences in distances depending on the active
runway and STAR. The objective is to determine the most
To make use of WAAS, however, the aircraft must be economical point for descent.
equipped with an IFR-approved GPS receiver with WAAS
signal reception that integrates WAAS error correction An example of a typical jet descent-planning chart is
signals into its position determining processing. The WAAS depicted in Figure 3-7. Item 1 is the pressure altitude from
enabled GPS receiver [Figure 3-5] allows the pilot to load an which the descent begins; item 2 is the time required
RNAV approach and receive guidance along the lateral and for the descent in minutes; item 3 is the amount of fuel
vertical profile shown on the approach chart. [Figure 3-6] consumed in pounds during descent to sea level; and
It is very important to know what kind of equipment is item 4 is the distance covered in NM. Item 5 shows that
the chart is based on a Mach .80 airspeed until 280 knots

3-6
NE-4, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

Figure 3-6. RNAV (GPS) approach.


NO
TF
OR
NA
VI
GA
TIO
NE-4, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010
N

3-7
the proper performance charts to compute their fuel
1 5 2 3 4 requirements, as well as the time and distance needed for
.80/280
their descent.
Pressure Altitude Time Fuel Distance
(1,000 feet) (minutes) (pounds) (NM) During the cruise and descent phases of flight, pilots

E
39 20 850 124 need to monitor and manage the airplane according to

US
37 19 800 112 the appropriate manufacturers recommendations. Flight
35 18 700 101 manuals and operating handbooks contain cruise and

AL
33 17 650 92 descent checklists, performance charts for specific cruise

TU
31 16 600 86 configurations, and descent charts that provide information
29 15
AC 600 80 regarding the fuel, time, and distance required to descend.
27 14 550 74 Aircrews should review this information prior to the
25 13 550 68 departure of every flight so they have an understanding
R

23 12 500 63 of how the airplane is supposed to perform at cruise


FO

21 11 500 58 and during descent. A stabilized descent constitutes a


19 10 450 52 preplanned maneuver in which the power is properly set,
T

17 10 450 46
NO

and minimum control input is required to maintain the


15 9 400 41
appropriate descent path. Excessive corrections or control
10 6 300 26
E

inputs indicate the descent was improperly planned. Plan


5 3 150 13
PL

the IFR descent from cruising altitude so that the aircraft


arrives at the approach gate altitude or initial approach
M

NOTE:
fix altitude prior to beginning the instrument approach.
SA

Note: Subtract 30 lb of fuel and 36 seconds for each


1,000 feet that the destination airport is above sea level For example, suppose you are asked to descend from
11,000 feet to meet a crossing restriction at 3,000 feet.
[Figure 3-8] Since there is a 200 knot speed restriction
Figure 3-7. Jet descent task. while approaching the destination airport, you choose a
descent speed of 190 knots and a descent rate of 1,000 fpm.
indicated airspeed (KIAS) is obtained. The 250 knot airspeed
Assuming a 10 knot headwind component, groundspeed
limitation below 10,000 feet mean sea level (MSL) is not
in the descent is 180 knots.
included on the chart, since its effect is minimal. Also, the
effect of temperature or weight variation is negligible and
is therefore omitted. Descending From the En Route Altitude
Making the transition from cruise flight to the beginning
Due to the increased flight deck workload, pilots should of an instrument approach procedure sometimes requires
get as much done ahead of time as possible. As with the arriving at a given waypoint at an assigned altitude. When
climb and cruise phases of flight, aircrews should consult this requirement is prescribed by a published arrival

Cruising speed 2 7 0 knots Top-of-descent point

Wind

Cruising altitude 1 1 0 0 0 ft

Descent speed and rate

Bottom-of-descent point
1 8 0 knots @ 1,000 fpm

Assigned altitude 3 0 0 0 ft

ECA VOR

Figure 3-8. The descent planning task.

3-8
procedure or issued by ATC, it is called a crossing restriction. operations, more than 9,000 people have died worldwide
Even when ATC allows a descent at the pilots discretion, because of controlled flight into terrain (CFIT). CFIT is
aircrews need to choose a waypoint and altitude for described as an event in which a normally functioning
positioning convenient to start the approach. In either case, aircraft is inadvertently flown into the ground, water, or an
descending from a cruising altitude to a given waypoint or obstacle. Of all CFIT accidents, 7.2 percent occurred during
altitude requires both planning and precise flying. the descent phase of flight.

ATC may ask the pilot to descend to and maintain a The basic causes of CFIT accidents involve poor flight
specific altitude. Generally, this clearance is for en route crew situational awareness (SA). One definition of SA is an
traffic separation purposes, and pilots need to respond to accurate perception by pilots of the factors and conditions
it promptly. Descend at the optimum rate for the aircraft currently affecting the safe operation of the aircraft and the
being flown until 1,000 feet above the assigned altitude, crew. The causes of CFIT are the flight crews lack of vertical
then descend at a rate between 500 and 1,500 fpm to the position awareness or their lack of horizontal position
assigned altitude. If at any time, other than when slowing awareness in relation to the ground, water, or an obstacle.
to 250 KIAS at 10,000 feet MSL, the pilot cannot descend More than two-thirds of all CFIT accidents are the result
at a rate of at least 500 fpm, advise ATC. of an altitude error or lack of vertical SA. CFIT accidents
most often occur during reduced visibility associated with
The second type of clearance allows the pilot to descend instrument meteorological conditions (IMC), darkness, or
at pilots discretion. When ATC issues a clearance to a combination of both.
descend at pilots discretion, pilots may begin the descent
whenever they choose and at any rate of their choosing. The inability of controllers and pilots to properly
Pilots are also authorized to level off, temporarily, at any communicate has been a factor in many CFIT accidents.
intermediate altitude during the descent. However, once Heavy workloads can lead to hurried communication and
the aircraft leaves an altitude, it may not return to that the use of abbreviated or non-standard phraseology. The
altitude. importance of good communication during the arrival
phase of flight was made evident in a report by an air traffic
A descent clearance may also include a segment where the controller and the flight crew of an MD-80.
descent is at the pilots discretionsuch as cross the Joliet
VOR at or above 12,000, descend and maintain 5,000. This The controller reported that he was scanning his radarscope
clearance authorizes pilots to descend from their current for traffic and noticed that the MD-80 was descending
altitude whenever they choose, as long as they cross the through 6,400 feet. He immediately instructed a climb
Joliet VOR at or above 12,000 feet MSL. After that, they are to at least 6,500 feet. The pilot returned to 6,500 feet, but
expected to descend at a normal rate until they reach the responded to ATC that he had been cleared to 5,000 feet.
assigned altitude of 5,000 feet MSL. When he had read back 5,000 feet to the controller, he
received no correction from the controller. After almost
Clearances to descend at pilots discretion are not just an simultaneous ground proximity warning system (GPWS)
option for ATC. Pilots may also request this type of clearance and controller warnings, the pilot climbed and avoided
so that they can operate more efficiently. For example, if the terrain. The recording of the radio transmissions
a pilot was en route above an overcast layer, he or she confirmed that the airplane was cleared to 7,000 feet and
might ask for a descent at his or her discretion to allow the the pilot mistakenly read back 5,000 feet then attempted
aircraft to remain above the clouds for as long as possible. to descend to 5,000 feet. The pilot stated in the report: I
This might be particularly important if the atmosphere dont know how much clearance from the mountains we
is conducive to icing and the aircrafts icing protection had, but it certainly makes clear the importance of good
is limited. The pilots request permits the aircraft to stay communications between the controller and pilot.
at its cruising altitude longer to conserve fuel or to avoid
prolonged IFR flight in icing conditions. This type of descent ATC is not always responsible for safe terrain clearance for
can also help to minimize the time spent in turbulence by the aircraft under its jurisdiction. Many times ATC issue en
allowing pilots to level off at an altitude where the air is route clearances for pilots to proceed off airway direct to
smoother. a point. Pilots who accept this type of clearance also are
accepting the shared responsibility for maintaining safe
Controlled Flight Into Terrain (CFIT) terrain clearance. Know the height of the highest terrain
Inappropriate descent planning and execution during and obstacles in the operating area and your position in
arrivals has been a contributing factor to many fatal relation to the surrounding high terrain.
aircraft accidents. Since the beginning of commercial jet

3-9
....cleared present position direct.....

I need to check my altitude requirement.

Figure 3-9. Altitude management when cleared direct.

The following are excerpts from CFIT accidents related may engage in, nor may any pilot in command permit, any
to descending on arrival: delayed the initiation of the activity during a critical phase of flight that could distract
descent; Aircraft prematurely descended too early; any flight crewmember from the performance of his or her
late getting down; During a descentincorrectly duties or which could interfere in any way with the proper
cleared down; aircraft prematurely let down; conduct of those duties. Activities such as eating meals,
lost situational awareness; Premature descent engaging in nonessential conversations within the flight
clearance; Prematurely descended; Premature deck and nonessential communications between the cabin
descent clearance while on vector; During initial and flight deck crews, and reading publications not related
descent [Figure 3-9] to the proper conduct of the flight are not required for the
safe operation of the aircraft. (c) Critical phases of flight
Practicing good communication skills is not limited to just include all ground operations involving taxi, takeoff and
pilots and controllers. In its findings from a 1974 air carrier landing, and all other flight operations conducted below
accident, the National Transportation Safety Board (NTSB) 10,000 feet, except cruise flight.
wrote, the extraneous conversation conducted by the
flight crew during the descent was symptomatic of a lax Standard Terminal Arrival Routes
atmosphere in the flight deck that continued throughout (STARs)
the approach. The NTSB listed the probable cause as A STAR is an ATC-coded IFR route established for application
the flight crews lack of altitude awareness at critical points to arriving IFR aircraft destined for certain airports. A STAR
during the approach due to poor flight deck discipline in provides a critical form of communication between pilots
that the crew did not follow prescribed procedures. and ATC. Once a flight crew has accepted a clearance for a
STAR, they have communicated with the controller what
In 1981, the FAA issued 14 CFR Part 121, section 121.542 route, and in some cases what altitude and airspeed, they
and Part 135, section 135.100, Flight Crewmember Duties, fly during the arrival, depending on the type of clearance.
commonly referred to as sterile flight deck rules. The The STAR provides a common method for leaving the en
provisions in this rule can help pilots, operating under any route structure and navigating to your destination. It is a
regulations, to avoid altitude and course deviations during preplanned instrument flight rule ATC arrival procedure
arrival. In part, it states: (a) No certificate holder should published for pilot use in graphic and textual form that
require, nor may any flight crewmember perform, any simplifies clearance delivery procedures.
duties during a critical phase of flight except those duties
required for the safe operation of the aircraft. Duties such as The principal difference between standard instrument
company required calls made for such purposes as ordering departure (SID) or departure procedures (DPs) and STARs
galley supplies and confirming passenger connections, is that the DPs start at the airport pavement and connect
announcements made to passengers promoting the air to the en route structure. STARs on the other hand, start
carrier or pointing out sights of interest, and filling out at the en route structure but do not make it down to the
company payroll and related records are not required for pavement; they end at a fix or NAVAID designated by ATC,
the safe operation of the aircraft. (b) No flight crewmember where radar vectors commonly take over. This is primarily

3-10
N
O I
AT
G
VI
SW-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

SW-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010


NA
R
FO
T
NO

NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

Figure 3-10. Arrival charts.

3-11
because STARs serve multiple airports. STARs greatly help to higher equipment requirements and, often, tighter
facilitate the transition between the en route and approach required navigation performance (RNP) tolerances than
phases of flight. The objective when connecting a STAR to RNAV-2. For RNAV-1 STARS, pilots are required to use a
an instrument approach procedure is to ensure a seamless course deviation indicator (CDI)/flight director, and/or
lateral and vertical transition. The STAR and approach autopilot in LNAV mode while operating on RNAV courses.
procedure should connect to one another in such a way as (These requirements are detailed in Chapter 1 of this book,
to maintain the overall descent and deceleration profiles. under RNAV Departures.) RNAV-1 STARs are generally
This often results in a seamless transition between the en designated for high-traffic areas. Controllers may clear a
route, arrival, and approach phases of flight, and serves as pilot to use an RNAV STAR in various ways.
a preferred route into high volume terminal areas. [Figure
3-10] If the pilots clearance simply states, cleared Hadly One
arrival, the pilot is to use the arrival for lateral routing only.
STARs provide a transition from the en route structure to an A clearance such as cleared Hadly One arrival,
approach gate, outer fix, instrument approach fix, or arrival descend and maintain flight level two four zero,
waypoint in the terminal area, and they usually terminate clears the pilot to descend only to the assigned
with an instrument or visual approach procedure. STARs altitude, and then should maintain that altitude until
are included at the front of each Terminal Procedures cleared for further VNAV.
Publication (TPP) regional booklet.
If the pilot is cleared using the phrase descend via,
For STARs based on conventional NAVAIDs, the procedure the controller expects the pilot to use the equipment
design and obstacle clearance criteria are essentially the for both lateral and VNAV, as published on the chart.
same as that for en route criteria, covered in Chapter 2, The controller may also clear the pilot to use the
En Route Operations. STAR procedures typically include a arrival with specific exceptionsfor example,
standardized descent gradient at and above 10,000 feet MSL Descend via the Haris One arrival, except cross
of 318 feet per nautical mile (FPNM), or 3 degrees. Below Bruno at one three thousand then maintain one
10,000 feet MSL, the maximum descent rate is 330 FPNM, zero thousand. In this case, the pilot should track the
or approximately 3.1 degrees. In addition to standardized arrival both laterally and vertically, descending so as
descent gradients, STARs allow for deceleration segments to comply with all altitude and airspeed restrictions
at any waypoint that has a speed restriction. As a general until reaching Bruno, and then maintain 10,000 feet
guideline, deceleration considerations typically add 1 NM until cleared by ATC to continue to descend.
of distance for each 10 knots of speed reduction required.
Pilots might also be given direct routing to intercept
a STAR and then use it for VNAV. For example,
RNAV STARs or STAR Transitions Proceed direct Mahem, descend via the Mahem
STARs designated RNAV serve the same purpose as Two arrival.
conventional STARs, but are only used by aircraft equipped
with FMS or GPS. An RNAV STAR or STAR transition typically
Interpreting the STAR
includes flyby waypoints, with fly over waypoints used
STARs use much of the same symbology as departure and
only when operationally required. These waypoints may
approach charts. In fact, a STAR may at first appear identical
be assigned crossing altitudes and speeds to optimize
to a similar graphic DP, except the direction of flight is
the descent and deceleration profiles. RNAV STARs often
reversed and the procedure ends at an approach fix. The
are designed, coordinated, and approved by a joint effort
STAR officially begins at the common NAVAID, intersection,
between air carriers, commercial operators, and the ATC
or fix where all the various transitions to the arrival come
facilities that have jurisdiction for the affected airspace.
together. A STAR transition is a published segment used to
connect one or more en route airways, jet routes, or RNAV
RNAV STAR procedure design, such as minimum leg
routes to the basic STAR procedure. It is one of several
length, maximum turn angles, obstacle assessment criteria,
routes that bring traffic from different directions into one
including widths of the primary and secondary areas, use
STAR. This way, arrivals from several directions can be
the same design criteria as RNAV DPs. Likewise, RNAV STAR
accommodated on the same chart, and traffic flow is routed
procedures are designated as either RNAV-1 or RNAV-
appropriately within the congested airspace.
2, based on the aircraft navigation equipment required,
flight crew procedures, and the process and criteria used
To illustrate how STARs can be used to simplify a complex
to develop the STAR. The RNAV-1 or RNAV-2 designation
clearance and reduce frequency congestion, consider
appears in the notes on the chart. RNAV-1 STARs have

3-12
The STAR does not depict terrain
information. You must look at World
Aeronautical Charts (WACs) or
sectional charts to get a feel for the
underlying topography.

RADDY

The primary arrival airport is Seattle-


Tacoma International. Other airports
may be served by the procedure, such as
Boeing Field/King County International.
NW-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011 CHINS

O N
STARs include the name

I
of the procedure title.

AT
Radar vectors lead from the
arrival to either a north or

V I G
A
south final approach course. The CHINS SEVEN

N
ARRIVAL starts at
CHINS Intersection.

R
The STAR helps controllers manage the flow
of traffic into a busy terminal area during

O
periods of delays due to weather. The hold at

F
RADDY Intersection often serves this purpose.

OT If the en route portion of your flight ends at the


Kimberly VOR, you should add the Kimberly

N
Transition to the end of the route description
of your flight plan.

NW-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011


Lost communication procedures are included when needed for obstacle
clearance. Otherwise, follow the standard lost communication procedure.

Figure 3-11. STAR interpretation.

the following arrival clearance issued to a pilot flying to Now consider how this same clearance is issued when a
Seattle, Washington, depicted in Figure 3-11: Cessna 32G, STAR exists for this terminal area. Cessna 32G, cleared to
cleared to the Seattle/Tacoma International Airport as filed. Seattle/Tacoma International Airport as filed, then CHINS
Maintain 12,000. At the Ephrata VOR, intercept the 221 EIGHT ARRIVAL, Ephrata Transition. Maintain 10,000 feet. A
radial to CHINS Intersection. Intercept the 284 radial of the shorter transmission conveys the same information.
Yakima VOR to RADDY Intersection. Cross RADDY at 10,000.
Continue via the Yakima 284 radial to AUBRN Intersection. Safety is enhanced when both pilots and controllers know
Expect radar vectors to the final approach course. what to expect. Effective communication increases with the

3-13
NO
T
FO
R
SW-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

SW-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010


NA
VI
GA
TI
ON

Figure 3-12. Reducing pilot/controlling workload.

3-14
reduction of repetitive clearances, decreasing congestion not all aircraft operating under IFR are equipped to
on control frequencies. To accomplish this, STARs are navigate them.
developed according to the following criteria: Altitude crossing and airspeed restrictions are
STARs must be simple, easily understood and, if included when they are assigned by ATC a majority
possible, limited to one page. of the time. [Figure 3-12]
A STAR transition should be able to accommodate as
many different types of aircraft as possible. STARs usually are named according to the point at which
the procedure begins. In the United States, typically there
VHF Omnidirectional Range/Tactical Aircraft Control are en route transitions before the STAR itself. So the STAR
(VORTACs) are used wherever possible, with some name is usually the same as the last fix on the en route
exceptions on RNAV STARs, so that military and transitions where they come together to begin the basic
civilian aircraft can use the same arrival. STAR procedure. A STAR that commences at the CHINS
DME arcs within a STAR should be avoided since Intersection becomes the CHINS SEVEN ARRIVAL. When a

From the Albany VOR, the transition follows the 194


radial to the ATHOS Intersection. From ATHOS, the
All altitudes on the chart are MSL and NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010
transition follows the 354 radial to the Pawling VOR,
distances are in nautical miles. The MEA
where it joins the STAR.
for this route segment is 6,000 feet MSL, and

NO
NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010
its length is 35 nautical miles.

TF
Each transition is named for its
point of origin. All transitions
OR Frequency data is given in
a corner of the chart. Note
that ATIS frequencies for all
airports served are shown.

NA
come together at Pawling VOR,
the beginning of the actual STAR.

VI
GA
TIO
N
NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010
You need not fly into JFK to use
this STAR. Republic Airport in
NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010
Farmingdale is also served.
If the en route portion of your flight ends
at Rockdale VOR, you enter this
transition on your IFR flight plan as Arrival charts are most often not to
RKA.PWL2. Notice that, as opposed to a scale due to the distribution of
DP, the transition name is stated first, important fixes along the route.
then the arrival name.

Figure 3-13. STAR symbology.

3-15
significant portion of the arrival is revised, such as an altitude, as practical. It is recommended that pilots have this
a route, or data concerning the NAVAID, the number of the information prior to flying the STAR. If you are landing at
arrival changes. For example, the CHINS SEVEN ARRIVAL is an airport with approach control services that has two or
now the CHINS EIGHT ARRIVAL due to modifications in the more published instrument approach procedures, you will
procedure. receive advance notice of which instrument approaches to
expect. This information is broadcast either by ATIS or by a
Studying the STARs for an airport may allow pilots to perceive controller. [Figure 3-14] It may not be provided when the
the specific topography of the area. Note the initial fixes and visibility is 3 statute miles (SM) or better and the ceiling is at
where they correspond to fixes on the National Aeronautical or above the highest initial approach altitude established
Navigational Products (AeroNav Products) en route or area for any instrument approach procedure for the airport.
chart. Arrivals may incorporate step-down fixes when
necessary to keep aircraft within airspace boundaries or For STAR procedures charted with radar vectors to the
for obstacle clearance. Routes between fixes contain final approach, look for routes from the STAR terminating
courses, distances, and minimum altitudes, alerting aircrews fixes to the IAF. If no route is depicted, you should have
to possible obstructions or terrain under their arrival a predetermined plan of action to fly from the STAR
path. Airspeed restrictions also appear where they aid in terminating fix to the IAF in the event of a communication
managing the traffic flow. In addition, some STARs require failure.
that pilots use DME and/or ATC radar. Aircrews can decode
the symbology on the PAWLING TWO ARRIVAL by referring Reviewing the Approach
to the legend at the beginning of the TPP. [Figure 3-13] Once the aircrew has determined which approach to
expect, review the approach chart thoroughly before
STAR Procedures entering the terminal area. Aircrews should check fuel level
Pilots may accept a STAR within a clearance or they may and make sure a prolonged hold or increased headwinds
file for one in their flight plan. As the aircraft nears its have not cut into the aircrafts fuel reserves because there is
destination airport, ATC may add a STAR procedure to always a chance the pilot has to make a missed approach or
its original clearance. Keep in mind that ATC can assign go to an alternate. By completing landing checklists early,
a STAR even if the aircrew has not requested one. Use of aircrews can concentrate on the approach.
a STAR requires pilot possession of at least the approved
chart. RNAV STARs must be retrievable by the procedure In setting up for the expected approach procedure when
name from the aircraft database and conform to charted using an RNAV, GPS, or FMS system, it is important to
procedure. If an aircrew does not want to use a STAR, they understand how multiple approaches to the same runway
must specify No STAR in the remarks section of their flight are coded in the database. When more than one RNAV
plan. Pilots may also refuse the STAR when it is given to procedure is issued for the same runway, there must be a
them verbally by ATC, but the system works better if the way to differentiate between them within the equipments
aircrew advises ATC ahead of time. database, as well as to select which procedure is to be
used. (Multiple procedures may exist to accommodate GPS
Preparing for the Arrival receivers and FMS, both with and without VNAV capability.)
As mentioned before, STARs include navigation fixes that Each procedure name incorporates a letter of the alphabet,
are used to provide transition and arrival routes from starting with Z and working backward through Y, X, W, and
the en route structure to the final approach course. They so on. (Naming conventions for approaches are covered in
also may lead to a fix where radar vectors are provided more depth in the next chapter). [Figure 3-15]
to intercept the final approach course. Pilots may have
noticed that minimum crossing altitudes and airspeed Altitude
restrictions appear on some STARs. These expected Upon arrival in the terminal area, ATC either clears the
altitudes and airspeeds are not part of the clearance until aircraft to a specific altitude, or they give it a descend
ATC includes them verbally. A STAR is simply a published via clearance that instructs the pilot to follow the
routing; it does not have the force of a clearance until altitudes published on the STAR. [Figure 3-16] Pilots are
issued specifically by ATC. For example, minimum en route not authorized to leave their last assigned altitude unless
altitude (MEAs) printed on STARs are not valid unless stated specifically cleared to do so. If ATC amends the altitude or
within an ATC clearance or in cases of lost communication. route to one that is different from the published procedure,
After receiving the arrival clearance, the aircrew should the rest of the charted descent procedure is cancelled. ATC
review the assigned STAR procedure and ensure the FMS assigns any further route, altitude, or airspeed clearances,
has the appropriate procedure loaded (if so equipped). as necessary. Notice the JANESVILLE FOUR ARRIVAL depicts
Obtain the airport and weather information as early only one published arrival route, with no named transition

3-16
N
The textual description indicates

TIO
different altitude and airspeed
restrictions for turbojet and non-
"Piper 52 Sierra, cleared to Logan
turbojet aircraft.
International via the GARDNER THREE
ARRIVAL, Albany Transition, maintain 9,000."
At REVER Intersection, you fly
inbound to the Boston VOR on

GA
the 030 radial.

VI
NE-1, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

NE-1, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010


NA
OR
At this point, you join the
STAR on the 111 radial
from Gardner VOR.

You need to change VOR frequencies at the mileage


breakdown point. Follow the 110 radial from Albany
TF

VOR to 23 DME, then change to the 294 radial off


of the Gardner VOR.
NO

This note indicates that you can expect radar


vectors to the final approach course. Have a
plan of action in the event of a communication
failure.

Figure 3-14. Arrival clearance.

3-17
O R N
F IO
O T T
N IG A
A V
N
NE-3, 21 O

OV 2010
Figure 3-15. Two RNAV (GPS) approaches to Runway 15R at Baltimore. A controller issuing a clearance for one of these approaches
would speak the identifying letterfor example, ...cleared for the RNAV (GPS) Yankee approach, Runway 15R...

routes leading to the basic STAR procedure beginning at the the STAR chart), the altimeter should be set to the standard
Janesville VOR/DME. VNAV planning information is included setting when passing through 5,000 feet, as an example.
for turbojet and turboprop airplanes at the bottom of the This means that altimeter readings when flying above
chart. Additionally, note that there are several ways to 5,000 feet are actual flight levels, not feet. This is common
identify the BRIBE reporting point using alternate formation for Europe, but very different for pilots experienced with
radials, some of which are from off- chart NAVAIDs. ATC may flying in the United States and Canada.
issue a descent clearance that includes a crossing altitude
restriction. In the PENNS ONE ARRIVAL, the ATC clearance Although standardization of these procedures for terminal
authorizes aircraft to descend at the pilots discretion, as locations is subject to local considerations, specific criteria
long as the pilot crosses the PENNS Intersection at 6,000 apply in developing new or revised arrival procedures.
feet MSL. [Figure 3-17] Normally, high performance airplanes enter the terminal
area at or above 10,000 feet above the airport elevation
In the United States, Canada, and many other countries, and begin their descent 30 to 40 NM from touchdown on
the common altitude for changing to the standard the landing runway. Unless pilots indicate an operational
altimeter setting of 29.92 inches of mercury ("Hg) (or need for a lower altitude, descent below 5,000 feet above
1013.2 hectopascals or millibars) when climbing to the high the airport elevation is typically limited to an altitude where
altitude structure is 18,000 feet. When descending from final descent and glideslope intercept can be made without
high altitude, the altimeter should be changed to the local exceeding specific obstacle clearance and other related
altimeter setting when passing through FL 180, although arrival, approach, and landing criteria.
in most countries throughout the world the change to or
from the standard altimeter setting is not done at the same Arrival delays typically are absorbed at a metering fix.
altitude for each instance. This fix is established on a route prior to the terminal
airspace, 10,000 feet or more above the airport elevation.
For example, the flight level where aircrews change their The metering fix facilitates profile descents, rather than
altimeter setting to the local altimeter setting is specified controllers using delaying vectors or a holding pattern at
by ATC each time they arrive at a specific airport. This low altitudes. Descent restrictions normally are applied
information is shown on STAR charts outside the United prior to reaching the final approach phase to preclude
States with the words: TRANS LEVEL: BY ATC. When relatively high descent rates close in to the destination
departing from that same airport (also depicted typically on airport. At least 10 NM from initial descent from 10,000

3-18
EC-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

I O N
V I G AT
R N A
F O
N OT

EC-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

"Aircraft 20350, cleared via the JANESVILLE


FIVE ARRIVAL."
The controller is only giving you a routing clearance
and will specify any altitudes and airspeeds to fly.
"Aircraft 20350, descend via the JANESVILLE
FIVE ARRIVAL."
Descent is at your discretion; however, you must
adhere to the minimum crossing altitudes and
airspeed restrictions printed on the chart.

Figure 3-16. Assigned altitudes.

feet above the airport elevation, the controller issues for separation purposes, ATC avoids assigning an altitude
an advisory that details when to expect to commence below 5,000 feet above the airport elevation.
the descent. ATC typically uses the phraseology, Expect
descent in (number) miles. Standard ATC phraseology There are numerous exceptions to the high performance
is, Maintain (altitude) until specified point (e.g., abeam airplane arrival procedures previously outlined. For
landing runway end), cleared for visual approach or expect example, in a non-radar environment, the controller may
visual or contact approach clearance in (number of miles, clear the flight to use an approach based on a NAVAID
minutes, or specified point). other than the one aligned with the landing runway, such
as a circling approach. In this case, the descent to a lower
Once the determination is made regarding the instrument altitude usually is limited to the circling approach area with
approach and landing runway pilots use, ATC will not the circle-to-land maneuver confined to the traffic pattern.
permit a change to another NAVAID that is not aligned with
the landing runway. When altitude restrictions are required IFR en route descent procedures should include a review

3-19
"Piper 6319K, cross PENNS Intersection at 6,000, maintain 6,000."
NE-2, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

I O N
I G AT
NA V
R
If you are at RACKI Intersection at 12,000 feet

TF O
MSL, you must adjust your rate of descent so
you can reach 6,000 feet MSL in the distance
available. At a groundspeed of 180 knots (3

NO
NM per minute), you will reach PENNS
Intersection in approximately 8 minutes (23 3
= 7.6). You must descend at least 750 feet per
minute to cross PENNS at 6,000 feet MSL
(6,000 8 = 750).

You are at HAYED Intersection at 12,000 feet MSL. Your planned rate of descent is 500 feet per minute
and your groundspeed is approximately 180NE-2,
knots (3 2010
21 OCT NMtoper minute).
18 NOV 2010 You should begin your descent no
less than 36 NM from PENNS Intersection ([6,000 500] x 3 = 36).

Figure 3-17. Altitude restrictions.

of minimum, maximum, mandatory, and recommended a reciprocating engine or turboprop airplane within 20
altitudes that normally precede the fix or NAVAID facility NM from the destination airport, 150 knots is usually the
to which they apply. The initial descent gradient for a low slowest airspeed that is assigned. If the aircraft cannot
altitude instrument approach procedure does not exceed maintain the assigned airspeed, the pilot must advise ATC.
500 FPNM (approximately 5), and for a high altitude Controllers may ask pilots to maintain the same speed as
approach, the maximum allowable initial gradient is 1,000 the aircraft ahead of or behind them on the approach. Pilots
FPNM (approximately 10). are expected to maintain the specified airspeed 10 knots.
At other times, ATC may ask pilots to increase or decrease
Remember during arrivals, when cleared for an instrument airspeed by 10 knots, or multiples thereof. When the speed
approach, maintain the last assigned altitude until adjustment is no longer needed, ATC advises the pilot to
established on a published segment of the approach or on resume normal speed.
a segment of a published route. If no altitude is assigned
with the approach clearance and the aircraft is already on a Keep in mind that the maximum speeds specified in 14 CFR
published segment, the pilot can descend to its minimum Part 91, section 91.117 still apply during speed adjustments.
altitude for that segment of the approach. It is the pilots responsibility to advise ATC if an assigned
speed adjustment would cause an exceedence of these
Airspeed limits. For operations in Class C or D airspace at or below
During the arrival, expect to make adjustments in speed at 2,500 feet above ground level (AGL), within 4 NM of the
the controllers request. When pilots fly a high-performance primary airport, ATC has the authority to approve a faster
aircraft on an IFR flight plan, ATC may ask them to adjust speed than those prescribed in 14 CFR Part 91, section
their airspeed to achieve proper traffic sequencing 91.117.
and separation. This also reduces the amount of radar
vectoring required in the terminal area. When operating Pilots operating at or above 10,000 feet MSL on an assigned

3-20
speed adjustment that is greater than 250 KIAS are expected the protected airspace that a holding pattern provides.
to reduce speed to 250 KIAS to comply with 14 CFR Part
91, section 91.117(a) when cleared below 10,000 feet MSL, Each holding pattern has a fix, a direction to hold from
within domestic airspace. This speed adjustment is made the fix, and an airway, bearing, course, radial, or route on
without notifying ATC. Pilots are expected to comply with which the aircraft is to hold. These elements, along with the
the other provisions of 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.117 direction of the turns, define the holding pattern.
without notifying ATC. For example, it is normal for faster
aircraft to level off at 10,000 feet MSL while slowing to the Since the speed of the aircraft affects the size of a
250 KIAS limit that applies below that altitude, and to level holding pattern, maximum holding airspeeds have been
off at 2,500 feet above airport elevation to slow to the 200 designated to limit the amount of airspace that must be
KIAS limit that applies within the surface limits of Class C protected. The three airspeed limits are shown in Figure
or D airspace. Controllers anticipate this action and plan 2-73 in Chapter 2, En Route Operations, of this book. Some
accordingly. holding patterns have additional airspeed restrictions to
keep faster airplanes from flying out of the protected area.
Speed restrictions of 250 knots do not apply to aircraft These are depicted on charts by using an icon and the
operating beyond 12 NM from the coastline within the limiting airspeed.
United States Flight Information Region in offshore Class
E airspace below 10,000 feet MSL. In airspace underlying DME and IFR-certified GPS equipment offer some additional
a Class B airspace area designated for an airport, pilots are options for holding. Rather than being based on time, the
expected to comply with the 200 KIAS limit specified in 14 leg lengths for DME/GPS holding patterns are based on
CFR Part 91, section 91.117(c). (See 14 CFR Part 91, sections distances in nautical miles. These patterns use the same
91.117(c) and 91.703.) Approach clearances cancel any entry and holding procedures as conventional holding
previously assigned speed adjustment. patterns. The controller or the instrument approach
procedure chart specifies the length of the outbound leg.
Holding Patterns The end of the outbound leg is determined by the DME
If aircraft reach a clearance limit before receiving a further or the along track distance (ATD) readout. The holding
clearance from ATC, a holding pattern is required at the fix on conventional procedures, or controller-defined
last assigned altitude. Controllers assign holds for a variety holding based on a conventional navigation aid with DME,
of reasons, including deteriorating weather or high traffic is a specified course or radial and distances are from the
volume. Holding might also be required following a missed DME station for both the inbound and outbound ends of
approach. Since flying outside the area set aside for a the holding pattern. When flying published GPS overlay
holding pattern could lead to an encounter with terrain or standalone procedures with distance specified, the
or other aircraft, aircrews need to understand the size of holding fix is a waypoint in the database and the end of the

...Bonanza 8394K, hold


northeast of the 16 DME fix on
the 030 radial of the stedman
VORTAC, 5 mile legs...
...Viking 5786P, hold east of the 20 DME fix on the
265 radial of the stedman VORTAC, 5 mile legs...

SET

Figure 3-18. Instead of flying for a specific time after passing the holding fix, these holding patterns use distances to mark where the
turns are made. The distances come from DME or IFR-certified GPS equipment.

3-21
outbound leg is determined by the ATD. Instead of using may be worded as simply as cleared for approach.
the end of the outbound leg, some FMS are programmed If ATC wants to restrict the pilot to a specific approach,
to cue the inbound turn so that the inbound leg length the controller names the approach in the clearance. For
matches the charted outbound leg length. example, cleared ILS Runway 35 Right approach.

Normally, the difference is negligible, but in high winds, When the landing is to be made on a runway that is not
this can enlarge the size of the holding pattern. Aircrews aligned with the approach being flown, the controller may
need to understand their aircrafts FMS holding program to issue a circling approach clearance, such as cleared
ensure that the holding entry procedures and leg lengths for VOR Runway 17 approach, circle to land Runway 23.
match the holding pattern. Some situations may require Approaches whose final approach segment is more than 30
pilot intervention in order to stay within protected airspace. degrees different from the landing runway alignment are
[Figure 3-18] always designated as circling approaches. Unless a specific
landing runway is specified in the approach clearance,
Approach Clearance the pilot may land on any runway. Pilots landing at non-
The approach clearance provides guidance to a position towered airports are reminded of the importance of making
from where the pilot can execute the approach. It is also radio calls as set forth in the AIM.
a clearance to fly that approach. If only one approach
procedure exists, or if ATC authorizes the aircrew to execute When cleared for an approach prior to reaching a holding
the approach procedure of their choice, the clearance fix, ATC expects the pilot to continue to the holding fix,

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
F
O T
N
Figure 3-19. Cleared present position direct from V295.

3-22
N
I O
A T
I G
A V
N
R
SE-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010

Dir

SE-3, 21 OCT 2010 to 18 NOV 2010


ec
t fr

O
om
V2
95

F
T
O
N

Figure 3-20. Cleared for the Palm Beach ILS approach.

3-23
along the feeder route associated with the fix, and then Radar Vectors to Final Approach Course
to the IAF. If a feeder route to an IAF begins at a fix located Arriving aircraft usually are vectored to intercept the final
along the route of flight prior to reaching the holding fix, approach course, except with vectors for a visual approach,
and clearance for an approach is issued, the pilot should at least 2 NM outside the approach gate unless one of the
commence the approach via the published feeder route. following exists:
The pilot is expected to commence the approach in a
1. When the reported ceiling is at least 500 feet above
similar manner at the IAF, if the IAF is located along the
the minimum vectoring altitude or minimum IFR
route to the holding fix.
altitude and the visibility is at least 3 NM (report
may be a pilot report if no weather is reported for
ATC also may clear an aircraft directly to the IAF by using
language such as direct or proceed direct. Controllers
normally identify an approach by its published name,
even if some component of the approach aid (such as
the glideslope of an ILS) is inoperative or unreliable. The
controller uses the name of the approach as published but
25
advises the aircraft when issuing the approach clearance
that the component is unusable.

Present Position Direct


In addition to using high and low altitude en route charts
as resources for arrivals, area charts can be helpful as a
planning aid for SA. Many pilots find the area chart helpful
in locating a depicted fix after ATC clears them to proceed LIMA 1500
to a fix and hold, especially at unfamiliar airports. LOM 6 DME

Looking at Figures 3-19 and 3-20 assume the pilot is on


V295 northbound en route to Palm Beach International
Airport. The pilot is en route on the airway when the X-RAY 1300
controller clears him present position direct to the ZISUR INT 12 DME 2
(IAF) and for the ILS approach. There is no transition
authorized or charted between his present position and the
approach facility. There is no minimum altitude published
for the route the pilot is about to travel.

In Figure 3-20, the pilot is just north of HEATT Intersection


at 5,000 feet when the approach controller states, Citation
9724J, 2 miles from HEATT, cleared present position
direct ZISUR, cleared for the Palm Beach ILS Runway 10L
Approach, contact Palm Beach Tower on 119.1 established 1
inbound. With no minimum altitude published from that ALPHA 4000
INT 20 DME
point to the ZISUR intersection, the pilot should maintain
the last assigned altitude until he reaches the IAF. In
Figure 3-19, after passing ZISUR intersection outbound,
commence the descent to 2,000 feet for the course reversal.

The ILS procedure relies heavily on the controllers


recognition of the restriction upon the pilot to maintain
the last assigned altitude until established on a published
IAF 3 IAF
segment of the approach. Prior to issuing a clearance for the
approach, the controller usually assigns the pilot an altitude
to maintain until established on the final approach course ,
compatible with glideslope intercept.

Figure 3-21. Arrival instructions when established.

3-24
the airport), aircraft may be vectored to intercept
the final approach course closer than 2 NM outside
IAF
the approach gate but no closer than the approach
gate.
2. If specifically requested by a pilot, ATC may vector
aircraft to intercept the final approach course inside
the approach gate but no closer than the final
approach fix (FAF). ALPHA

For a precision approach, aircraft are vectored at an altitude


that is not above the glideslope/glidepath or below the
minimum glideslope intercept altitude specified on the
approach procedure chart. For a non-precision approach,
aircraft are vectored at an altitude that allows descent in
accordance with the published procedure.

When a vector takes the aircraft across the final approach


course, pilots are informed by ATC and the reason for the
action is stated. In the event that ATC is not able to inform
the aircraft, the pilot is not expected to turn inbound on 4000
FAF
12 DME
the final approach course unless an approach clearance has
been issued. An example of ATC phraseology in this case
is, expect vectors across final for spacing.

The following ATC arrival instructions are issued to an IFR


aircraft before it reaches the approach gate:
Straight-in ILS
1. Position relative to a fix on the final approach course.
If none is portrayed on the controllers radar display
or if none is prescribed in the instrument approach
procedure, ATC issues position information relative
to the airport or relative to the NAVAID that provides
final approach guidance. Figure 3-22. Arrival instructions when not established.

2. Vector to intercept the final approach course if Aircraft 3: There are many times when it is desirable to
required. position an aircraft onto the final approach course prior to
3. Approach clearance except when conducting a radar a published, charted segment of an instrument approach
approach. ATC issues the approach clearance only procedure (IAP).
after the aircraft is established on a segment of a
published route or instrument approach procedure, or Sometimes IAPs have no initial segment and require
in the following examples as depicted in Figure 3-21. vectors. RADAR REQUIRED is charted in the plan view.
Sometimes a route intersects an extended final approach
Aircraft 1 was vectored to the final approach course course making a long intercept desirable.
but clearance was withheld. It is now at 4,000 feet and
established on a segment of the instrument approach When ATC issues a vector or clearance to the final approach
procedure. Seven miles from X-RAY. Cleared ILS runway course beyond the published segment, controllers assign
three six approach. an altitude to maintain until the aircraft is established on
a segment of a published route or IAP. This ensures that
Aircraft 2 is being vectored to a published segment of both the pilot and controller know precisely what altitude
the final approach course, 4 NM from LIMA at 2,000 feet. is to be flown and precisely where descent to appropriate
The minimum vectoring altitude for this area is 2,000 feet. minimum altitudes or step-down altitudes can begin.
Four miles from LIMA. Turn right heading three four zero.
Maintain two thousand until established on the localizer. Most aircraft are vectored onto a localizer or final approach
Cleared ILS runway three six approach. course between an intermediate fix and the approach gate.

3-25
These aircraft normally are told to maintain an altitude until ATC tries to make frequency changes prior to passing the
established on a segment of the approach. FAF, although when radar is used to establish the FAF, ATC
informs the pilot to contact the tower on the local control
When an aircraft is assigned a route that is not a published frequency after being advised that the aircraft is over the
segment of an approach, the controller must issue an fix. For example, Three miles from final approach fix. Turn
altitude to maintain until the aircraft is established on a left heading zero one zero. Maintain two thousand until
published segment of the approach. [Figure 3-21] Assume established on the localizer. Cleared ILS runway three six
the aircraft is established on the final approach course approach. I will advise when over the fix.
beyond the approach segments, 8 NM from Alpha at 6,000
feet. The minimum vectoring altitude for this area is 4,000 Over final approach fix. Contact tower one-one eight
feet. Eight miles from Alpha. Cross Alpha at or above four point one.
thousand. Cleared ILS runway three six approach.
Special Airport Qualification
If an aircraft is not established on a segment of a published It is important to note an example of additional resources
approach and is not conducting a radar approach, that are helpful for arrivals, especially into unfamiliar
ATC assigns an altitude to maintain until the aircraft airports requiring special pilot or navigation qualifications.
is established on a segment of a published route or The operating rules governing domestic and flag air
instrument approach procedure. [Figure 3-22] carriers require pilots in command to be qualified over
the routes and into airports where scheduled operations
The aircraft is being vectored to a published segment of the are conducted, including areas, routes, and airports in
ILS final approach course, 3 NM from Alpha at 4,000 feet. which special pilot qualifications or special navigation
The minimum vectoring altitude for this area is 4,000 feet. qualifications are needed. For Part 119 certificate holders
Three miles from Alpha. Turn left heading two one zero. who conduct operations under 14 CFR Part 121, section
Maintain four thousand until established on the localizer. 121.443, there are provisions in OpSpecs under which
Cleared ILS runway one eight approach. operators can comply with this regulation. Figure 3-27
provides some examples of special airports in the United
The ATC assigned altitude ensures IFR obstruction States along with associated comments.
clearance from the point at which the approach clearance
is issued until established on a segment of a published
route or instrument approach procedure.

Special Airports Comments


Kodiak, AK Airport is surrounded by mountainous terrain. Any go-around beyond ILS or GCA
MAP will not provide obstruction clearance.
Petersburg, AK Mountainous terrain in immediate vicinity of airport, all quadrants.
Cape Newenham AFS, AK Runway located on mountain slope with high gradient factor; nonstandard
instrument approach.
Washington, DC (National) Special arrival/departure procedures.
Shenandoah Valley, VA Mountainous terrain.
(Stanton-Waynesboro-Harrisonburg)
Aspen, CO High terrain; special procedures.
Gunnison, CO VOR only; uncontrolled; numerous obstructions in airport area; complete departure
procedures.
Missoula, MT Mountainous terrain; special procedures.
Jackson Hole, WY Mountainous terrain; all quadrants; complex departure procedures.
Hailey, ID (Friedman Memorial) Mountainous terrain; special arrival/departure procedures.
Hayden, Yampa Valley, CO Mountainous terrain; no control tower; special engine-out procedures for certain
large airplanes.
Lihue, Kauai, HI High terrain; mountainous to 2,300 feet within 3 miles of the localizer.
Ontario, CA Mountainous terrain and extremely limited visibility in haze conditions.

Figure 3-27. Special airports and comments.

3-26
Chapter 4

Approaches
Introduction
This chapter discusses general planning and conduct of
instrument approaches by pilots operating under Title 14
of the Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) Parts 91,
121, 125, and 135. The operations specifications (OpSpecs),
standard operating procedures (SOPs), and any other
Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) approved documents
for each commercial operator are the final authorities for
individual authorizations and limitations as they relate
to instrument approaches. While coverage of the various
authorizations and approach limitations for all operators
is beyond the scope of this chapter, an attempt is made
to give examples from generic manuals where it is
appropriate.

4-1
Approach Planning within the framework of each specific air carriers OpSpecs,
or Part 91.
Depending on speed of the aircraft, availability of weather
information, and the complexity of the approach procedure
or special terrain avoidance procedures for the airport
Weather Considerations
of intended landing, the in-flight planning phase of an Weather conditions at the field of intended landing dictate
instrument approach can begin as far as 100-200 nautical whether flight crews need to plan for an instrument
miles (NM) from the destination. Some of the approach approach and, in many cases, determine which approaches
planning should be accomplished during preflight. In can be used, or if an approach can even be attempted. The
general, there are five steps that most operators incorporate gathering of weather information should be one of the first
into their flight standards manuals for the in-flight planning steps taken during the approach-planning phase. Although
phase of an instrument approach: there are many possible types of weather information,
the primary concerns for approach decision-making are
Gathering weather information, field conditions,
windspeed, wind direction, ceiling, visibility, altimeter
and Notices to Airmen (NOTAMs) for the airport of
setting, temperature, and field conditions. It is also a good
intended landing.
idea to check NOTAMs at this time, in case there were any
Calculation of performance data, approach speeds, changes since preflight planning.
and thrust/power settings.
Flight deck navigation/communication and Windspeed and direction are factors because they often
automation setup. limit the type of approach that can be flown at a specific
location. This typically is not a factor at airports with
Instrument approach procedure (IAP) review and, for
multiple precision approaches, but at airports with only a
flight crews, IAP briefing.
few or one approach procedure, the wrong combination of
Operational review and, for flight crews, operational wind and visibility can make all instrument approaches at
briefing. an airport unavailable. Pilots must be prepared to execute
other available approaches, not just the one that they may
Although often modified to suit each individual operator, have planned for. As an example, consider the available
these five steps form the basic framework for the in-flight approaches at the Chippewa Valley Regional Airport (KEAU)
planning phase of an instrument approach. The extent of in Eau Claire, Wisconsin. [Figure 4-1] In the event that the
detail that a given operator includes in their SOPs varies visibility is reported as less than one mile, the only useable
from one operator to another; some may designate which approaches for Category C airplanes is the Instrument
pilot performs each of the above actions, the sequence, and Landing System (ILS) and Lateral navigation (LNAV)/vertical
the manner in which each action is performed. Others may navigation (VNAV) to Runway 22. This leaves very few
leave much of the detail up to individual flight crews and options for flight crews if the wind does not favor Runway
only designate which tasks should be performed prior to 22; and, in cases where the wind restricts a landing on that
commencing an approach. Flight crews of all levels, from runway altogether, even a circling approach cannot be
single-pilot to multi-crewmember Part 91 operators, can flown because of the visibility.
benefit from the experience of commercial operators in
developing techniques to fly standard instrument approach Weather Sources
procedures (SIAPs). Most of the weather information that flight crews receive
is issued to them prior to the start of each flight segment,
Determining the suitability of a specific IAP can be a very but the weather used for in-flight planning and execution
complex task, since there are many factors that can limit of an instrument approach is normally obtained en route
the usability of a particular approach. There are several via government sources, company frequency, or Aircraft
questions that pilots need to answer during preflight Communications Addressing and Reporting System
planning and prior to commencing an approach. Is the (ACARS).
approach procedure authorized for the company, if Part
91, subpart K, 121, 125, or 135? Is the weather appropriate Air carriers and operators certificated under the provisions
for the approach? Is the aircraft currently at a weight that of Part 119 (Certification: Air Carriers and Commercial
will allow it the necessary performance for the approach Operators) are required to use the aeronautical weather
and landing or go around/ missed approach? Is the aircraft information systems defined in the OpSpecs issued to that
properly equipped for the approach? Is the flight crew certificate holder by the FAA. These systems may use basic
qualified and current for the approach? Many of these types FAA/National Weather Service (NWS) weather services,
of issues must be considered during preflight planning and contractor or operator-proprietary weather services, and/

4-2
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

N
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010
16 DEC 2010

O
T
F O
R
N

Figure 4-1. Chippewa Regional Airport (KEAU), Eau Claire, Wisconsin.


A V I G
A T I

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


O
N

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010 EC-3, 18 NOV

4-3
or Enhanced Weather Information System (EWINS) when Applications Laboratory (RAL), and the Aviation
approved in the OpSpecs. As an integral part of EWINS Weather Center (AWC).
approval, the procedures for collecting, producing, and Hazardous In-flight Weather Advisory Service
disseminating aeronautical weather information, as well (HIWAS) is a national program for broadcasting
as the crewmember and dispatcher training to support hazardous weather information continuously over
the use of system weather products, must be accepted or selected navigation aids (NAVAIDs). The broadcasts
approved. include advisories such as Airmans Meteorological
Information (AIRMETs), Significant Meteorological
Operators not certificated under the provisions of 14 Information (SIGMETs), convective SIGMETs, and
CFR Part 119 are encouraged to use FAA/NWS products urgent pilot weather reports (PIREPs/UUA). These
through Flight Service Station (FSS)/Automated Flight broadcasts are only a summary of the information,
Service Station (AFSS). FSS and AFSS provide pilot weather and pilots should contact an FSS/AFSS or En
briefings, en route weather, receive and process instrument Route Flight Advisory Service (EFAS) for detailed
flight rule (IFR) and visual flight rule (VFR) flight plans, information.
relay air traffic control (ATC) clearances, and issue NOTAMs.
They also provide assistance to lost aircraft and aircraft in Telephone Information Briefing Service (TIBS) is
emergency situations and conduct VFR search and rescue a service prepared and disseminated by selected
services. AFSS. It provides continuous telephone recordings
of meteorological and aeronautical information.
Direct User Access Terminal System (DUATS), funded by Specifically, TIBS provides area and route briefings,
the FAA, allows any pilot with a current medical certificate as well as airspace procedures and special
to access weather information and file a flight plan via announcements, if applicable. It is designed to be
computer. Two methods of access are available to connect a preliminary briefing tool and is not intended to
with DUATS. The first is on the internet at www.duats.com replace a standard briefing from a flight service
or www.duat.com. The second method requires a modem specialist. The TIBS service is available 24 hours a day
and a communications program supplied by a DUATS and is updated when conditions change, but it can
provider. To access the weather information and file a only be accessed by a touch tone phone. The phone
flight plan by this method, pilots use a toll free telephone numbers for the TIBS service are listed in the Airport/
number to connect the users computer directly to the Facility Directory (A/FD). TIBS should also contain,
DUATS computer. The current vendors of DUATS service but is not limited to: surface observations, terminal
and the associated phone numbers are listed in Chapter 7 aerodrome forecast (TAFs), and winds/temperatures
of the Aeronautical Information Manual (AIM). aloft forecasts.

Flight Information ServiceBroadcast (FIS-B) provides The suite of available aviation weather product types
certain aviation weather and other aeronautical information is expanding with the development of new sensor
to aircraft equipped with an appropriate flight deck display. systems, algorithms, and forecast models. The FAA and
Reception of FIS-B services can be expected within a NWS, supported by the NCAR and the FSL, develop and
ground station coverage volume when line-of-sight implement new aviation weather product types through
geometry is maintained between the aircraft and ground a comprehensive process known as the Aviation Weather
station. National Airspace System (NAS) wide service Technology Transfer process. This process ensures that
availability was targeted for 2013 and is currently available user needs and technical and operational readiness
within certain regions. FIS-B provides the following textual requirements are met as experimental product types
and graphical aviation weather and aeronautical products mature to operational application.
free-of-charge. A detailed description of these products
can be found in the AIM. The development of enhanced communications
capabilities, most notably the internet, has allowed pilots
Aviation Digital Data Services (ADDS) provides the access to an increasing range of weather service providers
aviation community with text, digital and graphical and proprietary products. It is not the intent of the FAA to
forecasts, analyses, and observations of aviation limit operator use of this weather information. However,
related weather variables. ADDS is a joint effort of pilots and operators should be aware that weather services
National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administrations provided by entities other than the FAA, NWS, or their
(NOAA) Earth System Research Laboratory, National contractors (such as the DUATS and flight information
Center for Atmospheric Research (NCAR) Research services data link (FISDL) providers) may not meet FAA/

4-4
NWS quality control standards. Automated Weather Observing Programs
Automated weather reporting systems are increasingly
Broadcast Weather being installed at airports. These systems consist of
The most common method used by flight crews to obtain various sensors, a processor, a computer-generated voice
specific in-flight weather information is to use a source that subsystem, and a transmitter to broadcast local, minute-
broadcasts weather for the specific airport. Information by-minute weather data directly to the pilot.
about ceilings, visibility, wind, temperature, barometric
pressure, and field conditions can be obtained from most Automated Weather Observing System
types of broadcast weather services. Broadcast weather The automated weather observing system (AWOS)
can be transmitted to the aircraft in radio voice format or observations include the prefix AUTO to indicate that
digital format, if it is available, via an ACARS system. the data are derived from an automated system. Some
AWOS locations are augmented by certified observers who
Automated Terminal Information Service (ATIS) provide weather and obstruction to vision information
Automatic terminal information service (ATIS) is the in the remarks of the report when the reported visibility
continuous broadcast of recorded non-control information is less than 7 miles. These sites, along with the hours of
in selected high activity terminal areas. Its purpose is to augmentation, are published in the A/FD. Augmentation
improve controller effectiveness and to relieve frequency is identified in the observation as OBSERVER WEATHER.
congestion by automating the repetitive transmission The AWOS wind speed, direction and gusts, temperature,
of essential but routine information. The information is dew point, and altimeter setting are exactly the same as
continuously broadcast over a discrete very high frequency for manual observations. The AWOS also reports density
(VHF) radio frequency or the voice portion of a local NAVAID. altitude when it exceeds the field elevation by more than
ATIS transmissions on a discrete VHF radio frequency are 1,000 feet. The reported visibility is derived from a sensor
engineered to be receivable to a maximum of 60 NM from near the touchdown of the primary instrument runway.
the ATIS site and a maximum altitude of 25,000 feet above The visibility sensor output is converted to a visibility value
ground level (AGL). At most locations, ATIS signals may be using a 10-minute harmonic average. The reported sky
received on the surface of the airport, but local conditions condition/ ceiling is derived from the ceilometer located
may limit the maximum ATIS reception distance and/or next to the visibility sensor. The AWOS algorithm integrates
altitude. Pilots are urged to cooperate in the ATIS program the last 30 minutes of ceilometer data to derive cloud layers
as it relieves frequency congestion on approach control, and heights. This output may also differ from the observer
ground control, and local control frequencies. The A/FD sky condition in that the AWOS is totally dependent upon
indicates airports for which ATIS is provided. the cloud advection over the sensor site.

ATIS information includes the time of the latest weather Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS)/
sequence, ceiling, visibility, obstructions to visibility, Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS)
temperature, dew point (if available), wind direction
The automated surface observing system (ASOS)/
(magnetic), velocity, altimeter, other pertinent remarks,
automated weather sensor system (AWSS) is the primary
instrument approach and runway in use. The ceiling/sky
surface weather observing system of the United States. The
condition, visibility, and obstructions to vision may be
program to install and operate these systems throughout
omitted from the ATIS broadcast if the ceiling is above
the United States is a joint effort of the NWS, the FAA, and
5,000 feet and the visibility is more than five miles. The
the Department of Defense (DOD). AWSS is a follow-on
departure runway will only be given if different from the
program that provides identical data as ASOS. ASOS/AWSS
landing runway except at locations having a separate ATIS
is designed to support aviation operations and weather
for departure. The broadcast may include the appropriate
forecast activities. The ASOS/ AWSS provides continuous
frequency and instructions for VFR arrivals to make initial
minute-by-minute observations and performs the basic
contact with approach control. Pilots of aircraft arriving or
observing functions necessary to generate a aviation
departing the terminal area can receive the continuous
routine weather report (METAR) and other aviation weather
ATIS broadcast at times when flight deck duties are least
information. The information may be transmitted over a
pressing and listen to as many repeats as desired. ATIS
discrete VHF radio frequency or the voice portion of a local
broadcast will be updated upon the receipt of any official
NAVAID. ASOS/AWSS transmissions on a discrete VHF radio
hourly and special weather. A new recording will also be
frequency are engineered to be receivable to a maximum of
made when there is a change in other pertinent data, such
25 NM from the ASOS/AWSS site and a maximum altitude
as runway change and instrument approach in use.
of 10,000 feet AGL.

4-5
At many locations, ASOS/AWSS signals may be received of information about existing meteorological
on the surface of the airport, but local conditions may conditions.
limit the maximum reception distance and/or altitude. 3. When observed or developing weather conditions
While the automated system and the human may differ do not meet SIGMET, convective SIGMET, or
in their methods of data collection and interpretation, AIRMET criteria (e.g., in terms of intensity or area
both produce an observation quite similar in form and coverage), but current pilot reports or other
content. For the objective elements, such as pressure, weather information sources indicate that existing
ambient temperature, dew point temperature, wind, and or anticipated meteorological phenomena will
precipitation accumulation, both the automated system adversely affect the safe and efficient flow of air
and the observer use a fixed location and time-averaging traffic within the ARTCC area of responsibility.
technique. The quantitative differences between the
observer and the automated observation of these elements
Weather Regulatory Requirements
are negligible. For the subjective elements, however,
There are many practical reasons for reviewing weather
observers use a fixed time (spatial averaging technique) to
information prior to initiating an instrument approach.
describe the visual elements (sky condition, visibility, and
Pilots must familiarize themselves with the condition of
present weather, etc.), while the automated systems use
individual airports and runways so that they may make
a fixed location and time averaging technique. Although
informed decisions regarding fuel management, diversions,
this is a fundamental change, the manual and automated
and alternate planning. Because this information is critical,
techniques yield remarkably similar results within the limits
14 CFR requires pilots to comply with specific weather
of their respective capabilities.
minimums for planning and execution of instrument flights
and approaches..
The use of the aforementioned visibility reports and
weather services are not limited for Part 91 operators.
Weather Requirements and Part 91 Operators
Part 121 and 135 operators are bound by their individual
According to 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.103, the pilot in
OpSpecs documents and are required to use weather
command (PIC) must become familiar with all available
reports that come from the NWS or other approved
information concerning a flight prior to departure.
sources. While all OpSpecs are individually tailored, most
Included in this directive is the fundamental basis for
operators are required to use ATIS information, runway
pilots to review NOTAMs and pertinent weather reports
visual range (RVR) reports, and selected reports from
and forecasts for the intended route of flight. This review
automated weather stations. All reports coming from an
should include current weather reports and terminal
AWOS-3 station are usable for Part 121 and 135 operators.
forecasts for all intended points of landing and alternate
Each type of automated station has different levels of
airports. In addition, a thorough review of an airports
approval as outlined in individual OpSpecs. Ceiling and
current weather conditions should always be conducted
visibility reports given by the tower with the departure
prior to initiating an instrument approach. Pilots should
information are always considered official weather, and
also consider weather information as a planning tool for
RVR reports are typically the controlling visibility reference.
fuel management.
Refer to Chapter 1, Departures, of this manual, as well as
the AIM section 7-1-12 for further description of automated
For flight planning purposes, weather information must be
weather systems.
reviewed in order to determine the necessity and suitability
Center Weather Advisories (CWA) of alternate airports. For Part 91 operations, the 600-2 and
800-2 rule applies to airports with precision and non-
Center weather advisories (CWAs) are unscheduled inflight,
precision approaches, respectively. Approaches with
flow control, air traffic, and aircrew advisories. By nature of
vertical guidance (APV) are non-precision approaches
its short lead time, the CWA is not a flight planning product.
because they do not meet the International Civil Aviation
It is generally a nowcast for conditions beginning in the
Organization (ICAO) Annex 10 standards for a precision
next 2 hours. CWAs will be issued:
approach. (See Final Approach Segment section later in this
1. As a supplement to an existing SIGMET, convective chapter for more information regarding APV approaches.)
SIGMET, or AIRMET. Exceptions to the 600-2 and 800-2 alternate minimums are
2. When an in-flight advisory has not been issued listed in the front of the National Aeronautical Navigational
but observed or expected weather conditions Products (AeroNav Products) in the Terminal Procedures
meet SIGMET/AIRMET criteria based on current Publication (TPP) and are indicated by a symbol A on the
pilot reports and reinforced by other sources approach charts for the airport. This does not preclude
flight crews from initiating instrument approaches at

4-6
alternate airports when the weather conditions are thereof, indicate that the weather will be at or above the
below these minimums. The 600-2 and 800-2 rules, or any authorized minimums at the ETA at the airport to which
exceptions, only apply to flight planning purposes, while the flight is dispatched (14 CFR Part 121, section 121.613).
published landing minimums apply to the actual approach This regulation attempts to ensure that flight crews will
at the alternate. always be able to execute an instrument approach at
the destination airport. Of course, weather forecasts are
Weather Requirements and Part 135 Operators occasionally inaccurate; therefore, a thorough review
Unlike Part 91 operators, Part 135 operators may not depart of current weather is required prior to conducting an
for a destination unless the forecast weather there will allow approach. Like Part 135 operators, Part 121 operators are
an instrument approach and landing. According to 14 CFR restricted from proceeding past the FAF of an instrument
Part 135, section 135.219, flight crews and dispatchers approach unless the appropriate IFR landing minimums
may only designate an airport as a destination if the latest exist for the procedure. In addition, descent below the
weather reports or forecasts, or any combination of them, minimum descent altitude (MDA), decision altitude (DA),
indicate that the weather conditions will be at or above or decision height (DH) is governed, with one exception,
IFR landing minimums at the estimated time of arrival by the same rules that apply to Part 91 operators. The
(ETA). This ensures that Part 135 flight crews consider exception is that during Part 121 and 135 operations, the
weather forecasts when determining the suitability of airplane is also required to land within the touchdown
destinations. Departures for airports can be made when the zone (TDZ). Refer to the section titled Minimum Descent
forecast weather shows the airport will be at or above IFR Altitude, Decision Altitude, and Decision Height later in this
minimums at the ETA, even if current conditions indicate chapter for more information regarding MDA, DA, and DH.
the airport to be below minimums. Conversely, 14 CFR
Part 135, section 135.219 prevents departures when the Aircraft Performance Considerations
first airport of intended landing is currently above IFR All operators are required to comply with specific airplane
landing minimums, but the forecast weather is below those performance limitations that govern approach and landing.
minimums at the ETA. Many of these requirements must be considered prior to the
origination of flight. The primary goal of these performance
Another very important difference between Part 91 and considerations is to ensure that the aircraft can remain clear
Part 135 operations is the Part 135 requirement for airports of obstructions throughout the approach, landing, and go-
of intended landing to meet specific weather criteria once around phase of flight, as well as land within the distance
the flight has been initiated. For Part 135, not only is the required by the FAA. Although the majority of in-depth
weather required to be forecast at or above instrument flight performance planning for an instrument flight is normally
rules (IFR) landing minimums for planning a departure, done prior to the aircrafts departure, a general review of
but it also must be above minimums for initiation of an performance considerations is usually conducted prior to
instrument approach and, once the approach is initiated, to commencing an instrument approach.
begin the final approach segment of an approach. 14 CFR
Part 135, section 135.225 states that pilots may not begin Airplane Performance Operating Limitations
an instrument approach unless the latest weather report Generally speaking, air carriers must have in place an
indicates that the weather conditions are at or above the approved method of complying with Subpart I of 14
authorized IFR landing minimums for that procedure. 14 CFR Parts 121 and 135 (Airplane Performance Operating
CFR Part 135, section 135.225 provides relief from this rule Limitations), thereby proving the airplanes performance
if the aircraft has already passed the final approach fix (FAF) capability for every flight that it intends to make. Flight
when the weather report is received. It should be noted that crews must have an approved method of complying
the controlling factor for determining whether or not the with the approach and landing performance criteria in
aircraft can proceed is reported visibility. RVR, if available, the applicable regulations prior to departing for their
is the controlling visibility report for determining that the intended destination. The primary source of information for
requirements of this section are met. The runway visibility performance calculations for all operators, including Part
value (RVV), reported in statute miles (SM), takes precedent 91, is the approved Aircraft Flight Manual (AFM) or Pilots
over prevailing visibility. There is no required timeframe for Operating Handbook (POH) for the make and model of
receiving current weather prior to initiating the approach. aircraft that is being operated. It is required to contain the
manufacturer determined performance capabilities of the
Weather Requirements and Part 121 Operators aircraft at each weight, altitude, and ambient temperature
Like Part 135 operators, flight crews and dispatchers that are within the airplanes listed limitations. Typically, the
operating under Part 121 must ensure that the appropriate AFM for a large turbine powered airplane should contain
weather reports or forecasts, or any combination

4-7
information that allows flight crews to determine that 166 knots.
the airplane will be capable of performing the following Category E: Speed 166 knots or more.
actions, considering the airplanes landing weight and
other pertinent environmental factor:
NOTE: Helicopter pilots may use the Category A line of
Land within the distance required by the regulations. minimums provided the helicopter is operated at Category
Climb from the missed approach point (MAP) and A airspeeds.
maintain a specified climb gradient with one engine
inoperative. An airplane is certified in only one approach category, and
although a faster approach may require higher category
Perform a go-around from the final stage of landing minimums to be used, an airplane cannot be flown to the
and maintain a specified climb gradient with all minimums of a slower approach category. The certified
engines operating and the airplane in the landing approach category is permanent and independent of
configuration. the changing conditions of day-to-day operations. From
a terminal instrument procedures (TERPS) viewpoint,
Many airplanes have more than one allowable flap the importance of a pilot not operating an airplane at
configuration for normal landing. Often, a reduced flap a category line of minimums lower than the airplane is
setting for landing allows the airplane to operate at a higher certified for is primarily the margin of protection provided
landing weight into a field that has restrictive obstacles in for containment of the airplane within the procedure
the missed approach or rejected landing climb path. On design for a slower airplane. This includes height loss at
these occasions, the full-flap landing speed may not allow the decision altitude, missed approach climb surface, and
the airplane enough energy to successfully complete a go- turn containment in the missed approach at the higher
around and avoid any high terrain that might exist on the category speeds.
climb out. Therefore, all- engine and engine-out missed
approaches, as well as rejected landings, must be taken Pilots are responsible for determining if a higher approach
into consideration in compliance with the regulations. category applies. If a faster approach speed is used that
places the aircraft in a higher approach category, the
Aircraft Approach Categories minimums for the appropriate higher category must be
Aircraft approach category means a grouping of aircraft used. Emergency returns at weights in excess of maximum
based on a reference landing speed (VREF), if specified, or certificated landing weight, approaches made with
if VREF is not specified, 1.3 VSO at the maximum certified inoperative flaps, and approaches made in icing conditions
landing weight. VREF, VSO, and the maximum certified for some airplanes are examples of situations that can
landing weight are those values as established for the necessitate the use of higher approach category minima.
aircraft by the certification authority of the country of
registry. A pilot must use the minima corresponding to Circling approaches are one of the most challenging
the category determined during certification or higher. flight maneuvers conducted in the NAS, especially for
Helicopters may use Category A minima. If it is necessary pilots of CAT C and CAT D turbine-powered, transport
to operate at a speed in excess of the upper limit of the category airplanes These maneuvers are conducted at
speed range for an aircrafts category, the minimums low altitude, day and night, and often with precipitation
for the higher category must be used. For example, an present affecting visibility, depth perception, and the ability
airplane that fits into Category B, but is circling to land at to adequately assess the descent profile to the landing
a speed of 145 knots, must use the approach Category D runway. Most often, circling approaches are conducted to
minimums. As an additional example, a Category A airplane runways without the benefit of electronic navigation aids to
(or helicopter) that is operating at 130 knots on a straight-in support the descent from the Circling Minimums Decision
approach must use the approach Category C minimums. Altitude (CMDA) to the runway.
See the following category limits noting that the airspeeds
depicted are indicated airspeeds (IAS): Circling approaches conducted at faster-than-normal,
Category A: Speed less than 91 knots. straight-in approach speeds also require a pilot to
Category B: Speed 91 knots or more but less than 121 consider the larger circling approach area, since published
knots. circling minimums provide obstacle clearance only
within the appropriate area of protection and is based
Category C: Speed 121 knots or more but less than on the approach category speed. [Figure 4-2] The circling
141 knots. approach area is the obstacle clearance area for airplanes
Category D: Speed 141 knots or more but less than maneuvering to land on a runway that does not meet the

4-8
Approach category Radius (miles) The TERPS Change 21 to the circling protected airspace
A 1.3
afforded much greater obstacle protection. However, it
also afforded the pilot the opportunity to use the extra
B 1.5
protected airspace to mitigate the need to conduct a
C 1.7
high descent rate, unstabilized approach that was often
D 2.3
necessary as a result of the previous criteria for the Circling
E 4.5
Approach Radius (CAR). For example, under TERPS Change
RADII (r) defining size of areas, vary 21, a sea level airport with a 1,500 ft HAA will have CAT C
with the approach category
CAR of 2.86 NM, a 1.16 NM (68.5%) increase over pre-TERPS
Change 21 CAR for CAT C. This extra protected airspace
can be used by the pilot to maneuver the airplane instead
r Circling of being forced to use high descent rates which are often
approach area necessary for high HAA circling approaches.
r
r Most commercial operators dictate standard procedures for
conducting instrument approaches in their FAA-approved
r manuals. These standards designate company callouts,
r flight profiles, configurations, and other specific duties
for each flight deck crewmember during the conduct of
an instrument approach.

Instrument Approach Charts


Figure 4-2. Construction of circling approach area.
Beginning in February 2000, the FAA began issuing the
criteria for a straight- in approach. The size of the circling current format for instrument approach plates (IAPs). This
area varies with the approach category of the airplane, as chart was developed by the Department of Transportation
shown in Figure 4-2. (DOT), Volpe National Transportation Systems Center and
is commonly referred to as the Pilot Briefing Information
A minimum of 300 feet of obstacle clearance is provided format. The FAA chart format is presented in a logical order,
in the circling segment. Pilots should remain at or above facilitating pilot briefing of the procedures. [Figure 4-3]
the circling altitude until the airplane is continuously in a
position from which a descent to a landing on the intended Approach Chart Naming Conventions
runway can be made at a normal rate of descent and using Individual FAA charts are identified on both the top and
normal maneuvers. Since an approach category can make bottom of the page by their procedure name (based on the
a difference in the approach and weather minimums and, NAVAIDs required for the final approach), runway served,
in some cases, prohibit flight crews from initiating an and airport location. The identifier for the airport is also
approach, the approach speed should be calculated and listed immediately after the airport name. [Figure 4-4]
the effects on the approach determined and briefed in
the preflight planning phase, as well as reviewed prior to There are several types of approach procedures that may
commencing an approach. cause some confusion for flight crews unfamiliar with the
naming conventions. Although specific information about
Prior to TERPS Change 21, pilots were often faced with each type of approach is covered later in this chapter, listed
the challenge of descending using a stabilized approach below are a few procedure names that can cause confusion.
concept if the CMDA height above airport (HAA) exceeded
1,200 feet. Once the HAA approached 1,200 feet, pilots were Straight-In Procedures
often forced to increase their rates of descent in order to When two or more straight-in approaches with the same
arrive at the appropriate in-slot position. In-slot being type of guidance exist for a runway, a letter suffix is added
defined as at a minimum, a CAT C or CAT D turbine-powered to the title of the approach so that it can be more easily
airplane should be wings level on a 3 degree - 318/NM identified. These approach charts start with the letter Z
descent path not less than 1 NM from the touchdown and continue in reverse alphabetical order. For example,
point (1,000 feet beyond runway threshold). This was due consider the (RNAV) (GPS) Z RWY 13C and RNAV (RNP) Y
to the small size of the circling protected airspace that the RWY 13C approaches at Chicago Midway International
aircrews must remain within to ensure obstacle clearance. Airport. [Figure 4-5] Although these two approaches can

4-9
City and state Issue # (issue authority)
TOP MARGIN IDENTIFICATION
Approach lighting (this is U.S.
configuration sequenced
flashing, see FIH)
PILOT BRIEFING
INFORMATION

N
Missed approach verbiage

IO
AT
2011VIEW
NE-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011

PLAN
NE-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR
VI
NA

Missed approach icons


R
FO

PROFILE VIEW
AIRPORT DIAGRAM

T
NO

MINIMUMS
LANDING

Amendments
Latitude/longitude coordinates Airport identifier

Time and speed table BOTTOM MARGIN IDENTIFICATION

Figure 4-3. Instrument approach chart.

4-10
SC-5, 18 NO
Examples in Figure 4-6 show four procedure titles at the
same airport that have only circling minimums.

As can be seen from the example, the first approach of


N this type created at the airport is labeled with the letter A,

I O and the lettering continues in alphabetical order. Typically,

A T circling only approaches are designed for one of the


following reasons:

I G The final approach course alignment with the

A V
runway centerline exceeds 30.
The descent gradient is greater than 400 feet per
N nautical mile (FPNM) from the FAF to the threshold
R crossing height (TCH). When this maximum gradient

FO
is exceeded, the circling only approach procedure
may be designed to meet the gradient criteria

T limits. This does not preclude a straight-in landing

O if a normal descent and landing can be made in

N 010 to 16 DEC 2010



accordance with the applicable CFRs.
A runway is not clearly defined on the airfield.

Communications
The communication strip provided near the top of FAA
Figure 4-4. Procedure identification. approach charts gives flight crews the frequencies that
they can expect to be assigned during the approach.
be flown with a global positioning system (GPS) to the The frequencies are listed in the logical order of use from
same runway, they are significantly different (e.g., one is arrival to touchdown. Having this information immediately
a Required Navigation Performance (RNP) Authorization available during the approach reduces the chances of a
Required (AR) formally known as SPECIAL AIRCRAFT & loss of contact between ATC and flight crews during this
AIRCREW AUTHORIZATION REQUIRED (SAAAR); one has critical phase of flight.
circling minimums and the other does not; the minimums
are different; and the missed approaches are not the same). It is important for flight crews to understand their
The approach procedure labeled Z has lower landing responsibilities with regard to communications in the
minimums than Y (some older charts may not reflect this). various approach environments. There are numerous
differences in communication responsibilities when
In this example, the LNAV MDA for the RNAV (GPS) Z RWY operating into and out of airports without ATC towers
13C has the lowest minimums of either approach due to as compared to airports with control towers. Todays
the differences in the final approach required obstacle pilots face an increasing range of ATC environments and
clearance (ROC) evaluation. This convention also eliminates conflicting traffic dangers, making approach briefing and
any confusion with approach procedures labeled A and preplanning more critical. Individual company operating
B, where only circling minimums are published. The manuals and SOPs dictate the duties for each crewmember.
designation of two area navigation (RNAV) procedures
to the same runway can occur when it is desirable to Advisory Circular (AC) 120-71, Standard Operating
accommodate panel mounted GPS receivers and flight Procedures for Flight Deck Crewmembers, contains the
management systems (FMSs), both with and without following concerning ATC communications: SOPs should
vertical navigation (VNAV). It is also important to note that state who (Pilot Flying (PF), Pilot Monitoring (PM), Flight
only one of each type of approach for a runway, including Engineer (FE/SO)) handles the radios for each phase of
ILS, VHF omnidirectional range (VOR), and non-directional flight, as follows:
beacon (NDB) can be coded into a database.
PF makes input to aircraft/autopilot and/or verbally
Circling-Only Procedures states clearances while PM confirms input is what he
Approaches that do not have straight-in landing minimums or she read back to ATC.
are identified by the type of approach followed by a letter. Any confusion in the flight deck is immediately

4-11
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

N
IO
AT
G
VI
NA
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


R
FO
T
NO

EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

Figure 4-5. Multiple approaches.

4-12
is exercised primarily through direct pilot and controller

N communication and airport surveillance radar (ASR). Prior

TIO
to arriving at the initial approach fix (IAF), instructions will

A be received from the air route traffic control center (ARTCC)

VIG
to contact approach control on a specified frequency.
Where radar is approved for approach control service, it is
N A used not only for radar approaches, but also for vectors in

O R conjunction with published non-radar approaches using

T F conventional NAVAIDs or RNAV/GPS.


NW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16

NO

OV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


When radar handoffs are initiated between the ARTCC
and approach control, or between two approach control
NW-1, 1

C 2010
facilities, aircraft are cleared (with vertical separation) to
Figure 4-6. Procedures with circling landing minima.
an outer fix most appropriate to the route being flown
cleared up by requesting ATC confirmation. and, if required, given holding instructions. Or, aircraft
are cleared to the airport or to a fix so located that the
If any crewmember is off the flight deck, all ATC handoff is completed prior to the time the aircraft reaches
instructions are briefed upon his or her return. Or, the fix. When radar handoffs are used, successive arriving
if any crewmember is off the flight deck, all ATC flights may be handed off to approach control with radar
instructions are written down until his or her return separation in lieu of vertical separation.
and then passed to that crewmember upon return.
Similarly, if a crewmember is off ATC frequency when After release to approach control, aircraft are vectored
making a precision approach (PA) announcement to the final approach course. ATC occasionally vectors
or when talking on company frequency, all ATC the aircraft across the final approach course for spacing
instructions are briefed upon his or her return. requirements. The pilot is not expected to turn inbound
Company policy should address use of speakers, on the final approach course unless an approach clearance
headsets, boom microphone, and/or hand-held has been issued. This clearance is normally issued with the
microphone. final vector for interception of the final approach course,
SOPs should state the altitude awareness company and the vector enables the pilot to establish the aircraft on
policy on confirming assigned altitude. the final approach course prior to reaching the FAF.

Example: The PM acknowledges ATC altitude clearance. If Air Route Traffic Control Center (ARTCC)
the aircraft is on the autopilot, then the PF makes input into ARTCCs are approved for and may provide approach
the autopilot/altitude alerter. PF points to the input while control services to specific airports. The radar systems used
stating the assigned altitude as he or she understands it. by these centers do not provide the same precision as an
The PM then points to the input stating aloud what he or ASR or precision approach radar (PAR) used by approach
she understands the ATC clearance to be confirming that control facilities and control towers, and the update rate
the input and clearance match. If the aircraft is being hand- is not as fast. Therefore, pilots may be requested to report
flown, then the PM makes the input into the altitude alerter/ established on the final approach course. Whether aircraft
autopilot, then points to the input and states clearance. are vectored to the appropriate final approach course or
PF then points to the alerter stating aloud what he or she provide their own navigation on published routes to it,
understands the ATC clearance to be confirming that the radar service is automatically terminated when the landing
alerter and clearance match. is completed; or when instructed to change to advisory
frequency at airports without an operating ATC tower,
Example: If there is no altitude alerter in the aircraft, then whichever occurs first. When arriving on an IFR flight plan
both pilots write down the clearance, confirm that they at an airport with an operating control tower, the flight
have the same altitude, and then cross off the previously plan is closed automatically upon landing.
assigned altitude.
The extent of services provided by approach control varies
Approach Control greatly from location to location. The majority of Part 121
Approach control is responsible for controlling all operations in the NAS use airports that have radar service
instrument flights operating within its area of responsibility. and approach control facilities to assist in the safe arrival
Approach control may serve one or more airports. Control and departure of large numbers of aircraft. Many airports

4-13
SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

Figure 4-7. Durango approach and low altitude en route excerpt.

do not have approach control facilities. It is important for altitudes. There are many airports that are below the
pilots to understand the differences between approaches coverage area of Center radar, and, therefore, off-route
with and without an approach control facility. For example, transitions into the approach environment may require
consider the Durango, Colorado, ILS DME RWY 2 and low that the aircraft be flown at a higher altitude than would be
altitude en route chart excerpt shown in Figure 4-7. required for an on-route transition. In the Durango example,
an airplane approaching from the northeast on a direct
High or Lack of Minimum Vectoring Altitudes route to the Durango VOR may be restricted to a minimum
(MVAs) IFR altitude (MIA) of 17,000 feet mean sea level (MSL) due to
Considering the fact that most modern commercial and unavailability of Center radar coverage in that area at lower
corporate aircraft are capable of direct, point-to-point flight, altitudes. An arrival on V95 from the northeast would be
it is increasingly important for pilots to understand the able to descend to a minimum en route altitude (MEA) of
limitations of ARTCC capabilities with regard to minimum 12,000 feet, allowing a shallower transition to the approach
4-14
environment. An off-route arrival may necessitate a descent warning of terrain hazards, but the warning system
into holding in order to avoid an unstable approach to is configured to protect IFR flights and is normally
Durango. suppressed for VFR aircraft. Controllers can activate
the warning system for VFR flights upon pilot request,
Lack of Approach Control Terrain Advisories but it may produce numerous false alarms for aircraft
Flight crews must understand that terrain clearance cannot operating below the MIA, especially in en route center
be assured by ATC when aircraft are operating at altitudes airspace.
that are not served by Center or approach radar. Recent If you fly at night, especially in remote or unlit areas,
National Transportation Safety Board (NTSB) investigations consider whether a GPS-based terrain awareness unit
have identified several accidents that involved controlled would improve your safety of flight.
flight into terrain (CFIT) by IFR rated and VFR pilots
Lack of approach control traffic advisoriesif radar
operating under visual flight conditions at night in remote
service is not available for the approach, the ability
areas. In many of these cases, the pilots were in contact with
of ATC to give flight crews accurate traffic advisories
ATC at the time of the accident and receiving radar service.
is greatly diminished. In some cases, the common
The pilots and controllers involved all appear to have been
traffic advisory frequency (CTAF) may be the only tool
unaware that the aircraft were in danger. Increased altitude
available to enhance an IFR flights awareness of traffic
awareness and better preflight planning would likely have
at the destination airport. Additionally, ATC will not
prevented all of these accidents. How can pilots avoid
clear an IFR flight for an approach until the preceding
becoming involved in a CFIT accident?
aircraft on the approach has cancelled IFR, either on
the ground, or airborne once in visual meteorological
CFIT accidents are best avoided through proper preflight
conditions (VMC).
planning.
Terrain familiarization is critical to safe visual Airports With an ATC Tower
operations at night. Use sectional charts or other Control towers are responsible for the safe, orderly, and
topographic references to ensure that your altitude expeditious flow of all traffic that is landing, taking off,
safely clears terrain and obstructions all along your operating on and in the vicinity of an airport and, when
route. the responsibility has been delegated, towers also provide
In remote areas, especially in overcast or moonless for the separation of IFR aircraft in terminal areas. Aircraft
conditions, be aware that darkness may render visual that are departing IFR are integrated into the departure
avoidance of high terrain nearly impossible and that sequence by the tower. Prior to takeoff, the tower controller
the absence of ground lights may result in loss of coordinates with departure control to assure adequate
horizon reference. aircraft spacing.
When planning a nighttime VFR flight, follow IFR
Airports Without A Control Tower
practices, such as climbing on a known safe course,
From a communications standpoint, executing an
until well above surrounding terrain. Choose a
instrument approach to an airport that is not served by an
cruising altitude that provides terrain separation
ATC tower requires more attention and care than making
similar to IFR flights (2,000 feet AGL in mountainous
a visual approach to that airport. Pilots are expected to
areas and 1,000 feet above the ground in other areas.)
self-announce their arrival into the vicinity of the airport
When receiving radar services, do not depend on ATC no later than 10 NM from the field. Depending on the
to warn you of terrain hazards. Although controllers weather, as well as the amount and type of conflicting
try to warn pilots if they notice a hazardous situation, traffic that exists in the area, an approach to an airport
they may not always be able to recognize that a without an operating ATC tower increases the difficulty of
particular VFR aircraft is dangerously close to terrain. the transition to visual flight.
When issued a heading along with an instruction to
maintain VFR, be aware that the heading may not In many cases, a flight arriving via an instrument approach
provide adequate terrain clearance. If you have any needs to mix in with VFR traffic operating in the vicinity
doubt about your ability to visually avoid terrain and of the field. For this reason, many companies require that
obstacles, advise ATC immediately and take action to flight crews make contact with the arrival airport CTAF or
reach a safe altitude if necessary. company operations personnel via a secondary radio over
25 NM from the field in order to receive traffic advisories.
ATC radar software can provide limited prediction and

4-15
In addition, pilots should attempt to listen to the CTAF Initial call within 4-10 minutes of the aircrafts arrival
well in advance of their arrival in order to determine the at the IAF. This call should give the aircrafts location
VFR traffic situation. as well as the crews approach intentions.
Departing the IAF, stating the approach that is being
Since separation cannot be provided by ATC between initiated.
IFR and VFR traffic when operating in areas where there
is no radar coverage, pilots are expected to make radio Procedure turn (or equivalent) inbound.
announcements on the CTAF. These announcements FAF inbound, stating intended landing runway and
allow other aircraft operating in the vicinity to plan their maneuvering direction if circling.
departures and arrivals with a minimum of conflicts.
Short final, giving traffic on the surface notification
In addition, it is very important for crews to maintain a
of imminent landing.
listening watch on the CTAF to increase their awareness
of the current traffic situation. Flights inbound on an
When operating on an IFR flight plan at an airport without
instrument approach to a field without a control tower
a functioning control tower, pilots must initiate cancellation
should make several self-announced radio calls during
of the IFR flight plan with ATC or an AFSS. Remote
the approach:

N
I O
A T
I G
A V
N
R
O
NW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

NW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

F
T
O
N

Figure 4-8. Cheyenne Regional (KCYS), Cheyenne, Wyoming, ILS or LOC RWY 27.

4-16
communications outlets (RCOs) or ground communications guidance and a letter (for example, VOR A). More than one
outlets (GCOs), if available, can be used to contact an ARTCC navigation system separated by a slant indicates that more
or an AFSS after landing. If a frequency is not available on than one type of equipment must be used to execute the
the ground, the pilot has the option to cancel IFR while final approach (for example, VOR/DME RWY 31). More than
in flight if VFR conditions can be maintained while in one navigation system separated by the word or indicates
contact with ARTCC, as long as those conditions can be either type of equipment can be used to execute the final
maintained until landing. Additionally, pilots can relay a approach (for example, VOR or GPS RWY 15).
message through another aircraft or contact flight service
via telephone. In some cases, other types of navigation systems,
including radar, are required to execute other portions of
Primary NAVAID the approach or to navigate to the IAF (for example, an
Most conventional approach procedures are built around NDB procedure turn to an ILS, or an NDB in the missed
a primary final approach NAVAID; others, such as RNAV approach, or radar required to join the procedure or identify
(GPS) approaches, are not. If a primary NAVAID exists for a fix). When ATC radar or other equipment is required for
an approach, it should be included in the IAP briefing, set procedure entry from the en route environment, a note is
into the appropriate backup or active navigation radio, and charted in the plan view of the approach procedure chart
positively identified at some point prior to being used for (for example, RADAR REQUIRED or AUTOMATIC DIRECTION
course guidance. Adequate thought should be given to the FINDER (ADF) REQUIRED). When radar or other equipment
appropriate transition point for changing from FMS or other is required on portions of the procedure outside the final
en route navigation over to the conventional navigation to approach segment, including the missed approach, a note
be used on the approach. Specific company standards and is charted in the notes box of the pilot briefing portion
procedures normally dictate when this changeover occurs; of the approach chart (for example, RADAR REQUIRED or
some carriers are authorized to use FMS course guidance DISTANCE MEASURING EQUIPMENT (DME) REQUIRED).
throughout the approach, provided that an indication Notes are not charted when VOR is required outside the
of the conventional navigation guidance is available final approach segment. Pilots should ensure that the
and displayed. Many carriers, or specific carrier fleets, aircraft is equipped with the required NAVAIDs to execute
are required to change over from RNAV to conventional the approach, including the missed approach. Refer to the
navigation prior to the FAF of an instrument approach. AIM paragraph 5-4-5 for additional options with regards to
equipment requirements for IAPs.
Depending on the complexity of the approach procedure,
pilots may have to brief the transition from an initial NAVAID RNAV systems may be used as a Substitute Means of
to the primary and missed approach NAVAIDs. Figure 4-8 Navigation when a very high frequency (VHF) Omni-
shows the Cheyenne, Wyoming, ILS Runway 27 approach directional Range (VOR), Distance Measuring Equipment
procedure, which requires additional consideration during (DME), Tactical Air Navigation (TACAN), VOR/TACAN
an IAP briefing. (VORTAC), VOR/DME, non-directional radio beacon (NDB),
or compass locator facility including locator outer
If the 15 DME arc of the CYS VOR is to be used as the
transition to this ILS approach procedure, caution must marker and locator middle marker is out-of-service, i.e., the
be paid to the transition from en route navigation to the Navigation Aid (NAVAID) information is not available; an
initial NAVAID and then to the primary NAVAID for the ILS aircraft is not equipped with an automatic direction finder
approach. Planning when the transition to each of these (ADF) or DME; or the installed ADF or DME on an aircraft is
NAVAIDs occurs may prevent the use of the incorrect not operational. For example, if equipped with a suitable
NAVAID for course guidance during approaches where RNAV system, a pilot may hold over an out-of-service NDB.
high pilot workloads already exist. Refer to Advisory Circular 90-108, Use of Suitable RNAV
System on Conventional Routes and Procedures, dated
Equipment Requirements March 3, 2011 for additional guidance on the proper times
and procedures for substituting a RNAV system for means
The navigation equipment that is required to join and fly an
of navigation.
IAP is indicated by the title of the procedure and notes on
the chart. Straight-in IAPs are identified by the navigation
Courses
system by providing the final approach guidance and the
runway with which the approach is aligned (for example, Traditional Courses
VOR RWY 13). Circling-only approaches are identified An aircraft that has been cleared to a holding fix and
by the navigation system by providing final approach subsequently clearedapproach, normally does not

4-17
receive new routing. Even though clearance for the that the pilot can interpret without question. When a
approach may have been issued prior to the aircraft pilot is uncertain of the clearance, ATC should be queried
reaching the holding fix, ATC would expect the pilot to immediately as to what route of flight is preferred.
proceed via the holding fix that was the last assigned route,
and the feeder route associated with that fix, if a feeder The name of an instrument approach, as published, is
route is published on the approach chart, to the IAF to used to identify the approach, even if a component of the
commence the approach. When cleared for the approach, approach aid is inoperative or unreliable. The controller
the published off-airway (feeder) routes that lead from will use the name of the approach as published, but must
the en route structure to the IAF are part of the approach advise the aircraft at the time an approach clearance is
clearance. issued that the inoperative or unreliable approach aid
component is unusable. (Example: Cleared ILS RWY 4,
If a feeder route to an IAF begins at a fix located along glideslope unusable.)
the route of flight prior to reaching the holding fix,
and clearance for an approach is issued, a pilot should Area Navigation Courses
commence the approach via the published feeder route. RNAV (GPS) approach procedures introduce their own
For example, the aircraft would not be expected to overfly tracking issues because they are flown using an onboard
the feeder route and return to it. The pilot is expected to navigation database. They may be flown as coupled
commence the approach in a similar manner at the IAF, approaches or flown manually. In either case, navigation
if the IAF for the procedure is located along the route of system coding is based on procedure design, including
flight to the holding fix. waypoint (WP) sequencing for an approach and missed
approach. The procedure design indicates whether the WP
If a route of flight directly to the IAF is desired, it should is a fly-over (FO) or fly-by (FB), and provides appropriate
be so stated by the controller with phraseology to include guidance for each. A FB WP requires the use of turn
the words direct, proceed direct, or a similar phrase anticipation to avoid overshooting the next flight segment.

SW-4, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
SW-4, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

Figure 4-9. Fly-by and fly-over waypoints.

4-18
A FO WP precludes any turn until the WP is over flown and Minimum Safe Altitude
is followed by either an intercept maneuver of the next Minimum safe altitudes (MSAs) are published for emergency
flight segment or direct flight to the next WP. use on IAP charts. For conventional navigation systems, the
MSA is normally based on the primary omnidirectional
Approach waypoints, except for the missed approach facility on which the IAP is predicated. The MSA depiction
waypoint (MAWP) and the missed approach holding on the approach chart contains the facility identifier of the
waypoint (MAHWP), are normally FB WPs. Notice that in the NAVAID used to determine the MSA. For RNAV approaches,
plan view in Figure 4-9, there are four FB WPs, but only the the MSA is based on either the runway waypoint (RWY
circled WP symbol at PRINO is a FO WP. If flying manually to WP), the MAWP for straight-in approaches, or the airport
a selected RNAV WP, pilots should anticipate the turn at a FB waypoint (APT WP) for circling only approaches. For RNAV
WP to ensure a smooth transition and avoid overshooting (GPS) approaches with a terminal arrival area (TAA), the
the next flight segment. Alternatively, for a FO WP, no turn MSA is based on the IAF WP.
is accomplished until the aircraft passes the WP.
MSAs are expressed in feet above MSL and normally
There are circumstances when a WP may be coded into the have a 25 NM radius. This radius may be expanded to
database as both a FB WP and a FO WP, depending on how 30 NM if necessary to encompass the airport landing
the WPs are sequenced during the approach procedure. For surfaces. Ideally, a single sector altitude is established
example, a WP that serves as an IAF may be coded as a FB and depicted on the plan view of approach charts. When
WP for the approach and as a FO WP when it also serves necessary to maintain clearance from obstructions, the
as the MAWP for the missed approach procedure (MAP). area may be further sectored and as many as four MSAs
This is just one reason why instrument approaches should established. When established, sectors may be no less
be loaded in their entirety from the FMS and not manually than 90 in spread. MSAs provide 1,000 feet clearance over
built or modified. all obstructions but do not necessarily assure acceptable
navigation signal coverage.
Altitudes
Prescribed altitudes may be depicted in four different Final Approach Fix Altitude
configurations: minimum, maximum, recommended, and Another important altitude that should be briefed during
mandatory. The U.S. Government distributes approach an IAP briefing is the FAF altitude, designated by the
charts produced by the FAA. Altitudes are depicted on cross on a non-precision approach, and the lightning bolt
these charts in the profile view with an underscore or symbol designating the glideslope intercept altitude on
overscore, or both to identify them as minimum, maximum, a precision approach. Adherence and cross-check of this
or mandatory, respectively. altitude can have a direct effect on the success and safety
of an approach.
Minimum altitudes are depicted with the altitude value
underscored. Aircraft are required to maintain altitude
Proper airspeed, altitude, and configuration, when crossing
at or above the depicted value (e.g., 3000).
the FAF of a non-precision approach, are extremely
Maximum altitudes are depicted with the altitude value important no matter what type of aircraft is being flown.
overscored. Aircraft are required to maintain altitude The stabilized approach concept, implemented by the
at or below the depicted value (e.g., 4800). FAA within the SOPs of each air carrier, suggests that
Mandatory altitudes are depicted with the altitude value crossing the FAF at the published altitude is often a critical
both underscored and overscored. Aircraft are required component of a successful non-precision approach,
to maintain altitude at the depicted value (e.g., 5500). especially in a large turbojet aircraft.
Recommended altitudes are depicted without an
The glideslope intercept altitude of a precision approach
underscore or overscore.
should also be included in the IAP briefing. Awareness of
this altitude when intercepting the glideslope can ensure
NOTE: Pilots are cautioned to adhere to altitudes as
the flight crew that a false glideslope or other erroneous
prescribed because, in certain instances, they may be used
indication is not inadvertently followed. Many air carriers
as the basis for vertical separation of aircraft by ATC. If a
include a standard callout when the aircraft passes over the
depicted altitude is specified in the ATC clearance, that
FAF of the non-precision approach underlying the ILS. The
altitude becomes mandatory as defined above.
PM states the name of the fix and the charted glideslope
altitude, thus allowing both pilots to cross-check their
respective altimeters and verify the correct indications.

4-19
Minimum Descent Altitude (MDA), Decision
Altitude (DA), And Decision Height (DH)
MDAthe lowest altitude, expressed in feet MSL, to which
descent is authorized on final approach or during circle-to-
land maneuvering in execution of a standard instrument
approach procedure (SIAP) where no electronic glideslope
is provided.
Pilots view without EVS-4000 Pilots view with EVS-4000
DAa specified altitude in the precision approach at
which a missed approach must be initiated if the required Figure 4-10. Enhanced flight vision system.
visual reference to continue the approach has not been
established. factor for the MDA, DA, or DH for an instrument approach.
There are many CAT II and III approach procedures
DHwith respect to the operation of aircraft, means the authorized at airports throughout the United States, but
height at which a decision must be made during an ILS, MLS, RNP AR restricts their use to pilots who have received
or PAR IAP to either continue the approach or to execute a specific training, and aircraft that are equipped and
missed approach. authorized to conduct those approaches. Other rules
pertaining to flight crew qualifications can also determine
CAT II and III approach DHs are referenced to AGL and the lowest usable MDA, DA, or DH for a specific approach.
measured with a radio altimeter. 14 CFR Part 121, section 121.652, 14 CFR Part 125, section
125.379, and 14 CFR Part 135, section 135.225 require
The height above touchdown (HAT) for a CAT I precision that some PICs, with limited experience in the aircraft
approach is normally 200 feet above touchdown zone they are operating, increase the approach minimums and
elevation (TDZE). When a HAT of 250 feet or higher is visibility by 100 feet and one- half mile respectively. Rules
published, it may be the result of the signal-in-space for these high-minimums pilots are usually derived from
coverage, or there may be penetrations of either the final a combination of federal regulations and the companys
or missed approach obstacle clearance surfaces (OCSs). OpSpecs. There are many factors that can determine the
If there are OCS penetrations, the pilot has no indication actual minimums that can be used for a specific approach.
on the approach chart where the obstacles are located. It All of them must be considered by pilots during the
is important for pilots to brief the MDA, DA, or DH so that preflight and approach planning phases, discussed, and
there is no ambiguity as to what minimums are being used. briefed appropriately.
These altitudes can be restricted by many factors. Approach
category, inoperative equipment in the aircraft or on the Pilots are cautioned to fully understand and abide by
ground, crew qualifications, and company authorizations the guidelines set forth in 91.175(c) regarding proper
are all examples of issues that may limit or change the identification of the runway and runway environment when
height of a published MDA, DA, or DH. electing to continue any approach beyond the published
DA/DH or MDA.
For many air carriers, OpSpecs may be the limiting factor
for some types of approaches. NDB and circling approaches It is imperative to recognize that any delay in making a
are two common examples where the OpSpecs minimum decision to execute the Missed Approach Procedure at
listed altitudes may be more restrictive than the published the DA/DH or MDA/Missed Approach Point will put the
minimums. Many Part 121 and 135 operators are restricted aircrew at risk of impacting any obstructions that may be
from conducting circling approaches below 1,000 feet penetrating the visual obstacle clearance surface
MDA and 3 SM visibility by Part C of their OpSpecs,
and many have specific visibility criteria listed for NDB The visual segment of an IAP begins at DA or MDA and
approaches that exceed visibilities published for the continues to the runway. There are two means of operating
approach (commonly 2 SM). In these cases, flight crews in the visual segment, one is by using natural vision under
must determine which is the more restrictive of the two 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175 (c) and the other is by using
and comply with those minimums. an Enhanced Flight Vision System under 14 CFR Part 91,
section 91.175 (l).
In some cases, flight crew qualifications can be the limiting

4-20
Enhanced Flight Vision Systems (EFVS) and circle-to-land maneuver or circle-to-land minimums does
Instrument Approaches not meet criteria for straight-in landing minimums. While
the regulations do not prohibit EFVS from being used
An Enhanced Flight Vision System (EFVS) is an installed
during any phase of flight, they do prohibit it from being
airborne system that uses an electronic means to provide
used for operational credit on anything but a straight-in
a display of the forward external scene topography (the
IAP with straight-in landing minima. EFVS may only be
applicable natural or manmade features of a place or
used during a circle-to-land maneuver provided the visual
region especially in a way to show their relative positions
references required throughout the circling maneuver are
and elevation) through the use of imaging sensors, such
distinctly visible using natural vision. An EFVS cannot be
as forward looking infrared, millimeter wave radiometry,
used to satisfy the requirement that an identifiable part of
millimeter wave radar, and/or low light level image
the airport be distinctly visible to the pilot during a circling
intensifying. The EFVS imagery is displayed along with the
maneuver at or above MDA or while descending below
additional flight information and aircraft flight symbology
MDA from a circling maneuver.
required by 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175(m) on a head-
up display (HUD), or an equivalent display, in the same
The EFVS visual reference requirements of 14 CFR Part 91,
scale and alignment as the external view and includes the
section 91.175 (l)(3) comprise a more stringent standard than
display element, sensors, computers and power supplies,
the visual reference requirements prescribed under 14 CFR
indications, and controls. [Figure 4-10]
Part 91, section 91.175 (c)(3) when using natural vision. The
more stringent standard is needed because an EFVS might
When the runway environment cannot be visually acquired
not display the color of the lights used to identify specific
at the DA or MDA using natural vision, a pilot may use an
portions of the runway or might not be able to consistently
EFVS to descend below DA or MDA down to 100 feet above
display the runway markings. The main differences for EFVS
the TDZE, provided the pilot determines that the enhanced
operations are that the visual glideslope indicator (VGSI)
flight visibility (EFV) observed by using the EFVS is not less
lights cannot be used as a visual reference, and specific
than the minimum visibility prescribed in the IAP being
visual references from both the threshold and TDZ must
flown, the pilot acquires the required visual references
be distinctly visible and identifiable. However, when using
prescribed in 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175 (l)(3), and all
natural vision, only one of the specified visual references
of the other requirements of 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175
must be visible and identifiable.
(l) and (m) are met. The primary reference for maneuvering
the aircraft is based on what the pilot sees through the
Pilots must be especially knowledgeable of the approach
EFVS. At 100 feet above the TDZE, a pilot can continue to
conditions and approach course alignment when considering
descend only when the visual reference requirements for
whether to rely on EFVS during a non-precision approach
descent below 100 feet can be seen using natural vision
with an offset final approach course. Depending upon
(without the aid of the EFVS). In other words, a pilot may
the combination of crosswind correction and the lateral
not continue to rely on the EFVS sensor image to identify
field of view provided by a particular EFVS, the required
the required visual references below 100 feet above the
visual references may or may not be within the pilots view
TDZE. Supporting information is provided by the flight
looking through the EFVS display. Pilots conducting any
path vector (FPV) cue, flight path angle (FPA) reference
non-precision approach must verify lateral alignment with
cue, onboard navigation system, and other imagery and
the runway centerline when determining when to descend
flight symbology displayed on the HUD. The FPV and FPA
from the MDA.
reference cues, along with the EFVS imagery of the TDZ,
provide the primary vertical path reference for the pilot
Any pilot operating an aircraft with an EFVS installed should
when vertical guidance from a precision approach or
be aware that the requirements of 14 CFR Part 91, section
approach with vertical guidance is not available.
91.175 (c) for using natural vision, and the requirements of 14
CFR Part 91, section 91.175 (l) for using EFVS are different.
An EFVS may be used to descend below DA or MDA from
A pilot would, therefore, first have to determine whether
any straight-in IAP, other than Category II or Category III
an approach is commenced using natural vision or using
approaches, provided all of the requirements of 14 CFR
EFVS. While these two sets of requirements provide a
Part 91, section 91.175 (l) are met. This includes straight-in
parallel decision making process, the requirements for
precision approaches, approaches with vertical guidance
when a missed approach must be executed differ. Using
(localizer performance with vertical guidance (LPV) or
EFVS, a missed approach must be initiated at or below DA
lateral navigation (LNAV)/vertical navigation (VNAV)),
or MDA down to 100 feet above TDZE whenever the pilot
and non-precision approaches (VOR, NDB, localizer (LOC),
determines that:
RNAV, GPS, localizer type directional aid (LDA), simplified
directional facility (SDF)). An instrument approach with a
4-21
1. The enhanced flight visibility is less than the visibility
minima prescribed for the IAP being used; At and below 100 feet above the TDZE, the regulations
do not require the EFVS to be turned off or the display
2. The required visual references for the runway of
to be stowed in order to continue to a landing. A pilot
intended landing are no longer distinctly visible and
may continue the approach below this altitude using an
identifiable to the pilot using the EFVS imagery;
EFVS as long as the required visual references can be seen
3. The aircraft is not continuously in a position from through the display using natural vision. An operator may
which a descent to a landing can be made on the not continue to descend beyond this point by relying
intended runway, at a normal rate of descent, using solely on the sensor image displayed on the EFVS. In order
normal maneuvers; or to descend below 100 feet above the TDZE, the flight
4. For operations under 14 CFR Part 121 and 135, visibility assessed using natural vision must be sufficient
the descent rate of the aircraft would not allow for the following visual references to be distinctly visible
touchdown to occur within the TDZ of the runway and identifiable to the pilot without reliance on the EFVS
of intended landing. to continue to a landing:
1. The lights or markings of the threshold, or
It should be noted that a missed approach after passing 2. The lights or markings of the TDZ.
the DA, or beyond the MAP, involves additional risk until
established on the published missed approach segment. It is important to note that from 100 feet above the TDZE
Initiating a go-around after passing the published MAP may and below, the flight visibility does not have to be equal
result in loss of obstacle clearance. As with any approach, to or greater than the visibility prescribed for the IAP in
pilot planning should include contingencies between the order to continue descending. It only has to be sufficient
published MAP and touchdown with reference to obstacle for the visual references required by 14 CFR Part 91, section
clearance, aircraft performance, and alternate escape plans. 91.175 (l)(4) to be distinctly visible and identifiable to the
o 16 DEC 2010

EC-2, 18 NOV 20
O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
T F
N O
Figure 4-11. VNAV information.

4-22
pilot without reliance on the EFVS. may provide a visual descent point (VDP). [Figure 4-11] The
published VDA is for information only, advisory in nature,
A missed approach must be initiated when the pilot and provides no additional obstacle protection below the
determines that: MDA. Operators can be approved to add a height loss value
1. The flight visibility is no longer sufficient to distinctly to the MDA, and use this derived decision altitude (DDA)
see and identify the required visual references listed to ensure staying above the MDA. Operators authorized to
in 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175 (l)(4) using natural use a VNAV DA in lieu of the MDA must commence a missed
vision; approach immediately upon reaching the VNAV DA if the
required visual references to continue the approach have
2. The aircraft is not continuously in a position from not been established.
which a descent to a landing can be made on the
intended runway, at a normal rate of descent, using A constant-rate descent has many safety advantages over
normal maneuvers; or non-precision approaches that require multiple level-offs at
3. For operations under 14 CFR Part 121 and 135, stepdown fixes or manually calculating rates of descent. A
the descent rate of the aircraft would not allow stabilized approach can be maintained from the FAF to the
touchdown to occur within the TDZ of the runway landing when a constant-rate descent is used. Additionally,
of intended landing. the use of an electronic vertical path produced by onboard
avionics can serve to reduce CFIT, and minimize the
While touchdown within the TDZ is not specifically effects of visual illusions on approach and landing. Some
addressed in the regulations for operators other than countries even mandate the use of continuous descent
Part 121 and 135 operators, continued operations below final approaches (CDFAs) on non-precision approaches.
DA or MDA where touchdown in the TDZ is not assured,
where a high sink rate occurs, or where the decision to Wide Area Augmentation System
conduct a MAP is not executed in a timely manner, all The Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS) offers
create a significant risk to the operation. A missed approach an opportunity for airports to gain ILS like approach
initiated after the DA or MAP involves additional risk. At capability without the purchase or installation of any
100 feet or less above the runway, it is likely that an aircraft ground-based navigation equipment at the airport.
is significantly below the TERPS missed approach obstacle Today, WAAS is already being used at more than 900
runways across the United States to achieve minimums
clearance surface. Prior planning is recommended and
as low as 200 feet height above HAT/one-half mile
should include contingencies between the published
visibility.
MAP and touchdown with reference to obstacle clearance,
aircraft performance, and alternate escape plans.
Benefits Of WAAS In The Airport Environment
Vertical Navigation WAAS is a navigation service using a combination of GPS
satellites and the WAAS geostationary satellites to improve
One of the advantages of some GPS and multi-sensor FMS the navigational service provided by GPS. WAAS achieved
RNAV avionics is the advisory VNAV capability. Traditionally, initial operating capability (IOC) in 2003. The system is
the only way to get vertical path information during an owned and operated by the FAA and provided free of direct
approach was to use a ground-based precision NAVAID. user charges to users across the United States and most of
Modern RNAV avionics can display an electronic vertical Canada and Mexico.
path that provides a constant-rate descent to minimums.
WAAS improves the navigational system accuracy for
Since these systems are advisory and not primary guidance, en route, terminal, and approach operations over all the
the pilot must continuously ensure the aircraft remains at continental United States and significant portions of Alaska,
or above any published altitude constraint, including step- Canada, and Mexico. This new navigational technology
down fix altitudes, using the primary barometric altimeter. supports vertically-guided instrument approaches to all
The pilots, airplane, and operator must be approved to use qualifying runways in the United States. Vertically-guided
advisory VNAV inside the FAF on an instrument approach. approaches reduce pilot workload and provide safety
benefits compared to non-precision approaches. The WAAS
VNAV information appears on selected conventional enabled vertically guided approach procedures are called
nonprecision, GPS, and RNAV approaches (see Types of LPV, which stands for localizer performance with vertical
Approaches later in this chapter). It normally consists of guidance, and provide ILS equivalent approach minimums
two fixes (the FAF and the landing runway threshold), a as low as 200 feet at qualifying airports. Actual minimums
FAF crossing altitude, a vertical descent angle (VDA), and are based on an airports current infrastructure, as well as

4-23
4-24
SC-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011

NO
T

Figure 4-12. RNAV GPS approach minima.


FO
R
NA
VI
G
AT
IO
SC-1, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011
N
an evaluation of any existing obstructions. The FAA plans to be presented on an approach chart, with the exception of
publish 300 WAAS approach procedures per year to provide Global Navigation Satellite System Landing System (GLS).
service to all qualifying instrument runways within the NAS. This enables as many GPS equipped aircraft to use the
procedure as possible and provides operational flexibility
Advantages Of WAAS Enabled LPV Approaches if WAAS becomes unavailable. Some aircraft may only be
The advantages of WAAS enabled LPV approaches include: equipped with GPS receivers so they can fly to the LNAV
MDA. Some aircraft equipped with GPS and FMS (with
LPV procedures have no requirement for ground-
approach-certified barometric vertical navigation, or Baro-
based transmitters at the airport.
VNAV) can fly to the LNAV/VNAV MDA. Flying a WAAS LPV
No consideration needs to be given to the placement approach requires an aircraft with WAAS-LPV avionics. If
of navigation facility, maintenance of clear zones for some reason the WAAS service becomes unavailable, all
around the facility, or access to the facility for GPS or WAAS equipped aircraft can revert to the LNAV MDA
maintenance. and land safely using GPS only, which is available nearly 100
LPV approaches eliminate the need for critical area percent of the time.
limitations associated with an ILS.
LPV identifies WAAS approach with vertical guidance (APV)
From a pilots viewpoint, an LPV approach looks approach minimums with electronic lateral and vertical
and flies like an ILS, but the WAAS approach is more guidance capability. LPV is used for approaches constructed
stable than that of an ILS. with WAAS criteria where the value for the vertical alarm
WAAS equipped users can fly RNAV and basic limit is more than 12 meters and less than 50 meters.
required navigation performance (RNP) procedures, WAAS avionics equipment approved for LPV approaches is
as well as LPV procedures, and the avionics costs required for this type of approach. The lateral guidance is
are relatively inexpensive considering the total equivalent to localizer accuracy, and the protected area is
navigation solution provided. considerably smaller than the protected area for the present
LNAV and LNAV/VNAV lateral protection. Aircraft can fly this
RNAV (GPS) approach charts presently can have up to four minima line with a statement in the AFM that the installed
lines of approach minimums: LPV, LNAV/VNAV, LNAV, and equipment supports LPV approaches. In Figure 4-12, notice
Circling. Figure 4-12 shows how these minimums might the WAAS information shown in the top left corner of the

GPS satellites

Ranging sources

Status information

GBAS ground facility

Differential corrections, integrity


data and path definition

Omnidirectional VHF data broadcast (VDB) signal


GBAS reference receivers

Figure 4-13. GBAS architecture.

4-25
pilot briefing information on the chart depicted. Below the less than one meter in both the horizontal and vertical
term WAAS is the WAAS channel number (CH 50102), and axis. [Figure 4-13]
the WAAS approach identifier (W17A), indicating Runway
17R in this case, and then a letter to designate the first in a The GBAS augments the GPS to improve aircraft safety
series of procedures to that runway. during airport approaches and landings. It is expected
that the end state configuration will pinpoint the aircrafts
LNAV/VNAV identifies APV minimums developed to position to within one meter or less with a significant
accommodate an RNAV IAP with vertical guidance, usually improvement in service flexibility and user operating costs.
provided by approach certified Baro-VNAV, but with vertical
and lateral integrity limits larger than a precision approach GBAS is comprised of ground equipment and avionics.
or LPV. Many RNAV systems that have RNP 0.3 or less The ground equipment includes four reference receivers, a
approach capability are specifically approved in the AFM. GBAS ground facility, and a VHF data broadcast transmitter.
Airplanes that are commonly approved in these types of This ground equipment is complemented by GBAS avionics
operations include Boeing 737NG, 767, and 777, as well as installed on the aircraft. Signals from GPS satellites are
the Airbus A300 series. Landing minimums are shown as received by the GBAS GPS reference receivers (four
DAs because the approaches are flown using an electronic receivers for each GBAS) at the GBAS equipped airport.
glide path. Other RNAV systems require special approval. In The reference receivers calculate their position using GPS.
some cases, the visibility minimums for LNAV/VNAV might The GPS reference receivers and GBAS ground facility work
be greater than those for LNAV only. This situation occurs together to measure errors in GPS provided position.
because DA on the LNAV/VNAV vertical descent path is
farther away from the runway threshold than the LNAV The GBAS ground facility produces a GBAS correction
MDA missed approach point. message based on the difference between actual and GPS
calculated position. Included in this message is suitable
Also shown in Figure 4-12, is the LNAV minimums line. This integrity parameters and approach path information.
minimum is for lateral navigation only, and the approach This GBAS correction message is then sent to a VHF data
minimum altitude is published as a MDA. LNAV provides broadcast (VDB) transmitter. The VDB broadcasts the GBAS
the same level of service as the present GPS stand alone signal throughout the GBAS coverage area to avionics in
approaches. LNAV supports the following systems: WAAS, GBAS equipped aircraft. GBAS provides its service to a
when the navigation solution will not support vertical local area (approximately a 2030 mile radius). The signal
navigation; and GPS navigation systems which are coverage is designed support the aircrafts transition from
presently authorized to conduct GPS approaches. en route airspace into and throughout the terminal area
airspace.
Circling minimums that may be used with any type of
approach approved RNAV equipment when publication of The GBAS equipment in the aircraft uses the corrections
straight-in approach minimums is not possible. provided on position, velocity, and time to guide the
aircraft safely to the runway. This signal provides ILS look
Ground-Based Augmentation System (GBAS) alike guidance as low as 200 feet above touchdown.
The United States version of the Ground-Based GBAS will eventually support landings all the way to the
Augmentation System (GBAS) has traditionally been runway surface. Figure 4-14 is an example of a GBAS (LAAS)
referred to as the Local Area Augmentation System (LAAS). approach into Newark, New Jersey.
The worldwide community has adopted GBAS as the official
term for this type of navigation system. To coincide with Required Navigation Performance (RNP)
international terminology, the FAA is also adopting the term The operational advantages of RNP include accuracy
GBAS to be consistent with the international community. and integrity monitoring, which provide more precision
GBAS is a ground-based augmentation to GPS that focuses and lower minimums than conventional RNAV. RNP DAs
its service on the airport area (approximately a 2030 mile can be as low as 250 feet with visibilities as low as three-
radius) for precision approach, DPs, and terminal area fourths SM. Besides lower minimums, the benefits of
operations. It broadcasts its correction message via a very RNP include improved obstacle clearance limits, as well
high frequency (VHF) radio data link from a ground-based as reduced pilot workload. When RNP capable aircraft fly
transmitter. GBAS yields the extremely high accuracy, an accurate, repeatable path, ATC can be confident that
availability, and integrity necessary for Category I, II, and these aircraft are at a specific position, thus maximizing
III precision approachesand provides the ability for flexible, safety and increasing capacity.
curved approach paths. GBAS demonstrated accuracy is

4-26
N
IO
AT
G
NE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

NE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-14. GLS approach at Newark, New Jersey.

4-27
RNP procedures are sequenced in the same Procedure title RNAV includes
manner as RNAV (GPS) procedures. parenthetical (RNP) terminology.

N
RNP-required sensors, FMS capabilities, and relevant
procedure notes are included in the Pilot Briefing

O
Information procedure notes section.
RF legs can be used in any segment of the procedure
(transition, intermediate, final, or missed approach).

I
RF leg turn directions (left or right) are not noted in the

AT
planview because the graphic depiction of the flight
tracks is intuitive. Likewise, the arc centerpoints, arc
radius, and associated RF leg performance limits
such as bank angles and speedsare not depicted

G
because these aircraft performance characteristics
are encoded in the navigation database.
NE-3, 20 SEP 2012 to 18 OCT 2012

VI

NE-3, 20 SEP 2012 to 18 OCT 2012


NA

On this particular procedure, lateral and vertical course guidance


from the Decision Altitude (DA) to the Runway Waypoint (Landing
R

Threshold Point or LTP) is provided by the aircraft's flight


management system and onboard navigation database; however,
any continued flight beyond and below the DA to the landing
FO

threshold is to be conducted under visual meteorological


conditions (VMC).

RNP values for each individual


leg of the procedure, defined by
T

the procedure design criteria for


containment purposes, are
NO

encoded into the aircraft's


navigation database. Applicable
landing minimums are shown in
a normal manner along with the
associated RNP value in the
landing minimums section. When
more than one set of RNP landing
minimums is available and an
aircrew is able to achieve lower
RNP through approved means,
the available (multiple) sets of
RNP minimums are listed with the
lowest set shown first; remaining
sets shown in ascending order,
based on the RNP value.
RNP AR requirements are highlighted in large, bold print.

Figure 4-15. RNAV RNP approach procedure with curved flight tracks.

4-28
N
I O
AT
G
NC-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

NC-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-16. North Platte Regional (KLBF), North Platte, Nebraska, RNAV (GPS) RWY 30.

4-29
To attain the benefits of RNP approach procedures, a key of approach that should be considered and briefed. One
component is curved flight tracks. Constant radius turns is the terminal arrival area (TAA) that is displayed in the
around a fix are called radius-to-fix legs (RF legs). These approach planview. TAAs, discussed later in this chapter,
turns, which are encoded into the navigation database, depict the boundaries of specific arrival areas, and the
allow the aircraft to avoid critical areas of terrain or MIA for those areas. The TAAs should be included in an
conflicting airspace while preserving positional accuracy IAP briefing in the same manner as any other IFR transition
by maintaining precise, positive course guidance along altitude. It is also important to note that the altitudes listed
the curved track. The introduction of RF legs into the in the TAAs should be referenced in place of the MSAs on
design of terminal RNAV procedures results in improved the approach chart for use in emergency situations.
use of airspace and allows procedures to be developed to
and from runways that are otherwise limited to traditional In addition to the obvious differences contained in the
linear flight paths or, in some cases, not served by an IFR planview of Figure 4-16, RNAV (GPS) approach procedure
procedure at all. Navigation systems with RF capability example, pilots should be aware of the issues related to
are a prerequisite to flying a procedure that includes an Baro- VNAV and RNP . The notes section of the procedure
RF leg. Refer to the notes box of the pilot briefing portion in the example contains restrictions relating to these topics.
of the approach chart in Figure 4-15.
RNP values for each individual leg of the procedure,
In the United States, all RNP procedures are in the category defined by the procedure design criteria for containment
of RNP AR. Operators who seek to take advantage of purposes, are encoded into the aircrafts navigation
RNP approach procedures must meet the special RNP database. Applicable landing minimums are shown in
requirements outlined in FAA AC 90-101, Approval a normal manner along with the associated RNP value
Guidance for RNP Procedures with Special Aircraft and in the landing minimums section. When more than one
Aircrew Authorization Required (SAAAR). Currently, most set of RNP landing minimums is available and an aircrew
new transport category airplanes receive an airworthiness is able to achieve lower RNP through approved means,
approval for RNP operations. However, differences can exist the available (multiple) sets of RNP minimums are listed
in the level of precision that each system is qualified to with the lowest set shown first; remaining sets shown in
meet. Each individual operator is responsible for obtaining ascending order, based on the RNP value. On this particular
the necessary approval and authorization to use these procedure, lateral and vertical course guidance from the DA
instrument flight procedures with navigation databases. to the Runway Waypoint [Landing Threshold Point (LTP)]
is provided by the aircrafts FMS and onboard navigation
RNAV Approach Authorization database; however, any continued flight beyond and
Like any other authorization given to air carriers and Part 91 below the DA to the landing threshold is to be conducted
operators, the authorization to use VNAV on a conventional under VMC.
non-precision approach, RNAV approaches, or LNAV/VNAV
approaches is found in that operators OpSpecs, AFM, or RNP required sensors, FMS capabilities, and relevant
other FAA-approved documents. There are many different procedure notes are included in the Pilot Briefing
levels of authorizations when it comes to the use of RNAV Information procedure notes section. [Figure 4-15] RNP
approach systems. The type of equipment installed in the AR requirements are highlighted in large, bold print.
aircraft, the redundancy of that equipment, its operational RNP procedures are sequenced in the same manner as
status, the level of flight crew training, and the level of the RNAV (GPS) procedures. Procedure title RNAV includes
operators FAA authorization are all factors that can affect parenthetical (RNP) terminology. RF legs can be used in
a pilots ability to use VNAV information on an approach. any segment of the procedure (transition, intermediate,
final, or missed approach). RF leg turn directions (left or
Because most Part 121, 125, 135, and 91 flight departments right) are not noted in the planview because the graphic
include RNAV approach information in their pilot training depiction of the flight tracks is intuitive. Likewise, the arc
programs, a flight crew considering an approach to center points, arc radius, and associated RF leg performance
North Platte, Nebraska, using the RNAV (GPS) RWY 30 limits, such as bank angles and speeds are not depicted
approach shown in Figure 4-16, would already know which because these aircraft performance characteristics are
minimums they were authorized to use. The companys encoded in the navigation database. RNP values for each
OpSpecs, FOM, and the AFM for the pilots aircraft would individual leg of the procedure, defined by the procedure
dictate the specific operational conditions and procedures design criteria for containment purposes, are encoded
by which this type of approach could be flown. into the aircraft's navigation database. Applicable landing
minimums are shown in a normal manner along with the
There are several items of note that are specific to this type associated RNP value in the landing minimums section.
When more than one set of RNP landing minimums is
4-30
available and an aircrew is able to achieve lower RNP but correct the Baroaltimeter all the time, rather than
through approved means, the available (multiple) sets of just on the final, which would create conflicts with other
RNP minimums are listed with the lowest set shown first; aircraft if the feature were activated. Pilots should be
remaining sets shown in ascending order, based on the aware of compensation capabilities of the system prior to
RNP value. On this particular procedure, lateral and vertical disregarding the temperature limitations. The information
course guidance from the DA to the Runway Waypoint (LTP) can be seen in the notes section in Figure 4-16.
is provided by the aircrafts FMS and onboard navigation
database; however, any continued flight below the DA For the RNAV (GPS) RWY 30 approach, the note DME/
to the landing threshold is to be conducted under VMC. DME RNP-0.3 NA prohibits aircraft that use only DME/
[Figure 4-15] DME sensors for RNAV from conducting the approach.
[Figure 4-16]
Baro-VNAV Because these procedures can be flown with an approach
approved RNP system and RNP is not sensor specific, it
Baro-VNAV is an RNAV system function that uses barometric
was necessary to add this note to make it clear that those
altitude information from the aircrafts altimeter to
aircraft deriving RNP 0.3 using DME/DME only are not
compute and present a vertical guidance path to the pilot.
authorized to conduct the procedure.
The specified vertical path is computed as a geometric
The least accurate sensor authorized for RNP navigation
path, typically computed between two waypoints or
is DME/DME. The necessary DME NAVAID ground
an angle based computation from a single waypoint.
infrastructure may or may not be available at the airport of
Operational approval must also be obtained for Baro
intended landing. The procedure designer has a computer
VNAV systems to operate to the LNAV/VNAV minimums.
program for determining the usability of DME based on
BaroVNAV may not be authorized on some approaches
geometry and coverage. Where FAA flight inspection
due to other factors, such as no local altimeter source being
successfully determines that the coverage and accuracy of
available. BaroVNAV is not authorized on LPV procedures.
DME facilities support RNP, and that the DME signal meets
inspection tolerances, although there are none currently
Hot and Cold Temperature Limitations
published, the note DME/DME RNP 0.3 Authorized would
A minimum and maximum temperature limitation is
published on procedures that authorize BaroVNAV
operation. These temperatures represent the airport
temperature above or below which BaroVNAV is not
authorized to LNAV/VNAV minimums unless temperature
compensation can be accomplished. As an example, the
limitation will read, uncompensated BaroVNAV NA below
8 C (18 F) or above 47 C (117 F). This information will
Figure 4-17. Example of LNAV and Circling Minima lower than LNAV/VNAV
be found in the upper left hand box of the pilot briefing. DA. Harrisburg International RNAV (GPS) Runway 13.
When the temperature is above the high temperature
or below the low temperature limit, BaroVNAV may be
used to provide a stabilized descent to the LNAV MDA;
however, extra caution should be used in the visual
segment to ensure a vertical correction is not required. If
the VGSI is aligned with the published glide path, and the
aircraft instruments indicate on glide path, an above or
below glide path indication on the VGSI may indicate that
temperature error is causing deviations to the glide path.
These deviations should be considered if the approach is
continued below the MDA.

Many systems which apply BaroVNAV temperature


compensation only correct for cold temperature. In this
case, the high temperature limitation still applies. Also,
temperature compensation may require activation by
maintenance personnel during installation in order to be
functional, even though the system has the feature. Some
systems may have a temperature correction capability, Figure 4-18. Explanation of Minima.

4-31
4-32
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

NO
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010
TF
OR
NA

Figure 4-19. Airport sketch and diagram for Chicago O'Hare International.
VI

Airport sketch
GA
NO
TIO
TF N
OR
EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010
NA
VI
GA
TIO
N EC-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010
be charted. Where DME facility availability is a factor, the the likelihood of a successful instrument approach. Most
note would read, DME/DME RNP 0.3 Authorized; ABC and Part 121, 125, and 135 operators designate specific items
XYZ required, meaning that ABC and XYZ DME facilities are to be included in an IAP briefing, as well as the order in
required to assure RNP 0.3. which those items are briefed.

LNAV, LNAV/VNAV and Circling Minimums Before an IAP briefing can begin, flight crews must decide
There are some RNAV procedures with lower non-precision which procedure is most likely to be flown from the
LNAV minimums [Figure 4-17] than vertically-guided information that is available to them. Most often, when
LNAV/VNAV minimums. Circling procedures found on the flight is being conducted into an airport that has
the same approach plate may also have lower minimums ATIS information, the ATIS provides the pilots with the
than the vertically-guided LNAV/VNAV procedure. Each approaches that are in use. If more than one approach
RNAV procedure is evaluated independently and different is in use, the flight crew may have to make an educated
approach segments have differing required obstacle guess as to which approach will be issued to them based
clearance (ROC) values, obstacle evaluation area (OEA) on the weather, direction of their arrival into the area, any
dimensions and final segment types. Figure 4-18 explains published airport NOTAMs, and previous contact with the
the differences. approach control facility. Aircrews can query ATC as to
which approach is to be expected from the controller. Pilots
Airport/Runway Information may request specific approaches to meet the individual
Another important piece of a thorough approach briefing needs of their equipment or regulatory restrictions at any
is the discussion of the airport and runway environment. time and ATC will, in most cases, be able to accommodate
A detailed examination of the runway length (this must those requests, providing that workload and traffic permit.
include the A/FD for the landing distance available), the
intended turnoff taxiway, and the route of taxi to the If the flight is operating into an airport without a control
parking area, are all important briefing items. In addition, tower, the flight crew is occasionally given the choice of any
runway conditions should be discussed. The effect on the available instrument approach at the field. In these cases,
aircrafts performance must be considered if the runway the flight crew must choose an appropriate approach based
is contaminated. on the expected weather, aircraft performance, direction
of arrival, airport NOTAMs, and previous experience at the
FAA approach charts include a runway sketch on each airport.
approach chart to make important airport information
easily accessible to pilots. In addition, at airports that have Navigation and Communication Radios
complex runway/taxiway configurations, a separate full- Once the anticipated approach and runway have been
page airport diagram is published. selected, each crewmember sets up their side of the flight
deck. The pilots use information gathered from ATIS,
The airport diagram also includes the latitude/longitude dispatch (if available), ATC, the specific approach chart
information required for initial programming of FMS for the approach selected, and any other sources that are
equipment. The included latitude/longitude grid shows the available. Company regulations dictate how certain things
specific location of each parking area on the airport surface are set up and others are left up to pilot technique. In
for use in initializing FMS. Figure 4-19 shows the airport general, the techniques used at a specific most companies
sketch and diagram for Chicago-OHare International are similar. This section addresses two-pilot operations.
Airport (KORD). During single-pilot IFR flights, the same items must be set
up and the pilot should still do an approach briefing to verify
Pilots making approaches to airports that have this type of that everything is set up correctly.
complex runway and taxiway configuration must ensure
that they are familiar with the airport diagram prior to The number of items that can be set up ahead of time
initiating an instrument approach. A combination of poor depends on the level of automation of the aircraft and the
weather, high traffic volume, and high ground controller avionics available. In a conventional flight deck, the only
workload makes the pilots job on the ground every bit as things that can be set up, in general, are the airspeed bugs
critical as the one just performed in the air. (based on performance calculations), altimeter bug (to DA,
DH, or MDA), go around thrust/power setting, the radio
Instrument Approach Procedure (IAP) altimeter bug (if installed and needed for the approach),
Briefing and the navigation/communication radios (if a standby
A thorough instrument approach briefing greatly increases frequency selector is available). The standby side of the PF

4-33
N
IO
AT
G
NE-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

NE-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-20. Example approaches using autopilot.

4-34
navigation radio should be set to the primary NAVAID for FMC is available, use of the autopilot should be discussed
the approach and the PM navigation radio standby selector during the approach briefing, especially regarding the use
should be set to any other NAVAIDs that are required or of the altitude pre-selector and auto-throttles, if equipped.
available, and as dictated by company procedures, to The AFM for the specific airplane outlines procedures and
add to the overall situational awareness of the crew. The limitations required for the use of the autopilot during an
ADF should also be tuned to an appropriate frequency instrument approach in that aircraft.
as required by the approach, or as selected by the crew.
Aircrews should, as much as possible, set up the instruments There are just as many different autopilot modes to climb
for best success in the event of a vacuum or electrical failure. or descend the airplane, as there are terms for these modes.
For example, if the aircraft will only display Nav 1 on battery Some examples are level change (LVL CHG), vertical speed
or emergency power, aircrews should ensure that Nav 1 is (V/S), VNAV, and takeoff/go around (TO/GA). The pilot
configured to the primary NAVAID for the final approach controls the airplane through the autopilot by selecting
to be flown. pitch modes and/or roll modes, as well as the associated
auto-throttle modes. This panel, sometimes called a mode
Flight Management System (FMS) control panel, is normally accessible to both pilots. Most
In addition to the items that are available on a conventional aircraft with sophisticated auto-flight systems and auto-
flight deck aircraft, glass flight deck aircraft, as well as throttles have the capability to select modes that climb
aircraft with an approved RNAV (GPS) system, usually the airplane with maximum climb thrust and descend the
give the crew the ability to set the final approach course airplane with the throttles at idle (LVL CHG, flight level
for the approach selected and many other options to change (FL CHG), and manage level). They also have the
increase situational awareness. Crews of FMS equipped capability to capture, or level off at pre-selected altitudes,
aircraft have many options available as far as setting up as well as track a LOC and glideslope (G/S) or a VOR course.
the flight management computer (FMC), depending on If the airplane is RNAV-equipped, the autopilot also tracks
the type of approach and company procedures. The PF the RNAV- generated course. Most of these modes are
usually programs the FMC for the approach and the PM used at some point during an instrument approach using
verifies the information. A menu of available approaches the autopilot. Additionally, these modes can be used to
is usually available to select from based on the destination provide flight director (FD) guidance to the pilot while
airport programmed at the beginning of the flight or a new hand-flying the aircraft.
destination selected while en route.
For the purposes of this precision approach example, the
The amount of information provided for the approach auto-throttles are engaged when the autopilot is engaged
varies from aircraft to aircraft, but the crew can make and specific airspeed and configuration changes are not
modifications if something is not pre-programmed into the discussed. The PF controls airspeed with the speed selector
computer, such as adding a MAP or even building an entire on the mode control panel and calls for flaps and landing
approach for situational awareness purposes only. The PF gear as needed, which the PM selects. The example in
can also program a VNAV profile for the descent and LNAV Figure 4-20 begins with the airplane 5 NM northwest of
for segments that were not programmed during preflight, KNUCK at 4,500 feet with the autopilot engaged, and the
such as a standard terminal arrival route (STAR) or expected flight has been cleared to track the Rwy 12 LOC inbound.
route to the planned approach. Any crossing restrictions The current roll mode is LOC with the PFs NAV radio tuned
for the STAR might need to be programmed as well. The to the LOC frequency of 109.3; and the current pitch mode
most common crossing restrictions, whether mandatory is altitude hold (ALT HOLD). Approach control clears the
or to be expected, are usually automatically programmed airplane for the approach. The PF makes no immediate
when the STAR is selected, but can be changed by ATC at change to the autopilot mode to prevent the aircraft from
any time. Other items that need to be set up are dictated capturing a false glideslope; but the PM resets the altitude
by aircraft-specific procedures, such as autopilot, auto- selector to 1,700 feet. The aircraft remains level because
throttles, auto-brakes, pressurization system, fuel system, the pitch mode remains in ALT HOLD until another pitch
seat belt signs, anti-icing/ deicing equipment, and igniters. mode is selected. Upon reaching KNUCK, the PF selects
LVL CHG as the pitch mode. The auto-throttles retard to
Autopilot Modes idle as the airplane begins a descent. Approaching 1,700
In general, an autopilot can be used to fly approaches even feet, the pitch mode automatically changes to altitude
if the FMC is inoperative (refer to the specific airplanes acquire (ALT ACQ) then to ALT HOLD as the airplane levels
minimum equipment list (MEL) to determine authorization at 1,700 feet. In addition to slowing the airplane and calling
for operating with the FMC inoperative). Whether or not the for configuration changes, the PF selects approach mode

4-35
(APP). The roll mode continues to track the LOC and the information throughout an approach to properly maneuver
pitch mode remains in ALT HOLD; however, the G/S mode the aircraft or monitor autopilot performance and to decide
arms. Selecting APP once the aircraft has leveled at the on the proper course of action at the decision point (DA,
FAF altitude is a suggested technique to ensure that the DH, or MAP). Significant speed and configuration changes
airplane captures the glideslope from below and that a during an approach can seriously degrade situational
false glideslope is not being tracked. awareness and complicate the decision of the proper action
to take at the decision point. The swept wing handling
The PF should have the aircraft fully configured for landing characteristics at low airspeeds and slow engine response
before intercepting the glideslope to ensure a stabilized of many turbojets further complicate pilot tasks during
approach. As the airplane intercepts the glideslope approach and landing operations. You must begin to form
the pitch mode changes to G/S. Once the glideslope is a decision concerning the probable success of an approach
captured by the autopilot, the PM can select the missed before reaching the decision point. Your decision-making
approach altitude in the altitude pre-selector, as requested process requires you to be able to determine displacements
by the PF. The airplane continues to track the glideslope. from the course or glidepath centerline, to mentally project
The minimum altitude at which the PF is authorized to the aircrafts three-dimensional flight path by referring
disconnect the autopilot is airplane specific. For example, to flight instruments, and then apply control inputs as
50 feet below DA, DH, or MDA but not less than 50 feet AGL. necessary to achieve and maintain the desired approach
The PF can disconnect the autopilot at any time prior to path. This process is simplified by maintaining a constant
reaching this altitude during a CAT I approach. The initial approach speed, descent rate, vertical flight path, and
missed approach is normally hand flown with FD guidance configuration during the final stages of an approach. This
unless both autopilots are engaged for auto-land during a is referred to as the stabilized approach concept.
CAT II or III approach.
A stabilized approach is essential for safe turbojet operations
The differences when flying the underlying non-precision
approach begin when the aircraft has leveled off at 1,700
feet. Once ALT HOLD is annunciated, the MDA is selected Runway
by the PM as requested by the PF. It is extremely important
27

for both pilots to be absolutely sure that the correct altitude


is selected for the MDA so that the airplane does not
inadvertently descend below the MDA. For aircraft that the 10,000 feet
altitude pre-selector can only select 100 foot increments,
the MDA for this approach must be set at 700 feet instead 20:1
of 660 feet. 34:1
Runway
Vertical speed mode is used from the FAF inbound to allow
for more precise control of the descent. If the pilots had 200 feet Not to scale
not selected the MDA in the altitude pre-selector window,
the PF would not be able to input a V/S and the airplane Figure 4-21. Determination of visibility minimums.
would remain level. The autopilot mode changes from
ALT ACQ to ALT HOLD as the airplane levels at 700 feet. and commercial turbojet operators must establish and
Once ALT HOLD is annunciated, the PF calls for the missed use procedures that result in stabilized approaches. A
approach altitude of 5,000 feet to be selected in the altitude stabilized approach is also strongly recommended for
pre-selector window. This step is very important because propeller-driven airplanes and helicopters. You should limit
accurate FD guidance is not available to the PF during a configuration changes at low altitudes to those changes
missed approach if the MDA is left in the window. that can be easily accommodated without adversely
affecting your workload. For turbojets, the airplane must
NOTE: See Maximum Acceptable Descent Rates under the be in an approved configuration for landing or circling,
heading Descent Rates and Glide paths for Non-precision if appropriate, with the engines spooled up, and on the
Approaches. correct speed and flight path with a descent rate of less
than 1,000 feet per minute (fpm) before descending below
Descents the following minimum stabilized approach heights:
Stabilized Approach For all straight-in instrument approaches, to include
In IMC, you must continuously evaluate instrument contact approaches in IFR weather conditions, the

4-36
EC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SE-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JA


O N
T I
G A
V I
N A
O R
F
O T
N
Figure 4-22. RNAV approach Fort Campbell, Kentucky.

approach must be stabilized before descending that is independent of the type of airplane or helicopter.
below 1,000 feet above the airport or TDZE. Therefore, the operational practices and techniques must
For visual approaches and straight-in instrument ensure that descent rates greater than 1,000 fpm are not
approaches in VFR weather conditions, the approach permitted in either the instrument or visual portions of an
must be stabilized before descending below 500 feet approach and landing operation.
above the airport elevation.
For short runways, arriving at the MDA at the MAP when
For the final segment of a circling approach the MAP is located at the threshold may require a missed
maneuver, the approach must be stabilized 500 feet approach for some airplanes. For non-precision approaches,
above the airport elevation or at the MDA, whichever a descent rate should be used that ensures the airplane
is lower. These conditions must be maintained reaches the MDA at a distance from the threshold that
throughout the approach until touchdown for the allows landing in the TDZ. On many IAPs, this distance
approach to be considered a stabilized approach. is annotated by a VDP. To determine the required rate of
This also helps you to recognize a wind shear descent, subtract the TDZE from the FAF altitude and divide
situation should abnormal indications exist during this by the time inbound. For example, if the FAF altitude
the approach. is 2,000 feet MSL, the TDZE is 400 feet MSL and the time
inbound is 2 minutes, an 800 fpm rate of descent should
Descent Rates and Glidepaths for Nonprecision be used.
Approaches
Maximum Acceptable Descent Rates To verify the airplane is on an approximate three degree
Operational experience and research have shown that a glidepath, use a calculation of 300 feet to 1 NM. The
descent rate of greater than approximately 1,000 fpm is glidepath height above TDZE is calculated by multiplying
unacceptable during the final stages of an approach (below the NM distance from the threshold by 300. For example,
1,000 feet AGL). This is due to a human perceptual limitation at 10 NM the aircraft should be 3,000 feet above the TDZE,

4-37
91.175 TAKEOFF AND LANDING UNDER IFR

91.175 TAKEOFF AND LANDING UNDER IFR


(c) Operation below DA/ DH or MDA. Except as provided in paragraph (l) of this section, where a DA/DH or MDA is
applicable, no pilot may operate an aircraft, except a military aircraft of the United States, below the authorized MDA or
continue an approach below the authorized DA/DH unless
(1) The aircraft is continuously in a position from which a descent to a landing on the intended runway can be made at
a normal rate of descent using normal maneuvers, and for operations conducted under part 121 or part 135 unless
that descent rate will allow touchdown to occur within the touchdown zone of the runway of intended landing;
(2) The flight visibility is not less than the visibility prescribed in the standard instrument approach being used; and
(3) Except for a Category II or Category III approach where any necessary visual reference requirements are specified
by the Administrator, at least one of the following visual references for the intended runway is distinctly visible and
identifiable to the pilot:
(i) The approach light system, except that the pilot may not descend below 100 feet above the touchdown zone
elevation using the approach lights as a reference unless the red terminating bars or the red side row bars are
also distinctly visible and identifiable.
(ii) The threshold.
(iii) The threshold markings.
(iv) The threshold lights.
(v) The runway end identifier lights.
(vi) The visual approach slope indicator.
(vii) The touchdown zone or touchdown zone markings.
(viii) The touchdown zone lights.
(ix) The runway or runway markings.
(x) The runway lights.
(l) Approach to straight-in landing operations below DH, or MDA using an enhanced flight vision system (EFVS).
For straight-in instrument approach procedures other than Category II or Category III, no pilot operating under this section
or 121.651, 125.381, and 135.225 of this chapter may operate an aircraft at any airport below the authorized MDA or
continue an approach below the authorized DH and land unless
(1) The aircraft is continuously in a position from which a descent to a landing on the intended runway can be made at a
normal rate of descent using normal maneuvers, and, for operations conducted under part 121 or part 135 of this
chapter, the descent rate will allow touchdown to occur within the touchdown zone of the runway of intended landing;
(2) The pilot determines that the enhanced flight visibility observed by use of a certified enhanced flight vision system is
not less than the visibility prescribed in the standard instrument approach procedure being used;
(3) The following visual references for the intended runway are distinctly visible and identifiable to the pilot using the
enhanced flight vision system:
(i) The approach light system (if installed); or
(ii) The following visual references in both paragraphs (l)(3)(ii)(A) and (B) of this section:
(A) The runway threshold, identified by at least one of the following:
(1) The beginning of the runway landing surface;
(2) The threshold lights; or
(3) The runway end identifier lights.
(B) The touchdown zone, identified by at least one of the following:
(1) The runway touchdown zone landing surface;
(2) The touchdown zone lights;
(3) The touchdown zone markings; or
(4) The runway lights.
(4) At 100 feet above the touchdown zone elevation of the runway of intended landing and below that altitude, the flight
visibility must be sufficient for the following to be distinctly visible and identifiable to the pilot without reliance on the
enhanced flight vision system to continue to a landing:
(i) The lights or markings of the threshold; or
(ii) The lights or markings of the touchdown zone;
(5) The pilot(s) is qualified to use an EFVS as follows
(i) For parts 119 and 125 certificate holders, the applicable training, testing and qualification provisions of parts
121, 125, and 135 of this chapter;
(ii) For foreign persons, in accordance with the requirements of the civil aviation authority of the State of the
operator; or
(iii) For persons conducting any other operation, in accordance with the applicable currency and proficiency
requirements of part 61 of this chapter;

Figure 4-23. Takeoff and landing under IFR.

4-38
at 5 NM the aircraft should be 1,500 feet above the TDZE, The visibility published on an approach chart is dependent
at 2 NM the aircraft should be 600 feet above the TDZE, on many variables, including the height above touchdown
and at 1.5 NM the aircraft should be 450 feet above the for straight-in approaches or height above airport elevation
TDZE until a safe landing can be made. Using the example for circling approaches. Other factors include the approach
in the previous text, the aircraft should arrive at the MDA light system coverage, and type of approach procedure,
(800 feet MSL) approximately 1.3 NM from the threshold such as precision, non-precision, circling or straight-in.
and in a position to land within the TDZ. Techniques for Another factor determining the minimum visibility is the
deriving a 300-to-1 glide path include using DME, distance penetration of the 34:1 and 20:1 surfaces. These surfaces
advisories provided by radar-equipped control towers, are inclined planes that begin 200 feet out from the runway
RNAV (exclusive of Omega navigation systems), GPS, dead and extend outward to the DA point (for approaches with
reckoning, and pilotage when familiar features on the vertical guidance), the VDP location (for non-precision
approach course are visible. The runway threshold should approaches) and 10,000 feet for an evaluation to a circling
be crossed at a nominal height of 50 feet above the TDZE. runway. If there is a penetration of the 34:1 surface, the
published visibility can be no lower than three-fourths SM.
Transition to a Visual Approach If there is penetration of the 20:1 surface, the published
The transition from instrument flight to visual flight during visibility can be no lower than 1 SM with a note prohibiting
an instrument approach can be very challenging, especially approaches to the affected runway at night (both straight-
during low visibility operations. Aircrews should use caution in and circling). [Figure 4-21 ] Circling may be permitted
when transitioning to a visual approach at times of shallow at night if penetrating obstacles are marked and lighted.
fog. Adequate visibility may not exist to allow flaring of If the penetrating obstacles are not marked and lighted,
the aircraft. Aircrews must always be prepared to execute a note is published that night circling is Not Authorized.
a missed approach/go-around. Additionally, single-pilot Pilots should be aware of these penetrating obstacles
operations make the transition even more challenging. when entering the visual and/or circling segments of an
Approaches with vertical guidance add to the safety of approach and take adequate precautions to avoid them.
the transition to visual because the approach is already For RNAV approaches only, the presence of a grey shaded
stabilized upon visually acquiring the required references line from the MDA to the runway symbol in the profile view
for the runway. 100 to 200 feet prior to reaching the DA, is an indication that the visual segment below the MDA is
DH, or MDA, most of the PMs attention should be outside clear of obstructions on the 34:1 slope. Absence of the gray
of the aircraft in order to visually acquire at least one visual shaded area indicates the 34:1 OCS is not free of obstructions.
reference for the runway, as required by the regulations. [Figure 4-22]
The PF should stay focused on the instruments until the
PM calls out any visual aids that can be seen, or states Missed Approach
runway in sight. The PF should then begin the transition Many reasons exist for executing a missed approach. The
to visual flight. It is common practice for the PM to call out primary reasons, of course, are that the required flight
the V/S during the transition to confirm to the PF that the visibility prescribed in the IAP being used does not exist
instruments are being monitored, thus allowing more of when natural vision is used under 14 CFR Part 91, section
the PFs attention to be focused on the visual portion of the 91.175(c), the required enhanced flight visibility is less
approach and landing. Any deviations from the stabilized than that prescribed in the IAP when an EFVS is used under
approach criteria should also be announced by the PM. 14 CFR Part 91, section 91.175 (l), or the required visual
references for the runway cannot be seen upon arrival at
Single-pilot operations can be much more challenging the DA, DH, or MAP. In addition, according to 14 CFR Part 91,
because the pilot must continue to fly by the instruments the aircraft must continuously be in a position from which a
while attempting to acquire a visual reference for the descent to a landing on the intended runway can be made
runway. While it is important for both pilots of a two-pilot at a normal rate of descent using normal maneuvers, and
aircraft to divide their attention between the instruments for operations conducted under Part 121 or 135, unless that
and visual references, it is even more critical for the descent rate allows touchdown to occur within the TDZ of
single- pilot operation. The flight visibility must also be the runway of intended landing. [Figure 4-23 ] CAT II and
at least the visibility minimum stated on the instrument III approaches call for different visibility requirements as
approach chart, or as required by regulations. CAT II and III prescribed by the FAA Administrator.
approaches have specific requirements that may differ from
CAT I precision or non-precision approach requirements Prior to initiating an instrument approach procedure,
regarding transition to visual and landing. This information the pilot should assess the actions to be taken in the
can be found in the operators OpSpecs or FOM. event of a balked (rejected) landing beyond the missed

4-39
ON
TI
GA
SE-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

SE-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-24. Orlando Executive Airport, Orlando, Florida, ILS RWY 7.

4-40
ON
TI
GA
SC-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

SC-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-25. Missed approach procedures for Dallas-Fort Worth International (DFW).

4-41
010 to 16 DEC 2010

SW-3, 18 NOV 2010 t


This NOTE on the ILS RWY 8 chart for the missed approach climb requirement
applies to all lines of minimums. If you are unable to make the climb rate/gradient,
you must use the higher minimums on the separately published LOC RWY 8
chart that meet the standard climb gradient of 200 feet per NM.

N
O
SW-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

I SW-3, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


AT
G
VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-26. Missed approach point depiction and steeper than standard climb gradient requirements.

approach point or below the MDA or DA (H) considering point, direction of flight, and/ or the minimum turning
the anticipated weather conditions and available aircraft altitudes in the prescribed missed approach procedure.
performance. 14 CFR 91.175(e) authorizes the pilot to The pilot must also consider aircraft performance, visual
fly an appropriate missed approach procedure that climb restrictions, charted obstacles, published obstacle
ensures obstruction clearance, but it does not necessarily departure procedure, takeoff visual climb requirements
consider separation from other air traffic. The pilot must as expressed by nonstandard takeoff minima, other
consider other factors such as the aircrafts geographical traffic expected to be in the vicinity, or other factors not
location with respect to the prescribed missed approach specifically expressed by the approach procedures.

4-42
O N
TI
GA
SW-3, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011

SW-3, 10 MAR 2011 to 07 APR 2011


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-27. Two sets of minimums required when a climb gradient greater than 200 FPNM is required.

4-43
Instrument Approach/
1 Operational Briefing Items
15 2
ATIS
8 12 1
5 Weather/terrain

N
19 4
11 NOTAMS
9
Approaches in use

IO
Runway conditions

17 Performance considerations

Feeder route/expected routing to the

AT
planned approach

Traffic

Radar/non-radar environment
4
Towered/non-towered airport
10

VIG Straight-in/circling approach


1 Airport/city name
SC-4, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

SC-4, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


2 Approach title
4 4 3 Amendment number and Julian
date of when last procedural
change to the page was made
NA
4 Primary/secondary NAVAID
5 frequencies
5 Final approach course
6 Barometric altitude at OM for
cross-check
7 Decision altitude, decision height
18 or minimum descent altitude (DA,
OR

DH, or MDA)
11 16
9 15 8 Touchdown zone elevation and
8 airport elevation
9 Missed approach procedure

13 10 Minimum safe altitude (MSA)


6
TF

11 Applicable notes
12 Approach lighting system
5
12 13 13 Visual glideslope indicators (VGSI)

14 14 Required visibility (including


inoperative equipment adjustments)
7
NO

15 Runway length
16 Planned runway turnoff and
expected taxi route
1 17 Part-time facility
3 2
18 Airport diagram
1 19 Alternate/Take-off minimums not
standard
Aircraft specific items, such as auto-pilot, auto-brakes, auto-throttles, speed brakes, reverse thrust, etc.

Aircraft specific missed approach considerations/techniques

Additional items/duties pertaining to the situation (CAT II/III [auto-land], inoperative equipment, etc.)

Transfer of flight controls

Communications

Figure 4-28. Example of approach chart briefing sequence.

4-44
A clearance for an instrument approach procedure In the event a balked (rejected) landing occurs at a position
includes a clearance to fly the published missed approach other than the published missed approach point, the
procedure, unless otherwise instructed by ATC. Once pilot should contact ATC as soon as possible to obtain an
descent below the DA, DH, or MDA is begun, a missed amended clearance. If unable to contact ATC for any reason,
approach must be executed if the required visibility is lost the pilot should attempt to reintercept a published
or the runway environment is no longer visible, unless the segment of the missed approach and comply with route
loss of sight of the runway is a result of normal banking and altitude instructions. If unable to contact ATC, and
of the aircraft during a circling approach. A MAP is also in the pilots judgment it is no longer appropriate to fly
required upon the execution of a rejected landing for any the published missed approach procedure, then consider
reason, such as men and equipment or animals on the either maintaining visual conditions (if possible) and
runway, or if the approach becomes unstabilized and a reattempt a landing, or a circleclimb over the airport.
normal landing cannot be performed. After the MAP in Should a missed approach become necessary when
the visual segment of a non-precision approach, there may operating to an airport that is not served by an operating
be hazards when executing a missed approach below the control tower, continuous contact with an air traffic facility
MDA. The published missed approach procedure provides may not be possible. In this case, the pilot should execute
obstacle clearance only when the missed approach is the appropriate goaround/missed approach procedure
conducted on the missed approach segment from or without delay and contact ATC when able to do so.
above the missed approach point, and assumes a climb
rate of 200 FPNM or higher, as published. If the aircraft As shown in Figure 4-26 , there are many different ways
initiates a missed approach at a point other than the that the MAP can be depicted, depending on the type
missed approach point, from below MDA or DA (H), or on of approach. On all approach charts, it is depicted in the
a circling approach, obstacle clearance is not provided by profile and plan views by the end of the solid course
following the published missed approach procedure, nor line and the beginning of the dotted missed approach
is separation assured from other air traffic in the vicinity. course line for the top-line/ lowest published minima. For
a precision approach, the MAP is the point at which the
The missed approach climb is normally executed at the aircraft reaches the DA or DH while on the glideslope. MAPs
MAP. If such a climb is initiated at a higher altitude prior on non-precision approaches can be determined in many
to the MAP, pilots must be aware of any published climb- different ways. If the primary NAVAID is on the airport, and
altitude limitations, which must be accounted for when either a VOR or NDB approach is being executed, the MAP is
commencing an early climb. Figure 4-24 gives an example normally the point at which the aircraft passes the NAVAID.
of an altitude restriction that would prevent a climb
between the FAF and MAP. In this situation, the Orlando On some non-precision approaches, the MAP is given
Executive ILS or LOC RWY 7 approach altitude is restricted as a fixed distance with an associated time from the FAF
at the BUVAY 3 DME fix to prevent aircraft from penetrating to the MAP based on the groundspeed of the aircraft. A
the overlying protected airspace for approach routes into table on the lower right hand side of the approach chart
Orlando International Airport. If a missed approach is shows the distance in NM from the FAF to the MAP and
initiated before reaching BUVAY, a pilot may be required the time it takes at specific groundspeeds, given in 30
to continue descent to 1,200 feet before proceeding knot increments. Pilots must determine the approximate
to the MAP and executing the missed approach climb groundspeed and time based on the approach speed and
instructions. In addition to the missed approach notes true airspeed of their aircraft and the current winds along
on the chart, the Pilot Briefing Information icons in the the final approach course. A clock or stopwatch should be
profile view indicate the initial vertical and lateral missed started at the FAF of an approach requiring this method.
approach guidance. Many non-precision approaches designate a specific fix
as the MAP. These can be identified by a course (LOC or
The missed approach course begins at the MAP and VOR) and DME, a cross radial from a VOR, or an RNAV (GPS)
continues until the aircraft has reached the designated waypoint.
fix and a holding pattern has been entered. [Figure 4-25]
In these circumstances, ATC normally issues further Obstacles or terrain in the missed approach segment
instructions before the aircraft reaches the final fix of may require a steeper climb gradient than the standard
the missed approach course. It is also common for the 200 FPNM. If a steeper climb gradient is required, a note
designated fix to be an IAF so that another approach is published on the approach chart plan view with the
attempt can be made without having to fly from the penetration description and examples of the required
holding fix to an IAF. FPM rate of climb for a given groundspeed (future charting

4-45
Plan view
IF
FAF Obstacle
IAF
Initial Intermediate Final Runway Missed Re-enter
approach En route phase

Profile view Flightpath


Map
500 feet
1,000 feet 250 feet 1,000 feet
Project view
FAF
IF

IAF
Feeder route

Figure 4-29. Approach segments and obstacle clearance.

uses climb gradient). An alternative is normally charted multi-crew aircraft, the process is also applicable to single-
that allows using the standard climb gradient. [Figure pilot operations. A complete instrument approach and
4-26 ] In this example, if the missed approach climb operational briefing example follows.
requirements cannot be met for the Burbank ILS RWY 8
chart, the alternative is to use the LOC RWY 8 that is charted The approach briefing begins with a general discussion of
separately. The LOC RWY 8, S-8 procedure has a MDA that the ATIS information, weather, terrain, NOTAMs, approaches
is 400 feet higher than the ILS RWY 8, S-LOC 8 MDA and in use, runway conditions, performance considerations,
meets the standard climb gradient requirement over the expected route to the final approach course, and the
terrain. For some approaches a new charting standard is traffic situation. As the discussion progresses, the items
requiring two sets of minimums to be published when and format of the briefing become more specific. The
a climb gradient greater than 200 FPNM is required. The briefing can also be used as a checklist to ensure that
first set of minimums is the lower of the two, requiring a all items have been set up correctly. Most pilots verbally
climb gradient greater than 200 FPNM. The second set of brief the specific MAP so that it is fresh in their minds and
minimums is higher, but doesnt require a climb gradient. there is no confusion as to who is doing what during a
Shown in Figure 4-27 , Barstow-Daggett (KDAG) RNAV missed approach. Also, it is a very good idea to brief the
(GPS) RWY 26 is an example where there are two LPV lines published missed approach even if the tower is most likely
of minimums. to give you alternate instructions in the event of a missed
approach. A typical approach briefing might sound like
Example Approach Briefing the following example for a flight inbound to the Monroe
During an instrument approach briefing, the name of the Regional Airport (KMLU):
airport and the specific approach procedure should be
identified to allow other crewmembers the opportunity ATIS: Monroe Regional Airport Information Bravo, time
to cross-reference the chart being used for the brief. This 2253 Zulu, wind 360 at 10, visibility 1 mile, mist, ceiling 300
ensures that pilots intending to conduct an instrument overcast, temperature 4, dew point 3, altimeter 29.73, ILS
approach have collectively reviewed and verified the Runway 4 approach in use, landing and departing Runway
information pertinent to the approach. Figure 4-28 4, advise on initial contact that you have information Bravo.
gives an example of the items to be briefed and their
sequence. Although the following example is based on PF: Were planning an ILS approach to Runway 4 at Monroe

4-46
NC-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

Figure 4-30. Feeder routes.


NO
T FO
R
NA
VI
GA
TIO
N
NC-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

4-47
4-48
NC-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

Figure 4-31. Terminal routes.


NO
TF
OR
NA
VI
GA
TIO
N
NC-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011
Length
Required Obstacle Clearance (ROC)
The intermediate segment may NOT be less than
5 NM nor more than 15 NM in length, measured The ROC is 1,000 feet for the primary initial segment.
along the arc. The OPTIMUM length is 10 NM. The secondary area ROC starts at the primary ROC
A distance greater than 10 NM should not be used surface tapering to zero at the edges of the secondary
unless an operational requirement justifies the area in both initial and intermediate areas. In the
greater distance. primary area of the intermediate segment, the ROC is
500 feet.

2
NM
4 NM Intermediate
segment 500
4 NM feet
2
500 NM
feet Initial segment

2 2
NM 4 NM 4 NM NM
VORTAC
Width 500
feet
The total width of an arc intermediate segment is 6 1,000
NM on each side of the arc. For obstacle clearance feet
purposes, this width is divided into a primary and a 500
feet
secondary area. The primary area extends 4 NM
laterally on each side of the arc segment. The
secondary areas extend 2 NM laterally on each side
of the primary area.

Figure 4-32. DME arc obstruction clearance.

Regional Airport, page 270, effective date 22 Sep 11 to 20 Go-Around button used on some turbojets), call
Oct 11. Localizer frequency is 109.5, SABAR Locator Outer go-around thrust, flaps 15, positive climb, gear up, set me
Marker is 392, Monroe VOR is 117.2, final approach course is up, climb straight ahead to 2,000 feet then climbing right
042. Well cross SABAR at 1,483 feet barometric, decision turn to 3,000 feet toward Monroe or well follow the towers
altitude is 278 feet barometric, touchdown zone elevation is instructions. Any questions?
78 feet with an airport elevation of 79 feet. MAP is climb
to 2,000 feet, then climbing right turn to 3,000 feet direct PM: Ill back up the auto-speedbrakes. Other than that, I
Monroe VOR and hold. The MSA is 2,200 feet to the north dont have any questions.
and along our missed approach course, and 3,100 feet to
the south along the final approach course. ADF or DME Instrument Approach Procedure
is required for the approach and the airport has pilot Segments
controlled lighting when the tower is closed, which does An instrument approach may be divided into as many as
not apply to this approach. The runway has a medium four approach segments: initial, intermediate, final, and
intensity approach lighting system with runway alignment missed approach. Additionally, feeder routes provide a
indicator lights and a precision approach path indicator transition from the en route structure to the IAF. FAA Order
(PAPI). We need a half- mile visibility so with one mile we 8260.3 (ERPS) criteria provides obstacle clearance for each
should be fine. Runway length is 7,507 feet. Im planning segment of an approach procedure as shown in Figure 4-29.
a flaps 30 approach, auto- brakes 2, left turn on Alpha or
Charlie 1 then Alpha, Golf to the ramp. With a left crosswind, Feeder Routes
the runway should be slightly to the right. Ill use the By definition, a feeder route is a route depicted on IAP
autopilot until we break out and, after landing, Ill slow charts to designate routes for aircraft to proceed from the
the aircraft straight ahead until you say you have control en route structure to the IAF. [Figure 4-30 ] Feeder routes,
and Ill contact ground once we are clear of the runway. In also referred to as approach transitions, technically are
the case of a missed approach, Ill press TOGA (Take-off/ not considered approach segments but are an integral

4-49
Reversal fix may Specified time or depicted fix
be specified

Complete in remain
within distance

The 80/260 procedure turn Base turn

c
Reversal fix may se
be specified n 15 &E
i ,D
1 m at C 1 minute
-C

Complete in remain
within distance

The 45/180 procedure turn Racetrack procedure

Figure 4-33. Course reversal methods.

part of many IAPs. Although an approach procedure may begun the approach and is maneuvering to enter an
have several feeder routes, pilots normally choose the one intermediate or final segment of the approach. DME arcs
closest to the en route arrival point. When the IAF is part of may also be used as an intermediate or a final segment,
the en route structure, there may be no need to designate although they are extremely rare as final approach
additional routes for aircraft to proceed to the IAF. segments.

When a feeder route is designated, the chart provides An arc may join a course at or before the IF. When joining
the course or bearing to be flown, the distance, and the a course at or before the IF, the angle of intersection of the
minimum altitude. En route airway obstacle clearance arc and the course is designed so it does not exceed 120.
criteria apply to feeder routes, providing 1,000 feet of When the angle exceeds 90, a radial that provides at least 2
obstacle clearance (2,000 feet in mountainous areas). NM of lead will be identified to assist in leading the turn on
to the intermediate course. DME arcs are predicated on DME
Terminal Routes collocated with a facility providing omnidirectional course
In cases where the IAF is part of the en route structure information, such as a VOR. A DME arc cannot be based on
and feeder routes are not required, a transition or terminal an ILS or LOC DME source because omnidirectional course
route is still needed for aircraft to proceed from the IAF to information is not provided.
the intermediate fix (IF). These routes are initial approach
segments because they begin at the IAF. Like feeder routes, The ROC along the arc depends on the approach segment.
they are depicted with course, minimum altitude, and For an initial approach segment, a ROC of 1,000 feet is
distance to the IF. Essentially, these routes accomplish the required in the primary area, which extends to 4 NM on
same thing as feeder routes but they originate at an IAF, either side of the arc. For an intermediate segment primary
whereas feeder routes terminate at an IAF. [Figure 4-31 ] area, the ROC is 500 feet. The initial and intermediate
segment secondary areas extend 2 NM from the primary
DME Arcs boundary area edge. The ROC starts at the primary area
DME arcs also provide transitions to the approach course, boundary edge at 500 feet and tapers to zero feet at the
but DME arcs are actually approach segments while feeder secondary area outer edge. [Figure 4-32 ]
routes, by definition, are not. When established on a DME
arc, the aircraft has departed the en route phase and has

4-50
Obstacle

Entry zone

Obstacle

Maneuvering zone

Altitude restricted until completing


departing turn fix outbound

7,700

Procedure turn completion altitude


1,000 feet
6,900

1,000 feet

6,000

Figure 4-34. Procedure turn obstacle clearance.

Course Reversal or teardrop procedure is published, the point where pilots


Some approach procedures do not permit straight-in begin the turn and the type and rate of turn are optional.
approaches unless pilots are being radar vectored. In these If above the procedure turn minimum altitude, pilots may
situations, pilots are required to complete a procedure turn begin descent as soon as they cross the IAF outbound.
(PT) or other course reversal, generally within 10 NM of the
PT fix, to establish the aircraft inbound on the intermediate A procedure turn is the maneuver prescribed to perform
or final approach segment. a course reversal to establish the aircraft inbound on an
intermediate or final approach course. The procedure turn
If Category E airplanes are using the PT or there is a descent or hold-in-lieu-of procedure turn is a required maneuver
gradient problem, the PT distance available can be as much when it is depicted on the approach chart. However, the
as 15 NM. During a procedure turn, a maximum speed of procedure turn or the hold-in-lieu-of PT is not permitted
200 knots indicated airspeed (KIAS) should be observed when the symbol No PT is depicted on the initial segment
from first crossing the course reversal IAF through the being flown, when a RADAR VECTOR to the final approach
procedure turn maneuver to ensure containment within course is provided, or when conducting a timed approach
the obstruction clearance area. Unless a holding pattern from a holding fix.

4-51
En route fix
te
er rou
Feed
IAF

Initia
l app
roac
h se
gme
nt

FAF Beginning of intermediate segment

Figure 4-35. Approach without a designated IF.

and rate of turn is left to the discretion of the pilot (limited


The altitude prescribed for the procedure turn is a by the charted remain within XX NM distance). Some of the
minimum altitude until the aircraft is established on the options are the 45 procedure turn, the racetrack pattern,
inbound course. The maneuver must be completed within the teardrop procedure turn, or the 80 procedure turn, or
the distance specified in the profile view. This distance is the 80 260 course reversal. Racetrack entries should
usually 10 miles. This may be reduced to 5 miles where only be conducted on the maneuvering side where the majority
Category A or helicopter aircraft are operated. This distance of protected airspace resides. If an entry places the pilot
may be increased to as much as 15 miles to accommodate on the non-maneuvering side of the PT, correction to
high performance aircraft. intercept the outbound course ensures remaining within
protected airspace.
The pilot may elect to use the procedure turn or hold-in-
lieu- of PT when it is not required by the procedure, but Some procedure turns are specified by procedural track.
must first receive an amended clearance from ATC. When These turns must be flown exactly as depicted. These
ATC is radar vectoring to the final approach course, or to requirements are necessary to stay within the protected
the intermediate fix as may occur with RNAV standard airspace and maintain adequate obstacle clearance. [Figure
instrument approach procedures, ATC may specify in 4-33] A minimum of 1,000 feet of obstacle clearance is
the approach clearance CLEARED STRAIGHT-IN (type) provided in the procedure turn primary area. [Figure 4-34]
APPROACH to ensure that the pilot understands that the In the secondary area, 500 feet of obstacle clearance is
procedure turn or hold-in- lieu-of PT is not to be flown. If provided at the inner edge, tapering uniformly to 0 feet
the pilot is uncertain whether ATC intends for a procedure at the outer edge.
turn or a straight-in approach to be flown, the pilot will
immediately request clarification from ATC. The primary and secondary areas determine obstacle
clearance in both the entry and maneuvering zones. The
On U.S. Government charts, a barbed arrow indicates the use of entry and maneuvering zones provides further relief
maneuvering side of the outbound course on which the from obstacles. The entry zone is established to control the
procedure turn is made. Headings are provided for course obstacle clearance prior to proceeding outbound from the
reversal using the 45 type procedure turn. However, the procedure turn fix. The maneuvering zone is established
point at which the turn may be commenced and the type to control obstacle clearance after proceeding outbound

4-52
from the procedure turn fix. pattern, or by following a terminal route that intersects
the final approach course. The initial approach segment
Descent to the PT completion altitude from the PT fix begins at an IAF and usually ends where it joins the
altitude (when one has been published or assigned by ATC) intermediate approach segment or at an IF. The letters IAF
must not begin until crossing over the PT fix or abeam and on an approach chart indicate the location of an IAF and
proceeding outbound. Some procedures contain a note in more than one may be available. Course, distance, and
the chart profile view that says Maintain (altitude) or above minimum altitudes are also provided for initial approach
until established outbound for procedure turn. Newer segments. A given procedure may have several initial
procedures simply depict an at or above altitude at the PT approach segments. When more than one exists, each joins
fix without a chart note. Both are there to ensure required a common intermediate segment, although not necessarily
obstacle clearance is provided in the procedure turn at the same location.
entry zone. Absence of a chart note or specified minimum
altitude adjacent to the PT fix is an indication that descent Many RNAV approaches make use of a dual-purpose IF/
to the procedure turn altitude can commence immediately IAF associated with a hold-in-lieu-PT (HILPT) anchored at
upon crossing over the PT fix, regardless of the direction the Intermediate Fix. The HILPT forms the Initial Approach
of flight. This is because the minimum altitudes in the PT Segment when course reversal is required.
entry zone and the PT maneuvering zone are the same.
When the PT is required, it is only necessary to enter the
A holding pattern in lieu of procedure turn may be specified holding pattern to reverse course. The dual purpose fix
for course reversal in some procedures. In such cases, the functions as an IAF in that case. Once the aircraft has
holding pattern is established over an intermediate fix or entered the hold and is returning to the fix on the inbound
a FAF. The holding pattern distance or time specified in the course, the dual-purpose fix becomes an IF, marking the
profile view must be observed. For a hold-in-lieu-of PT, the beginning of the intermediate segment.
holding pattern direction must be flown as depicted and
the specified leg length/timing must not be exceeded. ATC may provide a vector to an IF at an angle of 90 degrees
Maximum holding airspeed limitations as set forth for all or less and specify Cleared Straight-in (type) Approach.
holding patterns apply. The holding pattern maneuver is In those cases, the radar vector is providing the initial
completed when the aircraft is established on the inbound approach segment and the pilot should not fly the PT
course after executing the appropriate entry. If cleared for without a clearance from ATC.
the approach prior to returning to the holding fix and the
aircraft is at the prescribed altitude, additional circuits of Occasionally, a chart may depict an IAF, although there is
the holding pattern are not necessary nor expected by ATC. no initial approach segment for the procedure. This usually
If pilots elect to make additional circuits to lose excessive occurs at a point located within the en route structure
altitude or to become better established on course, it is where the intermediate segment begins. In this situation,
their responsibility to so advise ATC upon receipt of their the IAF signals the beginning of the intermediate segment.
approach clearance. Refer to the AIM section 5-4-9 for
additional information on holding procedures. Intermediate Approach Segment
The intermediate segment is designed primarily to position
Initial Approach Segment the aircraft for the final descent to the airport. Like the feeder
The purposes of the initial approach segment are to provide route and initial approach segment, the chart depiction of
a method for aligning the aircraft with the intermediate the intermediate segment provides course, distance, and
or final approach segment and to permit descent during minimum altitude information.

The intermediate segment, normally aligned within 30 of


the final approach course, begins at the IF, or intermediate
point, and ends at the beginning of the final approach
segment. In some cases, an IF is not shown on an approach
chart. In this situation, the intermediate segment begins at
a point where you are proceeding inbound to the FAF, are
properly aligned with the final approach course, and are
located within the prescribed distance prior to the FAF. An
the alignment. This is accomplished by using a DME arc, instrument approach that incorporates a procedure turn
a course reversal, such as a procedure turn or holding is the most common example of an approach that may

4-53
not have a charted IF. The intermediate segment in this Approach Clearance
example begins when you intercept the inbound course According to FAA Order 7110.65, ATC clearances authorizing
after completing the procedure turn. [Figure 4-35 ] instrument approaches are issued on the basis that if visual
contact with the ground is made before the approach is
Final Approach Segment completed, the entire approach procedure is followed
The final approach segment for an approach with vertical unless the pilot receives approval for a contact approach, is
guidance or a precision approach begins where the cleared for a visual approach, or cancels the IFR flight plan.
glideslope intercepts the minimum glideslope intercept
altitude shown on the approach chart. If ATC authorizes Approach clearances are issued based on known traffic.
a lower intercept altitude, the final approach segment The receipt of an approach clearance does not relieve the
begins upon glideslope interception at that altitude. For pilot of his or her responsibility to comply with applicable
a non-precision approach, the final approach segment parts of the CFRs and notations on instrument approach
begins either at a designated FAF, which is depicted as a charts, which impose on the pilot the responsibility to
cross on the profile view, or at the point where the aircraft comply with or act on an instruction, such as procedure
is established inbound on the final approach course. not authorized at night. The name of the approach, as
When a FAF is not designated, such as on an approach published, is used to identify the approach. Approach name
that incorporates an on-airport VOR or NDB, this point items within parentheses are not included in approach
is typically where the procedure turn intersects the final clearance phraseology.
approach course inbound. This point is referred to as the
final approach point (FAP). The final approach segment Vectors To Final Approach Course
ends at either the designated MAP or upon landing. The approach gate is an imaginary point used within ATC
as a basis for vectoring aircraft to the final approach course.
There are three types of procedures based on the final The gate is established along the final approach course one
approach course guidance: mile from the FAF on the side away from the airport and is
Precision approach (PA)an instrument approach
based on a navigation system that provides course
and glidepath deviation information meeting
precision standards of ICAO Annex 10. For example,
PAR, ILS, and GLS are precision approaches.
Approach with vertical guidance (APV ) an
instrument approach based on a navigation system
that is not required to meet the precision approach
standards of ICAO Annex 10, but provides course
and glidepath deviation information. For example,
no closer than 5 NM from the landing threshold. Controllers
Baro-VNAV, LDA with glidepath, LNAV/VNAV and LPV
are also required to ensure the assigned altitude conforms
are APV approaches.
to the following:
Non-precision approach (NPA)an instrument
For a precision approach, at an altitude not above
approach based on a navigation system that
the glideslope/glidepath or below the minimum
provides course deviation information but no
glideslope intercept altitude specified on the
glidepath deviation information. For example, VOR,
approach procedure chart.
TACAN, LNAV, NDB, LOC, and ASR approaches are
examples of NPA procedures. For a non-precision approach, at an altitude that
allows descent in accordance with the published
Missed Approach Segment procedure.
The missed approach segment begins at the MAP and ends Further, controllers must assign headings that
at a point or fix where an initial or en route segment begins. intercept the final approach course no closer than
The actual location of the MAP depends upon the type of the following table:
approach you are flying. For example, during a precision
or an APV approach, the MAP occurs at the DA or DH on A typical vector to the final approach course and associated
the glideslope. For non-precision approaches, the MAP is approach clearance is as follows:
either a fix, NAVAID, or after a specified period of time has
elapsed after crossing the FAF. four miles from LIMA, turn right heading three four zero,

4-54
N
TIO
NAVAID information is for supplemental guidance only.

GA
A CVFP will help you locate key
landmarks at an unfamiliar airport
and provide you and ATC with
common reporting points.

VI
SW-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SW-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
You are not prohibited from flying other-
than-recommended altitudes as
operational requirements dictate.
R
FO

Published weather minimums are based


on minimum vectoring altitudes rather
than the recommended altitudes depicted
T

on charts.
NO

Often visual procedures are not authorized


at night due to surrounding terrain.

Figure 4-36. Charted visual flight procedures (CVFP).

4-55
maintain two thousand until established on the localizer, controller assigns an altitude compatible with glideslope
cleared ILS runway three six approach. intercept prior to being cleared for the approach.
Other clearance formats may be used to fit individual
circumstances, but the controller should always assign an Types of Approaches
altitude to maintain until the aircraft is established on a
In the NAS, there are approximately 1,105 VOR stations, 916
segment of a published route or IAP. The altitude assigned
NDB stations, and 1,194 ILS installations, including 25 LOC-
must guarantee IFR obstruction clearance from the point
type directional aids (LDAs), 11 simplified directional facilities
at which the approach clearance is issued until the aircraft
(SDFs), and 235 LOC only facilities. As time progresses, it is
is established on a published route. 14 CFR Part 91, section
the intent of the FAA to reduce navigational dependence on
91.175 (j) prohibits a pilot from making a procedure turn
VOR, NDB, and other ground-based NAVAIDs and, instead,
when vectored to a FAF or course, when conducting a
to increase the use of satellite-based navigation.
timed approach, or when the procedure specifies NO PT.
To expedite the use of RNAV procedures for all instrument
When vectoring aircraft to the final approach course,
pilots, the FAA has begun an aggressive schedule to
controllers are required to ensure the intercept is at least
develop RNAV procedures. As of 2010, the number of
2 NM outside the approach gate. Exceptions include the
RNAV/ GPS approaches published in the NAS numbered
following situations, but do not apply to RNAV aircraft
10,212, with additional procedures published every revision
being vectored for a GPS or RNAV approach:
cycle. While it had originally been the plan of the FAA to
When the reported ceiling is at least 500 feet above begin decommissioning VORs, NDBs, and other ground-
the MVA/MIA and the visibility is at least 3 SM (may based NAVAIDs, the overall strategy has been changed to
be a pilot report (PIREP) if no weather is reported for incorporate a majority dependence on augmented satellite
the airport), aircraft may be vectored to intercept navigation while maintaining a satisfactory backup system.
the final approach course closer than 2 NM outside This backup system includes retaining all CAT II and III ILS
the approach gate but no closer than the approach facilities and close to one-half of the existing VOR network.
gate.
If specifically requested by the pilot, aircraft may Each approach is provided obstacle clearance based on
be vectored to intercept the final approach course the Order 8260.3 TERPS design criteria as appropriate for
inside the approach gate but no closer than the FAF. the surrounding terrain, obstacles, and NAVAID availability.
Final approach obstacle clearance is different for every
type of approach but is guaranteed from the start of the
Nonradar Environment final approach segment to the runway (not below the MDA
In the absence of radar vectors, an instrument approach for non-precision approaches) or MAP, whichever occurs
begins at an IAF. An aircraft that has been cleared to last within the final approach area. It is dependent upon
a holding fix that, prior to reaching that fix, is issued a the pilot to maintain an appropriate flight path within
clearance for an approach, but not issued a revised routing, the boundaries of the final approach area and maintain
such as, proceed direct to is expected to proceed via the obstacle clearance.
last assigned route, a feeder route if one is published on
the approach chart, and then to commence the approach There are numerous types of instrument approaches
as published. If, by following the route of flight to the available for use in the NAS including RNAV (GPS), ILS, MLS,
holding fix, the aircraft would overfly an IAF or the fix LOC, VOR, NDB, SDF, and radar approaches. Each approach
associated with the beginning of a feeder route to be used, has separate and individual design criteria, equipment
the aircraft is expected to commence the approach using requirements, and system capabilities.
the published feeder route to the IAF or from the IAF as
appropriate. The aircraft would not be expected to overfly Visual and Contact Approaches
and return to the IAF or feeder route. To expedite traffic, ATC may clear pilots for a visual
approach in lieu of the published approach procedure if
For aircraft operating on unpublished routes, an altitude flight conditions permit. Requesting a contact approach
is assigned to maintain until the aircraft is established on may be advantageous since it requires less time than
a segment of a published route or IAP. (Example: Maintain the published IAP and provides separation from IFR and
2,000 until established on the final approach course special visual flight rules (SVFR) traffic. A contact or visual
outbound, cleared VOR/DME runway 12.) The FAA approach may be used in lieu of conducting a SIAP, and
definition of established on course requires the aircraft both allow the flight to continue as an IFR flight to landing
to be established on the route centerline. Generally, the while increasing the efficiency of the arrival.

4-56
TAAs do not describe specific routes of flight, but rather describe a
volume of airspace within which an aircraft proceeds inbound from
the 30 NM arc boundary toward an appropriate IAF.

N
I O
Straight-in Left base

A T
I G
A V
N
The Basic T usually incorporates 2
IAFs located 3 to 6 NM on either side
of the final IF/IAF, approximately 90
NE-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

R
to the final approach course. The leg

NE-2, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


length or angle of the turn to the inter-
mediate segment may be modified when

O
required by obstructions or airspace.

F
T
N O Right base

Normally, the IF also is designated


an IAF for straight-in (NoPT)
The Basic T design ideally aligns the
procedures. If a straight-in procedure
procedure with runway centerline,
cannot be used due to terrain or
with the MAP located at the threshold,
airspace considerations, the IF will
the FAF 5 NM from the threshold, and
not be designated an IAF. If
the intermediate fix (IF) 5 NM from the
circumstances require a course
FAF.
reversal, a holding pattern is
established at the IF/IAF.

Figure 4-37. Terminal arrival area (TAA) design basic T.

Visual Approaches the event pilots have the airport in sight but do not see
When it is operationally beneficial, ATC may authorize the aircraft they are to follow, ATC may issue the visual
pilots to conduct a visual approach to the airport in lieu approach clearance but maintain responsibility for aircraft
of the published IAP. A pilot, or the controller, can initiate a and wake turbulence separation. Once pilots report the
visual approach. Before issuing a visual approach clearance, aircraft in sight, they assume the responsibilities for their
the controller must verify that pilots have the airport, or a own separation and wake turbulence avoidance.
preceding aircraft that they are to follow, in sight. In

4-57
ION
AT
The RNAV (GPS) procedure (KAPF)
features the basic T design. Notice
the left base icon is sectorized in this
SE-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VIG
example and the MSA has been

SE-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


replaced. This means the TAA
minimum altitudes specified in the
plan view can be flown as depicted.
NA
OR
TF
SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NO

to 13 JAN 2011
EC-1, 16 DEC 201

0
EC-1, 16 DEC 201

The other RNAV (GPS) procedures


0

(KAFW and KOZW) do not incorporate


to 13 JAN 2011

TAAs for operational reasons. Instead,


feeder routes have been estblished for
transitions to the approach. Notice
MSAs are established for emergency
use only; terminal arrival area minimum
altitudes are not specified.

Figure 4-38. RNAV approaches with and without TAAs.

4-58
A visual approach is an ATC authorization for an aircraft to have the airport in sight, or a preceding aircraft to be
on an IFR flight plan to proceed visually to the airport of followed, and the ceiling must be at least 1,000 feet AGL
intended landing; it is not an IAP. Also, there is no missed with at least 3 SM visibility.
approach segment. An aircraft unable to complete a visual
approach must be handled as any other go-around and Charted Visual Flight Procedures
appropriate separation must be provided. A vector for a A charted visual flight procedure (CVFP) may be established
visual approach may be initiated by ATC if the reported at some airports with control towers for environmental or
ceiling at the airport of intended landing is at least 500 feet noise considerations, as well as when necessary for the
above the MVA/MIA and the visibility is 3 SM or greater. At safety and efficiency of air traffic operations. Designed
airports without weather reporting service, there must be primarily for turbojet aircraft, CVFPs depict prominent
reasonable assurance through area weather reports and landmarks, courses, and recommended altitudes to specific
PIREPs that descent and approach to the airport can be runways. When pilots are flying the Roaring Fork Visual RWY
made visually, and the pilot must be informed that weather 15, shown in Figure 4-36 , mountains, rivers, and towns
information is not available. provide guidance to Aspen, Colorados Sardy Field instead
of VORs, NDBs, and DME fixes.
The visual approach clearance is issued to expedite the flow
of traffic to an airport. It is authorized when the ceiling is Pilots must have a charted visual landmark or a preceding
reported or expected to be at least 1,000 feet AGL and the aircraft in sight, and weather must be at or above the
visibility is at least 3 SM. Pilots must remain clear of the published minimums before ATC will issue a CVFP clearance.
clouds at all times while conducting a visual approach. At ATC will clear pilots for a CVFP if the reported ceiling at the
an airport with a control tower, pilots may be cleared to fly a airport of intended landing is at least 500 feet above the
visual approach to one runway while others are conducting MVA/MIA, and the visibility is 3 SM or more, unless higher
VFR or IFR approaches to another parallel, intersecting, or minimums are published for the particular CVFP. When
converging runway. Also, when radar service is provided, accepting a clearance to follow a preceding aircraft, pilots
it is automatically terminated when the controller advises are responsible for maintaining a safe approach interval
pilots to change to the tower or advisory frequency. While and wake turbulence separation. Pilots must advise ATC if
conducting a visual approach, the pilot is responsible for unable at any point to continue a charted visual approach
providing safe obstacle clearance. or if the pilot loses sight of the preceding aircraft.

Contact Approaches RNAV Approaches


If conditions permit, pilots can request a contact approach, Because of the complications with database coding,
which is then authorized by the controller. A contact naming conventions were changed in January 2001 to
approach cannot be initiated by ATC. This procedure may accommodate all approaches using RNAV equipment into
be used instead of the published procedure to expedite one classification which is RNAV. This classification includes
arrival, as long as the airport has a SIAP the reported ground both ground- based and satellite dependent systems.
visibility is at least 1 SM, and pilots are able to remain clear Eventually all approaches that use some type of RNAV will
of clouds with at least one statute mile flight visibility reflect RNAV in the approach title.
throughout the approach. Some advantages of a contact
approach are that it usually requires less time than the This changeover is being made to reflect two shifts in
published instrument procedure, it allows pilots to retain instrument approach technology. The first shift is the
the IFR clearance, and provides separation from IFR and use of the RNP concept outlined in Chapter 1, Departure
SVFR traffic. On the other hand, obstruction clearances and Procedures, in which a single performance standard
VFR traffic avoidance becomes the pilots responsibility. concept is being implemented for departure/approach
Unless otherwise restricted, the pilot may find it necessary procedure design. Through the use of RNP, the underlying
to descend, climb, or fly a circuitous route to the airport to system of navigation may not be required, provided the
maintain cloud clearance or terrain/ obstruction clearance. aircraft can maintain the appropriate RNP standard. The
second shift is advanced avionics systems, such as FMS,
The main differences between a visual approach and used by most airlines, needed a new navigation standard by
a contact approach are: a pilot must request a contact which RNAV could be fully integrated into the instrument
approach, while a visual approach may be assigned by approach system.
ATC or requested by the pilot; and a contact approach may
be approved with 1 mile visibility if the flight can remain An FMS uses multi-sensor navigation inputs to produce
clear of clouds, while a visual approach requires the pilot a composite position. Essentially, the FMS navigation

4-59
N
TIO
GA
SE-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SE-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


VI
NA
R
T FO
NO

Figure 4-39. Traditional GPS approach overlay.

4-60
N
TIO
GA
NC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

NC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


VI
NA
OR
TF
NO

Figure 4-40. Lincoln Muni KLNK Lincoln, Nebraska, RNAV GPS RWY 14 approach.

4-61
function automatically blends or selects position sensors to terrain or ATC considerations. For instance, the T design
compute aircraft position. Instrument approach charts and may appear more like a regularly or irregularly shaped Y,
RNAV databases needed to change to reflect these issues. or may even have one or both outboard IAFs eliminated
A complete discussion of airborne navigation databases resulting in an upside down L or an I configuration.
is included in Chapter 6, Airborne Navigation Databases. Further, the leg lengths associated with the outboard IAFs
Due to the multi- faceted nature of RNAV, new approach may differ.
criteria have been developed to accommodate the design
of RNAV instrument approaches. This includes criteria for Another modification of the T design may be found at
terminal arrival areas (TAAs, RNAV basic approach criteria, airports with parallel runway configurations. Each parallel
and specific final approach criteria for different types of runway may be served by its own T IAF, IF (IAF), and FAF
RNAV approaches. combination, resulting in parallel final approach courses.
Common IAFs may serve both runways; however, only
Terminal Arrival Areas the intermediate and final approach segments for the
TAAs are the method by which aircraft equipped with a landing runway is shown on the approach chart. Alternative
FMS and/or GPS are transitioned from the RNAV en route designs are addressed in FAA Order 8260.58. U.S Standard
structure to the terminal area with minimal ATC interaction. for Performance-Based Navigation (PBN) Instrument
TAAs are depicted in the planview of the approach chart, Procedure Design. Variations may eliminate one or both
and each waypoint associated with them is also provided base areas, and/or limit or modify the angular size of the
with a unique five character, pronounceable name. The TAA straight-in area. When both base areas are eliminated, TAAs
is not found on all RNAV approaches however, especially are not depicted in the planview. Normally, a portion of
in areas of heavy concentration of air traffic. When the the TAA underlies an airway. If this is not the case, at least
TAA is published, it replaces the MSA for that approach one feeder route is provided from an airway fix or NAVAID
procedure. The TAA consists of a designated volume of to the TAA boundary. The feeder route provides a direct
airspace designed to allow aircraft to enter a protected course from the en route fix/NAVAID to the appropriate
area, offering guaranteed obstacle clearance where the IF/IAF. Multiple feeder routes may also be established. In
initial approach course is intercepted based on the location some cases, TAAs may not be depicted because of airspace
of the aircraft relative to the airport. The RNAV procedure congestion or other operational requirements. [Figure
underlying the TAA is the T design (also called the Basic 4-38 ]
T) or a modification of the T. The T design incorporates
from one to three IAFs: an IF that serves as a dual purpose IF RNAV Approach Types
(IAF): a FAF, and a missed approach point usually located at RNAV encompasses a variety of underlying navigation
the runway threshold. The three IAFs are normally aligned systems and, therefore, approach criteria. This results in
in a straight line perpendicular to the intermediate course, different sets of criteria for the final approach segment
which is an extension of the final course leading to the of various RNAV approaches. RNAV instrument approach
runway, forming a T. The initial segment is normally from criteria address the following procedures:
36 NM in length; the intermediate 57 NM, and the final GPS overlay of pre-existing nonprecision approaches.
segment 5 NM. Specific segment length may be varied to
accommodate specific aircraft categories for which the VOR/DME based RNAV approaches.
procedure is designed. However, the published segment Stand-alone RNAV (GPS) approaches.
lengths reflect the highest category of aircraft normally RNAV (GPS) approaches with vertical guidance
expected to use the procedure. [Figure 4-37 ] (APV).

Procedurally, pilots may be cleared to an IAF associated RNAV (GPS) precision approaches (WAAS and
with the TAA. ATC expects the flight to proceed to the IAF LAAS).
and maintain the altitude depicted for that area of the TAA,
unless cleared otherwise. An obstacle clearance of at least GPS Overlay of Nonprecision Approach
1,000 feet is guaranteed within the boundaries of the TAA. The original GPS approach procedures provided
authorization to fly non-precision approaches based
TAAs are modified or even eliminated, if necessary, to meet on conventional, ground-based NAVAIDs. Many of
the requirements of a specific airport and surrounding these approaches have been converted to stand-alone
terrain or airspace considerations negating the use of approaches, and the few that remain are identified by
the T approach design concept. The T design may be the name of the procedure and or GPS. These GPS non-
modified by the procedure designers where required by precision approaches are predicated upon the design

4-62
1,400 feet current and 1,000 feet previous

200 feet current


and previous Final a
50, pproac
200 h area

us
io t
fee

ev en
t cu

pr rr
et cu
rre
nt a

fe et
nd

00 fe
50,

,0 52
000

16 2,1
fee

1
t pr
evi
ous

ILS final approach criteria (for primary protected airspace)

Figure 4-41. ILS final approach segment design criteria.

The lowest authorized ILS minimums, with all required ground and airborne systems components operative, are:
CAT I - decision height (DH) 200 feet and runway visual range CAT IIIb - No DH or DH below 50 feet and RVR less than
(RVR) 2,400 feet (with touchdown zone and centerline lighting. 700 feet but not less than 150 feet.
RVR 1,800 feet). CAT IIIc - No DH and no RVR limitation.
CAT II - DH 100 feet and RVR 1,200 feet.
CAT IIIa - No DH or DH below 100 feet and RVR not less than NOTE: Special authorization and equipment are required
700 feet. for CAT II and III.
CAT I
Decision height (feet AGL)

200

CAT II
100

CAT IIIc
CAT IIIb CAT IIIa

0 150 700 1,200 1,800 2,400


Runway visual range (feet)

Figure 4-42. ILS approach categories.

4-63
criteria of the ground-based NAVAID used as the basis of considered part of the RNAV (GPS) approach classification
the approach. As such, they do not adhere to the RNAV for determining design criteria. [Figure 4-39 ]
design criteria for stand-alone GPS approaches, and are not

N
TIO
GA
NE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

NE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
OR
TF
NO

Figure 4-43. Category III approach procedure.

4-64
GPS Stand-Alone/RNAV (GPS) Approach For a non-vertically guided straight-in RNAV (GPS)
As of November 2010, there are approximately 419 GPS approach, the final approach course must be aligned within
stand-alone approaches throughout the country. The 15 of the extended runway centerline. The final approach
number of GPS stand-alone approaches continues to segment should not exceed 10 NM, and when it exceeds
decrease as they are replaced by RNAV approaches. RNAV 6 NM, a stepdown fix is typically incorporated. A minimum
(GPS) approaches are named so that airborne navigation of 250 feet obstacle clearance is also incorporated into the
databases can use either GPS or RNAV as the title of the final approach segment for straight-in approaches, and a
approach. This is required for non-GPS approach systems, maximum 400-feet per NM descent gradient is permitted.
such as VOR/DME based RNAV systems. In the past,
these approaches were often referred to as "stand-alone The approach design criteria are different for approaches
GPS" approaches. They are considered non-precision that use vertical guidance provided by a Baro-VNAV
approaches, offering only LNAV and circling minimums. system. Because the Baro-VNAV guidance is advisory and
Precision minimums are not authorized, although LNAV/ not primary, Baro-VNAV approaches are not authorized in
VNAV minimums may be published and used as long as areas of hazardous terrain, nor are they authorized when
the on-board system is capable of providing approach a remote altimeter setting is required. Due to the inherent
approved VNAV. The RNAV (GPS) Runway 14 approach for problems associated with barometric readings and cold
Lincoln, Nebraska, incorporates only LNAV and circling temperatures, these procedures are also temperature
minimums [Figure 4-40]. limited. Additional approach design criteria for RNAV
Approach Construction Criteria can be found in the

Independent Parallel Approaches


Simultaneous parallel approaches PRM approaches
Dependent Parallel Approaches (simultaneous close parallel)
Runway centerlines space 2,500 feet or greater Runway centerlines spaced 4,300 Runway centerlines spaced less than
Staggered approaches feet or greater (duals and trips) 4,300 feet (Duals)
Final monitor controller NOT required Final monitor controllers required Runways centerline spaced greater
than 4,300 feet (Triples)
FMC
PRM

27 27

27 27 27 No transgression zone 27
No transgression zone

Dependant Parallel Approaches Diagonal separation


Runway centerlines spaced 2,500 feet or greater
Radar monitoring required
Staggered approaches

27

27

Figure 4-44. Parallel (dependent) ILS approach separation criteria.

4-65
N
TIO
GA
SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
R
T FO
NO

Figure 4-45. Sacramento International KSMF, Sacramento, California, ILS RWY 16L.

4-66
Note indicates simultaneous (independent) approaches are authorized.

N
TIO
GA
SE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
R
T FO
NO

Figure 4-46. Charlotte Douglas International KCLT, Charlotte, North Carolina, ILS RWY 18.

4-67
appropriate FAA Order 8260-series directives. Multiple Navigation Sensors, or AC 20-138, Airworthiness
Approval of Positioning and Navigation Systems.
RNAV (GPS) Approach Using WAAS Precision approach capability will become available as more
WAAS was commissioned in July 2003, with IOC. Although GBAS (LAAS) approach types become operational. GBAS
precision approach capability is still in the future, initial (LAAS) further increases the accuracy of GPS and improves
WAAS currently provides a new type of APV known as signal integrity warnings. Precision approach capability
LPV. WAAS approaches consist of the following approach requires obstruction planes and approach lighting systems
types: LPV, LNAV/VNAV, and LNAV. Approach minimums to meet Part 77 standards for ILS approaches. This delays
as low as 200 feet HAT and 1/2 SM visibility is possible, the implementation of RNAV (GPS) precision approach
even though LPV is semi-precision and not considered a capability due to the cost of certifying each runway.
precision approach. WAAS covers 95 percent of the country
95 percent of the time. ILS Approaches
Notwithstanding emerging RNAV technology, the ILS is the
NOTE: WAAS avionics receive an airworthiness approval most precise and accurate approach NAVAID currently in
in accordance with Technical Standard Order (TSO) C-145, use throughout the NAS. An ILS CAT I precision approach
Airborne Navigation Sensors Using the (GPS) Augmented allows approaches to be made to 200 feet above the TDZE
by the Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS), or TSO- and with visibilities as low as 1,800 RVR; with CAT II and CAT
146, Stand-Alone Airborne Navigation Equipment Using III approaches allowing descents and visibility minimums
the Global Positioning System (GPS) Augmented by the that are even lower. Non-precision approach alternatives
Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS), and installed cannot begin to offer the precision or flexibility offered by
in accordance with AC 20-130, Airworthiness Approval an ILS. In order to further increase the approach capacity
of Navigation or Flight Management Systems Integrating of busy airports and exploit the maximum potential of ILS

Runway centerlines spaced 4,300 feet


or more [dual runways] or 5,000 feet
or more, [triple or quadruple runways] 3,200'
radar monitoring required.
2,200'

2,200'
3,2
00'
2,2
2,2 00'
Radar monitoring provided to ensure aircraft do
00
' no penetrate the no-transgression zone (NTZ)
Radar monitoring provided to
ensure aircraft do no penetrate
the no-transgression zone (NTZ)
NO
TR
AN
SG
RE
SS
IO

Intercept glideslope at 2,200 feet


N
ZO
NE
(N

26
TZ

L
)

26
26L
26R
R

Note: Extend radar monitoring and no-transgression zone (NTZ) to 7 NM


beyond runway departure end for quadruple simultaneous ILS approaches.

7 NM

Figure 4-47. Simultaneous parallel ILS approach criteria.

4-68
3,200 feet

Runway centerlines spaced less than


4,300 feet apart, radar monitoring and
PRM required

Radar monitoring provided to ensure


lateral or vertical separation between
aircraft on parallel localizers prior to
the beginning of the NTZ

2,200 feet

APUSA INT established where 3,200 feet


altitude intercepts glideslope NTZ begins

Intercept glideslope at 2,200 feet


NO
TRA
Radar monitoring provided to 0.5
NM beyond departure and to

NS
ensure separation during
simultaneous missed approaches

GR
ESS
26R

ION26L

ZO
NE
8L
(NT 8R

Z)
0.5 NM
0.5 NM

Figure 4-48. Simultaneous close parallel ILS approach ILS PRM criteria.

technology, many different applications are in use. azimuth course is required.

A single ILS system can accommodate 29 arrivals per hour In order to successfully accomplish parallel, simultaneous
on a single runway. Two or three parallel runways operating parallel, and converging ILS approaches, flight crews
consecutively can double or triple the capacity of the and ATC have additional responsibilities. When multiple
airport. For air commerce, this means greater flexibility instrument approaches are in use, ATC advises flight
in scheduling passenger and cargo service. Capacity is crews either directly or through ATIS. It is the pilots
increased through the use of parallel (dependent) ILS, responsibility to inform ATC if unable or unwilling to
simultaneous parallel (independent) ILS, simultaneous execute a simultaneous approach. Pilots must comply
close parallel (independent) ILS, precision runway with all ATC requests in a timely manner and maintain
monitor (PRM), and converging ILS approaches. A parallel strict radio discipline, including using complete aircraft
(dependent) approach differs from a simultaneous call signs. It is also incumbent upon the flight crew to
(independent) approach in that the minimum distance notify ATC immediately of any problems relating to aircraft
between parallel runway centerlines is reduced; there is communications or navigation systems. At the very least,
no requirement for radar monitoring or advisories; and a the approach procedure briefing should cover the entire
staggered separation of aircraft on the adjacent localizer/ approach procedure including the approach name, runway

4-69
NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

N
TIO
GA
VI
NA
NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


OR

Parallel runways used for PRM operations


TF
NO

Specifies dual VHF and additional information


NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

Figure 4-49. St Louis, Missouri, ILS PRM RWY 11.

4-70
number, frequencies, final approach course, glideslope well as special aircrew training and authorization. The
intercept altitude, DA or DH, and the missed approach OpSpecs of individual air carriers detail the requirements
instructions. The review of autopilot procedures is also of these types of approaches, as well as their performance
appropriate when making coupled ILS or MLS approaches. criteria. Lists of locations where each operator is approved
to conduct CAT II and III approaches can also be found in
As with all approaches, the primary navigation responsibility the OpSpecs.
falls upon the pilot in command. ATC instructions will be
limited to ensuring aircraft separation. Additionally, MAPs Special Authorization CAT I and Special Authorization CAT III
are normally designed to diverge in order to protect all are approaches designed to take advantage of advances in
involved aircraft. ILS approaches of all types are afforded flight deck avionics and technologies like Head-Up Displays
the same obstacle clearance protection and design (HUD) and automatic landings. There are extensive ground
criteria, no matter how capacity is affected by multiple ILS infrastructures and lighting requirements for standard CAT
approaches. [Figure 4-41 ] II/III, and the Special Authorization approaches mitigate
the lack of some lighting with the modern avionics found
ILS Approach Categories in many aircraft today. Similar to standard CAT II/III, an air
There are three general classifications of ILS approaches: carrier must be specifically authorized to conduct Special
CAT I, CAT II, and CAT III (autoland). The basic ILS approach is Authorization CAT I/II in OpSpecs Part C.
a CAT I approach and requires only that pilots be instrument
rated and current, and that the aircraft be equipped ILS Approaches To Parallel Runways
appropriately. CAT II and CAT III ILS approaches typically Airports that have two or three parallel runways may be
have lower minimums and require special certification for authorized to use parallel approaches to maximize the
operators, pilots, aircraft, and airborne/ground equipment. capacity of the airport. There are three classifications
Because of the complexity and high cost of the equipment, of parallel ILS approaches, depending on the runway
CAT III ILS approaches are used primarily in air carrier and centerline separation and ATC procedures.
military operations. [Figure 4-42 ]
Parallel (Dependent) ILS Approaches
CAT II and III Approaches Parallel (dependent) ILS approaches are allowed at airports
The primary authorization and minimum RVRs allowed with parallel runways that have centerlines separated by
for an air carrier to conduct CAT II and III approaches at least 2,500 feet. Aircraft are allowed to fly ILS and other
can be found in OpSpecs Part C. CAT II and III operations approaches to parallel runways; however, the aircraft must
allow authorized pilots to make instrument approaches in be staggered by a minimum of 112 NM diagonally. Aircraft
weather that would otherwise be prohibitive. are staggered by 2 NM diagonally for runway centerlines
that are separated by more than 4,300 feet and up to but
While CAT I ILS operations permit substitution of midfield not including 9,000 feet, and that do not have final monitor
RVR for TDZ RVR (when TDZ RVR is not available), CAT II ILS air traffic controllers. Radar separation is provided between
operations do not permit any substitutions for TDZ RVR. aircraft participating in parallel (dependent) approach
The TDZ RVR system is required and must be used. The TDZ operations. [Figure 4-44 ] Recently, RNAV procedures with
RVR is controlling for all CAT II ILS operations. vertical guidance will be permitted to participate in all
parallel (dependent) approach operations.
The weather conditions encountered in CAT III operations
range from an area where visual references are adequate Where this type of approach is approved, each approach
for manual rollout in CAT IIIa, to an area where visual plate indicates the other runway with which simultaneous
references are inadequate even for taxi operations in CAT approaches can be conducted. For example, Simultaneous
IIIc. To date, no U.S. operator has received approval for CAT approaches authorized with runway 12L. Until the
IIIc in OpSpecs. Depending on the auto-flight systems, approach plates for all such runway pairs can be modified
some airplanes require a DH to ensure that the airplane is to include this note, P-NOTAMS will be issued identifying
going to land in the TDZ and some require an Alert Height such operations. ATC normally communicates an advisory
as a final cross-check of the performance of the auto-flight over ATIS that parallel approach procedures are in effect.
systems. These heights are based on radio altitude (RA) and For example, pilots flying into Sacramento, California, may
can be found in the specific aircrafts AFM. [Figure 4-43 ] encounter parallel approach procedures. [Figure 4-45 ]

Both CAT II and III approaches require special ground and Simultaneous Parallel ILS Approaches
airborne equipment to be installed and operational, as Simultaneous parallel ILS approaches are used at authorized

4-71
SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

N
TIO
GA
VI
NA
SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


OR
TF
NO

SW-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

Figure 4-50. Simultaneous offset instrument approach procedure.

4-72
NE-3, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

NE-3, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

Figure 4-51. Converging approach criteria.

4-73
N
TIO
Indicates runways authorized for converging approach operations

GA
SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
OR
TF
NO

Figure 4-52. Dallas-Fort Worth KDFW, Dallas-Fort Worth, Texas, CONVERGING ILS RWY 35C.

4-74
N
IO
AT
G
VI
NA
On-airport VOR facility
SE-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SE-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


FO
T
NO

Figure 4-53. Fort Rucker, Alabama, KOZR VOR RWY 6.

airports that have between 4,300 feet and 9,000 feet elevation. Additionally, for triple parallel approaches above
separation between runway centerlines. A dedicated final airport elevations of 1,000 feet MSL, ASR with high-resolution
monitor controller is required to monitor separation for this final monitor aids or high update RADAR with associated
type of approach, which eliminates the need for staggered final monitor aids is required.
approaches. Final monitor controllers track aircraft positions
and issue instructions to pilots of aircraft observed deviating As a part of the simultaneous parallel approach approval,
from the LOC course. [Figure 4-46 ] As of March 2010, normal operating zones (NOZ) and no-transgression zones
RNAV approach procedures with vertical guidance will (NTZ) must be established to ensure proper flight track
be permitted to conduct simultaneous parallel approach boundaries for all aircraft. The NOZ is the operating zone
operations. within which aircraft remain during normal approach
operations. The NOZ is typically no less than 1,400 feet
Triple simultaneous approaches are authorized provided the wide, with 700 feet of space on either side of the runway
runway centerlines are separated by at least 5,000 feet, or centerline. A NTZ is a 2,000-foot wide area located between
4,300 feet with PRM, and are below 1,000 feet MSL airport the parallel runway final approach courses. It is equidistant

4-75
ON
TI
GA
SC-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SC-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


AEX VOR is an off-airport facility
NA
R
FO

FAF
T
NO

Figure 4-54. Alexandria International (AEX), Alexandria, Louisiana, KAEX VOR DME RWY 32.

4-76
between the runways and indicates an area within which later in this chapter.
flight is not authorized. [Figure 4-47 ] Any time an aircraft
breaches the NTZ, ATC issues instructions for all aircraft to The PRM system provides the ability to accomplish
break off the approach to avoid potential conflict. simultaneous close parallel (independent) ILS approaches
and enables reduced delays and fuel savings during reduced
Simultaneous Close Parallel ILS Precision visibility operations. It is also the safest method of increasing
Runway Monitor Approaches ILS capacity through the use of parallel approaches. The
Simultaneous close parallel (independent) ILS PRM PRM system incorporates high-update radar with one
approaches are authorized for use at airports that have second or better update time and a high resolution ATC
parallel runways separated by at least 3,400 feet and no radar display that contains automated tracking software
more than 4,300 feet. [Figure 4-48 ] They are also approved that can track aircraft in real time. Position and velocity is
for airports with parallel runways separated by at least 3,000 updated each second and a ten second projected position
feet with an offset LOC where the offset angle is at least is displayed. The system also incorporates visual and aural
2.5 but no more than 3. Other offset LOC approaches to alerts for the controllers.
lesser runway spacing are referred to as Simultaneous Offset
Instrument Approaches (SOIA) and are discussed in depth Approval for ILS PRM approaches requires the airport to

N
I O
A T
I G
A V
N
R On-airport NDB facility

O
SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SC-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

F
T
N O

Figure 4-55. Carthage/Panola County-Sharpe Field, Carthage, Texas, (K4F2), NDB RWY 35.

4-77
N
TIO
GA
SW-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SW-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
On-airport NDB facility
NDB/DME FAF
OR

FAF
TF
NO

Figure 4-56. Tucson/Ryan Field, Tuscson, Arizona, (KRYN), NDB/DME or GPS RWY 6R.

4-78
have a precision runway monitoring system and a final Listen concurrently to the tower and the PRM
monitor controller who can only communicate with aircraft monitor to avoid missed instructions from stuck
on the final approach course. Additionally, two tower mikes or blocked transmissions. The final ATC
frequencies are required to be used and the controller controller can override the radio frequency if
broadcasts over both frequencies to reduce the chance of necessary.
instructions being missed. Pilot training is also required for Broadcast only over the main tower frequency.
pilots using the PRM system. Part 121 and 135 operators are
required to complete training that includes the viewing of Disengage the autopilot for breakouts because
videos. The FAA PRM website (http://www.faa.gov/training hand- flown breakouts are quicker.
_testing/training/prm) contains training information for Set the Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance System
PRM approaches and is a location from which the videos (TCAS) to the appropriate TA (traffic advisory) or
can be seen and/or downloaded. RA (resolution advisory) mode in compliance with
current operational guidance on the attention all
When pilots or flight crews wish to decline a PRM approach, users page (AAUP), or other authorized guidance
ATC must be notified immediately and the flight will be (i.e., approved flight manual, flight operations
transitioned into the area at the convenience of ATC. Pilots manual. It is important to note that descending
who are unable to accept a PRM approach may be subject breakouts may be issued. Additionally, flight crews
to delays. are never issued breakout instructions that clear
them below the MVA, and they are not required to
The approach chart for the PRM approach typically requires descend at more than 1,000 fpm.
two pages and outlines pilot, aircraft, and procedure
requirements necessary to participate in PRM operations. Simultaneous Offset Instrument Approaches
[Figure 4-49 ] Pilots need to be aware of the differences (SOIAs)
associated with this type of ILS approach which are listed SOIAs allow simultaneous approaches to two parallel
below: runways spaced at least 750 feet apart, but less than 3,000
Immediately follow break out instructions as soon feet. The SOIA procedure utilizes an ILS/PRM approach
as safety permits. to one runway and an offset localizer-type directional
aid (LDA)/PRM approach with glideslope to the adjacent

N1
RADAR MINS

O N
I
10266

T
RADAR INSTRUMENT APPROACH MINIMUMS

ASHEVILLE, NC

G A
I
A m dt. 5 A , N O V 1 8 , 1 9 9 8 ( F A A ) E L E V 2165
ASHEVILLE RGNL
RADAR - 124.65 269.575
HAT/

A V HAT/

N
DA/ HATh/ DA/ HATh/
RWY GS/TCH/RPI CAT MDA-VIS HAA CEIL-VIS CAT MDA-VIS HAA CEIL-VIS
ASR 34 AB 2800 /24 660 (700-) C 2800 /60 660 (700-1)

R
D 2800 -1 660 (700-1)

O
16 A 3000 /50 835 (900-1) B 3000 /60 835 (900-1)
C 3000 -2 835 (900-2) D 3000 -2 835 (900-2)

F
C IR C L IN G A 3000 -1 835 (900-1) B 3000 -1 835 (900-1)
C 3000 -2 835 (900-2) D 3000 -2 835 (900-2)

T
NO
Circling not authorized west of Rwy 16-34. Night circling not authorized.

BEAUFORT, SC A m dt. 3 A , N O V 2 0 , 2 0 0 8 ( F A A ) E L E V 10
BEAUFORT COUNTY
RADAR -1 118.45 292.125 NA
16 DEC

N 2011

HAT/ HAT/
DA/ HATh/ DA/ HATh/
RWY GS/TCH/RPI CAT MDA-VIS HAA CEIL-VIS CAT MDA-VIS HAA CEIL-VIS

Figure 4-57. Asheville Regional KAVL, Asheville, North Carolina, radar instrument approach minimums.

4-79
3.0
2. 5 -
34:1 visual segment eslope
Glid
CS)
ace (O
e surf
Ground point of intercept (GPI) ranc
le clea
Obstac

954

Figure 4-58. PAR final approach area criteria.

runway. The use of PRM technology is also required with be able to visually separate intersecting runway traffic.
these operations; therefore, the approach charts will
include procedural notes, such as Simultaneous approach Approaches to intersecting runways also have higher
authorized with LDA PRM RWY XXX. San Francisco had the minimums with a 700-foot minimum and no less than 2
first published SOIA approach. [Figure 4-50 ] SM visibility. Pilots are informed of the use of converging
ILS approaches by the controller upon initial contact or
The training, procedures, and system requirements for through ATIS. [Figure 4-51 ]
SOIA ILS/PRM and LDA/PRM approaches are identical
with those used for simultaneous close parallel ILS/PRM Dallas/Fort Worth International airport is one of the few
approaches until near the LDA/PRM approach MAP, where airports that makes use of converging ILS approaches
visual acquisition of the ILS aircraft by the LDA aircraft must because its runway configuration has multiple parallel
be accomplished. If visual acquisition is not accomplished runways and two offset runways. [Figure 4-52 ] The
prior to reaching the LDA MAP , a missed approach must approach chart title indicates the use of converging
be executed. A visual segment for the LDA/PRM approach approaches and the notes section highlights other runways
is established between the LDA MAP and the runway that are authorized for converging approach procedures.
threshold. Aircraft transition in visual conditions from
the LDA course, beginning at the LDA MAP, to align with VOR Approach
the runway and can be stabilized by 500 feet AGL on the The VOR is one of the most widely used non-precision
extended runway centerline. Pilots are reminded that they approach types in the NAS. VOR approaches use VOR
are responsible for collision avoidance and wake turbulence facilities both on and off the airport to establish approaches
mitigation between the LDA MAP and the runway. and include the use of a wide variety of equipment, such
as DME and TACAN. Due to the wide variety of options
The FAA website has additional information about PRM included in a VOR approach, TERPS outlines design criteria
and SOIA, including instructional videos at http://www. for both on and off airport VOR facilities, as well as VOR
faa.gov/training_testing/training/prm. approaches with and without a FAF. Despite the various
configurations, all VOR approaches are non-precision
Converging ILS Approaches approaches, require the presence of properly operating
Another method by which ILS approach capacity can be VOR equipment, and can provide MDAs as low as 250 feet
increased is through the use of converging approaches. above the runway. VOR also offers a flexible advantage in
Converging approaches may be established at airports that an approach can be made toward or away from the
that have runways with an angle between 15 and 100 navigational facility.
and each runway must have an ILS. Additionally, separate
procedures must be established for each approach, and The VOR approach into Fort Rucker, Alabama, is an example
each approach must have a MAP at least 3 NM apart with of a VOR approach where the VOR facility is on the airport
no overlapping of the protected missed approach airspace. and there is no specified FAF. [Figure 4-53 ] For a straight-
Only straight-in approaches are approved for converging in approach, the final approach course is typically aligned
ILS procedures. If the runways intersect, the controller must to intersect the extended runway centerline 3,000 feet
from the runway threshold, and the angle of convergence
4-80
N
T IO
GA
SC-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SC-4, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-59. Vicksburg Tallulah Regional KTVR, Tallulah Vicksburg, Louisiana, LOC RWY 36.

4-81
ON
TI
GA
SE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

SE-2, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-60. Davidson County KEXX, Lexington, North Carolina, LOC DME RWY 6.

4-82
ON
TI
GA
SE-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

VI

SE-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-61. Dayton Beach International DAB, Dayton Beach, Florida, LOC BC RWY 25R.

4-83
between the two does not exceed 30. This type of VOR mile of any portion of usable landing surface for circling
approach also includes a minimum of 300 feet of obstacle approaches. The final approach segment of the approach
clearance in the final approach area. The final approach is designed with a final approach area that is 2.5 NM wide
area criteria include a 2 NM wide primary area at the facility at the facility and increases to 8 NM wide at 10 NM from
that expands to 6 NM wide at a distance of 10 NM from the facility. Additionally, the final approach course and
the facility. Additional approach criteria are established the extended runway centerline angle of convergence
for courses that require a high altitude teardrop approach cannot exceed 30 for straight-in approaches. This type of
penetration. NDB approach is afforded a minimum of 350 feet obstacle
clearance.
When DME is included in the title of the VOR approach,
operable DME must be installed in the aircraft in order to When a FAF is established for an NDB approach, the
fly the approach from the FAF. The use of DME allows for an approach design criteria changes. It also takes into account
accurate determination of position without timing, which whether or not the NDB is located on or off the airport.
greatly increases situational awareness throughout the Additionally, this type of approach can be made both
approach. Alexandria, Louisiana, is an excellent example moving toward or away from the NDB facility. The Tuscon
of a VOR/DME approach in which the VOR is off the airport Ryan Field, NDB/DME RWY 6 is an approach with a FAF
and a FAF is depicted. [Figure 4-54 ] In this case, the final using an on-airport NDB facility that also incorporates the
approach course is a radial or straight-in final approach and use of DME. [Figure 4-56 ] In this case, the NDB has DME
is designed to intersect the runway centerline at the runway capabilities from the LOC approach system installed on the
threshold with the angle of convergence not exceeding 30. airport. While the alignment criteria and obstacle clearance
remain the same as an NDB approach without a FAF, the
The criteria for an arc final approach segment associated final approach segment area criteria changes to an area that
with a VOR/DME approach is based on the arc being is 2.5 NM wide at the facility and increases to 5 NM wide,
beyond 7 NM and no farther than 30 NM from the VOR 15 NM from the NDB.
and depends on the angle of convergence between the
runway centerline and the tangent of the arc. Obstacle Radar Approaches
clearance in the primary area, which is considered the area The two types of radar approaches available to pilots when
4 NM on either side of the arc centerline, is guaranteed by operating in the NAS are precision approach radar (PAR) and
at least 500 feet. airport surveillance radar (ASR). Radar approaches may be
given to any aircraft at the pilots request. ATC may also offer
NDB Approach radar approach options to aircraft in distress regardless of
Like the VOR approach, an NDB approach can be designed the weather conditions or as necessary to expedite traffic.
using facilities both on and off the airport, with or without Despite the control exercised by ATC in a radar approach
a FAF, and with or without DME availability. At one time, environment, it remains the pilots responsibility to ensure
it was commonplace for an instrument student to learn the approach and landing minimums listed for the approach
how to fly an NDB approach, but with the growing use of are appropriate for the existing weather conditions
GPS, many pilots no longer use the NDB for instrument considering personal approach criteria certification and
approaches. New RNAV approaches are also rapidly being company OpSpecs.
constructed into airports that are served only by NDB. The
long-term plan includes the gradual phase out of NDB Perhaps the greatest benefit of either type of radar approach
facilities, and eventually, the NDB approach becomes is the ability to use radar to execute a no gyro approach.
nonexistent. Until that time, the NDB provides additional Assuming standard rate turns, ATC can indicate when to
availability for instrument pilots into many smaller, remotely begin and end turns. If available, pilots should make use of
located airports. this approach when the heading indicator has failed and
partial panel instrument flying is required.
The NDB Runway 35 approach at Carthage/Panola County
Sharpe Field is an example of an NDB approach established Information about radar approaches is published in tabular
with an on-airport NDB that does not incorporate a FAF. form in the front of the TPP booklet. PAR, ASR, and circling
[Figure 4-55 ] In this case, a procedure turn or penetration approach information including runway, DA, DH, or MDA,
turn is required to be a part of the approach design. For height above airport (HAA), HAT, ceiling, and visibility criteria
the NDB to be considered an on-airport facility, the facility are outlined and listed by specific airport.
must be located within one mile of any portion of the
landing runway for straight-in approaches and within one Regardless of the type of radar approach in use, ATC

4-84
ON
TI
GA
NE-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

NE-1, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-62. Hartford Brainard KHFD, Hartford, Connecticut, LDA RWY 2.

4-85
ON
TI
GA
NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011

NC-3, 16 DEC 2010 to 13 JAN 2011


VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 4-63. Lebanon Floyd W Jones, Lebonon, Missouri, SDF RWY 36.

4-86
monitors aircraft position and issues specific heading The final approach course for an ASR approach is aligned
and altitude information throughout the entire approach. with the runway centerline for straight-in approaches
Particularly, lost communications procedures should and aligned with the center of the airport for circling
be briefed prior to execution to ensure pilots have a approaches. Within the final approach area, the pilot is also
comprehensive understanding of ATC expectations if radio guaranteed a minimum of 250 feet obstacle clearance. ASR
communication were lost. ATC also provides additional descent gradients are designed to be relatively flat, with an
information concerning weather and missed approach optimal gradient of 150 feet per mile and never exceeding
instructions when beginning a radar approach. [Figure 300 feet per mile.
4-57 ]
Localizer Approaches
Precision Approach Radar (PAR) As an approach system, the localizer is an extremely flexible
PAR provides both vertical and lateral guidance, as well as approach aid that, due to its inherent design, provides
range, much like an ILS, making it the most precise radar many applications for a variety of needs in instrument
approach available. The radar approach, however, is not flying. An ILS glideslope installation may be impossible due
able to provide visual approach indications in the flight to surrounding terrain. For whatever reason, the localizer
deck. This requires the flight crew to listen and comply is able to provide four separate applications from one
with controller instructions. PAR approaches are rare, with approach system:
most of the approaches used in a military setting; any
opportunity to practice this type of approach is beneficial Localizer approach
to any flight crew.
Localizer/DME approach
The final approach course of a PAR approach is normally Localizer back course approach
aligned with the runway centerline, and the associated Localizer-type directional aid (LDA)
glideslope is typically no less than 2.5 and no more than 3.
Obstacle clearance for the final approach area is based on
the particular established glideslope angle and the exact
Localizer and Localizer DME
The localizer approach system can provide both precision
formula is outlined in Order 8260.3, Volume 3, Chapter 3.
and non-precision approach capabilities to a pilot. As a part
[Figure 4-58 ] practice this type of approach is beneficial
of the ILS system, the localizer provides horizontal guidance
to any flight crew.
for a precision approach. Typically, when the localizer is
The final approach course of a PAR approach is normally
discussed, it is thought of as a non-precision approach
aligned with the runway centerline, and the associated
due to the fact that either it is the only approach system
glideslope is typically no less than 2.5 and no more than 3.
installed, or the glideslope is out of service on the ILS. In
Obstacle clearance for the final approach area is based on
either case, the localizer provides a non-precision approach
the particular established glideslope angle and the exact
using a localizer transmitter installed at a specific airport.
formula is outlined in Order 8260.3, Volume 3, Chapter 3.
[Figure 4-59 ]
[Figure 4-56]
TERPS provides the same alignment criteria for a localizer
Airport Surveillance Radar (ASR)
approach as it does for the ILS, since it is essentially the
ASR approaches are typically only approved when
same approach without vertical guidance stemming from
necessitated for an ATC operational requirement or in an
the glideslope. A localizer is always aligned within 3 of the
unusual or emergency situation. This type of radar only
runway, and it is afforded a minimum of 250 feet obstacle
provides heading and range information, although the
clearance in the final approach area. In the case of a
controller can advise the pilot of the altitude where the
localizer DME (LOC DME) approach, the localizer installation
aircraft should be based on the distance from the runway.
has a collocated DME installation that provides distance
An ASR approach procedure can be established at any radar
information required for the approach. [Figure 4-60 ]
facility that has an antenna within 20 NM of the airport
and meets the equipment requirements outlined in FAA
Order 8200.1, U.S. Standard Flight Inspection Manual. ASR
Localizer Back Course
In cases where an ILS is installed, a back course may be
approaches are not authorized for use when Center Radar
available in conjunction with the localizer. Like the localizer,
ARTS processing (CENRAP) procedures are in use due to
the back course does not offer a glideslope, but remember
diminished radar capability.
that the back course can project a false glideslope signal
and the glideslope should be ignored. Reverse sensing

4-87
occurs on the back course using standard VOR equipment. The approach techniques and procedures used in an SDF
With a horizontal situation indicator (HSI) system, reverse instrument approach are essentially the same as those
sensing is eliminated if it is set appropriately to the front employed in executing a standard localizer approach
course. [Figure 4-61 ] except the SDF course may not be aligned with the runway
and the course may be wider, resulting in less precision.
Localizer-Type Directional Aid (LDA) Like the LOC type approaches, the SDF is an alternative
The LDA is of comparable use and accuracy to a localizer approach that may be installed at an airport for a variety
but is not part of a complete ILS. The LDA course usually of reasons, including terrain. The final approach is provided
provides a more precise approach course than the similar a minimum of 250 feet obstacle clearance for straight-in
simplified directional facility (SDF) installation, which may approaches while in the final approach area, which is an
have a course width of 6 or 12. area defined for a 6 course: 1,000 feet at or abeam the
runway threshold expanding to 19,228 feet (10 NM) from
The LDA is not aligned with the runway. Straight-in the threshold. The same final approach area for a 12
minimums may be published where alignment does course is larger. This type of approach is also designed
not exceed 30 between the course and runway. Circling with a maximum descent gradient of 400 feet per NM,
minimums only are published where this alignment unless circling only minimums are authorized.of reasons,
exceeds 30. including terrain. The final approach is provided a minimum
of 250 feet obstacle clearance for straight-in approaches
A very limited number of LDA approaches also incorporate while in the final approach area, which is an area defined
a glideslope. These are annotated in the plan view of the for a 6 course: 1,000 feet at or abeam the runway threshold
instrument approach chart with a note, LDA/Glideslope. expanding to 19,228 feet (10 NM) from the threshold. The
These procedures fall under a newly defined category of same final approach area for a 12 course is larger. This type
approaches called Approach (Procedure) with Vertical of approach is also designed with a maximum descent
Guidance (aviation) APVs. LDA minima for with and without gradient of 400 feet per NM, unless circling only minimums
glideslope is provided and annotated on the minima lines are authorized.
of the approach chart as SLDA/GS and SLDA. Because
the final approach course is not aligned with the runway
centerline, additional maneuvering is required compared
to an ILS approach. [Figure 4-62 ]

Simplified Directional Facility (SDF)


The SDF provides a final approach course similar to that of
the ILS localizer. It does not provide glideslope information.
A clear understanding of the ILS localizer and the additional
factors listed below completely describe the operational
characteristics and use of the SDF. [Figure 4-63 ]

4-88
Chapter 5

Improvement Plans
Introduction
In the upcoming years, exciting new technologies will
be developed and implemented to help ease air traffic
congestion, add to system capacity, and enhance safety.
Some of these seamless changes will be invisible to
pilots. Others will entail learning new procedures, aircraft
equipment, and systems that will introduce powerful new
capabilities and dramatically increase the safety of all flight
operations.

5-1
Next Generation Air Transportation (NextGen) a wide-range transformation of the entire United States air
System transportation system. NextGen consists of the following
five systems:
Next Generation Air Transportation System (NextGen) is a
comprehensive overhaul of the National Airspace System 1. Automatic dependent surveillance-broadcast
(NAS) designed to make air travel more convenient and (ADS-B)will use the global positioning system
dependable, while ensuring flights are as safe and secure (GPS) satellite signals to provide air traffic control
as possible. It moves away from ground-based surveillance (ATC) and pilots with more accurate information
and navigation to new and more dynamic satellite-based that keeps aircraft safely separated in the sky and on
systems and procedures, and introduces new technological runways. [Figure 5-3] Aircraft transponders receive
innovations in areas such as weather forecast, digital GPS signals and use them to determine the aircrafts
communications, and networking. [Figure 5-1] When fully precise position in the sky. This and other data is
implemented, NextGen will safely allow aircraft to fly more then broadcast to other aircraft and ATC. Once fully
closely together on more direct routes, reducing delays, established, both pilots and ATC will, for the first
and providing unprecedented benefits for the environment time, see the same real-time display of air traffic,
and the economy through reductions in carbon emissions, substantially improving safety. The FAA will mandate
fuel consumption, and noise. [Figure 5-2] the avionics necessary for implementing ADS-B.
2. System wide information management (SWIM)
Implementation in stages across the United States is due will provide a single infrastructure and information
between 2012 and 2025. In order to implement NextGen, management system to deliver high quality, timely
the Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) will undertake data to many users and applications. By reducing

DHS DOC
DOD NASA
FAA OSTP
State/Local NGATS
DOT Government Institute
Industry &
Community

Air Navigation Operations and Support

ICAO Flight Operations and Support

Global
Harmonization

Super Density Policy & Regulations


Operations

Equivalent
Visual Operations

Airport Operations and Support

Aeronautical Geospatial Performance


Flight Planning Flight Data Communication
Information Information Metrics
Enterprise Services
Layered Position, Navigation,
Environment Surveillance Safety Weather
Adaptive Security and Timing
Net Centric Infrastructure Services Network-Enabled Information Acess

Figure 5-1. Next Generation Air Transportation System (NEXGEN) introduces new technological innovations for weather forecasting,
digital communications, and networking.

5-2
Figure 5-2. Satellite-based navigation and tracking allows more aircraft to fly closely together on more direct routes.

crew requests, and reports. With the majority of


aircraft data link equipped, the exchange of routine
controller-pilot messages and clearances via data
link will enable controllers to handle more traffic.
This will improve ATC productivity, enhancing
capacity and safety. [Figure 5-5]
4. Next generation network enabled weather
(NNEW ) seventy percent of NAS delays are
attributed to weather every year. The goal of NNEW
is to cut weather-related delays at least in half. Tens
of thousands of global weather observations and
sensor reports from ground, airborne, and space-
based sources will fuse into a single national weather
information system updated in real time. NNEW
will provide a common weather picture across the
NAS and enable better air transportation decision-
Figure 5-3. Automatic Dependent Surveillance-Broadcast (ADS-B)
making. [Figure 5-6]
systems.
5. NAS voice switch (NVS)there are currently
the number and types of interfaces and systems, seventeen different voice switching systems in the
SWIM will reduce data redundancy and better NAS; some in use for more than twenty years. NVS
facilitate multi- user information sharing. SWIM will replace these systems with a single air/ground
will also enable new modes of decision-making as and ground/ground voice communications system.
information is more easily accessed. [Figure 5-4] [Figure 5-7]
3. Next generation data communicationscurrent
communications between aircrew and ATC, and NextGen Existing Improvements
between air traffic controllers, are largely realized The goal of NextGen is to provide new capabilities that
through voice communications. Initially, the make air transportation safer and more reliable while
introduction of data communications will provide improving the capacity of the NAS and reducing aviations
an additional means of two-way communication impact on the environment. Below is a list of some of the
for ATC clearances, instructions, advisories, flight capabilities for operational use that have already been

5-3
Today Enterprise Management
Existing systems communication Secure access points for NAS systems
structure and data sharing

En Route Data

Surveillance Weather

SWIM
Terminal Core
Radar Data Data Services

Traffic Flow
Inter-Agency
Management

Aeronautical
Information

Figure 5-4. System wide information management (SWIM)an information management system that helps deliver high quality, timely
data to improve the efficiency of the national airspace.

AR
TR TC
Trajectory Based Operations AC CS
High Performance Airspeed TO ON
W
ER S
S

Clearances WX Reroutes

Time Based Metering

Fix

Optimized
Descents
(TAPs/CDAs)
ARTCCs

VDL-2
Network VDL-2
User Flight
Operations
Control Tower
ARTCSCC
Taxi Instructions TRACONs

Digital ATIS Departure Clearance

Figure 5-5. Next generation data communications provides an additional means of two-way communication for ATC clearances,
instructions, advisories, flight crew requests, and reports.

5-4
Figure 5-6. Next generation network enabled weather (NNEW) provides a common weather picture across the NAS.

implemented through NextGen.


1. Starting in December 2009, the FAA began
controlling air traffic over the Gulf of Mexico, an
area of active airspace where surveillance was
never before possible, using the satellite-based
technology of ADS-B. [Figure 5-8] Having a real-time
visual representation of aircraft flying over the Gulf
of Mexico, where no radar coverage was available,
means that ATC can safely and more efficiently
separate air traffic. It also provides pilots with
more safety benefits such as improved situational
awareness (SA), new weather information, and
additional voice communications.
2. Initial operating capability was achieved for ADS-B
at Louisville, Kentucky, where ADS-B was integrated
into the Common Automated Radar Terminal
System.
Figure 5-7. National airspace voice switch (NVS) will replace 3. Satellite-based technologies, including the Wide
existing voice switching systems with single air/ground and ground/ Area Augmentation System (WAAS), are improving
ground voice communication systems. access to runways at both large and small airports.
34

f Domestic/oceanic cruise
of D
es
ke ce
Ta nt
Flight planning Push back xi Final approach/landing
Ta

Figure 5-8. ADS-B, is being used to provide ATC surveillance over the Gulf of Mexico.

5-5
GPS satellites

Barrow

Kotzebue
Fairbanks Iqaluit
Bethel
Anchorage
Juneau
Cold Bay
Goose Bay

Winnipeg Gander

Auburn
Billings Farmington Nashua
Olathe
Ronkonkoma
Freemont Oberlin
Salt Lake Aurora
Longmont Leesburg

Palmdale Memphis
Fort Worth Hampton
Albuquerque Houston Jacksonville

Miami
San Jose Del Cabo San Juan
Honolulu Puert Vallarta Merida
GEO satellite Mexico City
Tapachula

Legend
GEO satellite
Wide-area reference station (WRS) New WRSs
Wide-area master station (WMS) Ground uplink station

Figure 5-9. Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS).

[Figure 5-9] Directions and maps have been published Colorado. This allows air traffic to be safely separated
for more than 500 precision-like approaches by five miles whereas before each aircraft had to clear
enabled by WAAS. Localizer performance with the airspace around the airport before the next could
vertical guidance (LPV ) procedures improves enter.
access to airports in lower visibility conditions and 6. New runways at Chicago OHare, Washington
where obstacles are present. These procedures Dulles, and Seattle-Tacoma Airports opened in
are particularly valuable for smaller airports used November of 2008, which are now beginning to
by general aviation. There are now nearly 1,100 have a reduction in delays.
LPV procedures available at runways where no
instrument landing system (ILS) is present. Benefits of NextGen
4. The Ground-Based Augmentation System (GBAS) has The implementation of NextGen will allow pilots and
been approved for Category I operations and the dispatchers to select their own direct flightpaths, rather
first satellite-based system has been approved for than follow the existing Victor, Jet, and LF/MF airways. Each
this category of precision approach which enables airplane will transmit and receive precise information about
instrument-based operations down to 200 feet the time at which it and others will cross key points along
above the surface even during reduced visibility. their paths. Pilots and air traffic managers on the ground
[Figure 5-10] GBAS was installed at Memphis, will have the same precise information transmitted via data
Tennessee and Newark, New Jersey airport in 2009. communications.
5. Multilateration, a ground-based surveillance
technology, is being implemented to help improve Major demand and capacity imbalances will be worked
runway access. The FAA installed and is now using collaboratively between FAA air traffic managers and flight
wide area multilateration (WAM) systems to control operations. The increased scope, volume, and widespread
air traffic in Juneau, Alaska, and at four airports in distribution of information by SWIM will improve decision-

5-6
GPS satellites

Ranging sources
GBAS ground facility

GBAS reference receivers

tion
informa
Status

path definition
ections, integrity data and
Differential corr

Omnidirectional VHF data broadcast (VDB) signal

Figure 5-10. Ground-Based Augmentation System (GBAS).

making and let more civil aviation authorities participate. fly precise routes into and out of many airports to increase
The impact of weather on flight operations will be reduced throughput. For more information on NextGen, visit www.
through the use of improved information sharing, new faa.gov/nextgen.
technology to sense and mitigate the impacts of the
weather, and to improve weather forecasts and decision- Head-Up Displays (HUD)
making. Better forecasts, coupled with greater automation, As aircraft became more sophisticated and electronic
will minimize airspace limitations and traffic restrictions. instrument landing systems (ILS) were developed in the
1930s and 1940s, it was necessary while landing in poor
The new procedures of NextGen will improve airport weather for one pilot to monitor the instruments to keep
surface movements, reduce spacing and separation the aircraft aligned with radio beams while the second pilot
requirements, and better manage the overall flows into divided time between monitoring the instruments and
and out of busy airspace, as well as provide maximum use the outside environment. The pilot monitoring reported
of busy airports. [Figure 5-11] Targeting NextGen at the the runway environment in sight and the flying pilot
whole of the NAS, rather than just the busiest airports, completed the approach visually. This is still the standard
practice used for passenger carrying aircraft in commercial
service while making ILS landings. As single-piloted aircraft
became more complex, it became very difficult for pilots
to focus on flying the aircraft while also monitoring a large
number of navigation, flight, and systems instruments. To
overcome this problem, the head-up display (HUD) was
developed. By showing airspeed, altitude, heading, and
aircraft attitude on the HUD glass, pilots were able to keep
their eyes outside of the flight deck rather than have to
continuously scan from outside to inside to view the flight
instruments. [Figure 5-12] Collimators make the image on
the glass appear to be far out in front of the aircraft so that
the pilot need not change eye focus to view the relatively
Figure 5-11. NextGen improves airport surface movements, reduces
nearby HUD. Todays head-up guidance systems (HGS)
spacing and separation requirements, and better manages the
use holographic displays. [Figure 5-13] Everything from
overall flows into and out of busy airports.
weapons status to approach information can be shown
on current military and civilian HGS displays.
will uncover untapped capacity across the whole system.
During busy traffic periods, NextGen will rely on aircraft to

5-7
160 7800
10

140
220 7600
20
11 4 240 75
00
100
10 7400
80

60 7200
Figure 5-14. A synthetic vision system (SVS) is an electronic means to
display a synthetic vision image of the external scene topography to the
flight crew to assist during takeoffs, landings, and en route operations.

Figure 5-12. Head-up guidance system (HGS).

Figure 5-15. An aircraft on an approach equipped with a SVS.

This is particularly useful during critical phases of flight,


Figure 5-13. HGS using a holographic display. such as takeoff, approach, and landing where important
features such as terrain, obstacles, runways, and landmarks
Synthetic and Enhanced Vision Systems may be depicted on the SVS display. [Figure 5-15] During
Synthetic Vision System (SVS) approach operations, the obvious advantages of SVS are
A synthetic vision system (SVS) is an electronic means that the digital terrain image remains on the pilots display
to display a synthetic vision image of the external scene regardless of how poor the visibility is outside. An SVS
topography to the flight crew. [Figure 5-14] It is not a image can be displayed on either a head-down display or
real-time image like that produced by an enhanced flight head-up display (HUD). Development efforts are currently
vision system (EFVS). Unlike EFVS, SVS requires a terrain underway that would combine SVS with a real-time sensor
and obstacle database, a precise navigation solution, and image produced by an EFVS. These systems will be known
a display. The terrain image is based on the use of data as Combined Vision Systems (CVS).
from a digital elevation model (DEM) that is stored within
the SVS. With SVS, the synthetic terrain/vision image is Enhanced Flight Vision System (EFVS)
intended to enhance pilot awareness of spatial position For an in-depth discussion regarding Enhanced Flight
relative to important features in all visibility conditions. Vision Systems, please see Chapter 4, page 4-20.

5-8
Developing Combined Technology
The United States air transportation system is undergoing
a transformation to accommodate a projected three-fold
increase in air operations by 2025. Technological and
systemic changes are being developed to significantly
increase the capacity, safety, efficiency, and security for this
Next Generation Air Transportation System (NextGen). One
of the key capabilities envisioned to achieve these goals is
the concept of equivalent visual operations (EVO), whereby
visual flight rules (VFR) and operating procedures, such as
separation assurance, are maintained independent of the
actual weather conditions. One methodology by which the
goal of EVO might be attainable is to create a virtual visual
flight environment for the flight crew, independent of the Figure 5-18. Portable flight bag.
actual outside weather and visibility conditions, through
application of EV and synthetic vision (SV) technologies.

Figure 5-16. Enhanced and synthetic vision displayed on primary


Figure 5-17. Installed flight bag.
flight displays.
The hardware device, whether its an installed avionics
[Figure 5-16] display or portable commercial-off-the-shelf (COTS)
Electronic Flight Bag (EFB) device, commonly referred to as a portable electronic
The electronic flight bag (EFB) is a system for pilots or device (PED), is not considered to be an EFB unless the
crewmembers that provide a variety of electronic display, hardware device hosts and actively displays either Type
content manipulation, and calculation capabilities. A or B software application(s). A non-inclusive list of Type
Functions include, but are not limited to, aeronautical A and B software application examples can be found in
charts, documents, checklists, weight & balance, fuel appendix 1 and 2 of FAA Advisory Circular (AC) 120-76.
calculations, moving maps, and logbooks.
The purpose, technology, and functions for EFB use are
EFB systems may manage information for use in the rapidly evolving. New and advanced software applications
cockpit, cabin, and/or in support of ground operations and databases beyond traditional flight bag uses continue
and planning. The use of an EFB is unique to each aircraft to be developed. The FAA has published and continues
operator and, depending on the type of operation, EFB use to update EFB policy and guidance to educate and assist
may require an authorization for use from the FAA issued as aircraft operators interested in using or obtaining an EFB
either an operations specification (OpSpec), maintenance authorization as appropriate. The most current editions of
specification (MSpec), or letter of authorization (LOA). the following FAA guidance and policy can be accessed
from the FAAs website (http://www.faa.gov) or FAAs
EFBs can be portable [Figure 5-18] or installed [Figure Flight Standards Information Management System (FSIMS
5-19] in the aircraft. Portable EFBs may have a provision for http://fsims.faa.gov).
securing in the cockpit for use during all phases of flight. AC 120-76, Guidelines for the Certification,
Airworthiness, and Operational Use of Electronic
5-9
Flight Bags;
AC 91-78, Use of Class 1 or Class 2 Electronic Flight
Bag (EFB);
AC 20-173, Installation of Electronic Flight Bag
Components;
FAA Order 8900.1 Volume 4, Chapter 15, Section 1,
Electronic Flight Bag authorization for use; and
FAA Order 8900.1 Volume 3, Chapter 18, Section 3,
Part A Operations Specifications - General

Access to Special Use Airspace


Special use airspace consists of airspace of defined
dimensions identified by an area on the surface of the earth
wherein activities must be confined because of their nature,
or wherein limitations are imposed upon aircraft operations
that are not a part of those activities, or both. Special use
airspace includes: restricted airspace, prohibited airspace, Figure 5-29. Military operations area (MOA).
Military Operations Areas (MOA), warning areas, alert areas,
temporary flight restriction (TFR), and controlled firing
areas (CFAs). [Figures 5-27 through 5-32] Prohibited and
restricted areas are regulatory special use airspace and
are established in 14 CFR Part 73 through the rulemaking

Figure 5-27. Restricted airspace.


Figure 5-30. Warning area.

process. Warning areas, MOAs, alert areas, and CFAs are


non-regulatory special use airspace. All special use airspace
descriptions (except CFAs) are contained in FAA Order
7400.8, Special Use Airspace, and are charted on IFR or
visual charts and include the hours of operation, altitudes,
and the controlling agency. [Figure 5-33]

The vertical limits of special use airspace are measured


by designated altitude floors and ceilings expressed as
flight levels or as feet above mean sea level (MSL). Unless
otherwise specified, the word to (an altitude or flight level)
means to and including (that altitude or flight level). The
Figure 5-28. Prohibited airspace. horizontal limits of special use airspace are measured by

5-10
Figure 5-32. Temporary flight restriction (TFR).

Groups include SUA, MTR, or TFR. The Map tabbed page


provides a graphical depiction of scheduled airspaces
Figure 5-31. Alert area. that may be customized using a fly-out menu of map
boundaries described by geographic coordinates or other display options. This tabbed page also contains look-up
appropriate references that clearly define their perimeter. functionality that allows a user to locate one or more
The period of time during which a designation of special airports within the map. [Figures 5-35 through 5-38]
use airspace is in effect is stated in the designation.
Additional navigation features are included which allows
Civilians Using Special Use Airspace the user to pan in any direction by dragging the cursor
The FAA and the Department of Defense (DOD) work within the map. A permalink feature is also available that
together to maximize the use of special use airspace enables a user to bookmark a customized set of map layers
by opening such areas to civilian traffic when they are that can easily be added to their Internet browser favorites
not being used by the military. The military airspace list. Once a specific set of customized map layers has been
management system (MAMS) keeps an extensive database bookmarked, a user may open that customized map display
of information on the historical use of special use airspace, using the favorites option within their browser menu. The
as well as schedules describing when each area is expected List tabbed page allows a user to view all SUA and MTR
to be active. MAMS transmits the data to the special use scheduling data and NOTAM text for a TFR. This text may
airspace management system (SAMS), an FAA program be viewed for each NOTAM ID by expanding the NOTAM
that provides current and scheduled status information text section within the List grid or clicking the NOTAM ID
on special use airspace to civilian users. The two systems to open a TFR Details page. The TFR Details page displays
work together to ensure that the FAA and system users NOTAM text in a form layout for easy reading and includes
have current information on a daily basis. This information a mapped image and sectional navigation map if available
is available 24 hours a day at the following link: http://sua. for the TFR.
faa.gov. The website merges information for both special
use airspace and TFR making it a single comprehensive
source to review airspace closure information.

The website contains two tabbed pages, List and Map, that
display the scheduling and Notice to Airmen (NOTAM) data
for SUAs, military training routes (MTRs), and TFRs. [Figure
5-34] By default, the List tabbed page displays all airspace
types, and the Map tabbed page displays all airspace types
apart from MTRs and ATC Assigned Airspaces (ATCAAs).
Both the List and Map tabbed pages can be filtered to
display specific data for an airspace name, type, or group.

5-11
SPECIAL USE AIRSPACE ON JACKSONVILLE SECTIONAL CHART
Unless otherwise noted are MSL and in feet. Other times by NOTAM.
Time is local. TO an altitude means To and including. NOTAM Use of this term in Restricted Areas
FL Flight Level indicates FAA and DoD NOTAM systems.
NO A/G No air to ground communications. Use of this term in all other Special Use areas indicates
Contact nearest FSS for information. the DoD NOTAM system.

U.S. PPROHIBITED, RRESTRICTED, WWARNING, AALERT, MOAMILITARY OPERATIONS AREA


CONTROLLING AGENCY/
NUMBER ALTITUDE TIME OF USE CONTACT FACILITY FREQUENCIES

P-50 TO BUT NOT CONTINUOUS NO A/G


INCL 3,000
R-2903 A TO BUT NOT INTERMITTENT JACKSONVILLE CNTR
INCL 23,000 0700-1900 TUE-SUN
24 HRS IN ADVANCE
R-2903 C TO 7,000 INTERMITTENT JACKSONVILLE TRACON
0700-1900 TUE-SUN
24 HRS IN ADVANCE
R-2903 D TO 5,000 INTERMITTENT JACKSONVILLE TRACON
0700-1900 TUE-SUN
24 HRS IN ADVANCE
R-2904 A TO BUT NOT 0800-1700 (APR-AUG) JACKSONVILLE TRACON
INCL 1,800 0800-1700 SAT-SUN (SEP-MAR)
24 HRS IN ADVANCE
R-2906 TO 14,000 INTERMITTENT JACKSONVILLE TRACON
0500-0100
6 HRS IN ADVANCE
R-2907 A TO FL 230 INTERMITTENT JACKSONVILLE CNTR
0500-0100
6 HRS IN ADVANCE

Figure 5-33. Special use airspace charted on an aeronautical chart.

5-12
Figure 5-34. FAA website providing information for both special use airspace and temporary flight restrictions.

5-13
Figure 5-35. Center locations and information available to pilots through the FAA website.

5-14
Figure 5-36. State information available to pilots through the FAA website.

5-15
Figure 5-37. Map layer options and information available to pilots through the FAA website.

5-16
Figure 5-38. Airport information available to pilots through the FAA website.

5-17
5-18
Chapter 6

Airborne Navigation Databases


Introduction
Area Navigation (RNAV) systems, aeronautical applications,
and functions that depend on databases are widespread.
[Figure 6-1] Since the 1970s, installed flight systems
have relied on airborne navigation databases to support
their intended functions, such as navigation data used
to facilitate the presentation of flight information to the
flight crew and understanding and better visualization
of the governing aeronautical flight charts. With the
overwhelming upgrades to navigation systems and fully
integrated flight management systems (FMS) that are now
installed in almost all corporate and commercial aircraft,
the need for reliable and consistent airborne navigation
databases is more important than ever.

6-1
Figure 6-1. Area navigation (RNAV) receivers.

The capabilities of airborne navigation databases depend processed by the avionics manufacturer. manufacturer.
largely on the way they are implemented by the avionics Vital to this discussion is understanding of the regulations
manufacturers. They can provide data about a large guiding database maintenance and use.
variety of locations, routes, and airspace segments for use
by many different types of RNAV equipment. Databases There are many different types of RNAV systems certified
can provide pilots with information regarding airports, for instrument flight rules (IFR) use in the National Airspace
air traffic control (ATC) frequencies, runways, and special System (NAS). The two most prevalent types are GPS and
use airspace. Without airborne navigation databases, the multisensory FMS. [Figure 6-2] A modern GPS unit
RNAV would be extremely limited. In order to understand accurately provides the pilot with the aircrafts present
the capabilities and limitations of airborne navigation position; however, it must use an airborne navigation
databases, pilots must understand the way databases database to determine its direction or distance from
are compiled and revised by the database provider and another location. The database provides the GPS with

6-2
position information for navigation fixes so it may perform
The display allows you to view information stored in the FMS. the required geodetic calculations to determine the
appropriate tracks, headings, and distances to be flown.
. nm [Figure 6-3]
RNG
PROC CRSR

DTK
PUSH ON TK MENU Modern FMS are capable of a large number of functions
BRT LEG
APT 1 VOR NDB INT USR ACT NAV FPL SET AUX including basic en route navigation, complex departure
MSG OBS ALT NRST D CLR ENT PULL SCAN and arrival navigation, fuel planning, and precise vertical
navigation. Unlike stand-alone navigation systems, most
FMS/

FMS use several navigation inputs. Typically, they formulate


RANGE
NAV-COM
PFD MENU
+

FPL PROC the aircrafts current position using a combination of


PUSH CRSR/PUSH 1-2 PUSH PAN
Controls such as
PFD MFD A B C D buttons and knobs conventional distance measuring equipment (DME) signals,
E F G H
allow you to make inertial navigation systems (INS), GPS receivers, or other
entries into the FMS.
EMERG

NAV COM I J K L RNAV devices. Like stand-alone navigation avionics, they


1 2 3
M N O P
rely heavily on airborne navigation databases to provide
the information needed to perform their numerous
Q R S T
4 5 6

U V W X

functions.
7 8 9

0 + Y Z SPC BKSP
DFLT MAP

SOFTKEY SELECT

SEL CLR ENT


Airborne Navigation Database
Standardization
Beginning in the 1970s, the requirement for airborne
Figure 6-2. GPS with a flight route on display.

119.000 Modified
A
DIST
C
T Modify
121.600 KSQL 027
S
B
Y
A
C
T
114.10 KSQL
BRG 060 21.7
--.- vor
SUNOL 21.7 mn Wpt
discontinuity
116.00
S
B
Y BRG --- --- This FMS allows you to insert
Arwy an entire airway into your route.
1200 027 21.7
S n
B
Y m
FLAGGED
GPS ENR No Active Leg FPL
BACK EXEC XPND

A
119.000 SUNOL The navigation database looks up
C
T V195
S
B 121.600 V195 ECA all of the airways that connect to
Y
50nm V301 the previous waypoint in the route.
A
C
T
114.10
--.- vor N V334 119.000 Modified
A
ECA C DIST
Modify
S
116.00
T
KSQL
121.600 BRG 060
B S
Y SUNOL B 21.7
Y
1200 114.10 SUNOL 21.7
S n
B A m
Y C

FLAGGED
T
--.- vor
V195 ECA: The software performs a
BRG 060 18.3
GPS ENR FPL TRACY 40.0 mn database search for all of the
116.00
S
B
BACK Y BRG 060 9.6 airways, causing all waypoints
S
B 1200 SHARR 49.6 mn along the airway to be inserted
Y BRG 049 5.4
FLAGGED ECA 55.0mn into the route.
GPS ENR No Active Leg FPL
BACK EXEC XPND

Figure 6-3. FMS display.

6-3
navigation databases became more critical. In 1973, The data included in an airborne navigation database is
National Airlines installed the Collins ANS-70 and AINS- organized into ARINC 424 records. These records are strings
70 RNAV systems in their DC-10 fleet, which marked the of characters that make up complex descriptions of each
first commercial use of avionics that required navigation navigation entity. ARINC records can be sorted into four
databases. A short time later, Delta Air Lines implemented general groups: fix records, simple route records, complex
the use of an ARMA Corporation RNAV system that also route records, and miscellaneous records. Although it is not
used a navigation database. Although the type of data important for pilots to have in-depth knowledge of all the
stored in the two systems was basically identical, the fields contained in the ARINC 424 records, pilots should be
designers created the databases to solve the individual aware of the types of records contained in the navigation
problems of each system, which meant that they were not database and their general content.
interchangeable. As the implementation of RNAV systems
expanded, a world standard for airborne navigation Fix Records
databases was needed. Database records that describe specific locations on the
face of the earth can be considered fix records. Navigational
In 1973, Aeronautical Radio, Inc. (ARINC) sponsored the aids (NAVAIDs), waypoints, intersections, and airports are
formation of a committee to standardize aeronautical all examples of this type of record. These records can be
databases. In 1975, the committee published the first used directly by avionics systems and can be included as
standard, ARINC Specification 424, which has remained the parts of more complex records like airways or approaches.
worldwide accepted format for transmission of navigation
databases. Another concept pilots should understand relates to how
aircraft make turns over navigation fixes. Fixes can be
ARINC 424 designated as fly-over or fly-by, depending on how they
ARINC 424 is the air transport industrys recommended are used in a specific route. [Figure 6-4] Under certain
standard for the preparation and transmission of data for circumstances, a navigation fix is designated as fly-over.
the assembly of airborne system navigation databases. The This simply means that the aircraft must actually pass
data is intended for merging with the aircraft navigation directly over the fix before initiating a turn to a new course.
system software to provide a source of navigation Conversely, a fix may be designated fly-by, allowing an
reference. Each subsequent version of ARINC 424 aircrafts navigation system to use its turn anticipation
Specification provides additional capability for navigation feature, which ensures that the proper radius of turn is
systems to utilize. Merging of ARINC 424 data with each commanded to avoid overshooting the new course. Some
manufacturers system software is unique and ARINC 424 RNAV systems are not programmed to fully use this feature.
leg types provide vertical guidance and ground track for It is important to remember a fix can be coded as fly-over
a specific flight procedure. These leg types must provide and fly-by in the same procedure, depending on how the
repeatable flight tracks for the procedure design. The fix is used (i.e., holding at an initial approach fix). RNAV or
navigation database leg type is the path and terminator GPS stand-alone IAPs are flown using data pertaining to
concept. the particular IAP obtained from an onboard database
to include the sequence of all waypoints used for the
ARINC 424 Specification describes 23 leg types by their path approach and missed approach, except that step down
and terminator. The path describes how the aircraft gets to waypoints may not be included in some TSO-C129 receiver
the terminator by flying direct (a heading, a track, a course, databases. Included in the database, in most receivers, is
etc.). The terminator is the event or condition that causes coding that informs the navigation system of which WPs
the navigation computer system to switch to the next leg (a are fly-over or fly-by. The navigation system may provide
fix, an altitude, an intercept, etc.). When a flight procedure guidance appropriately to include leading the turn prior
instructs the pilot to fly runway heading to 2000 feet then to a fly-by waypoint; or causing over flight of a fly-over
direct to a fix, this is the path and terminator concept. The waypoint. Where the navigation system does not provide
path is the heading and the terminator is 2000 feet. The such guidance, the pilot must accomplish the turn lead or
next leg is then automatically sequenced. A series of leg waypoint over flight manually. Chart symbology for the fly-
types are coded into a navigation database to make a flight by waypoint provides pilot awareness of expected actions.
procedure. The navigation database allows an FMS or GPS
navigator to create a continuous display of navigational
data, thus enabling an aircraft to be flown along a specific
route. Vertical navigation can also be coded.

6-4
Fly-over

Fly-by

Waypoint
Waypoint

Flight plan path


Airplane track

Figure 6-4. Fly-by-waypoints and fly-over-waypoints.

Simple Route Records altitudes (MORAs).


Route records are those that describe a flightpath instead
of a fixed position. Simple route records contain strings Path and Terminator Concept
of fix records and information pertaining to how the fixes The path and terminator concept is a means to permit
should be used by the navigation avionics. coding of terminal area procedures, SIDs, STARs, and
approach procedures. Simply put, a textual description of
A Victor Airway, for example, is described in the database by a route or a terminal procedure is translated into a format
a series of en route airway records that contain the names that is useable in RNAV systems. One of the most important
of fixes in the airway and information about how those concepts for pilots to learn regarding the limitations of
fixes make up the airway. RNAV equipment has to do with the way these systems
deal with the path and terminator field included in complex
Complex Route Records route records.
Complex route records include those strings of fixes that
describe complex flightpaths like standard instrument The first RNAV systems were capable of only one type of
departures (SIDs), standard terminal arrival routes (STARs), navigation; they could fly directly to a fix. This was not a
and instrument approach procedures (IAPs). Like simple problem when operating in the en route environment
routes, these records contain the names of fixes to be in which airways are mostly made up of direct routes
used in the route, as well as instructions on how the route between fixes. The early approaches for RNAV did not
is flown. present problems for these systems and the databases
they used because they consisted mainly of DME/DME
Miscellaneous Records overlay approaches flown only direct point-to-point
There are several other types of information that is coded navigation. The desire for RNAV equipment to have the
into airborne navigation databases, most of which deal ability to follow more complicated flightpaths necessitated
with airspace or communications. The receiver may contain the development of the path and terminator field that is
additional information, such as restricted airspace, airport included in complex route records.
minimum safe altitudes, and grid minimum off route

6-5
Path and Terminator Legs
There are currently 23 different leg types, or path and
terminators that have been created in the ARINC 424 G N
LE seg ext
standard that enable RNAV systems to follow the complex F me
nt

R
paths that make up instrument departures, arrivals, and
approaches. They describe to navigation avionics a path
to be followed and the criteria that must be met before

ARC
CENTER
FIX

Previous
segment
Figure 6-7. Constant radius arc or RF leg.
Figure 6-5. Initial fix.

the path concludes and the next path begins. Although


there are 23 leg types available, none of the manufactured
database equipment is capable of using all of the leg types. CF LEG
Pilots must continue to monitor procedures for accuracy 080

and not rely solely on the information that the database

Course is flown making adjustment for wind

Figure 6-8. Course to a fix or CF leg.

TF LEG
Unspecified position

DF LEG

Figure 6-6. Track to a fix leg type.

is showing. If the RNAV system does not have the leg type
demanded by procedures, data packers have to select one Figure 6-9. Direct to a fix or DF leg.
or a combination of available lleg types to give the best
approximation, which can result in an incorrect execution
of the procedure. Below is a list of the 23 leg types and Unspecified position
their uses that may or may not be used by all databases.
Initial fix or IF legdefines a database fix as a point
in space and is only required to define the beginning FA LEG
of a route or procedure. [Figure 6-5] 080
8,000'
Track to a fix or TF legdefines a great circle track
over the ground between two known database FA leg is flown making adjustment for wind
fixes and the preferred method for specification of Figure 6-10. Fix to an altitude or FA leg.
straight legs (course or heading can be mentioned
on charts but designer should ensure TF leg is used

6-6
for coding). [Figure 6-6] fix for a specific distance. [Figure 6-11]
Constant radius arc or RF legdefines a constant
radius turn between two databases fixes, lines
tangent to the arc, and a center fix. [Figure 6-7]
Unspecified position

090
CA LEG

FC LEG
9,000'
080
9 NM Course is flown making adjustment for wind

Figure 6-14. Course to an altitude or CA leg.

Figure 6-11. Track from a fix from a distance or FC leg.

Course to a fix or CF legdefines a specified course D 10


to a specific database fix. Whenever possible, TF legs
should be used instead of CF legs to avoid magnetic
090
CD LEG

080
FD LEG Figure 6-15. Course to a DME distance of CD leg.
D
10

0 eg
07 xt l
090 Ne

Figure 6-12. Track from a fix to a DME distance or FD leg. CI LEG

variation issues. [Figure 6-8]


Figure 6-16. Course to an intercept or CI leg.
Direct to a fix or DF legdefines an unspecified track
starting from an undefined position to a specified Track from a fix to a distance measuring equipment
(DME) distance or FD legdefines a specified track
Manual
over the ground from a database fix to a specific
termination DME distance that is from a specific database DME
080 FM LEG

FM leg is flown making adjustment for wind


1
CR 20
Figure 6-13. From a fix to a manual termination or FM leg. LE
G
170

fix. [Figure 6-9]


Fix to an altitude or FA legdefines a specified track
over the ground from a database fix to a specified
altitude at an unspecified position. [Figure 6-10]
Track from a fix from a distance or FC legdefines
a specified track over the ground from a database Figure 6-17. Course to a radial termination or CR leg.

6-7
NAVAID. [Figure 6-12] from a specific database DME NAVAID. [Figure 6-15]
From a fix to a manual termination or FM leg Course to an intercept or CI legdefines a specified
defines a specified track over the ground from a course to intercept a subsequent leg. [Figure 6-16]

0 eg
07 xt l
090 Ne
VI LEG
G
LE

D10
AF

Figure 6-21. Heading to an intercept or VI leg.

Course to a radial termination or CR legdefines a


adial course to a specified radial from a specific database
dary r 245
Boun VOR NAVAID. [Figure 6-17]

Figure 6-18. Arc to a fix or AF leg.


070 Manual termination
VM LEG
database fix until manual termination of the leg.
[Figure 6-13] No correction made for wind

Figure 6-22. Heading to a manual termination or VM leg.

Unspecified position
Arc to a fix or AF legdefines a track over the ground
at a specified constant distance from a database
090 DME NAVAID. [Figure 6-18]
VA LEG

8,000'
No correction made for wind
1
Figure 6-19. Heading to an altitude termination or VA leg. VR 20
LE
G
170

Course to an altitude or CA legdefines a specified


course to a specific altitude at an unspecified
position. [Figure 6-14]
Course to a DME distance or CD legdefines a
specified course to a specific DME distance that is

Figure 6-23. Heading to a radial termination or VR leg.

D 10 Heading to an altitude termination or VA leg


defines a specified heading to a specific altitude
termination at an unspecified position. [Figure 6-19]
090
VD LEG

Figure 6-20. Heading to a DME distance termination or VD leg.

6-8
Regional in Grand Junction, Colorado, provides a good
example of different types of path and terminator legs
used. [Figure 6-26] When this procedure is coded into the
navigation database, the person entering the data into the

8
01
PI records must identify the individual legs of the flightpath
and then determine which type of terminator should be
used.
063
The first leg of the departure for Runway 11 is a climb
via runway heading to 6,000 feet mean sea level (MSL)
and then a climbing right turn direct to a fix. When this is
Figure 6-24. Procedure turn or PI leg. entered into the database, a heading to an altitude (VA)
value must be entered into the records path and terminator
Heading to a DME distance termination or VD field for the first leg of the departure route. This path and
legdefines a specified heading terminating at a terminator tells the avionics to provide course guidance
specified DME distance from a specific database based on heading, until the aircraft reaches 6,000 feet,
and then the system begins providing course guidance
for the next leg. After reaching 6,000 feet, the procedure
HA, HF, HM
calls for a right turn direct to the Grand Junction (JNC)
076 VORTAC. This leg is coded into the database using the path
and terminator direct to a fix (DF) value, which defines an
unspecified track starting from an undefined position to a
specific database fix. After reaching
eg
usl
e vio HA - Terminates at an altitude
Pr Another commonly used path and terminator value is
HF - Terminates at the fix after one orbit
HM - Manually terminated
heading to a radial (VR) which is shown in Figure 6-27
using the CHANNEL ONE DEPARTURE procedure for Santa
Figure 6-25. Racetrack course reversal or HA, HF, and HM leg.
Ana, California. The first leg of the runway 19L/R procedure
requires a climb on runway heading until crossing the I-SNA
1 DME fix or the SLI R-118, this leg must be coded into the
DME NAVAID. [Figure 6-20] database using the VR value in the Path and Terminator
Heading to an intercept or VI legdefines a field. After crossing the I-SNA 1 DME fix or the SLI R-118, the
specified heading to intercept the subsequent leg avionics should cycle to the next leg of the procedure that
at an unspecified position. [Figure 6-21] in this case, is a climb on a heading of 175 until crossing SLI
Heading to a manual termination or VM leg R-132. This leg is also coded with a VR Path and Terminator.
defines a specified heading until a manual The next leg of the procedure consists of a heading of 200
termination. [Figure 6-22] until intercepting the SXC R-084. In order for the avionics to
correctly process this leg, the database record must include
Heading to a radial termination or VR legdefines a the heading to an intercept (VI) value in the Path and
specified heading to a specified radial from a specific Terminator field. This value directs the avionics to follow
database VOR NAVAID. [Figure 6-23] a specified heading to intercept the subsequent leg at an
Procedure turn or PI legdefines a course reversal unspecified position.
starting at a specific database fix and includes
outbound leg followed by a left or right turn and The path and terminator concept is a very important part
180 course reversal to intercept the next leg. [Figure of airborne navigation database coding. In general, it is not
6-24] necessary for pilots to have an in-depth knowledge of the
ARINC coding standards; however, pilots should be familiar
Racetrack course reversal or altitude termination
with the concepts related to coding in order to understand
(HA), single circuit terminating at the fix (base turn)
the limitations of specific RNAV systems that use databases.
(HF), or manual termination (HM) leg typesdefine
racetrack pattern or course reversals at a specified
database fix. [Figure 6-25] Path and Terminator Limitations
How a specific RNAV system deals with Path and
The GRAND JUNCTION FIVE DEPARTURE for Grand Junction Terminators is of great importance to pilots operating

6-9
6-10
SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

NO
T

Figure 6-26. Grand Junction Five Departure.


FO
R
NA
VI
GA
TI
ON
SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010
ON
TI
GA
VI
NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 6-27. Channel One Departure.

6-11
ON
TI
GA
SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010

VI

SW-1, 18 NOV 2010 to 16 DEC 2010


NA
R
FO
T
NO

Figure 6-28. ILS or LOC/DME RWY 3 in Durango, Colorado.

6-12
with airborne navigation databases. Some early RNAV analyzed, edited, and processed before it can be coded
systems may ignore this field completely. The ILS or LOC/ into the database. In some cases, data from outside the
DME RWY 3 approach at Durango, Colorado, provides an United States must be translated into English so it may be
example of problems that may arise from the lack of path analyzed and entered into the database. Once the data is
and terminator capability in RNAV systems. Although coded, it must be continually updated and maintained.
approaches of this type are authorized only for sufficiently
equipped RNAV systems, it is possible that a pilot may elect Once the FAA notifies the database provider that a change
to fly the approach with conventional navigation, and then is necessary, the update process begins. The change is
reengage RNAV during a missed approach. If this missed incorporated into a 28-day airborne database revision cycle
approach is flown using an RNAV system that does not use based on its assigned priority. If the information does not
Path and terminator values or the wrong leg types, then reach the coding phase prior to its cutoff date (the date that
the system will most likely ignore the first two legs of the new aeronautical information can no longer be included
procedure. This will cause the RNAV equipment to direct in the next update), it is held out of revision until the next
the pilot to make an immediate turn toward the Durango cycle. The cutoff date for aeronautical databases is typically
VOR instead of flying the series of headings that terminate 21 days prior to the effective date of the revision.
at specific altitudes as dictated by the approach procedure.
[Figure 6-28] Pilots must be aware of their individual The integrity of the data is ensured through a process called
systems Path and Terminator handling characteristics cyclic redundancy check (CRC). A CRC is an error detection
and always review the manufacturers documentation to algorithm capable of detecting small bit-level changes in
familiarize themselves with the capabilities of the RNAV a block of data. The CRC algorithm treats a data block as
equipment they are operating. Pilots should be aware that a single, large binary value. The data block is divided by a
some RNAV equipment was designed without the fly-over fixed binary number called a generator polynomial whose
capability which can cause problems for pilots attempting form and magnitude is determined based on the level of
to use this equipment to fly complex flightpaths in the integrity desired. The remainder of the division is the CRC
departure, arrival, or approach environments. value for the data block. This value is stored and transmitted
with the corresponding data block. The integrity of the
Role of the Database Provider data is checked by reapplying the CRC algorithm prior to
Compiling and maintaining a worldwide airborne distribution.
navigation database is a large and complex job. Within the
United States, the FAA sources give the database providers Role of the Avionics Manufacturer
information, in many different formats, which must be When avionics manufacturers develop a piece of
equipment that requires an airborne navigation database,

EUGA <VOR 34 >APR


IAF / TRAN: D130NIF

Figure 6-29. Naming conventions of three different systems for the VOR 34 Approach.

6-13
they typically form an agreement with a database provider Users Role
to supply the database for that new avionics platform. It Like paper charts, airborne navigation databases are
is up to the manufacturer to determine what information subject to revision. According to Title 14 of the Code of
to include in the database for their system. In some cases, Federal Regulations (14 CFR) Part 91, section 91.503, the
the navigation data provider has to significantly reduce the end user (operator) is ultimately responsible for ensuring
number of records in the database to accommodate the that data meets the quality requirements for its intended
storage capacity of the manufacturers new product, which application. Updating data in an aeronautical database is
means that the database may not contain all procedures. considered to be maintenance and all Part 91 operators
may update databases in accordance with 14 CFR Part 91,
Another important fact to remember is that although there section 43.3(g). Parts 121, 125, and 135 operators must
are standard naming conventions included in the ARINC update databases in accordance with their approved
424 specification, each manufacturer determines how maintenance program. For Part 135 helicopter operators,
the names of fixes and procedures are displayed to the this includes maintenance by the pilot in accordance with
pilot. This means that although the database may specify 14 CFR Part 43, section 43.3(h).
the approach identifier field for the VOR/DME Runway
34 approach at Eugene Mahlon Sweet Airport (KEUG) in Pilots using the databases are ultimately responsible for
Eugene, Oregon, as V34, different avionics platforms ensuring that the database they are operating with is
may display the identifier in any way the manufacturer current. This includes checking Notices to Airmen (NOTAM)-
deems appropriate. For example, a GPS produced by one type information concerning errors that may be supplied
manufacturer might display the approach as VOR 34, by the avionics manufacturer or the database supplier. The
whereas another might refer to the approach as VOR/DME database user is responsible for learning how the specific
34, and an FMS produced by another manufacturer may navigation equipment handles the navigation database.
refer to it as VOR34. [Figure 6-29] The manufacturers documentation is the pilots best source
of information regarding the capabilities and limitations of
These differences can cause visual inconsistencies between a specific database. [Figure 6-30]
chart and GPS displays, as well as confusion with approach
clearances and other ATC instructions for pilots unfamiliar Operational Limitations of Airborne
with specific manufacturers naming conventions. The Navigation Databases
manufacturer determines the capabilities and limitations
Understanding the capabilities and limitations of the
of an RNAV system based on the decisions that it makes
navigation systems installed in an aircraft is one of the
regarding that systems processing of the airborne
pilots biggest concerns for IFR flight. Considering the vast
navigation database.
number of RNAV systems and pilot interfaces available
today, it is critical that pilots and flight crews be familiar
Database Providers
with the manufacturers operating manual for each RNAV
Collect the data
system they operate and achieve and retain proficiency
Format per ARINC 424
operating those systems in the IFR environment.
Revise and maintain database

Most professional and general aviation pilots are familiar


with the possible human factors issues related to flightdeck
Avionics Manufacturers automation. It is particularly important to consider those
Decide on: issues when using airborne navigation databases. Although
Information to be included modern avionics can provide precise guidance throughout
How information will be processed all phases of flight, including complex departures and
User interface arrivals, not all systems have the same capabilities.

RNAV equipment installed in some aircraft is limited to


Pilots (End Users) direct route point-to-point navigation. Therefore, it is
very important for pilots to familiarize themselves with
Ensure currency
Execute updates
the capabilities of their systems through review of the
Responsible for working knowledge of avionics using
manufacturer documentation. Most modern RNAV systems
database are contained within an integrated avionics system that
receives input from several different navigation and aircraft
Figure 6-30. Database rolls. system sensors. These integrated systems provide so much

6-14
information that pilots may sometimes fail to recognize will be included with their system. For instance, older GPS
errors in navigation caused by database discrepancies or units rarely include all of the waypoints that are coded into
misuse. Pilots must constantly ensure that the data they master databases. Even some modern FMS equipment,
enter into their avionics is accurate and current. Once which typically have much larger storage capacity, do not
the transition to RNAV is made during a flight, pilots and include all of the data that is available from the database
flight crews must always be capable and ready to revert to producers. The manufacturers often choose not to include
conventional means of navigation if problems arise. certain types of data that they think is of low importance
to the usability of the unit. For example, manufacturers
Closed Indefinitely Airports of FMS used in large airplanes may elect not to include
Some US airports have been closed for up to several years, airports where the longest runway is less than 3,000 feet
with little or no chance that they will ever reopen; yet their or to include all the procedures for an airport.
indefinite closure status as opposed to permanent or
UFN closure, or abandonment causes them to continue Manufacturers of RNAV equipment can reduce the size of
to appear on both VFR and IFR charts and in airborne the data storage required in their avionics by limiting the
navigation databases; and their instrument approach geographic area the database covers. Like paper charts, the
procedures, if any, continue to be included and still amount of data that needs to be carried with the aircraft is
appear to be valid in the paper and electronic versions directly related to the size of the coverage area. Depending
of the United States Terminal Procedures Publication (TPP) on the data storage that is available, this means that the
charts. Airpark South, 2K2, at Ozark, Missouri, is a case in larger the required coverage area, the less detailed the
point. database can be.

Even though this airport has been closed going on two Again, due to the wide range of possible storage capacities,
years and, due to industrial and residential development and the number of different manufacturers and product
surrounding it, likely will never be reopened, the airport lines, the manufacturers documentation is the pilots best
is nonetheless still charted in a way that could easily source of information regarding limitations caused by
lead a pilot to believe that it is still open and operating. storage capacity of RNAV avionics.
Even the current US Low Altitude En route chart displays
a blue symbol for this airport, indicating that it still has Charting/Database Inconsistencies
a Department of Defense (DOD) approved instrument It is important for pilots to remember that many
approach procedure available for use. inconsistencies may exist between aeronautical charts
and airborne navigation databases. Since there are so
Aircrews need to use caution when selecting an airport many sources of information included in the production
in a cautionary or emergency situation, especially if the of these materials, and the data is manipulated by several
airport was not previously analyzed suitable for diversion different organizations before it is eventually displayed
during preflight. Aircrews could assume, based on charts on RNAV equipment, the possibility is high that there will
and their FMS database, the airport is suitable and perhaps be noticeable differences between the charts and the
the only available diversionary or emergency option. The databases. Because of this, pilots must be familiar with the
airport however, could be closed and hazardous even for capabilities of the database and have updated aeronautical
emergency use. In these situations, Air Traffic Control may charts while flying to ensure the proper course is being
be queried for the airports status. flown.

Storage Limitations Naming Conventions


As the data in a worldwide database grows, the required Obvious differences exist between the names of procedures
data storage space increases. Over the years that panel- shown on charts and those that appear on the displays of
mounted GPS and FMSs have developed, the size of the many RNAV systems. Most of these differences can be
commercially available airborne navigation databases has accounted for simply by the way the avionics manufacturers
grown exponentially. elect to display the information to the pilot. It is the avionics
manufacturer that creates the interface between the pilot
Some manufacturers systems have kept up with this and the database. For example, the VOR 12R approach in
growth and some have not. Many of the limitations of San Jose, California, might be displayed several different
older RNAV systems are a direct result of limited data ways depending on how the manufacturer designs the
storage capacity. For this reason, avionics manufacturers pilot interface. Some systems display procedure names
must make decisions regarding which types of procedures exactly as they are charted, but many do not.

6-15
The naming of multiple approaches of the same type to the Using the VOR/DME Runway 34 approach at Eugene
same runway is also changing. Multiple approaches with Mahlon Sweet Airport (KEUG) in Eugene, Oregon, as
the same guidance will be annotated with an alphabetical another example, which is named V34, may be displayed
suffix beginning at the end of the alphabet and working differently by another avionics platform. For example, a
backwards for subsequent procedures (e.g., ILS Z RWY GPS produced by one manufacturer might display the
28, ILS Y RWY 28, etc.). The existing annotations, such as approach as VOR 34, whereas another might refer to the
ILS 2 RWY 28 or Silver ILS RWY 28, will be phased out and approach as VOR/DME 34, and an FMS produced by another
replaced with the new designation. manufacturer may refer to it as VOR34. These differences
can cause visual inconsistencies between chart and GPS
NAVAIDs are also subject to naming discrepancies as well. displays, as well as confusion with approach clearances
This problem is complicated by the fact that multiple and other ATC instructions for pilots unfamiliar with specific
NAVAIDs can be designated with the same identifier. VOR manufacturers naming conventions.
XYZ may occur several times in a providers database, so
the avionics manufacturer must design a way to identify For detailed operational guidance, refer to Advisory Circular
these fixes by a more specific means than the three-letter (AC) 90-100, U.S. Terminal and En Route Area Navigation
identifier. Selection of geographic region is used in most (RNAV) Operations; AC 90-101, Approval Guidance for RNP
instances to narrow the pilots selection of NAVAIDs with Procedures with Special Aircraft and Aircrew Authorization
like identifiers. Required (SAAAR); AC 90-105, Approval Guidance for RNP
Operations and Barometric Vertical Navigation in the
Non-directional beacons (NDBs) and locator outer markers U.S. National Airspace System; and AC 90-107, Guidance
(LOMs) can be displayed differently than they are charted. for Localizer Performance with Vertical Guidance and
When the first airborne navigation databases were being Localizer Performance without Vertical Guidance Approach
implemented, NDBs were included in the database as Operations in the U.S. National Airspace System.
waypoints instead of NAVAIDs. This necessitated the use
of five character identifiers for NDBs. Eventually, the NDBs Issues Related To Magnetic Variation
were coded into the database as NAVAIDs, but many of
Magnetic variations for locations coded into airborne
the RNAV systems in use today continue to use the five-
navigation databases can be acquired in several ways. In
character identifier. These systems display the characters
many cases they are supplied by government agencies in
NB after the charted NDB identifier. Therefore, NDB ABC
the epoch year variation format. Theoretically, this value
would be displayed as ABCNB.
is determined by government sources and published for
public use every five years. Providers of airborne navigation
Other systems refer to NDB NAVAIDs using either the NDBs
databases do not use annual drift values; instead the
charted name if it is five or fewer letters, or the one to three
database uses the epoch year variation until it is updated by
character identifier. PENDY NDB located in North Carolina,
the appropriate source provider. In the United States, this
for instance, is displayed on some systems as PENDY, while
is the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
other systems might only display the NDBs identifier ACZ.
(NOAA). In some cases the variation for a given location is
[Figure 6-31]

Figure 6-31. Manufacturers naming conventions.

6-16
a value that has been calculated by the avionics system.
These dynamic magnetic variation values can be different
than those used for locations during aeronautical charting
and must not be used for conventional NAVAIDs or airports.

Discrepancies can occur for many reasons. Even when the


variation values from the database are used, the resulting
calculated course might be different from the course
depicted on the charts. Using the magnetic variation for the
region instead of the actual station declination can result
in differences between charted and calculated courses and
incorrect ground track. Station declination is only updated
when a NAVAID is site checked by the governing authority
that controls it, so it is often different than the current
magnetic variation for that location. Using an onboard
means of determining variation usually entails coding
some sort of earth model into the avionics memory. Since
magnetic variation for a given location changes predictably
over time, this model may only be correct for one time in
the lifecycle of the avionics. This means that if the intended
lifecycle of a GPS unit were 20 years, the point at which the
variation model might be correct would be when the GPS
unit was 10 years old. The discrepancy would be greatest
when the unit was new, and again near the end of its life
span.

Another issue that can cause slight differences between


charted course values and those in the database
occurs when a terminal procedure is coded using
magnetic variation of record. When approaches or other
procedures are designed, the designers use specific rules
to apply variation to a given procedure. Some controlling
government agencies may elect to use the epoch year
variation of an airport to define entire procedures at that
airport. This may result in course discrepancies between
the charted value and the value calculated using the actual
variations from the database.

Issues Related To Revision Cycle


Pilots should be aware that the length of the airborne
navigation database revision cycle could cause
discrepancies between aeronautical charts and information
derived from the database. One important difference
between aeronautical charts and databases is the length
of cutoff time. Cutoff refers to the length of time between
the last day that changes can be made in the revision, and
the date the information becomes effective. Aeronautical
charts typically have a cutoff date of 10 days prior to the
effective date of the charts.

6-17
6-18
Chapter 7

Helicopter Instrument
Procedures
Introduction
This chapter presents information on IFR helicopter
operations in the National Airspace System. Advances in
avionics technology installed in helicopters such as Global
Positioning System (GPS) and Wide Area Augmentation
System (WAAS) are bringing approach procedures to
heliports around the country.

The ability to operate helicopters under IFR increases


their utility and safety. Helicopter IFR operators have
an excellent safety record due to the investment in
IFR-equipped helicopters, development of instrument
approach procedures (IAPs), and IFR-trained flight crews.
The safety record of IFR operations in the Gulf of Mexico is
equivalent to the safety record of the best-rated airlines.
Manufacturers are working to increase IFR all-weather
capabilities of helicopters by providing slower minimum
instrument airspeeds (VMINI), faster cruising speeds, and
better autopilots and flight management systems (FMS).
As a result, in October 2005, the first civil helicopter in
the United States was certified for flight into known icing
conditions. [Figure 7-1]

7-1
Flight and Navigation Equipment
The basic installed flight and navigation equipment for
helicopter IFR operations is listed under 14 CFR Part 29,
section 29.1303, with amendments and additions in
Appendix B of 14 CFR Parts 27 and 29 under which they are
certified. The list includes:
Clock
Airspeed indicator
Sensitive altimeter (A sensitive altimeter relates to
the instruments displayed change in altitude over its
range. For Copter Category (CAT) II operations,
the scale must be in 20-foot intervals.) adjustable for
barometric pressure
Magnetic direction indicator
Free-air temperature indicator
Rate-of-climb (vertical speed) indicator
Magnetic gyroscopic direction indicator
Stand-by bank and pitch (attitude) indicator
Figure 7-1. Icing tests. To safely provide an all-weather capability Non-tumbling gyroscopic bank and pitch (attitude)
and flight into known icing conditions that would otherwise delay indicator
or cancel winter flight operations, the digital control of the S-92
Speed warning device (if required by 14 CFR Part 29)
Rotor Ice Protection System (RIPS) determines the temperature and
moisture content of the air and removes any ice buildup by heating the
Miscellaneous Requirements
main and tail rotor blades. The system is shown here during testing.
Overvoltage disconnect
Helicopter Instrument Flight Rule (IFR)
Certification Instrument power source indicator

It is very important that pilots be familiar with the IFR Adequate ice protection of IFR systems
requirements for their particular helicopter. Within the Alternate static source (single-pilot configuration)
same make, model, and series of helicopter, variations in Thunderstorm lights (transport category helicopters)
the installed avionics may change the required equipment
or the level of augmentation for a particular operation. The Stabilization and Automatic Flight Control
Automatic Flight Control System/Autopilot/Flight Director System (AFCS)
(AFCS/AP/FD) equipment installed in IFR helicopters can Helicopter manufacturers normally use a combination
be very complex. For some helicopters, the AFCS/AP/ of a stabilization and/or AFCS in order to meet the IFR
FD complexity requires formal training in order for the stability requirements of 14 CFR Parts 27 and 29. These
pilot(s) to obtain and maintain a high level of knowledge systems include:
of system operation, limitations, failure indications, and
reversionary modes. For a helicopter to be certified Aerodynamic surfaces, which impart some stability
to conduct operations in instrument meteorological or control capability that generally is not found in
conditions (IMC), it must meet the design and installation the basic VFR configuration.
requirements of Title 14 Code of Federal Regulations (14 Trim systems provide a cyclic centering effect. These
CFR) Part 27, Appendix B (Normal Category) and Part 29, systems typically involve a magnetic brake/spring
Appendix B (Transport Category), which is in addition to device and may be controlled by a four-way switch
the visual flight rule (VFR) requirements. on the cyclic. This system requires hands on flying
of the helicopter.
These requirements are broken down into the
Stability Augmentation Systems (SAS) provide
following categories: flight and navigation equipment,
short-term rate damping control inputs to increase
miscellaneous requirements, stability, helicopter flight
helicopter stability. Like trim systems, SAS requires
manual limitations, operations specifications, and
hands-on flying.
minimum equipment list (MEL).
7-2
Attitude Retention Systems (ATT ) return the Pilots should have an established set of procedures and
helicopter to a selected attitude after a disturbance. responsibilities for the control of FD/AP modes for the
Changes in attitude can be accomplished usually various phases of flight. Not only does a full understanding
through a four- way beep switch or by actuating a of the system modes provide for a higher degree of
force trim switch on the cyclic, which sets the desired accuracy in control of the helicopter, it is the basis for crew
attitude manually. Attitude retention may be a SAS identification of a faulty system.
function or may be the basic hands off autopilot
function. Helicopter Flight Manual Limitations
Autopilot Systems (APs) provide for hands off Helicopters are certificated for IFR operations with either
flight along specified lateral and vertical paths. The one or two pilots. Certain equipment is required to be
functional modes may include heading, altitude, installed and functional for two-pilot operations and
vertical speed, navigation tracking, and approach. additional equipment is required for single-pilot operation.
APs typically have a control panel for mode selection
and indication of mode status. APs may or may not be In addition, the Helicopter Flight Manual (HFM) defines
installed with an associated FD. APs typically control systems and functions that are required to be in operation
the helicopter about the roll and pitch axes (cyclic or engaged for IFR flight in either the single or two-pilot
control) but may also include yaw axis (pedal control) configurations. Often, in a two-pilot operation, this level of
and collective control servos. augmentation is less than the full capability of the installed
systems. Likewise, a single-pilot operation may require a
Flight Directors (FDs) provide visual guidance to higher level of augmentation.
the pilot to fly selected lateral and vertical modes of
operation. The visual guidance is typically provided The HFM also identifies other specific limitations associated
by a single cue, commonly known as a vee bar, with IFR flight. Typically, these limitations include, but are
which provides the indicated attitude to fly and not limited to:
is superimposed on the attitude indicator. Other
FDs may use a two cue presentation known as a Minimum equipment required for IFR flight (in some
cross pointer system. These two presentations cases, for both single-pilot and two-pilot operations)
only provide attitude information. A third system, VMINI (minimum speedIFR) [Figure 7-2]
known as a three cue system, provides information
VNEI (never exceed speedIFR)
to position the collective as well as attitude (roll
and pitch) cues. The collective control cue system Maximum approach angle
identifies and cues the pilot what collective control Weight and center of gravity (CG) limits
inputs to use when path errors are produced or when
Helicopter configuration limitations (such as door
airspeed errors exceed preset values. The three-cue
positions and external loads)
system pitch command provides the required cues
to control airspeed when flying an approach with Helicopter system limitations (generators, inverters,
vertical guidance at speeds slower than the best- etc.)
rate-of-climb (BROC) speed. The pilot manipulates System testing requirements (many avionics and AFCS,
the helicopters controls to satisfy these commands, AP, and FD systems incorporate a self-test feature)
yielding the desired flightpath or may couple the
Pilot action requirements (for example, the pilot must
autopilot to the FD to fly along the desired flightpath.
have hands and feet on the controls during certain
Typically, FD mode control and indication are shared
operations, such as an instrument approach below
with the autopilot. Pilots must be aware of the mode
certain altitudes)
of operation of the augmentation systems and the
control logic and functions in use. For example, on an
Final approach angles/descent gradient for public
instrument landing system (ILS) approach and using
approach procedures can be as high as 7.5 degrees/795
the three-cue mode (lateral, vertical, and collective
feet per nautical mile (NM). At 70 knots indicated airspeed
cues), the FD collective cue responds to glideslope
(KIAS) (no wind), this equates to a descent rate of 925 feet
deviation, while the horizontal bar cue of the cross-
per minute (fpm). With a 10-knot tailwind, the descent
pointer responds to airspeed deviations. However,
rate increases to 1,056 fpm. Copter Point-in-space (PinS)
the same system when operated in the two-cue
approach procedures are restricted to helicopters with a
mode on an ILS, the FD horizontal bar cue responds
maximum VMINI of 70 KIAS and an IFR approach angle that
to glideslope deviations. The need to be aware of the
enables them to meet the final approach angle/descent
FD mode of operation is particularly significant when
gradient. Pilots of helicopters with a VMINI of 70 KIAS may
operating using two pilots.
7-3
Manufacturer VMINI Limitations MAX IFR Approach Angle G/A Mode Speed
Augusta
A-109 60 (80 coupled)

E
A-109C 40 9.0
Bell
BH 212 40
U S
BH 214ST 70

A L
U
BH 222 50
BH 222B 50

C T
A
BH 412 60 5.0

R
BH 430 50 (65 coupled) 4.0

O
Eurocopter
AS-355 55
F 4.5

OT
AS-365 75 4.5

EN
BK-117 45 (70 coupled) 6.0
EC-135 60 4.6

PL
EC-155 70 4.0
Sikorsky

AM
S-76A 60 (AFCS Phase II) 3.5 75 KIAS
S-76A
S-76B
S-76C
S 50 (AFCS Phase III)
60
60
7.5
7.5
75 KIAS
75 KIAS

SK-76C++ 50 (60 coupled) 6.5


NOTE: The VMINI, MAX IFR Approach Angle and G/A Mode Speed for a specific helicopter may vary with avionics/autopilot installation.
Pilots are therefore cautioned to refer only to the Rotorcraft Flight Manual limitations for their specific helicopter. The maximum rate of
descent for many autopilots is 1,000 FPM.

LEGEND
In some helicopters with the autopilot engaged, the VMINI may increase to a speed greater than 70 KIAS, or in the go around
mode requires a speed faster than 70 KIAS.

Figure 7-2. VMINI limitations, maximum IFR approach angles and G/A mode speeds for selected IFR certified helicopters.

have inadequate control margins to fly an approach that below VMINI and the minimum helicopter requirements
is designed with the maximum allowable angle/descent are specified in Advisory Circulars (AC) 27-1, Certification
gradient or minimum allowable deceleration distance of Normal Category Rotorcraft and AC 29-2, Certification
from the missed approach point (MAP) to the heliport. of Transport Category Rotorcraft. Application guidance is
The Copter PinS final approach segment is limited to 70 available from the Rotorcraft Directorate Standards Staff,
KIAS since turn containment and the deceleration distance ASW-110, 2601 Meacham Blvd., Fort Worth, Texas, 76137-
from the MAP to the heliport may not be adequate at faster 4298, (817) 222-5111.
speeds. For some helicopters, engaging the autopilot may
increase the VMINI to a speed greater than 70 KIAS, or in Performance data may not be available in the HFM for
the go around (G/A) mode, require a speed faster than 70 speeds other than the best rate of climb speed. To meet
KIAS. [Figure 7-2] It may be possible for these helicopters missed approach climb gradients, pilots may use observed
to be flown manually on the approach or on the missed performance for similar weight, altitude, temperature, and
approach in a mode other than the G/A mode. speed conditions to determine equivalent performance.
When missed approaches utilizing a climbing turn are
Since slower IFR approach speeds enable the helicopter flown with an autopilot, set the heading bug on the
to fly steeper approaches and reduces the distance from missed approach heading, and then at the MAP, engage
the heliport that is required to decelerate the helicopter, the indicated airspeed mode, followed immediately by
you may want to operate your helicopter at speeds slower applying climb power and selecting the heading mode.
than its established VMINI. The provision to apply for a This is important since the autopilot roll rate and maximum
determination of equivalent safety for instrument flight bank angle in the Heading Select mode are significantly

7-4
more robust than in the NAV mode. Figure 7-3 represents
the bank angle and roll limits of the S76 used by the Federal Legend
Aviation Administration (FAA) for flight testing. It has a roll Bin Mean
rate in the Heading Select mode of 5 degrees per second Bin Maximum
with only 1 degree per second in the NAV mode. The bank Approach Tracks
angle in the Heading Select mode is 20 degrees, with only
17 degrees in the NAV Change Over mode. Furthermore, if


the Airspeed Hold mode is not selected on some autopilots

when commencing the missed approach, the helicopter


accelerates in level flight until the best rate of climb is


attained, and only then will a climb begin.


Autopilot Bank Angle Limit Roll Rate Limit


Mode (Degrees) (Degrees/Sec)

Heading hold <6 None specified


E
US


5L
VOR/RNAV
+/22
A
TU
(Capture)
VOR/RNAV +/13
A5 C 1

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

80
AP
R

00

00

00

00

00

00

00

00
O

ft.

ft.

ft.

ft.

ft.

ft.

ft.

ft.
(On Course) VOR/RNAV Approach
F Distance from MAP
Heading Select
N OT+/20 5
VOR/RNAV
E Figure 7-4. Flight tests at the William J. Hughes Technical Center

M PL
(Course Change +/17 1 point out the importance of airspeed control and using the correct
SAStation/Fix)
Over technique to make a turning missed approach.

Figure 7-3. Autopilot bank angle and roll rate limits for the S-76
used by the William J. Hughes Technical Center for Flight Tests. OpSpecs based on their own equipment, training, and
experience.
WAAS localizer performance (LP) lateral-only PinS testing
conducted in 2005 by the FAA at the William J. Hughes Minimum Equipment List (MEL)
Technical Center in New Jersey for helicopter PinS also A helicopter operating under 14 CFR Part 135 with
captured the flight tracks for turning missed approaches. certain installed equipment inoperative is prohibited
[Figure 7-4] The large flight tracks that resulted during from taking off unless the operation is authorized in the
the turning missed approach were attributed in part to approved MEL. The MEL provides for some equipment to
operating the autopilot in the NAV mode and exceeding be inoperative if certain conditions are met. [Figure 7-6]
the 70 KIAS limit. In many cases, a helicopter configured for single-pilot
IFR may depart IFR with certain equipment inoperative
Operations Specifications provided a crew of two pilots is used. Under 14 CFR Part
A flight operated under 14 CFR Part 135 has minimums and 91, a pilot may defer certain items without an MEL if
procedures more restrictive than a flight operated under those items are not required by the type certificate, CFRs,
14 CFR Part 91. These Part 135 requirements are detailed or airworthiness directives (ADs), and the flight can be
in their operations specifications (OpSpecs). Helicopter performed safely without them. If the item is disabled,
Emergency Medical Service (HEMS) operators have even removed, or marked inoperative, a logbook entry is made.
more restrictive OpSpecs. Shown in Figure 7-5 is an excerpt
from an OpSpecs detailing the minimums for precision Pilot Proficiency
approaches. The inlay in Figure 7-5 shows the minimums for Helicopters of the same make and model may have
the ILS Runway 3R approach at Detroit Metro Airport. With variations in installed avionics that change the required
all lighting operative, the minimums for helicopter Part equipment or the level of augmentation for a particular
91 operations are a 200-foot ceiling, and 1,200-feet runway operation. The complexity of modern AFCS, AP, and FD
visual range (RVR) - one-half airplane Category A visibility systems requires a high degree of understanding to safely
but no less than 14 SM/1,200 RVR. However, as shown in and efficiently control the helicopter in IFR operations.
the OpSpecs, the minimum visibility this Part 135 operator Formal training in the use of these systems is highly
must adhere to is 1,600 RVR. Pilots operating under 14 CFR
Part 91 are encouraged to develop their own personal

7-5
U.S. Department
of Transportation

E
Federal Aviation Operations Specifications
Administration

US
H117. Straight-in Category I Precision Instrument Approach HQ Control: 11/22/00
Procedures - All Airports HQ Revision: 000

a. Except as provided in this paragraph, the certificate holder shall not use any Category I IFR landing
minimum lower than that prescribed by any applicable published instrument approach procedure. The
IFR landing minimums prescribed in this paragraph are the lowest authorized (other than Airborne

AL
Radar approaches) for use at any airport. Provided that the fastest approach speed used in the final
approach segment is less than 91 knots, the certificate holder is authorized to conduct straight-in
precision instrument approach procedures using the following:

TU
(1) The published Category A minimum descent altitude (MDA) or decision height (DH), as
appropriate.

(2) One-half of the published Category A visibility/RVR minimum or the visibility/RVR minimums
prescribed by this paragraph, whichever is higher.

b.
AC
Straight-In Category I Precision Approach Procedures. The certificate holder shall not use an IFR
landing minimum for straight-in precision approach procedures lower than that specified in the
following table. Touchdown zone RVR reports, when available for a particular runway, are controlling
for all approaches to and landings on that runway. (See NOTE 2.)
OR
Precision Approaches Full ILS (See NOTE 1), MLS, or PAR
Approach Light HAT Helicopters Operated at Helicopters Operated at
Configuration Speeds of 90 Knots or Less Speeds More Than 90 Knots
Visibility In TDZ RVR Visibility In TDZ RVR In
SM. In Feet SM. Feet
TF

No Lights or ODALS or 200 3/4 3500 3/4 4000


MALS or SSALS
MALSR or SSALR or 200 1/4 1600 1/2 2400
ALSF-1 or ALSF-2
NO

MALSR with TDZ and 200 1/4 1600 1/2 1800


CL or SSALR with TDZ
and CL or ALSF-1/ALSF- SAMPLE NOT FOR ACTUAL USE
2 with TDZ and CL

NOTE 1: A full ILS requires an operative LOC, GS, and OM or FAF. A precision or surveillance radar
E

fix, an NDB, VOR, DME fix, or a published minimum GSIA fix may be used in lieu of an outer marker.
NOTE 2: The Mid RVR and Rollout RVR reports (if available) provide advisory information to pilots.
PL

The Mid RVR report may be substituted for the TDZ RVR report if the TDZ RVR report is not available.

c. Special Limitations and Provisions for Instrument Approach Procedures at Foreign Airports. If the
certificate holder is authorized operations at foreign airports, the following criteria apply.
M

(1) Foreign approach lighting systems equivalent to U.S. standards are authorized for both precision
and nonprecision approaches. Sequenced flashing lights are not required when determining the
equivalence of a foreign lighting system to U.S. standards.
SA

(2) For straight-in landing minimums at foreign airports where an MDA or DH is not specified, the
lowest authorized MDA or DH shall be obtained as follows:

Print Date: 4/16/2008 H117-1

SAMPLE NOT FOR ACTUAL USE

Figure 7-5. Operations Specifications.

7-6
U.S. DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION
MASTER MINIMUM EQUIPMENT LIST
FEDERAL AVIATION ADMINISTRATION

E
AIRCRAFT: REVISION NO: 3 PAGE:
BH-206/407 SERIES

US
DATE: 12/22/2008 28-1
SYSTEM & 1. 2. NUMBER INSTALLED
ITEM
SEQUENCE 3. NUMBER REQUIRED FOR DISPATCH
NUMBERS
4. REMARKS OR EXCEPTIONS

L
28 FUEL

1. Fuel Quantity Gauge DELETED. |

A
2. Auxiliary Fuel Tank D - 0 May be inoperative provided:

TU
***
a) Flight is not predicated upon
the use of the system,
and
b) Auxiliary tank fuel is
considered in weight and

AC
balance computations.

3. Fuel Low Warning Caution DELETED. |


Light System(206A and |
206B only) |

(206L series and407


only) R DELETED. |
|
FO
4. Solenoid Drain Valve D - 0 (O) May be inoperative provided the
*** System manual drain valve is verified
closed prior to flight.

5. Fuel Boost Pump(Twin B 4 3 One aft boost pump may be


engine models only) inoperative.
T

6. Fuel Flow Indicator B 2 0


NO

(Twin engine models


only)
LE
MP
SA

Figure 7-6. Example of a Minimum Equipment List (MEL).

7-7
recommended for all pilots.
Helicopter VFR Minimums
During flight operations, you must be aware of the mode
Airspace Flight Distance from clouds
of operation of the augmentation system and the control
visibility
logic and functions employed. [Figure 7-2] Class A Not Not applicable
applicable
Helicopter VFR Minimums Class B 3 SM Clear of clouds
Helicopters have the same VFR minimums as airplanes Class C 3 SM 500 feet below
with two exceptions. In Class G airspace or under a special 1,000 feet above
visual flight rule (SVFR) clearance, helicopters have no 2,000 feet horizontal
minimum visibility requirement but must remain clear of Class D 3 SM 500 feet below
1,000 feet above
clouds and operate at a speed that is slow enough to give
2,000 feet horizontal
the pilot an adequate opportunity to see other aircraft or
Class E 3 SM 500 feet below
an obstruction in time to avoid a collision. Helicopters are Less than 1,000 feet above
also authorized (14 CFR Part 91, appendix D, section 3) to 10,000 feet MSL 2,000 feet horizontal
obtain SVFR clearances at airports with the designation
NO SVFR in the Airport Facility Directory (A/FD) or on the At or above 5 SM 1,000 feet below
sectional chart. Figure 7-7 shows the visibility and cloud 10,000 feet MSL 1,000 feet above
clearance requirements for VFR and SVFR. However, lower 1 statue mile horizontal
minimums associated with Class G airspace and SVFR do Class G
1,200 feet or less
not take the place of the VFR minimum requirements of above the surface
either Part 135 regulations or respective OpSpecs. (regardless of MSL altitude)

Knowledge of all VFR minimums is required in order to Day, except as provided None Clear of clouds
determine if a PinS approach can be conducted or if a SVFR in 91.155(b)
clearance is required to continue past the (MAP). These Night, except as provided None Clear of clouds
approaches and procedures are discussed in detail later. in 91.155(b)
More than 1,200 feet above
Helicopter IFR Takeoff Minimums the surface but less than
10,000 feet MSL
A pilot operating under 14 CFR Part 91 has no takeoff
minimums to comply with other than the requirement to
Day 1 SM 500 feet below
attain VMINI before entering IMC. For most helicopters, 1,000 feet above
this requires a distance of approximately 12 mile and 2,000 feet horizontal
an altitude of 100 feet. If departing with a steeper climb Night 3 SM 500 feet below
gradient, some helicopters may require additional altitude 1,000 feet above
to accelerate to VMINI. To maximize safety, always consider 2,000 feet horizontal
using the Part 135 operator standard takeoff visibility More than 1,200 feet 5 SM 1,000 feet below
above the surface and at 1,000 feet above
minimum of 12 statute mile (SM) or the charted departure
or above 10,000 feet MSL 1 statute mile horizontal
minima, whichever is higher. A charted departure that
B, C, D, E, Surface Area
provides protection from obstacles has either a higher Airspace SVFR Minimums
visibility requirement, climb gradient, and/or departure Day None Clear of clouds
path. Part 135 operators are required to adhere to the Night None Clear of clouds
takeoff minimums prescribed in the instrument approach
procedures (IAPs) for the airport Figure 7-7. Helicopter VFR minimums.

Helicopter IFR Alternates ceiling is at least 1,000 feet above the airport elevation or
The pilot must file for an alternate if weather reports and 400 feet above the lowest applicable approach minima,
forecasts at the proposed destination do not meet certain whichever is higher, and the visibility is at least 2 SM. If an
minimums. These minimums differ for Part 91 and Part alternate is required, an airport can be used if the ceiling is
135 operators. at least 200 feet above the minimum for the approach to
be flown and visibility is at least 1 SM, but never less than
Part 91 Operators the minimum required for the approach to be flown. If no
Part 91 operators are not required to file an alternate if, at instrument approach procedure has been published for the
the estimated time of arrival (ETA) and for 1 hour after, the alternate airport, the ceiling and visibility minima are those
allowing descent from the MEA, approach, and landing
under basic VFR.
7-8
Part 135 Operators 97.3 Symbols and Terms Used in Procedures
Part 135 operators are not required to file an alternate if, for
at least 1 hour before and 1 hour after the ETA, the ceiling
is at least 1,500 feet above the lowest circling approach b) (1) Copter procedures means helicopter procedures
with applicable minimums as prescribed in 97.35
minimum descent altitude (MDA). If a circling instrument of this part. Helicopters may also use other
approach is not authorized for the airport, the ceiling must procedures prescribed in Subpart C of this part and
be at least 1,500 feet above the lowest published minimum may use the Category A minimum descent altitude
or 2,000 feet above the airport elevation, whichever is (MDA) or decision height (DH). The required visibility
minimum may be reduced to the published
higher. For the IAP to be used at the destination airport, the visibility minimum, but in no case may it be reduced
forecasted visibility for that airport must be at least 3 SM or to less than one-quarter mile or 1,200 feet RVR.
2 SM more than the lowest applicable visibility minimums,
whichever is greater. Figure 7-8. Part 97 excerpt.

Alternate landing minimums for flights conducted under 14 with the stabilized approach concept since a decelerating
CFR Part 135 are described in the OpSpecs for that approach may make early detection of wind shear on the
operation. All helicopters operated under IFR must carry approach path more difficult. [Figure 7-9]
enough fuel to fly to the intended destination, fly from that
airport to the filed alternate, if required, and continue for When visibility minimums must be increased for inoperative
30 minutes at normal cruising speed. components or visual aids, use the Inoperative Components
and Visual Aids Table (provided in the front cover of the U.S.
Helicopter Instrument Approaches Terminal Procedures) to derive the Category A minima before
Many new helicopter IAPs have been developed to take applying any visibility reduction. The published visibility
advantage of advances in both avionics and helicopter may be increased above the standard visibility minima due
technology. to penetrations of the 20:1 and 34:1 final approach obstacle
identification surfaces (OIS). The minimum visibility required
Standard Instrument Approach Procedures to for 34:1 penetrations is 34 SM and for 20:1 penetrations 1
an Airport SM, which is discussed in Chapter 5 of this handbook. When
Helicopters flying standard instrument approach there are penetrations of the final approach OIS, a visibility
procedures (SIAP) must adhere to the MDA or decision credit for approach lighting systems is not allowed for
altitude for Category A airplanes and may apply the 14 either airplane or helicopter procedures that would result
CFR Part 97.3 (d-1) rule to reduce the airplane Category A in values less than the appropriate 34 SM or 1 SM visibility
visibility by half but in no case less than 14 SM or 1,200 RVR. requirement. The 14 CFR Part 97.3 visibility reduction rule
[Figure 7-8] The approach can be initiated at any speed up does not apply, and you must take precautions to avoid
to the highest approach category authorized; however, the any obstacles in the visual segment. Procedures with
speed on the final approach segment must be reduced to penetrations of the final approach OIS are annotated at the
the Category A speed of less than 90 KIAS before the MAP in next amendment with Visibility Reduction by Helicopters
order to apply the visibility reduction. A constant airspeed NA.
is recommended on the final approach segment to comply

Helicopter Use of Standard Instrument Approach Procedures


Procedure Helicopter Visibility Minima Helicopter MDA/DA Maximum Speed Limitations
Standard The greater of: one half the As published for The helicopter may initiate the final approach
Category A visibility minima, Category A segment at speeds up to the upper limit of the
statute mile visibility or highest Approach Category authorized by the
1,200 RVR unless annotated procedure, but must be slowed to no more
(Visibility Reduction by than 90 KIAS at the MAP in order to apply the
Helicopters NA.) visibility reduction.
Copter Procedure As published As published 90 KIAS when on a published route/track.
GPS Copter Procedure As published As published 90 KIAS when on a published route, track, or
holding, 70 KIAS when on the final approach
or missed approach segment. Military procedures
are limited to 90 KIAS for all segments.

Figure 7-9. Helicopter use of standard instrument approach procedures.

7-9
Until all the affected SIAPs have been annotated, an Copter ILS approaches to Category (CAT) I facilities with
understanding of how the standard visibilities are DAs no lower than a 200-foot HAT provide an advantage
established is the best aid in determining if penetrations over a conventional ILS of shorter final segments and lower
of the final approach OIS exists. Some of the variables in minimums (based on the 20:1 missed approach surface).
determining visibilities are: density altitude (DA)/MDA There are also Copter approaches with minimums as low as
height above touchdown (HAT), height above airport 100-foot HAT and 14 SM visibility. Approaches with a HAT
(HAA), distance of the facility to the MAP (or the runway below 200 feet are annotated with the note: Special Aircrew
threshold for non- precision approaches), and approach & Aircraft Certification Required since the FAA must approve
lighting configurations. the helicopter and its avionics, and the flight crew must have
the required experience, training, and checking.
The standard visibility requirement, without any credit
for lights, is 1 SM for non-precision approaches and 34 The ground facilities (approach lighting, signal in space, hold
SM for precision approaches. This is based on a Category lines, maintenance, etc.) and air traffic infrastructure for CAT
A airplane 250320 feet HAT/HAA; for non-precision II ILS approaches are required to support these procedures.
approaches a distance of 10,000 feet or less from the The helicopter must be equipped with an AP, FD, or head
facility to the MAP (or runway threshold). For precision up guidance system, alternate static source (or heated static
approaches, credit for any approach light configuration; for source), and radio altimeter. The pilot must have at least a
non-precision approaches (with a 250 HAT) configured with private pilot helicopter certificate, an instrument helicopter
a Medium Intensity Approach Lighting System (MALSR), rating, and a type rating if the helicopter requires a type
Simplified Short Approach Lighting System (SSALR), or rating. Pilot experience requires the following flight times:
Approach Lighting System With Sequenced Flashing Lights 250 pilot in command (PIC), 100 helicopter PIC, 50 night
(ALSF)-1 normally results in a published visibility of 12 SM. PIC, 75 hours of actual or simulated instrument flight time,
including at least 25 hours of actual or simulated instrument
Consequently, if an ILS is configured with approach lights flight time in a helicopter or a helicopter flight simulator, and
or a non-precision approach is configured with MALSR, the appropriate recent experience, training and check. For
SSALR, or ALSF-1 lighting configurations and the procedure Copter CAT II ILS operations below 200 feet HAT, approach
has a published visibility of 34 SM or greater, a penetration deviations are limited to 14 scale of the localizer or glide
of the final approach OIS may exist. Also, pilots are unable slope needle. Deviations beyond that require an immediate
to determine whether there are penetrations of the final missed approach unless the pilot has at least one of the visual
approach OIS if a non-precision procedure does not have references in sight and otherwise meets the requirements of
approach lights or is configured with ODALS, MALS, 14 CFR Part 91.175(c). The reward for this effort is the ability
or SSALS/ SALS lighting since the minimum published to fly Copter ILS approaches with minima that are sometimes
visibility is 34 SM or greater. below the airplane CAT II minima. The procedure to apply for
this certification is available from your local Flight Standards
As a rule of thumb, approaches with published visibilities of District Office (FSDO).
34 SM or more should be regarded as having final approach
OIS penetrations and care must be taken to avoid any Copter GPS Approaches to an Airport or
obstacles in the visual segment. Heliport
Pilots flying Copter GPS or WAAS SIAPs must limit the speed
Approaches with published visibilities of 12 SM or less are to 90 KIAS on the initial and intermediate segment of the
free of OIS penetrations and the visibility reduction in Part approach and to no more than 70 KIAS on the final and
97.3 is authorized. missed approach segments. If annotated, holding may also
be limited to 90 KIAS to contain the helicopter within the
Copter Only Approaches to An Airport or small airspace provided for helicopter holding patterns.
Heliport During testing for helicopter holding, the optimum
Pilots flying Copter SIAPs, other than GPS, may use the airspeed and leg length combination was determined to
published minima with no reductions in visibility allowed. be 90 KIAS with a 3 NM outbound leg length. Consideration
The maximum airspeed is 90 KIAS on any segment of the was given to the wind drift on the dead reckoning entry
approach or missed approach. Figure 7-10 illustrates the leg at slower speeds, the turn radius at faster airspeeds,
COPTER ILS or LOC RWY 13 approach at New York/La Guardia and the ability of the helicopter in strong wind conditions
(LGA) airport. to intercept the inbound course prior to the holding fix.
The published minimums are to be used with no visibility

7-10
NE-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

NE-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

Figure 7-10. The COPTER ILS or LOC RWY 13 approach at New York/La Guardia (LGA) airport.

7-11
EC-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

EC-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

Figure 7-11. COPTER RNAV (GPS) 291 at Indianapolis Downtown Heliport.

7-12
reductions allowed. Figure 7-11 is an example of a Copter the runway). The pilot must begin the missed approach at
GPS PinS approach that allows the helicopter to fly VFR those points. Flying beyond either point before beginning
from the MAP to the heliport. the missed approach results in flying below the protected
obstacle clearance surface (OCS) and can result in a collision
The final and missed approach protected airspace providing with an obstacle.
obstacle and terrain avoidance is based on 70 KIAS, with
a maximum 10-knot tailwind component. It is absolutely The missed approach segment U.S. Standard for Terminal
essential that pilots adhere to the 70 KIAS limitation Instrument Procedures (TERPS) criteria for all Copter
in procedures that include an immediate climbing approaches take advantage of the helicopters climb
and turning missed approach. Exceeding the airspeed capabilities at slow airspeeds, resulting in high climb
restriction increases the turning radius significantly and gradients. [Figure 7-12] The OCS used to evaluate the
can cause the helicopter to leave the missed approach missed approach is a 20:1 inclined plane. This surface is
protected airspace. This may result in controlled flight into twice as steep for the helicopter as the OCS used to evaluate
terrain (CFIT) or obstacles. the airplane missed approach segment. The helicopter
climb gradient is therefore required to be double that of
If a helicopter has a VMINI greater than 70 knots, then the airplanes required missed approach climb gradient.
it is not capable of conducting this type of approach.
Similarly, if the autopilot in go-around mode climbs at a A minimum climb gradient of at least 400 feet per NM
VYI greater than 70 knots, then that mode cannot be used. is required unless a higher gradient is published on the
It is the responsibility of the pilot to determine compliance approach chart (e.g., a helicopter with a ground speed of
with missed approach climb gradient requirements 70 knots is required to climb at a rate of 467 fpm (467 fpm
when operating at speeds other than VY or VYI. Missed = 70 KIAS 400 feet per NM/60 seconds)). The advantage
approaches that specify an IMMEDIATE CLIMBING TURN of using the 20:1 OCS for the helicopter missed approach
have no provision for a straight ahead climbing segment segment instead of the 40:1 OCS used for the airplane is
before turning. A straight segment results in exceeding the that obstacles that penetrate the 40:1 missed approach
protected airspace limits. segment may not have to be considered. The result is
the DA/MDA may be lower for helicopters than for other
Protected obstacle clearance areas and surfaces for the aircraft. The minimum required climb gradient of 400 feet
missed approach are established on the assumption that per NM for the helicopter in a missed approach provides
the missed approach is initiated at the DA point and for 96 feet of required obstacle clearance (ROC) for each NM
non-precision approaches no lower than the MDA at the of flightpath.
MAP (normally at the threshold of the approach end of

20:1 versus 40:1 Obstacle clearance surface (OCS) for nonprecision missed approach procedures

40
0f
ee
t/N MAP
M
200 (st
feet an
/NM da
(sta rd)
nda
20:1 rd)
OSC

40:1 O 96 feet/NM
SC

48 feet/NM

The Copter 20:1 OCS provides for a lower MDA for the helicopter than for the airplane. A climb gradient
of 400 feet/NM will allow a required obstacle clearance (ROC) of 96 feet/NM for each NM of flightpath.

Figure 7-12. Obstacle clearance surface (OCS).

7-13
Helicopter Approaches to VFR Heliports To proceed VFR in uncontrolled airspace, Part 135 operators
Helicopter approaches to VFR heliports are normally are required to have at least 12 SM visibility and a 300-foot
developed either as public procedures to a PinS that may ceiling. Part 135 HEMS operators must have at least 1 SM day
serve more than one heliport or as a special procedure or 2 SM night visibility and a 500-foot ceiling provided the
to a specific VFR heliport that requires pilot training due heliport is located within 3 NM of the MAP. These minimums
to its unique characteristics. These approaches can be apply regardless of whether the approach is located on the
developed using very high frequency omni-directional plains of Oklahoma or in the Colorado mountains. However,
range (VOR) or automatic direction finder (ADF), but area for heliports located farther than 3 NM from the heliport, Part
navigation (RNAV) using GPS is the most common system 135 HEMS operators are held to an even higher standard and
used today. In the future, RNAV using the WAAS offers the the minimums and lighting conditions contained in Figure
most advantages because it can provide lower approach 7-15 apply to the entire route. Mountainous terrain at night
minimums, narrower route widths to support a network of with low light conditions requires a ceiling of 1,000 feet and
approaches, and may allow the heliport to be used as an either 3 SM or 5 SM visibility depending on whether it has
alternate. A majority of the special procedures to a specific been determined as part of the operators local flying area.
VFR heliport are developed in support of HEMS operators
and have a Proceed Visually segment between the MAP In Class B, C, D, and E surface area airspace, a SVFR clearance
and the heliport. Public procedures are developed as a PinS may be obtained if SVFR minimums exist. On your flight plan,
approach with a Proceed VFR segment between the MAP give ATC a heads up about your intentions by entering the
and the landing area. These PinS Proceed VFR procedures following in the remarks section: Request SVFR clearance
specify a course and distance from the MAP to the available after the MAP.
heliports in the area.
Approach to a Specific VFR Heliport
Approach to a PinS The note associated with these procedures is: PROCEED
The note associated with these procedures is: PROCEED VISUALLY FROM (NAMED MAP) OR CONDUCT THE
VFR FROM (NAMED MAP) OR CONDUCT THE SPECIFIED SPECIFIED MISSED APPROACH. Due to their unique
MISSED APPROACH. They may be developed as a special characteristics, these approaches require training. They are
or public procedure where the MAP is located more than 2 developed for hospitals, oil rigs, private heliports, etc. As
SM from the landing site, the turn from the final approach Specials, they require Flight Standards approval by a Letter
to the visual segment is greater than 30 degrees, or the VFR of Authorization (LOA) for Part 91 operators or by OpSpecs
segment from the MAP to the landing site has obstructions for Part 135 operators. The heliport associated with these
that require pilot actions to avoid them. Figure 7-13 is an procedures must be located within 10,560 feet of the MAP,
example of a public PinS approach that allows the pilot to the visual segment between the MAP and the heliport
fly to one of four heliports after reaching the MAP. evaluated for obstacle hazards, and the heliport must meet
the appropriate VFR heliport recommendations of AC
For Part 135 operations, pilots may not begin the instrument 150/5390-2, Heliport Design.
approach unless the latest weather report indicates that the
weather conditions are at or above the authorized IFR or VFR The PinS optimum location is 0.65 NM from the heliport.
minimums as required by the class of airspace, operating rule This provides an adequate distance to decelerate and
and/or OpSpecs, whichever is higher. Visual contact with the land from an approach speed of 70 KIAS. Certain airframes
landing site is not required; however, prior to the MAP, for may be certified to fly at reduced VMINI or below VMINI
either Part 91 or 135 operators, the pilot must determine if speeds as a result of flight control design or adherence to
the flight visibility meets the basic VFR minimums required AC 29-2, Certification of Transport Category Rotorcraft. In
by the class of airspace, operating rule and/or OpSpecs these cases, an approach procedure stating the minimum
(whichever is higher). The visibility is limited to no lower certified airspeed or flight below VMINI should be
than that published in the procedure until canceling IFR. If annotated on the approach procedure. The distance also
VFR minimums do not exist, then the published MAP must permits optimal blending of obstacle clearance criteria with
be executed. The pilot must contact air traffic control (ATC) non-instrument heliport approach areas.
upon reaching the MAP, or as soon as practical after that, and
advise whether executing the missed approach or canceling The visibility minimum is based on the distance from the
IFR and proceeding VFR. Figure 7-14 provides examples of MAP to the heliport, among other factors (e.g., height
the procedures used during a PinS approach for Part 91 and above the heliport elevation when at the MAP MDA). The
Part 135 operations. pilot is required to acquire and maintain visual contact

7-14
NE-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

NE-2, 23 AUG 2012 to 20 SEP 2012

Figure 7-13. COPTER RNAV (GPS) 250 at New York/La Guardia Airport.

7-15
Non-Mountainous Mountainous (14 CFR Part 95)
Area Local Cross Country Local Cross Country
Condition Ceiling-visibility
Day 500-1 800-2 500-2 800-3
NightHigh Lighting Conditions 500-2 1000-3 500-3 1000-3
NightLow Lighting Conditions 800-3 1000-5 1000-3 1000-5

Figure 7-14. Weather minimums and lighting conditions for HEMS operators.

Point-in-Space Approach Examples

EXAMPLE 1

Under Part 91, the operator flies the published IFR PinS approach procedure that has a charted MDA of 340 mean sea level (MSL)

and visibility of SM. When approaching the MAP at an altitude of 340 feet MSL, the pilot transitions from Instrument Meteorological

Conditions (IMC) to Visual Meteorological Conditions (VMC) and determines that the flight visibility is SM. The pilot must determine

prior to the MAP whether the applicable basic VFR weather minimums can be maintained from the MAP to the heliport or execute a
missed approach. If the pilot determines that the applicable basic VFR weather minimums can be maintained to the heliport, the pilot

may proceed VFR. If the visual segment is in Class B, C, D, or the surface area of Class E airspace, it may require the pilot to obtain
a Special VFR clearance.

EXAMPLE 2

For an operator to proceed VFR under Part 135, a minimum visibility of SM during the day and 1 SM at night with a minimum

ceiling of 300 feet. If prior to commencing the approach, the pilot determines the reported visibility is SM during the day, the pilot

descends IMC to an altitude no lower than the MDA and transitions to VMC. If the pilot determines prior to the MAP that the flight

visibility is less than SM in the visual segment, a missed approach must be executed at the MAP.

Figure 7-15. Point-in-space (PinS) approach examples for Part 91 and Part 135 operations.

with the heliport final approach and takeoff (FATO) area snow showers, or night operations over unlit surfaces such
at or prior to the MAP. Obstacle or terrain avoidance from as water). Flight in conditions of limited visual contrast
the MAP to the heliport is the responsibility of the pilot. should be avoided since this can result in a loss of horizontal
Pilots need to level off when reaching the MDA, which or surface reference, and obstacles such as wires become
may occur before arriving at the MAP, until reaching the perceptually invisible. To prevent spatial disorientation, loss
visual approach angle on the approach path to clear the of control (LOC) or CFIT, pilots should slow the helicopter to a
obstacles. If the required weather minimums do not exist, speed that provides a controlled deceleration in the distance
then the published MAP must be executed at the MAP equal to the forward visibility. The pilot should look for terrain
because IFR obstruction clearance areas are not applied to that provides sufficient contrast to either continue the flight
the visual segment of the approach and a missed approach or to make a precautionary landing. If spatial disorientation
segment protection is not provided between the MAP occurs and a climb into IMC is not feasible due to fuel state,
and the heliport. As soon as practicable after reaching icing conditions, equipment, etc., make every effort to land
the MAP, the pilot advises ATC whether cancelling IFR and the helicopter with a slight forward descent to prevent any
proceeding visually or executing the missed approach. sideward or rearward motion.

Inadvertent IMC All helicopter pilots should receive training on avoidance


Whether it is a corporate or HEMS operation, helicopter pilots and recovery from inadvertent IMC with emphasis on
sometimes operate in challenging weather conditions. An avoidance. An unplanned transition from VFR to IFR flight
encounter with weather that does not permit continued is an emergency that involves a different set of pilot actions.
flight under VFR might occur when conditions do not allow It requires the use of different navigation and operational
for the visual determination of a usable horizon (e.g., fog, procedures, interaction with ATC, and crewmember resource

7-16
management (CRM). Consideration should be given to the the helicopter is stabilized in the climb and headed
local flying areas terrain, airspace, air traffic facilities, weather away from danger. If the appropriate frequency is
(including seasonal affects such as icing and thunderstorms), not known, you should attempt to contact ATC on
and available airfield/heliport approaches. either very high frequency (VHF) 121.5 or ultra high
frequency (UHF) 243.0. Initial information provided
Training should emphasize the identification of to ATC should be your approximate location, that
circumstances conducive to inadvertent IMC and a inadvertent IMC has been encountered and an
strategy to abandon continued VFR flight in deteriorating emergency climb has been made, your altitude,
conditions. This strategy should include a minimum amount of flight time remaining (fuel state), and
altitude/airspeed combination that provides for an off- number of persons on board. You should then
airport/heliport landing, diverting to better conditions, request a vector to either VFR weather conditions
or initiating an emergency transition to IFR. Pilots should or to the nearest suitable airport/heliport that
be able to readily identify the minimum initial altitude conditions will support a successful approach. If
and course in order to avoid CFIT. Current IFR en route unable to contact ATC and a transponder code
and approach charts for the route of flight are essential. has not been previously established with ATC for
A GPS navigation receiver with a moving map provides inadvertent IMC, change the transponder code to
exceptional situational awareness for terrain and obstacle 7700.
avoidance.
A radio altimeter is a necessity for alerting the pilot
Training for an emergency transition to IFR should when inadvertently going below the minimum altitude.
include full and partial panel instrument flight, unusual Barometric altimeters are subject to inaccuracies that
attitude recovery, ATC communications, and instrument become important in helicopter IFR operations, especially
approaches. If an ILS is available and the helicopter is in cold temperatures.
equipped, an ILS approach should be made. Otherwise, if
the helicopter is equipped with an IFR approach-capable IFR Heliports
GPS receiver with a current database, a GPS approach A C 1 5 0 / 5 3 9 0 - 2 , H e l i p o r t D e s i g n , p r o v i d e s
should be made. If neither, an ILS or GPS procedure is recommendations for heliport design to support non-
available use another instrument approach. precision, approach with vertical guidance (APV), and
precision approaches to a heliport. When a heliport does
Upon entering inadvertent IMC, priority must be given not meet the criteria of this AC, FAA Order 8260.42, United
to control of the helicopter. Keep it simple and take one States Standard for Helicopter Area Navigation (RNAV),
action at a time. requires that an instrument approach be published as a
SPECIAL procedure with annotations that special aircrew
Control. First use the wings on the attitude indicator qualifications are required to fly the procedure. Currently,
to level the helicopter. Maintain heading and there are no operational civil IFR heliports in the U.S.,
increase to climb power. Establish climb airspeed at although the U.S. military has some non-precision and
the best angle of climb but no slower than VMINI. precision approach procedures to IFR heliports.
Climb. Climb straight ahead until your crosscheck is
established. Then make a turn only to avoid terrain
or objects. If an altitude has not been previously
established with ATC to climb to for inadvertent IMC,
then you should climb to an altitude that is at least
1,000 feet above the highest known object and that
allows for contacting ATC.
Communicate. Attempt to contact ATC as soon as

7-17
7-18
Appendix A

Emergency Procedures
Introduction
Changing weather conditions, air traffic control (ATC), aircraft, and pilots are variables that make instrument flying an
unpredictable and challenging operation. Safety of the flight depends on the pilots ability to manage these variables
while maintaining positive aircraft control and adequate situational awareness (SA). This appendix discusses recognition
and suggested remedies for emergency events related to un-forecasted, adverse weather, aircraft system malfunctions,
communication/navigation system malfunctions, loss of SA, and inadvertent instrument meteorological conditions
(IIMCs).

Emergencies
An emergency can be either a distress or urgency condition as defined in the pilot/controller glossary. Distress is defined
as a condition of being threatened by serious and/or imminent danger and requiring immediate assistance. Urgency is
defined as a condition of being concerned about safety and requiring timely but not immediate assistance; a potential
distress condition.

Pilots do not hesitate to declare an emergency when faced with distress conditions, such as fire, mechanical failure,
or structural damage. However, some are reluctant to report an urgency condition when encountering situations that
may not be immediately perilous but are potentially catastrophic. An aircraft is in an urgency condition the moment
that the pilot becomes doubtful about position, fuel endurance, weather, or any other condition that could adversely
affect flight safety. After the situation has developed into a distress condition is not the time to be requesting help.

The pilot in command (PIC) is responsible for crew, passengers, and operation of the aircraft at all times. Title 14 of the
Code of Federal Regulations (14 CFR) part 91, section 91.3 allows deviations from regulations during emergencies that
allow the PIC to make the best decision to ensure safety of all personnel during these contingencies. Also, by declaring
an emergency during flight, that aircraft becomes a priority to land safely. Pilots who become apprehensive for their
safety for any reason should request assistance immediately. Assistance is available in the form of radio, radar, direction
finding (DF) stations, and other aircraft.

Inadvertent Thunderstorm Encounter


A pilot should always avoid intentionally flying through a thunderstorm of any intensity; however, certain conditions may
be present that could lead to an inadvertent thunderstorm encounter. For example, flying in areas where thunderstorms
are embedded in large cloud masses may make thunderstorm avoidance difficult, even when the aircraft is equipped
with thunderstorm detection equipment. Pilots must be prepared to deal with inadvertent thunderstorm penetration.
At the very least, a thunderstorm encounter subjects the aircraft to turbulence that could be severe. The pilot, as well
as the crew and any passengers, should tighten seat belts and shoulder harnesses and secure any loose items in the
cabin or flight deck.

As with any emergency, the first order of business is to fly the aircraft. The pilot workload is high; therefore, increased
concentration is necessary to maintain an instrument scan. Once in a thunderstorm, it is better to maintain a course
straight through the thunderstorm rather than turning around. A straight course most likely gets the pilot out of the
hazard in the least amount of time, and turning maneuvers only increase structural stress on the aircraft.

Reduce power to a setting that maintains a recommended turbulence penetration speed as described in the appropriate
aircraft operators manual, and try to minimize additional power adjustments. Concentrate on keeping the aircraft in

A-1
a level attitude while allowing airspeed and altitude to fluctuate. Similarly, if using autopilot, disengage altitude and
speed hold modes because they only increase the aircrafts maneuvering, which increases structural stress.

During a thunderstorm encounter, the potential for icing also exists. As soon as possible, if the aircraft is so equipped,
turn on anti-icing/deicing equipment. Icing can be rapid at any altitude, and may lead to power failure and/or loss of
airspeed indication. Lightning is also present in a thunderstorm and can temporarily blind the pilot. To reduce risk,
turn up flight deck lights to the highest intensity, concentrate on flight instruments, and resist the urge to look outside.

Inadvertent Icing Encounter


Because icing is unpredictable, pilots may find themselves in icing conditions although they have done everything to
avoid the condition. To stay alert to this possibility while operating in visible moisture, pilots should monitor the outside
air temperature (OAT).

Anti-icing/deicing equipment is critical to safety of the flight. If anti-icing/deicing equipment is not used before sufficient
ice has accumulated, it may not be able to remove all ice accumulation. Use of anti-icing/deicing reduces power
availability; therefore, pilots should be familiar with the aircraft operators manual for use of anti-icing/deicing equipment.

Before entering visible moisture with temperatures at five degrees above freezing or cooler, activate appropriate
anti-icing/ deicing equipment in anticipation of ice accumulation; early ice detection is critical. Detecting ice may be
particularly difficult during night flight. The pilot may need to use a flashlight to check for ice accumulation on the
wings, fuselage, landing gear, and horizontal stabilizer. At the first indication of ice accumulation, the pilot must act
to circumvent icing conditions. Options for action once ice has begun to accumulate on the aircraft are the following:

Move to an altitude with significantly colder temperatures.


Move to an altitude with temperatures above freezing.
Fly to an area clear of visible moisture.
Change the heading, and fly to an area of known non-icing conditions.

If these options are not available, consider an immediate landing at the nearest suitable airport. Anti-icing/deicing
equipment does not allow aircraft to operate in icing conditions indefinitely; it only provides more time to evade icing
conditions. If icing is encountered, an aircraft controllability check should be considered in the landing configuration.
Give careful consideration to configuration changes that might produce unanticipated aircraft flight dynamics.

Precipitation Static
Precipitation static occurs when accumulated static electricity discharges from extremities of the aircraft. This discharge
has the potential to create problems with the aircrafts instruments. These problems range from serious, such as
complete loss of VHF communications and erroneous magnetic compass readings, to the annoyance of high-pitched
audio squealing.

Precipitation static is caused when an aircraft encounters airborne particles during flight (rain or snow) and develops a
negative charge. It can also result from atmospheric electric fields in thunderstorm clouds. When a significant negative
voltage level is reached, the aircraft discharges it, creating electrical disturbances. To reduce problems associated with
precipitation static, the pilot ensures that the aircrafts static wicks are maintained and accounted for. All broken or
missing static wicks should be replaced before an instrument flight.

Aircraft System Malfunction


Preventing aircraft system malfunctions that might lead to an in-flight emergency begins with a thorough preflight
inspection. In addition to items normally checked before visual flight rules (VFR) flight, pilots intending to fly instrument
flight rules (IFR) should pay particular attention to antennas, static wicks, anti-icing/deicing equipment, pitot tube, and
static ports. During taxi, verify operation and accuracy of all flight instruments. The pilots must ensure that all systems
are operational before departing into IFR conditions.

A-2
Generator Failure
Depending on aircraft being flown, a generator failure is indicated in different ways. Some aircraft use an ammeter
that indicates the state of charge or discharge of the battery. A positive indication on the ammeter indicates a charge
condition; a negative indication reveals a discharge condition. Other aircraft use a load meter to indicate the load being
carried by the generator. If the generator fails, a zero load indication is shown on the load meter. Review the appropriate
aircraft operators manual for information on the type of systems installed in the aircraft.

Once a generator failure is detected, the pilot must reduce electrical load on the battery and land as soon as practical.
Depending on electrical load and condition of the battery, sufficient power may be available for an hour or more of
flight or for only a matter of minutes. The pilot must be familiar with systems requiring electricity to run and which
continue to operate without power. In aircraft with multiple generators, care should be taken to reduce electrical load
to avoid overloading the operating generator(s). The pilot can attempt to troubleshoot generator failure by following
established procedures published in the appropriate aircraft operators manual. If the generator cannot be reset, inform
ATC of an impending electrical failure.

Instrument Failure
System or instrument failure is usually identified by a warning indicator or an inconsistency between indications on
the attitude indicator, supporting performance instruments, and instruments at the other pilot station, if so equipped.
Aircraft control must be maintained while the pilot identifies the failed components and expedite cross-check including
all flight instruments. The problem may be individual instrument failure or a system failure affecting several instruments.

One method of identification involves an immediate comparison of the attitude indicator with rate-of-turn indicator
and vertical speed indicator (VSI). Along with providing pitch-and-bank information, this technique compares the static
system with the pressure system and electrical system. Identify the failed components and use remaining functional
instruments to maintain aircraft control. Attempt to restore inoperative components by checking the appropriate power
source, changing to a backup or alternate system, and resetting the instrument if possible. Covering failed instruments
may enhance the ability to maintain aircraft control and navigate the aircraft. ATC should be notified of the problem
and, if necessary, declare an emergency before the situation deteriorates beyond the ability to recover.

Pitot/Static System Failure


A pitot or static system failure can also cause erratic and unreliable instrument indications. When a static system
problem occurs, it affects the airspeed indicator, altimeter, and VSI. In the absence of an alternate static source in an
unpressurized aircraft, the pilot could break the glass on the VSI because it is not required for instrument flight. Breaking
the glass provides both the altimeter and airspeed indicator a source of static pressure, but pilots should be cautious
because breaking the glass can cause additional instrument errors. Before considering, pilots should be familiar with
their aircrafts specific procedures for static problems.

Loss of Situational Awareness (SA)


SA is an overall assessment of environmental elements and how they affect flight. SA permits the pilot to make decisions
ahead of time and allows evaluation of several different options. Conversely, a pilot who is missing important information
about the flight is apt to make reactive decisions. Poor SA means that the pilot lacks vision regarding future events
that can force him or her to make decisions quickly often with limited options. During an IFR flight, pilots operate at
varying levels of SA. For example, a pilot may be en route to a destination with a high level of SA when ATC issues an
unexpected standard terminal arrival route (STAR). Because the STAR is unexpected and the pilot is unfamiliar with the
procedure, SA is reduced. However, after becoming familiar with the STAR and resuming normal navigation, the pilot
returns to a higher level of SA.

Factors reducing SA include distractions, unusual or unexpected events, complacency, high workload, unfamiliar
situations, and inoperative equipment. In some situations, a loss of SA may be beyond a pilots control. With an electrical
system failure and associated loss of an attitude indication, a pilot may find the aircraft in an unusual attitude. In this
situation, established procedures are used to regain SA. Pilots must be alert to loss of SA especially when hampered by

A-3
a reactive mindset. To regain SA, reassess the situation and work toward understanding what the problem is. The pilot
may need to seek additional information from other sources, such as navigation instruments, other crewmembers, or ATC.

Inadvertent Instrument Meteorological Condition (IIMC)


Some pilots have the misconception that inadvertent instrument meteorological condition (IIMC) does not apply to an IFR
flight. The following examples could cause a pilot to inadvertently encounter IMC.

1. The aircraft has entered visual meteorological conditions (VMC) during an instrument approach procedure
(IAP) and while circling to land encounters IMC.

2. During a non-precision IAP, the aircraft, in VMC, levels at the MDA just below the overcast. Suddenly, the
aircraft re-enters the overcast because either the pilot was unable to correctly hold his or her altitude and
climbed back into the overcast, or the overcast sloped downward ahead of the aircraft and, while maintaining
the correct MDA, the aircraft re-entered the clouds.

In order to survive an encounter with IIMC, a pilot must recognize and accept the seriousness of the situation. The pilot
will need to immediately commit to the instruments and perform the proper recovery procedures.

Maintaining Aircraft Control


Once the crewmembers recognize the situation, they commit to controlling the aircraft by using and trusting flight
instruments. Attempting to search outside the flight deck for visual confirmation can result in spatial disorientation
and complete loss of control. The crew must rely on instruments and depend on crew coordination to facilitate that
transition. The pilot or flight crew must abandon their efforts to establish visual references and fly the aircraft by their
flight instruments.

The most important concern, along with maintaining aircraft control, is to initiate a climb immediately. An immediate
climb provides a greater separation from natural and manmade obstacles, as well as improve radar reception of the
aircraft by ATC. An immediate climb should be appropriate for the current conditions, environment, and known or
perceived obstacles. Listed below are procedures that can assist in maintaining aircraft control after encountering IIMC
with the most critical action being to immediately announce IIMC and begin a substantial climb while procedures are
being performed. These procedures are performed nearly simultaneously:

Attitudelevel wings on the attitude indicator.


Headingmaintain heading; turn only to avoid known obstacles.
Poweradjust power as necessary for desired climb rate.
Airspeedadjust airspeed as necessary. Complete the IIMC recovery according to local and published
regulations and policies.

In situations where the pilot encounters IIMC while conducting an instrument maneuver, the best remedy is immediate
execution of the published missed approach.

The pilot must trust the flight instruments concerning the aircrafts attitude regardless of intuition or visual interpretation.
The vestibular sense (motion sensing by the inner ear) can confuse the pilot. Because of inertia, sensory areas of the
inner ear cannot detect slight changes in aircraft attitude nor can they accurately sense attitude changes that occur at
a uniform rate over time. Conversely, false sensations often push the pilot to believe that the attitude of the aircraft has
changed when in fact it has not, resulting in spatial disorientation.

ATC Requirements During an In-Flight Emergency


ATC personnel can help pilots during in-flight emergency situations. Pilots should understand the services provided
by ATC and the resources and options available. These services enable pilots to focus on aircraft control and help them
make better decisions in a time of stress.

A-4
Provide Information
During emergency situations, pilots should provide as much information as possible to ATC. ATC uses the information to
determine what kind of assistance it can provide with available assets and capabilities. Information requirements vary
depending on the existing situation. ATC requires at a minimum, the following information for in-flight emergencies:
Aircraft identification and type
Nature of the emergency
Pilots desires

If time and the situation permits, the pilot should provide ATC with more information. Listed below is additional
information that would help ATC in further assisting the pilot during an emergency situation.
Aircraft altitude
Point of departure and destination
Airspeed
Fuel remaining in time
Heading since last known position
Visible landmarks
Navigational aids (NAVAID) signals received
Time and place of last known position
Aircraft color
Pilot reported weather
Emergency equipment on board
Number of people on board
Pilot capability for IFR flight
Navigation equipment capability

When the pilot requests, or when deemed necessary, ATC can enlist services of available radar facilities and DF facilities
operated by the FAA. ATC can also coordinate with other agencies, such as the Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) and other local authorities and request their emergency services.

Radar Assistance
Radar is an invaluable asset that can be used by pilots during emergencies. With radar, ATC can provide navigation
assistance to aircraft and provide last-known location during catastrophic emergencies. If a VFR aircraft encounters or
is about to encounter IMC weather conditions, the pilot can request radar vectors to VFR airports or VFR conditions. If
the pilot determines that he or she is qualified and the aircraft is capable of conducting IFR flight, the pilot should file
an IFR flight plan and request a clearance from ATC to the destination airport as appropriate. If the aircraft has already
encountered IFR conditions, ATC can inform the pilot of appropriate terrain/obstacle clearance minimum altitude. If the
aircraft is below appropriate terrain/obstacle clearance minimum altitude and sufficiently accurate position information
has been received or radar identification is established, ATC can furnish a heading or radial on which to climb to reach
appropriate terrain/ obstacle clearance minimum altitude.

Emergency Airport
ATC personnel consider how much remaining fuel in relation to the distance to the airport and weather conditions
when recommending an emergency airport to aircraft requiring assistance. Depending on the nature of the emergency,
certain weather phenomena may deserve weighted consideration. A pilot may elect to fly further to land at an airport
with VFR conditions instead of closer airfield with IFR conditions. Other considerations are airport conditions, NAVAID
status, aircraft type, pilots qualifications, and vectoring or homing capability to the emergency airport. In addition,
ATC and pilots should determine which guidance can be used to fly to the emergency airport. The following options

A-5
may be available:
Radar
DF
Following another aircraft
NAVAIDs
Pilotage by landmarks
Compass headings

Emergency Obstruction Video Map (EOVM)


The emergency obstruction video map (EOVM) is intended to facilitate advisory service in an emergency situation when
appropriate terrain/obstacle clearance minimum altitude cannot be maintained. The EOVM, and the service provided,
are used only under the following conditions:
1. The pilot has declared an emergency.
2. The controller has determined an emergency condition exists or is imminent because of the pilots inability to
maintain an appropriate terrain/obstacle clearance minimum altitude.

NOTE: Appropriate terrain/obstacle clearance minimum altitudes may be defined as minimum IFR altitude (MIA), minimum
en route altitude (MEA), minimum obstacle clearance altitude (MOCA), or minimum vectoring altitude (MVA).

When providing emergency vectoring service, the controller advises the pilot that any headings issued are emergency
advisories intended only to direct the aircraft toward and over an area of lower terrain/obstacle elevation. Altitudes and
obstructions depicted on the EOVM are actual altitudes and locations of the obstacle/terrain and contain no lateral or
vertical buffers for obstruction clearance.

Responsibility
ATC, in communication with an aircraft in distress, should handle the emergency and coordinate and direct the activities
of assisting facilities. ATC will not transfer this responsibility to another facility unless that facility can better handle the
situation. When an ATC facility receives information about an aircraft in distress, they forward detailed data to the center
in the area of the emergency. Centers serve as central points for collecting information, coordinating with search and
rescue (SAR) and distributing information to appropriate agencies.

Although 121.5 megahertz and 243.0 megahertz are emergency frequencies, the pilot should keep the aircraft on the
initial contact frequency. The pilot should change frequencies only when a valid reason exists. When necessary, and
if weather and circumstances permit, ATC should recommend that aircraft maintain or increase altitude to improve
communications, radar, or DF reception.

Escort
An escort aircraft, if available, should consider and evaluate an appropriate formation. Special consideration must be
given if maneuvers take the aircraft through clouds. Aircraft should not execute an in-flight join up during emergency
conditions unless both crews involved are familiar with and capable of formation flight and can communicate and have
visual contact with each other.

A-6
Appendix B

Acronyms
A
AACAircraft Administration Communications
AAUPAttention All Users Page
ACAdvisory Circular
ACARSAircraft Communications Addressing and Reporting System
ADCsAir Data Computers
ADDSAviation Digital Data Services
ADFAutomatic Direction Finder
ADSAutomatic Dependent Surveillance
ADS-BAutomatic Dependent Surveillance-Broadcast
AEGAircraft Evaluation Group
A/FDAirport/Facility Directory
AFMAirplane Flight Manual or Aircraft Flight Manual
AFMSAirplane Flight Manual Supplements
AFSAircraft Flight Safety
AFSFlight Standards Service
AFSSAutomated Flight Service Station
AGLAbove Ground Level
AIMAeronautical Information Manual
AIPAeronautical Information Publication
AIRAircraft Certification Service
AIRMETsAirmans Meteorological Information
AJV-3Aeronautical Navigation Products
AJW-3Flight Inspection Services
ALT ACQAltitude Acquire
ALT HoldAltitude Hold
ANPActual Navigation Performance
AOCAircraft Operational Communications
APT WPAirport Waypoint
APVApproach with Vertical Guidance
ARINCAeronautical Radio Incorporated
A-RNAVAdvanced Area Navigation
ARTCCAir Route Traffic Control Center
ARTSAutomated Radar Terminal System
ASDAAccelerate-Stop Distance Available
ASDE-XAirport Surface Detection Equipment-Model X
A-SMGCSAdvanced Surface Movement Guidance and Control System
ASOSAutomated Surface Observing System
ASRAirport Surveillance Radar
ASRSAviation Safety Reporting System
ATAAir Transport Association
ATCAir Traffic Control
ATCAAAir Traffic Control Assigned Airspace
ATCRBSAir Traffic Control Radar Beacon System

B-1
ATCSAir Traffic Control Specialist
ATDAlong-Track Distance

ATISAutomatic Terminal Information Service


ATSAir Traffic Service
AWCAviation Weather Center
AWOSAutomated Weather Observing System
AWSSAutomated Weather Sensor System

B
Baro-VNAVBarometric Vertical Navigation
B-RNAVEuropean Basic RNAV

C
CATCategory
CDICourse Deviation Indicator
CDLConfiguration Deviation List
CENRAPCenter Radar ARTS Processing
CFAControlled Firing Areas
CFITControlled Flight Into Terrain
CFRCode of Federal Regulations
CNFComputer Navigation Fix
COPChangeover Point
COTSCommercial Off-The-Shelf
CRCCyclic Redundancy Check
CTAFCommon Traffic Advisory Frequency
CVFPCharted Visual Flight Procedure
CWASCenter Weather Advisories

D
DADensity Altitude; Decision Altitude
D-ATISDigital Automatic Terminal Information Service
DDADerived Decision Altitude
DEMDigital Elevation Model
DERDeparture End of the Runway
DFDirection Finding
DHDecision Height
DMEDistance Measuring Equipment
DODDepartment of Defense
DOTDepartment of Transportation
DPsDeparture Procedures
DRVSMDomestic Reduced Vertical Separation Minimums
DUATSDirect User Access Terminal System
DVADiverse Vector Area

E
E/DEnd of Decent
EDCTExpect Departure Clearance Time
EFASEn-Route Flight Advisory Service
EFBElectronic Flight Bag
EFCExpect Further Clearance
EFVEnhanced Flight Visibility

B-2
EFVSEnhanced Flight Vision System
EGPWSEnhanced Ground Proximity Warning Systems
EOPsEngine Out Procedures
EOVMEmergency Obstruction Video Map
ER-OPSExtended Range Operations
ETAEstimated Time of Arrival
EVEnhanced Vision
EVOEquivalent Visual Operations
EWINSEnhanced Weather Information System

F
FAAFederal Aviation Administration
FAFFinal Approach Fix
FAPFinal Approach Point
FBFly-By
FBWPFly-By Waypoint
FCCFederal Communications Commission
FDFlight Director
FDPFlight Data Processing
FEFlight Engineer
FIRFlight Information Region
FISFlight Information System
FIS-BFlight Information ServicesBroadcast
FISDLFlight Information Services Data Link
FLFlight Level
FL CHGFlight Level Change
FLIRForward Looking Infra-Red
FMCFlight Management Computer
FMSFlight Management System
FOFly-Over
FOMFlight Operations Manual
FOWPFly-Over Waypoint
FPAFlight Path Angle
FPMFeet Per Minute
FPNMFeet Per Nautical Mile
FPVFlight Path Vector
FSBFlight Standardization Board
FSDOFlight Standards District Office
FSLNOAA Forecast Systems Laboratory
FSSFlight Service Station

G
GBASGround-Based Augmentation System
GCAGround Controlled Approach
GCOGround Communication Outlet
GDPGround Delay Programs
GDPEGround Delay Program Enhancements
GLSGlobal Navigation Satellite System Landing System
GNSSGlobal Navigation Satellite System GPSGlobal Positioning System
GPWSGround Proximity Warning System G/SGlide Slope
GSGround Speed

B-3
GWSGraphical Weather Service

H
HAAHeight Above Airport
HARHigh Altitude Redesign
HATHeight Above Touchdown
HAZMATHazardous Materials
HDDHead-Down Display
HFHigh Frequency
HGSHead-up Guidance System
HIWASHazardous In-flight Weather Advisory Service
HSIHorizontal Situation Indicator
HUDHead-Up Display

I
IAFInitial Approach Fix
IAPInstrument Approach Procedure
IASIndicated Air Speed
ICAOInternational Civil Aviation Organization
IFIntermediate Fix
IFRInstrument Flight Rules
IIMCInadvertent Instrument Meteorological Condition
ILSInstrument Landing System
IMCInstrument Meteorological Conditions
INSInertial Navigation System
IOCInitial Operational Capability
IRUInertial Reference Unit

K
KIASknots indicated airspeed
KLAXLos Angeles International Airport
KLMUMonroe Regional Airport

L
LAASLocal Area Augmentation System
LAHSOLand And Hold Short Operations
LDALocalizer-type Directional Aid; Landing Distance Available
LFLow Frequency
LNAVLateral Navigation
LOCLocalizer
LOMLocator Outer Marker
LPVLocalizer Performance with Vertical Guidance
LTPLanding Threshold Point
LVL CHGLevel Change

M
MAAMaximum Authorized Altitude
MAHWPMissed Approach Holding Waypoint
MAMSMilitary Airspace Management System
MAPMissed Approach Point

B-4
MAWPMissed Approach Waypoint
MCAMinimum Crossing Altitude

MDAMinimum Descent Altitude


MDHMinimum Descent Height
MEAMinimum En-route Altitude
MELMinimum Equipment List
METARAviation Routine Weather Report
MFMedium Frequency
MIAMinimum IFR Altitude
MLSMicrowave Landing System
MMWRMillimeter Wave Radar
MNPSMinimum Navigation Performance Specifications
MOAMilitary Operations Area
MOCAMinimum Obstruction Clearance Altitude
MOPSMinimum Operational Performance Standards
MORAMinimum Off-Route Altitude
MRAMinimum Reception Altitude
MSAMinimum Safe Altitude
MSAWMinimum Safe Altitude Warning
MSLMean Sea Level
MTAMinimum Turning Altitude
MTRMilitary Training Route
MVAMinimum Vectoring Altitude

N
NANot Authorized
NACONational Aeronautical Charting Office
NASNational Airspace System
NASANational Aeronautics and Space Administration
NATNorth Atlantic
NAVAIDNavigational Aid
NCARNational Center for Atmospheric Research
NDBNon-Directional Beacon
NextGenNext Generation Air Transportation System
NFDCNational Flight Data Center
NFPONational Flight Procedures Office
NGANational Geospatial- Intelligence Agency
NMNautical Mile
NMACNear Mid-Air Collision
NNEWNext Generation Network-Enabled
NOAANational Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
NO A/GNo Air-to-Ground Communication
NOPACNorth Pacific
NOTAMNotice to Airmen
NOZNormal Operating Zone
NPANon-Precision Approach
NRRNon-Restrictive Routing
NRSNational Reference System
NTAPNotice to Airmen Publication
NTSBNational Transportation Safety Board
NTZNo Transgression Zone

B-5
NVSNAS voice switch
NWSNational Weather Service

O
OATOutside Air Temperature
OBSOmni Bearing Selector
OCSObstacle Clearance Surface
ODPObstacle Departure Procedure
OpSpecsOperations Specifications
OROCAOff-Route Obstruction Clearance Altitude
OSVOperational Service Volume

P
PAPrecision Approach
PARPrecision Approach Radar
PCGPositive Course Guidance
PDCPre-Departure Clearance
PDRPreferential Departure Route
PFPilot Flying
PFDPrimary Flight Display
PIPrincipal Inspector
PICPilot In Command
PIREPPilot Weather Report
PKIPublic/Private Key Technology
PMPilot Monitoring
POHPilots Operating Handbook
POIPrinciple Operations Inspector
PRMPrecision Runway Monitor
P-RNAVEuropean Precision RNAV
PTProcedure Turn
PTPPoint-To-Point

Q
QFETransition Height
QNETransition Level
QNHTransition Altitude

R
RAResolution Advisory; Radio Altitude
RAIMReceiver Autonomous Integrity Monitoring
RALResearch Applications Laboratory
RCORemote Communications Outlet
RJRegional Jet
RNAVArea Navigation
RNPRequired Navigation Performance
RNP ARRequired Navigation Performance Authorization Required
ROCRequired Obstacle Clearance
RSPRunway Safety Program
RVRRunway Visual Range
RVSMReduced Vertical Separation Minimums
RVVRunway Visibility Value

B-6
RWYRunway
RWY WPRunway Waypoint

S
SASituational Awareness
SAAARSpecial Aircraft and Aircrew Authorization Required
SAARSpecial Aircraft and Aircrew Requirements
SAMSSpecial Use Airspace Management System
SARSearch and Rescue
SASStability Augmentation System
SATNAVSatellite Navigation
SDFSimplified Directional Facility
SDRService Difficulty Reports
SERStart End of Runway
SIAPStandard Instrument Approach Procedure
SIDStandard Instrument Departure
SIGMETSignificant Meteorological Information
SMStatute Mile
SMASurface Movement Advisor
SMGCSSurface Movement Guidance and Control System
SOIASimultaneous Offset Instrument Approaches
SOPStandard Operating Procedure
SPECINon-routine (Special) Aviation Weather Report
SSVStandard Service Volume
STARStandard Terminal Arrival
STARSStandard Terminal Automation Replacement System
STCSupplemental Type Certificate
SUASpecial Use Airspace
SUA/ISESpecial Use Airspace/In-flight Service Enhancement
SVFRSpecial Visual Flight Rules
SVSSynthetic Vision System
SWAPSevere Weather Avoidance Plan
SWIMSystem Wide Information Management

T
TATraffic Advisory
TAATerminal Arrival Area
TACANTactical Air Navigation
TAFTerminal Aerodrome Forecast
TASTrue Air Speed
TAWSTerrain Awareness and Warning Systems
TBTrack Bar
TCASTraffic Alert and Collision Avoidance System
TCHThreshold Crossing Height
TDLSTerminal Data Link System
TDZTouchdown Zone
TDZETouchdown Zone Elevation
TECTower En-route Control
TERPSU.S. Standard for Terminal Instrument Procedures
TFRTemporary Flight Restriction
TIS-BTraffic Information Service-Broadcast
TIBSTelephone Information Briefing Service

B-7
TIS-BTraffic Information Service-Broadcast
TIBSTelephone Information Briefing Service
TOCTop Of Climb
TODTop Of Descent
TODATakeoff Distance Available
TOGATakeoff/Go Around
TORATakeoff Runway Available
TPPTerminal Procedures Publication
TRACABTerminal Radar Approach Control in Tower Cab
TSOTechnical Standard Order
TSOATechnical Standing Order Authorization

U
UHFUltra High Frequency
UNICOMUniversal Communications
USUnited States
USAFUnited States Air Force
USDAUnited States Department of Agriculture

V
VCOAVisual Climb Over Airport / Airfield
VDAVertical Descent Angle
VDPVisual Descent Point
VFRVisual Flight Rules
VGSIVisual Glide Slope Indicator
VHFVery High Frequency
VLJVery Light Jet
VMCVisual Meteorological Conditions
VMINIMinimum SpeedIFR
VNAVVertical Navigation
VNEINever-Exceed Speed-IFR
VSIVertical Speed Indicator
VORVery High-Frequency Omnidirectional Range
VORTACVery High Frequency Omnidirectional Range/Tactical Air Navigation
VOTVOR Test Facility Signal
VPAVertical Path Angle
VREFReference Landing Speed
V/SVertical Speed
VSOStalling Speed or the Minimum Steady Flight Speed in the Landing Configuration

W
WAASWide Area Augmentation System
WACWorld Aeronautical Chart
WAMWide Area Multi-lateration
WPWaypoint

Z
ZFWFort Worth Air Route Traffic Control Center

B-8
Glossary

Abeam Fix. A fix, NAVAID, point, or object positioned Airport Sketch. Depicts the runways and their length, width,
approximately 90 degrees to the right or left of the aircraft and slope, the touchdown zone elevation, the lighting
track along a route of flight. Abeam indicates a general system installed on the end of the runway, and taxiways.
position rather than a precise point. Airport sketches are located on the lower left or right
portion of the instrument approach chart.
Accelerate-Stop Distance Available (ASDA). The runway
plus stopway length declared available and suitable for Airpor t Sur face Detec tion Equipment-Model X
the acceleration and deceleration of an airplane aborting a (ASDE-X). Enables air traffic controllers to detect potential
takeoff. runway conflicts by providing detailed coverage of movement
on runways and taxiways. By collecting data from a variety of
Advanced Surface Movement Guidance and Control sources, ASDE-X is able to track vehicles and aircraft on the
System (A-SMGCS). A system providing routing, guidance airport movement area and obtain identification information
and surveillance for the control of aircraft and vehicles, from aircraft transponders.
in order to maintain the declared surface movement rate
under all weather conditions within the aerodrome visibility Air Route Traffic Control Center (ARTCC). A facility
operational level (AVOL) while maintaining the required established to provide air traffic control service to aircraft
level of safety. operating on IFR flight plans within controlled airspace and
principally during the en route phase of flight
Aircraft Approach Category. A grouping of aircraft based
on reference landing speed (VREF), if specified, or if VREF is Air Traffic Service (ATS). Air traffic service is an ICAO
not specified, 1.3 VSO (the stalling speed or minimum steady generic term meaning variously, flight information service,
flight speed in the landing configuration) at the maximum alerting service, air traffic advisory service, air traffic control
certificated landing weight. service (area control service, approach control service, or
aerodrome control service).
Airport Diagram. A full-page depiction of the airport that
includes the same features of the airport sketch plus Approach End of Runway (AER). The first portion of the
additional details, such as taxiway identifiers, airport runway available for landing. If the runway threshold is
latitude and longitude, and building identification. Airport displaced, use the displaced threshold latitude/longitude
diagrams are located in the U.S. Terminal Procedures as the AER.
booklet following the instrument approach charts for a
particular airport. Approach Fix. From a database coding standpoint, an
approach fix is considered to be an identifiable point
Airport/Facility Directory (A/FD). Regional booklets in space from the intermediate fix (IF) inbound. A fix
published by the Aeronautical Navigation Products branch located between the initial approach fix (IAF) and the IF is
(AJV-3) that provide textual information about all airports, considered to be associated with the approach transition
both VFR and IFR. The A/FD includes runway length and or feeder route.
width, runway surface, load bearing capacity, runway
slope, airport services, and hazards, such as birds and
reduced visibility.

G-1
Approach Gate. An imaginary point used by ATC to vector Automatic Dependent Surveillance-Broadcast (ADS-B).
aircraft to the final approach course. The approach gate A surveillance system that continuously broadcasts GPS
is established along the final approach course 1 NM from position information, aircraft identification, altitude,
the final approach fix (FAF) on the side away from the velocity vector, and direction to all other aircraft and air
airport and is located no closer than 5 NM from the landing traffic control facilities within a specific area. Automatic
threshold. dependent surveillance-broadcast (ADS-B) information
is displayed in the flight deck via a flight deck display of
Area Navigation (RNAV). A method of navigation that traffic information (CDTI) unit, providing the pilot with
permits aircraft operations on any desired course within greater situational awareness. ADS-B transmissions also
the coverage of station referenced navigation signals or provides controllers with a more complete picture of traffic
within the limits of self contained system capability. and updates that information more frequently than other
surveillance equipment.
Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS)/Automated
Weather Sensor System (AWSS). The ASOS/AWSS is the Automatic Terminal Information Service (ATIS). A
primary surface weather observing system of the U.S. recorded broadcast available at most airports with an
operating control tower that includes crucial information
Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS). A weather about runways and instrument approaches in use, specific
observing system that provides minute-by minute weather outages, and current weather conditions, including visibility.
observations, such as temperature, dew point, wind, altimeter
setting, visibility, sky condition, and precipitation. Some Center Radar ARTS Presentation/Processing (CENRAP).
ASOS stations include a precipitation discriminator that can CENRAP was developed to provide an alternative to a
differentiate between liquid and frozen precipitation. non-radar environment at terminal facilities should an ASR
fail or malfunction. CENRAP sends aircraft radar beacon
Automated Weather Observing System (AWOS). A suite target information to the ASR terminal facility equipped
of sensors that measure, collect, and disseminate weather with ARTS.
data. AWOS stations provide a minute-by-minute update
of weather parameters, such as wind speed and direction, Changeover Point (COP). A COP indicates the point where
temperature and dew point, visibility, cloud heights and types, a frequency change is necessary between navigation aids,
precipitation, and barometric pressure. A variety of AWOS when other than the midpoint on an airway, to receive
system types are available (from AWOS 1 to AWOS 3), each course guidance from the facility ahead of the aircraft
of which includes a different sensor array. instead of the one behind. These COPs divide an airway
or route segment and ensure continuous reception of
Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS). The AWSS navigational signals at the prescribed minimum en route
is part of the Aviation Surface Weather Observation Network IFR altitude.
suite of programs and provides pilots and other users
with weather information through the Automated Surface Charted Visual Flight Procedure (CVFP). A CVFP may be
Observing System. The AWSS sensor suite automatically established at some towered airports for environmental
collects, measures, processes, and broadcasts surface or noise considerations, as well as when necessary for the
weather data. safety and efficiency of air traffic operations. Designed
primarily for turbojet aircraft, CVFPs depict prominent
Automated Weather System. Any of the automated landmarks, courses, and recommended altitudes to specific
weather sensor platforms that collect weather data at runways.
airports and disseminate the weather information via
radio and/or landline. The systems currently consist of the Cockpit Display of Traffic Information (CDTI). The display
Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS), Automated and user interface for information about air traffic within
Weather Sensor System (AWSS), and Automated Weather approximately 80 miles. It typically combines and shows
Observation System (AWOS). traffic data from TCAS, TIS-B, and ADS-B. Depending on

G-2
features, the display may also show terrain, weather, and of the fields necessary to define fully a single useful piece
navigation information. of data.

Collision Hazard. A condition, event, or circumstance Decision Altitude (DA). A specified altitude in the precision
that could induce an occurrence of a collision or surface approach at which a missed approach must be initiated
accident or incident. if the required visual reference to continue the approach
has not been established. The term Decision Altitude (DA)
Columns. See database columns. is referenced to mean sea level and the term Decision
Height (DH) is referenced to the threshold elevation. Even
Contact Approach. An approach where an aircraft on an though DH is charted as an altitude above MSL, the U.S.
IFR flight plan, having an air traffic control authorization, has adopted the term DA as a step toward harmonization
operating clear of clouds with at least one mile flight of the United States and international terminology. At
visibility, and a reasonable expectation of continuing to some point, DA will be published for all future instrument
the destination airport in those conditions, may deviate approach procedures with vertical guidance.
from the instrument approach procedure and proceed to
the destination airport by visual reference to the surface. Decision Height (DH). See Decision Altitude.
This approach is only authorized when requested by the
pilot and the reported ground visibility at the destination Departure End of Runway (DER). The end of runway
airport is at least one statute mile. available for the ground run of an aircraft departure. The
end of the runway that is opposite the landing threshold,
Controlled Flight Into Terrain (CFIT). A situation where a sometimes referred to as the stop end of the runway.
mechanically normally functioning airplane is inadvertently Altitude, velocity vector, and direction to all other aircraft
flown into the ground, water, or an obstacle. There are and air traffic control facilities within a specific area.
two basic causes of CFIT accidents; both involve flight Automatic dependent surveillance-broadcast (ADS-B)
crew situational awareness. One definition of situational information is displayed in the flight deck via a cockpit
awareness is an accurate perception by pilots of the factors display of traffic information (CDTI) unit, providing the pilot
and conditions currently affecting the safe operation of the with greater situational awareness. ADS-B transmissions
aircraft and the crew. The causes of CFIT are the flight crews also provide controllers with a more complete picture of
lack of vertical position awareness or their lack of horizontal traffic and update that information more frequently than
position awareness in relation to terrain and obstacles. other surveillance equipment.

Database Columns. The spaces for data entry on each Descend Via. A descend via clearance instructs you to follow
record. One column can accommodate one character. the altitudes published on a STAR. You are not authorized to
leave your last assigned altitude unless specifically cleared
Database Field. The collection of characters needed to to do so. If ATC amends the altitude or route to one that
define one item of information. is different from the published procedure, the rest of the
charted descent procedure is canceled. ATC will assign
Database Identifier. A specific geographic point in space you any further route, altitude, or airspeed clearances, as
identified on an aeronautical chart and in a naviation necessary.
database, officially designated by the controlling state
authority or derived by Jeppesen. It has no ATC function Digital ATIS (D-ATIS). An alternative method of receiving
and should not be used in filing flight plans nor used when ATIS reports by aircraft equipped with datalink services
communicating with ATC. capable of receiving information in the flight deck over their
Aircraft Communications Addressing and Reporting System
Database Record. A single line of computer data made up (ACARS) unit.

G-3
Digital elevation model (DEM). A digital representation of hover or a departure is made. The touchdown and lift-off
ground surface topography or terrain. area (TLOF) where the helicopter is permitted to land is
normally centered in the FATO. A safety area is provided
Diverse Vector Area (DVA). An airport may establish a around the FATO.
diverse vector area if it is necessary to vector aircraft below
the minimum vectoring altitude to assist in the efficient Fix. A geographical position determined by visual reference
flow of departing traffic. DVA design requirements are to the surface, by reference to one or more radio NAVAIDs,
outlined in TERPS and allow for the vectoring of aircraft by celestial plotting, or by another navigational device.
immediately off the departure end of the runway below NOTE: Fix is a generic name for a geographical position
the MVA. and is referred to as a fix, waypoint, intersection, reporting
point, etc.
Dynamic Magnetic Variation. A field that is simply a
computer model calculated value instead of a measured Flight Information Region (FIR). A FIR is an airspace of
value contained in the record for a waypoint. defined dimensions within which Flight Information Service
and Alerting Service are provided. Flight Information Service
Electronic Flight Bag (EFB). An electronic display system (FIS) is a service provided for the purpose of giving advice
intended primarily for flight deck or cabin use. EFB devices and information useful for the safe and efficient conduct
can display a variety of aviation data or perform basic of flights. Alerting Service is a service provided to notify
calculations (e.g., performance data, fuel calculations, etc.). appropriate organizations regarding aircraft in need of search
In the past, some of these functions were traditionally and rescue aid, and assist such organizations as required.
accomplished using paper references or were based on
data provided to the flight crew by an airlines flight dispatch Flight Level (FL). A flight level is a level of constant
function. The scope of the EFB system functionality may also atmospheric pressure related to a reference datum of
include various other hosted databases and applications. 29.92 "Hg. Each flight level is stated in three digits that
Physical EFB displays may use various technologies, represents hundreds of feet. For example, FL 250 represents
formats, and forms of communication. These devices are an altimeter indication of 25,000 feet.
sometimes referred to as auxiliary performance computers
(APC) or laptop auxiliary performance computers (LAPC). Floating Waypoints. Floating waypoints represent
airspace fixes at a point in space not directly associated
Ellipsoid of Revolution. The surface that results when an with a conventional airway. In many cases, they may be
ellipse is rotated about one of its axes. established for such purposes as ATC metering fixes,
holding points, RNAV-direct routing, gateway waypoints,
En Route Obstacle Clearance Areas. Obstacle clearance STAR origination points leaving the en route structure,
areas for en route planning are identified as primary, and SID terminating points joining the en route structure.
secondary, and turning areas, and they are designed to
provide obstacle clearance route protection width for Fly-by (FB) Waypoint. A waypoint that requires the use of
airways and routes. turn anticipation to avoid overshooting the next flight
segment.
Expanded Service Volume. When ATC or a procedures
specialist requires the use of a NAVAID beyond the Fly-over (FO) Waypoint. A waypoint that precludes any turn
limitations specified for standard service volume, an until the waypoint is overflown, and is followed by either
expanded service volume (ESV) may be established. See an intercept maneuver of the next flight segment or direct
standard service volume. flight to the next waypoint.

Feeder Route. A feeder route is a route depicted on IAP Four Corner Post Configuration. An arrangement of air
charts to designate courses for aircraft to proceed from the traffic pathways in a terminal area that brings incoming
en route structure to the IAF. Feeder routes, also referred flights over fixes at four corners of the traffic area, while
to as approach transitions, technically are not considered outbound flights depart between the fixes, thus minimizing
approach segments but are an integral part of many IAPs. conflicts between arriving and departing traffic.

Field. See database field.

Final Approach and Takeoff Area (FATO). The FATO is a


defined heliport area over which the final approach to a

G-4
Gateway Fix. A navigational aid or fix where an aircraft interface system that provides an aircraft operator with all
transitions between the domestic route structure and the of the attitude and guidance inputs required to safely fly
oceanic route airspace. an aircraft in close conformance to air traffic procedures.

Geodetic Datum. The reference plane from which geodetic Initial Climb Area (ICA). An area beginning at the departure
calculations are made. Or, according to ICAO Annex 15, the end of runway (DER) to provide unrestricted climb to at
numerical or geometrical quantity or set of such quantities least 400 feet above DER elevation.
(mathematical model) that serves as a reference for
computing other quantities in a specific geographic region, Instrument Approach Waypoint. Fixes used in defining
such as the latitude and longitude of a point. RNAV IAPs, including the feeder waypoint (FWP), the initial
approach waypoint (IAWP), the intermediate waypoint
Glidepath Angle (GPA). The angular displacement of the (IWP), the final approach waypoint (FAWP), the RWY WP,
vertical guidance path from a horizontal plane that passes and the APT WP, when required.
through the reference datum point (RDP). This angle is
published on approach charts (e.g., 3.00, 3.20, etc.). GPA Instrument Landing System (ILS). A precision instrument
is sometimes referred to as vertical path angle (VPA). approach system that normally consists of the following
electronic components and visual aids: localizer, glide
Global Navigation Satellite System (GNSS). An umbrella slope, outer marker, middle marker, and approach lights.
term adopted by the International Civil Aviation Organization
(ICAO) to encompass any independent satellite navigation Instrument Procedure with Vertical Guidance (IPV). Satellite
system used by a pilot to perform onboard position or flight management dystem (FMS) lateral navigation
determinations from the satellite data. (LNAV) with computed positive vertical guidance based
on barometric or satellite elevation. This term has been
Gross Navigation Error (GNE). In the North Atlantic area of renamed APV.
operations, a gross navigation error is a lateral separation
of more than 25 NM from the centerline of an aircrafts International Civil Aviation Organization (ICAO).
cleared route, which generates an Oceanic Navigation Error ICAO is a specialized agency of the United Nations whose
Report. This report is also generated by a vertical separation objective is to develop standard principles and techniques
if you are more than 300 feet off your assigned flight level. of international air navigation and to promote development
of civil aviation.
Ground Communication Outlet (GCO). An unstaffed,
remotely controlled ground/ground communications Intersection. Typically, the point at which two VOR radial
facility. Pilots at uncontrolled airports may contact ATC and position lines cross on a route, usually intersecting at a good
AFSS via very high frequency (VHF) radio to a telephone angle for positive indication of position, resulting in a VOR/
connection. This lets pilots obtain an instrument clearance VOR fix.
or close a VFR/IFR flight plan.
Landing Distance Available (LDA). ICAO defines LDA as the
Head-Up Display (HUD). See head-up guidance system length of runway, that is declared available and suitable for
(HGS). the ground run of an aeroplane landing.

Head-up Guidance System (HGS). A system that projects Lateral Navigation (LNAV). Azimuth navigation without
critical flight data on a display positioned between the pilot positive vertical guidance. This type of navigation is
and the windscreen. In addition to showing primary flight associated with nonprecision approach procedures or en
information, the HUD computes an extremely accurate route.
instrument approach and landing guidance solution, and
displays the result as a guidance cue for head-up viewing
by the pilot.

Height Above Touchdown (HAT). The height of the DA


above touchdown zone elevation (TDZE).

Highway in the Sky (HITS). A graphically intuitive pilot

G-5
Local Area Augmentation System (LAAS). LAAS further Management System (SAMS). The electronic interface
increases the accuracy of GPS and improves signal integrity also provides SUA schedules and historical activation and
warnings. utilization data.

Localizer Performance with Vertical Guidance (LPV). LPV is Minimum Crossing Altitude (MCA). An MCA is the lowest
one of the four lines of approach minimums found on an altitude at certain fixes at which the aircraft must cross
RNAV (GPS) approach chart. Lateral guidance accuracy is when proceeding in the direction of a higher minimum en
equivalent to a localizer. The HAT is published as a DA since route IFR altitude. MCAs are established in all cases where
it uses an electronic glide path that is not dependent on obstacles intervene to prevent pilots from maintaining
any ground equipment or barometric aiding and may be obstacle clearance during a normal climb to a higher MEA
as low as 200 feet and 12 SM visibility depending on the after passing a point beyond which the higher MEA applies.
airport terrain and infrastructure. WAAS avionics approved
for LPV is required. Baro-VNAV is not authorized to fly the Minimum Descent Altitude (MDA). The lowest altitude,
LPV line of minimums on a RNAV (GPS) procedure since it expressed in feet above mean sea level, to which descent
uses an internally generated descent path that is subject to is authorized on final approach or during circle-to-land
cold temperature effects and incorrect altimeter settings. maneuvering in execution of a standard instrument
approach procedure where no electronic glide slope is
Loss of Separation. An occurrence or operation that results provided.
in less than prescribed separation between aircraft, or
between an aircraft and a vehicle, pedestrian, or object. Minimum En Route Altitude (MEA). The MEA is the lowest
published altitude between radio fixes that assures
LPV. See Localizer Performance with Vertical Guidance. acceptable navigational signal coverage and meets
obstacle clearance requirements between those fixes. The
Magnetic Variation. The difference in degrees between MEA prescribed for a Federal Airway or segment, RNAV low
the measured values of true north and magnetic north at or high route, or other direct route applies to the entire
that location. width of the airway, segment, or route between the radio
fixes defining the airway, segment, or route.
Maximum Authorized Altitude (MAA). An MAA is a
published altitude representing the maximum usable Minimum IFR Altitude (MIA). Minimum altitudes for IFR
altitude or flight level for an airspace structure or route operations are prescribed in 14 CFR Part 91. These MIAs are
segment. It is the highest altitude on a Federal airway, jet published on IFR charts and prescribed in 14 CFR Part 95
route, RNAV low or high route, or other direct route for for airways and routes, and in 14 CFR Part 97 for standard
which an MEA is designated at which adequate reception instrument approach procedures.
of navigation signals is assured.
Minimum Navigation Performance Specifications (MNPS).
Metering Fix. A fix along an established route over which A set of standards that require aircraft to have a minimum
aircraft are metered prior to entering terminal airspace. navigation performance capability in order to operate in
Normally, this fix should be established at a distance from MNPS designated airspace. In addition, aircraft must be
the airport which facilitates a profile descent 10,000 feet certified by their State of Registry for MNPS operation.
above airport elevation (AAE) or above. Under certain conditions, non-MNPS aircraft can operate
in MNPS airspace, however, standard oceanic separation
Mid-RVR. The RVR readout values obtained from sensors minima is provided between the non-MNPS aircraft and
located midfield of the runway. other traffic.

Mileage Break. A point on a route where the leg segment Minimum Obstruction Clearance Altitude (MOCA). The
mileage ends, and a new leg segment mileage begins, often MOCA is the lowest published altitude in effect between
at a route turning point. radio fixes on VOR airways, off-airway routes, or route
segments that meets obstacle clearance requirements
Military Airspace Management System (MAMS). A for the entire route segment. This altitude also assures
Department of Defense system to collect and disseminate acceptable navigational signal coverage only within 22
information on the current status of special use airspace. NM of a VOR.
This information is provided to the Special Use Airspace
Minimum Reception Altitude (MRA). An MRA is determined
by FAA flight inspection traversing an entire route of flight

G-6
to establish the minimum altitude the navigation signal can equipment can determine bearing to or from the radio
be received for the route and for off-course NAVAID facilities beacon and home on or track to or from the station. When
that determine a fix. When the MRA at the fix is higher than the radio beacon is installed in conjunction with the ILS
the MEA, an MRA is established for the fix, and is the lowest marker, it is normally called a compass locator.
altitude at which an intersection can be determined.
Non-RNAV DP. A DP whose ground track is based on
Minimum Safe Altitude (MSA). MSAs are published for ground-based NAVAIDS and/or dead reckoning navigation.
emergency use on IAP charts. For conventional navigation
systems, the MSA is normally based on the primary Obstacle Clearance Surface (OCS). An inclined or level
omnidirectional facility on which the IAP is predicated. surface associated with a defined area for obstruction
For RNAV approaches, the MSA is based on the runway evaluation.
waypoint (RWY WP) for straight-in approaches, or the
airport waypoint (APT WP) for circling approaches. For Obstacle Departure Procedure (ODP). A procedure that
GPS approaches, the MSA center is the Missed Approach provides obstacle clearance. ODPs do not include ATC
Waypoint (MAWP). related climb requirements. In fact, the primary emphasis
of ODP design is to use the least erroneous route of flight to
Minimum Vectoring Altitude (MVA). Minimum vectoring the en route structure while attempting to accommodate
altitude charts are developed for areas where there are typical departure routes.
numerous minimum vectoring altitudes due to variable
terrain features or man-made obstacles. MVAs are Obstacle Identification Surface (OIS). The design of a
established for use by ATC when radar ATC is exercised. departure procedure is based on TERPS, a living document
that is updated frequently. Departure design criteria
Missed Approach Holding Waypoint (MAHWP). An assumes an initial climb of 200 feet per NM after crossing
approach waypoint sequenced during the holding portion the departure end of the runway (DER) at a height of at
of the missed approach procedure that is usually a fly-over least 35 feet above the ground. Assuming a 200 feet per
waypoint, rather than a fly-by waypoint. NM climb, the departure is structured to provide at least
48 feet per NM of clearance above objects that do not
Missed Approach Waypoint (MAWP). An approach waypoint penetrate the obstacle slope. The slope, known as the
sequenced during the missed approach procedure that is obstacle identification slope (OIS), is based on a 40 to 1
usually a fly-over waypoint, rather than a fly-by waypoint. ratio, which is the equivalent of a 152-foot per NM slope.

National Airspace System (NAS). Consists of a complex Off-Airway Routes. The FAA prescribes altitudes governing
collection of facilities, systems, equipment, procedures, and the operation of aircraft under IFR for fairway routes in a
airports operated by thousands of people to provide a safe similar manner to those on federal airways, jet routes, area
and efficient flying environment. navigation low or high altitude routes, and other direct
routes for which an MEA is designated.
Navigational Gap. A navigational course guidance gap,
referred to as an MEA gap, describes a distance along an Off-Route Obstruction Clearance Altitude (OROCA). An off-
airway or route segment where a gap in navigational signal route altitude that provides obstruction clearance with a
coverage exists. The navigational gap may not exceed a 1,000 foot buffer in nonmountainous terrain areas and a
specific distance that varies directly with altitude. 2,000 foot buffer in designated mountainous areas within
the U.S. This altitude may not provide signal coverage from
Next Generation Air Transportation System (NextGen). groundbased navigational aids, air traffic control radar, or
Ongoing, wide-ranging transformation of the National communications coverage.
Airspace System (NAS). NextGen represents an evolution
from a ground-based system of air traffic control to a satellite- Operations Specifications (OpSpecs). A published
based system of air traffic management. document providing the conditions under which an air carrier
and operator for compensation or hire must operate in order
Non-Directional Radio Beacon (NDB). An L/MF or UHF to retain approval from the FAA.
radio beacon transmitting nondirectional signals whereby
the pilot of an aircraft equipped with direction finding Pilot Briefing Information. The current format for charted

G-7
IAPs issued by AJV-3. The information is presented in a qualification airspace; the operator and the aircraft used
logical order facilitating pilot briefing of the procedures. by the operator must be approved by the Administrator.
Charts include formatted information required for quick Air traffic control notifies operators of RVSM by providing
pilot or flight crew reference located at the top of the chart. route planing information.

Point-in-Space (PinS) Approach. An approach normally Reference Landing Speed (VREF). The speed of the airplane,
developed to heliports that do not meet the IFR heliport in a specified landing configuration, at the point where it
design standards but meet the standards for a VFR descends through the 50-foot height in the determination
heliport. A helicopter PinS approach can be developed of the landing distance.
using conventional NAVAIDs or RNAV systems. These
procedures have either a VFR or visual segment between the Remote Communications Outlet (RCO). An unmanned
MAP and the landing area. The procedure specifies a course communications facility remotely controlled by air traffic
and distance from the MAP to the heliport(s) and includes a personnel. RCOs serve FSSs and may be UHF or VHF. RCOs
note to proceed VFR or visually from the MAP to the heliport, extend the communication range of the air traffic facility.
or conduct the missed approach. RCOs were established to provide ground-to-ground
communications between air traffic control specialists
Positive Course Guidance (PCG). A continuous display of and pilots located at a satellite airport for delivering en
navigational data that enables an aircraft to be flown along route clearances, issuing departure authorizations, and
a specific course line (e.g., radar vector, RNAV, ground- acknowledging IFR cancellations or departure/landing
based NAVAID). times.

Precision Runway Monitor (PRM). Provides air traffic Reporting Point. A geographical location in relation
controllers with high precision secondary surveillance to which the position of an aircraft is reported. (See
data for aircraft on final approach to parallel runways that Compulsory Reporting Points).
have extended centerlines separated by less than 4,300
feet. High resolution color monitoring displays (FMA) are Required Navigation Performance (RNP). RNP is a statement
required to present surveillance track data to controllers of the navigation performance necessary for operation
along with detailed maps depicting approaches and a no within a defined airspace. On-board monitoring and
transgression zone. alerting is required.

Preferential Departure Route (PDR). A specific departure RNAV DP. A Departure Procedure developed for RNAV-
route from an airport or terminal area to an en route point equipped aircraft whose ground track is based on satellite
where there is no further need for flow control. It may be or DME/DME navigation systems.
included in an instrument Departure Procedure (DP) or a
Preferred IFR Route. Roll-Out RVR. The RVR readout values obtained from
sensors located nearest the rollout end of the runway.
Preferred IFR Routes. A system of preferred IFR routes
guides you in planning your route of flight to minimize Runway Heading. The magnetic direction that corresponds
route changes during the operational phase of flight, and with the runway centerline extended, not the painted
to aid in the efficient orderly management of air traffic runway numbers on the runway. Pilots cleared to fly or
using federal airways. maintain runway heading are expected to fly or maintain
the published heading that corresponds with the extended
Principal Operations Inspector (POI). Scheduled air centerline of the departure runway (until otherwise
carriers and operators for compensation or hire are assigned instructed by ATC), and are not to apply drift correction
a principal operations inspector (POI) who works directly (e.g., RWY 4, actual magnetic heading of the runway
with the company and coordinates FAA operating approval. centerline 044.22, fly 044).

Record. See Database Record. Runway Hotspots. Locations on a particular airport that
historically have hazardous intersections. Hot spots alert
Reduced Vertical Separation Minimums (RVSM). RVSM pilots to the fact that there may be a lack of visibility at
airspace is where air traffic control separates aircraft by certain points or the tower may be unable to see that
a minimum of 1,000 feet vertically between flight level particular intersection. Whatever the reason, pilots need
(FL) 290 and FL 410 inclusive. RVSM airspace is special

G-8
to be aware that these hazardous intersections exist and standard service volume (SSV). The SSV defines the
they should be increasingly vigilant when approaching reception limits of unrestricted NAVAIDS that are usable for
and taxiing through these intersections. Pilots are typically random/unpublished route navigation. Standard service
notified of these areas by a Letter to Airmen or by accessing volume limitations do not apply to published IFR routes or
the FAA Office of Runway Safety. procedures. See the AIM (Chapter 1) for the SSV for specific
NAVAID types.
Runway Incursion. An occurrence at an airport involving
an aircraft, vehicle, person, or object on the ground that Standard Terminal Arrival (STAR). Provides a common
creates a collision hazard or results in a loss of separation method for departing the en route structure and navigating
with an aircraft that is taking off, intending to take off, to your destination. A STAR is a preplanned instrument
landing, or intending to land. flight rule ATC arrival procedure published for pilot use
in graphic and textual form to simplify clearance delivery
Runway Safety Program (RSP). Designed to create and procedures. STARs provide you with a transition from the
execute a plan of action that reduces the number of runway en route structure to an outer fix or an instrument approach
incursions at the nations airports. fix or arrival waypoint in the terminal area, and they usually
terminate with an instrument or visual approach procedure.
Runway Visual Range (RVR). An estimate of the maximum
distance at which the runway, or the specified lights or Standardized Taxi Routes. Coded taxi routes that follow
markers delineating it, can be seen from a position above typical taxiway traffic patterns to move aircraft between
a specific point on the runway centerline. RVR is normally gates and runways. ATC issues clearances using these
determined by visibility sensors or transmissometers coded routes to reduce radio communication and eliminate
located alongside and higher than the centerline of the taxi instruction misinterpretation.
runway. RVR is reported in hundreds of feet.
STAR Transition. A published segment used to connect
Runway Visibility Value (RVV). The visibility determined one or more en route airways, jet routes, or RNAV routes
for a particular runway by a transmissometer. A meter to the basic STAR procedure. It is one of several routes that
provides a continuous indication of the visibility (reported bring traffic from different directions into one STAR. STARs
in miles or fractions of miles) for the runway. RVV is used are published for airports with procedures authorized by
in lieu of prevailing visibility in determining minimums for the FAA, and these STARs are included at the front of each
a particular runway. Terminal Procedures Publication regional booklet.

Significant Point. [ICAO Annex 11] A specified geographical Start End of Runway (SER). The beginning of the takeoff
location used in defining an ATS route or the flightpath runway available.
of an aircraft and for other navigation and ATS purposes.
Station Declination. The angular difference between true
Special Instrument Approach Procedure. A procedure north and the zero radial of a VOR at the time the VOR was
approved by the FAA for individual operators, but not last site-checked.
published in FAR 97 for public use.
Surface Incident. An event during which authorized or
Special Use Airspace Management System (SAMS). A unauthorized/unapproved movement occurs in the
joint FAA and military program designed to improve civilian movement area or an occurrence in the movement area
access to special use airspace by providing information on associated with the operation of an aircraft that affects or
whether the airspace is active or scheduled to be active. The could affect the safety of flight.
information is available to authorized users via an Internet
website. Surface Movement Guidance Control System (SMGCS).
Facilitates the safe movement of aircraft and vehicles
Standard Instrument Departure (SID). An ATC requested at airports where scheduled air carriers are conducting
and developed departure route designed to increase capacity authorized operations. The SMGCS low visibility taxi plan
of terminal airspace, effectively control the flow of traffic includes the improvement of taxiway and runway signs,
with minimal communication, and reduce environmental markings, and lighting, as well as the creation of SMGCS
impact through noise abatement procedures. low visibility taxi route charts.

Standard Service Volume. Most air navigation radio aids Synthetic Vision System (SVS). A visual display of terrain,
that provide positive course guidance have a designated

G-9
obstructions, runways, and other surface features that creates Touchdown and Lift-Off Area (TLOF). The TLOF is a load
a virtual view of what the pilot would see out the window. bearing, usually paved, area at a heliport where the
This tool could be used to supplement normal vision in helicopter is permitted to land. The TLOF can be located
low visibility conditions, as well as to increase situational at ground or rooftop level, or on an elevated structure. The
awareness in IMC. TLOF is normally centered in the FATO.

System Wide Information Management (SWIM). Touchdown RVR. The RVR visibility readout values
An advanced technology program designed to facilitate obtained from sensors serving the runway touchdown zone.
greater sharing of Air Traffic Management (ATM) system
information, such as airport operational status, weather Touchdown Zone Elevation (TDZE). The highest elevation
information, flight data, status of special use airspace, in the first 3,000 feet of the landing surface.
and National Airspace System (NAS) restrictions. SWIM
supports current and future NAS programs by providing Tower En Route Control (TEC). The control of IFR en route
flexible and secure information management architecture for traffic within delegated airspace between two or more
sharing NAS information. adjacent approach control facilities. This service is designed
to expedite air traffic and reduces air traffic control and
Takeoff Distance Available (TODA). ICAO defines TODA as pilot communication requirements.
the length of the takeoff runway available plus the length
of the clearway, if provided. TRACAB. A new type of air traffic facility that consists of
a radar approach control facility located in the tower cab of
Takeoff Runway Available (TORA). ICAO defines TORA as the primary airport, as opposed to a separate room.
the length of runway declared available and suitable for
the ground run of an aeroplane takeoff. Traffic Information Service-Broadcast (TIS-B). An air
traffic surveillance system that combines all available traffic
Tangent Point (TP). The point on the VOR/DME RNAV route information on a single display.
centerline from which a line perpendicular to the route
centerline would pass through the reference facility. Traffic Management Advisor (TMA). A software suite that
helps air traffic controllers to sequence arriving air traffic.
Terminal Arrival Area (TAA). TAAs are the method by which
aircraft are transitioned from the RNAV en route structure Transition Altitude (QNH). The altitude in the vicinity of an
to the terminal area with minimal ATC interaction. The TAA airport at or below which the vertical position of an aircraft
consists of a designated volume of airspace designed to is controlled by reference to altitudes (MSL).
allow aircraft to enter a protected area, offering guaranteed
obstacle clearance where the initial approach course is Transition Height (QFE). Transition height is the height in
intercepted based on the location of the aircraft relative the vicinity of an airport at or below which the vertical
to the airport. position of an aircraft is expressed in height above the
airport reference datum.
Threshold. The beginning of the part of the runway usable
for landing. Transition Layer. Transition layer is the airspace between
the transition altitude and the transition level. Aircraft
Top Of Climb (TOC). An identifiable waypoint representing descending through the transition layer will set altimeters
the point at which cruise altitude is first reached. TOC is to local station pressure, while departing aircraft climbing
calculated based on your current aircraft altitude, climb through the transition layer will be using standard altimeter
speed, and cruise altitude. There can only be one TOC setting (QNE) of 29.92 inches of Mercury, 1013.2 millibars,
waypoint at a time. or 1013.2 hectopascals.

Top Of Descent ( TOD). Generally utilized in flight Transition Level (QNE). The lowest flight level available for
management systems, top of descent is an identifiable use above the transition altitude.
waypoint representing the point at which descent is first
initiated from cruise altitude. TOD is generally calculated Turn Anticipation. The capability of RNAV systems to
using the destination elevation (if available) and the determine the point along a course, prior to a turn WP,
descent speed schedule. where a turn should be initiated to provide a smooth path
to intercept the succeeding course and to enunciate the
information to the pilot.

G-10
Turn WP (Turning Point). A WP that identifies a change from fix along the route. By knowing an intermediate altitude in
one course to another. advance when flying a high performance aircraft, you can
plan the power or thrust settings and aircraft configurations
Universal Communications (UNICOM). An air-ground that result in the most efficient descent, in terms of time,
communication facility operated by a private agency to fuel requirements, and engine wear.
provide advisory service at uncontrolled aerodromes and
airports. Visual Approach. A visual approach is an ATC authorization
for an aircraft on an IFR flight plan to proceed visually to
User-Defined Waypoint. User-defined waypoints typically the airport of intended landing; it is not an IAP. Also, there
are created by pilots for use in their own random RNAV is no missed approach segment. When it is operationally
direct navigation. They are newly established, unpublished beneficial, ATC may authorize pilots to conduct a visual
airspace fixes that are designated geographic locations/ approach to the airport in lieu of the published IAP. A visual
positions that help provide positive course guidance for approach can be initiated by a pilot or the controller.
navigation and a means of checking progress on a flight.
They may or may not be actually plotted by the pilot on Visual Climb Over the Airport (VCOA). An option to allow
en route charts, but would normally be communicated to an aircraft to climb over the airport with visual reference
ATC in terms of bearing and distance or latitude/longitude. to obstacles to attain a suitable altitude from which to
An example of user-defined waypoints typically includes proceed with an IFR departure.
those derived from database-driven area navigation (RNAV)
systems whereby latitude/longitude coordinate-based Waypoints. Area navigation waypoints are specified
waypoints are generated by various means including geographical locations, or fixes, used to define an area
keyboard input, and even electronic map mode functions navigation route or the flightpath of an aircraft employing
used to establish waypoints with a cursor on the display. area navigation. Waypoints may be any of the following
Another example is an offset phantom waypoint, which types: predefined, published, floating, user-defined, fly-by,
is a point in space formed by a bearing and distance from or fly-over.
NAVAIDs, such as VORs, VORTACs, and TACANs, using a
variety of navigation systems. Waypoint (WP). A predetermined geographical position used
for route/instrument approach definition, progress reports,
User Request Evaluation Tool (URET). The URET helps published VFR routes, visual reporting points or points for
provide enhanced, automated flight data management. transitioning and/or circumnavigating controlled and/or
URET is an automated tool provided at each radar position special use airspace, that is defined relative to a VORTAC
in selected en route facilities. It uses flight and radar data station or in terms of latitude/longitude coordinates.
to determine present and future trajectories for all active
and proposed aircraft flights. A graphic plan display Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS). A method of
depicts aircraft, traffic, and notification of predicted navigation based on GPS. Ground correction stations transmit
conflicts. Graphic routes for current plans and trial plans position corrections that enhance system accuracy and add
are displayed upon controller request. URET can generate vertical navigation (VNAV) features.
a predicted conflict of two aircraft, or between aircraft
and airspace.

Vertical Navigation (VNAV). Traditionally, the only way


to get glidepath information during an approach was to
use a ground-based NAVAID, but modern area navigation
systems allow flight crews to display an internally
generated descent path that allows a constant rate descent
to minimums during approaches that would otherwise
include multiple level-offs.

Vertical Navigation Planning. Included within certain STARs


is information provided to help you reduce the amount of
low altitude flying time for high performance aircraft, like
jets and turboprops. An expected altitude is given for a key

G-11
G-12
Index

A Approaches................................................................................4-56
Access to special use airspace.............................................5-10 Approach planning.................................................................... 4-2
Advanced Surface Movement Guidance Control Approach to a PinS..................................................................7-14
System (A-SMGCS)..................................................................... 1-4 Approach to a specific VFR heliport..................................7-14
Airport signs, lighting, and markings............................. 1-4 Area navigation (RNAV) systems........................................... 6-1
Aeronautical Radio, Inc. (ARINC)........................................... 6-4 Global positioning system (GPS)...................................... 6-2
Aeronautical Radio, Inc. (ARINC) 424................................... 6-4 Multisensory flight management system (FMS)......... 6-2
Complex route records........................................................ 6-5 ARTCC Radio Frequency Outage........................................2-48
Fix records................................................................................. 6-4 ATC holding instructions.......................................................2-51
Miscellaneous records.......................................................... 6-5 ATC requirements during an inflight emergency...........A-4
Simple route records............................................................. 6-4 Emergency airport.................................................................A-5
Victor airway........................................................................ 6-5 Emergency Obstruction Video Map (EOVM)................A-6
Airborne navigation database standardization.............. 6-3 Escort..........................................................................................A-6
Aircraft approach categories.................................................. 4-8 Provide information..............................................................A-5
Aircraft performance considerations.................................. 4-7 Radar assistance.....................................................................A-5
Aircraft speed and altitude...................................................2-49 Responsibility..........................................................................A-6
Aircraft system malfunctions.................................................A-2 Automated Terminal Information Sevice (ATIS).............. 4-5
Airplane performance operating limitations................... 4-7 Automated weather observing programs........................ 4-5
Airport Facility Directory (A/FD)............................................ 1-2 Automated Surface Observing System (ASOS)/
Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS)................ 4-5
Airport/runway information.................................................4-33
Automated Weather Observing System (AWOS)........ 4-5
Airport sketches and diagrams............................................. 1-2
Automated weather systems...............................................1-11
Airport Surveillance Radar (ASR)........................................4-87
ASOS/Automated Weather Sensor System
Airports with an ATC tower...................................................4-15
(AWSS)......................................................................................1-11
Airports without a control tower........................................4-15
Automated Weather Observing System (AWOS)......1-11
Air Route Traffic Control Center (ARTCC)................ 2-3, 4-13
Automated Weather Sensor System (AWSS)..............1-11
High or Lack of Minimum Vectoring Altitudes
Automatic Terminal Information Service (ATIS).............1-12
(MVAs)......................................................................................4-14
Autopilot modes.......................................................................4-35
Lack of approach control terrain advisories...............4-15
Aviation Digital Data Services (ADDS)................................ 4-4
Airspeed.......................................................................................3-20
Airway and route system.......................................................2-13
Airway/route depiction..........................................................2-13
B
IFR en route high altitude chart......................................2-17 Benefits of NextGen.................................................................. 5-6
IFR en route low altitude chart........................................2-14 Broadcast Weather..................................................................... 4-5
Victor airway navigation procedures............................2-18
Airways........................................................................................... 2-2 C
Alternate minimums for commercial operators............1-14 CAT II and III approaches........................................................4-71
Altitude........................................................................................3-16 Ceilings.........................................................................................1-11
Altitudes......................................................................................4-19 Center Weather Advisories (CWA)........................................ 4-6
Approach chart naming conventions................................. 4-9 Changeover points..................................................................2-20
Approach clearance......................................................3-22, 4-54 Charted Visual Flight Procedures (CVFP).........................4-59
Approach control.....................................................................4-13

I-1
Charting/database inconsistencies...................................6-15 Diverse vector area..................................................................1-38
Issues related to magnetic variation.............................6-16 Diversion procedures..............................................................2-52
Issues related to revision cycle........................................6-17 DME arcs......................................................................................4-50
Naming conventions..........................................................6-15 DP responsibilities...................................................................1-42
Circling only procedures........................................................4-11
Civilians using special use airspace...................................5-11 E
Climbing and descending en route...................................2-48 Electronic flight bag (EFB)....................................................... 5-9
Closed indefinitely airports..................................................6-15 Emergency procedures............................................................A-1
Communication failure..........................................................2-47 Enhanced Flight Vision Systems (EFVS)............................4-20
Communications......................................................................4-11 En route holding procedures...............................................2-51
Computer navigation performance..................................2-33 En route navigation................................................................... 2-2
Contact approaches................................................................4-59 En route obstacle clearance areas......................................2-18
Controlled Flight Into Terrain (CFIT).................................... 3-9 Primary and secondary en route obstacle
Converging ILS approaches..................................................4-80 clearance areas.....................................................................2-19
Copter GPS approaches to an airport or heliport.........7-10 En route reporting procedures............................................2-46
Copter only approaches to an airport or heliport........7-10 En route safety considerations............................................2-52
Course reversal..........................................................................4-50 Equipment requirements......................................................4-17
Courses.........................................................................................4-17 Example approach briefing..................................................4-46
Area navigation courses....................................................4-18
Traditional courses..............................................................4-17 F
Cruise clearance........................................................................2-43
Feeder routes.............................................................................4-49
Cyclic redundancy check (CRC)...........................................6-13
Final approach fix (FAF) altitude.........................................4-19
Final approach segment........................................................4-53
D
Flight and navigation equipment........................................ 7-2
Decision altitude (DA).............................................................4-20 Flight Information ServiceBroadcast (FIS-B)................ 4-4
Decision height (DH)...............................................................4-20 Flight level (FL)..........................................................................2-43
Departure procedures (DP)...................................................1-14 Flight Management System (FMS).....................................4-33
Obstacle departure procedures (ODPs).......................1-23 Flights in a radar environment............................................2-46
Area Navigation (RNAV) departures.........................1-30 Fuel state awareness...............................................................2-52
ODP flight planning considerations.........................1-23
Pilot responsibility for use of RNAV G
departures..........................................................................1-36
Generator failure.........................................................................A-2
SID altitudes.......................................................................1-36
Global Navigation Satellite System (GNSS)....................... 2-2
SID flight planning considerations............................1-26
GPS overlay of nonprecision approach............................4-62
Standard instrument departures (SIDs)...................1-23
GPS stand-alone/RNAV (GPS) approach...........................4-62
Transition routes..............................................................1-26
Ground-Based Augmentation System (GBAS)...............4-26
Departures from airports without an operating
Ground communication outlet...........................................1-43
control tower.............................................................................1-43
Departures from tower-controlled airports....................1-43
H
Descending from the en route altitude............................. 3-8
Descent planning....................................................................... 3-3 Hazardous Inflight Weather Advisory Service
Descent planning for high performance aircraft............ 3-6 (HIWAS).......................................................................................... 4-4
Descent rates and glidepaths for nonprecision Head-Up Displays (HUD).......................................................... 5-7
approaches.................................................................................4-37 Helicopter approaches to VFR heliports..........................7-14
Maximum acceptable descent rates.............................4-37 Helicopter flight manual (HFM)............................................. 7-3
Descents......................................................................................4-36 Helicopter flight manual limitations................................... 7-3
Design criteria...........................................................................1-16 Helicopter IFR alternates......................................................... 7-8
Digital Automatic Terminal Information Service Part 91 operators.................................................................... 7-8
(D-ATIS)........................................................................................1-12 Part 135 operators................................................................. 7-9
Direct route flights...................................................................2-21 Helicopter IFR Takeoff Minimums........................................ 7-8
Direct User Access Terminal System (DUATS)................... 4-4 Helicopter instrument approaches...................................... 7-9

I-2
Standard instrument approach procedures to an M
airport........................................................................................ 7-9 Maintaining aircraft control....................................................A-4
Helicopter Instrument Flight Rule (IFR) Assistance.................................................................................A-4
certification.................................................................................. 7-2 Maximum authorized altitude (MAA)...............................2-36
Helicopters flying standard instrument approach Maximum holding speed......................................................2-52
procedures (SIAP)....................................................................... 7-9
Minimum crossing altitude (MCA).....................................2-40
Helicopter VFR minimums...................................................... 7-8
Minimum descent altitude (MDA)......................................4-20
High altitude area navigation routing................................ 2-7
Minimum en route altitude (MEA).....................................2-35
High performance holding...................................................2-52
Minimum Equipment List (MEL)........................................... 7-5
Holding patterns......................................................................3-21
Minimum IFR altitude (MIA).................................................2-40
Minimum obstruction clearance altitude (MOCA).......2-36
I Minimum reception altitude (MRA)...................................2-35
IFR alternate requirements...................................................1-12 Minimum safe altitudes (MSAs)..........................................4-19
IFR cruising altitude or flight level.....................................2-42 Minimum turning altitude (MTA)........................................2-38
IFR en route altitudes..............................................................2-35 Minimum vectoring altitudes (MVA).................................2-41
IFR heliports...............................................................................7-17 Missed approach......................................................................4-39
ILS approaches..........................................................................4-68 Missed approach segment....................................................4-54
ILS approach categories....................................................4-69 Monitoring of navigation facilities.....................................2-29
ILS approaches to parallel runways...............................4-64
Parallel (dependent) ILS approaches............................4-71 N
Simultaneous close parallel ILS precision
National Aeronautical Navigation Products
runway monitor (PRM) approaches...............................4-75
(AeroNav Products)............................................................1-2, 2-6
Simultaneous parallel ILS approaches.........................4-71
NAVAID accuracy check.........................................................2-29
Inadvertent icing encounter..................................................A-2
Airborne VOR check............................................................2-31
Precipitation static.................................................................A-2
Dual VOR check.....................................................................2-31
Inadvertent IMC........................................................................7-16
NDB accuracy check............................................................2-31
Inadvertent Instrument Meteorological Condition
RNAV accuracy check..........................................................2-32
(IIMC)...............................................................................................A-4
VOR accuracy.........................................................................2-29
Inadvertent thunderstorm encounter................................A-1
VOR checkpoint signs.........................................................2-29
Initial approach segment......................................................4-53
VOT............................................................................................2-30
Instrument approach charts................................................... 4-9
Navigational gaps....................................................................2-29
Instrument approaches..........................................................4-20
Navigation and communication radios............................4-33
Instrument approach procedure (IAP) briefing.............4-33
Navigation in the arrival environment............................... 3-2
Instrument approach procedure segments...................4-49
NDB approach...........................................................................4-84
Instrument failure.......................................................................A-3
Next Generation Air Transportation System
Intermediate approach segment.......................................4-53
(NextGen)...................................................................................... 5-2
Interpreting the STAR..............................................................3-12
Automatic dependent surveillance-broadcast
(ADS-B)....................................................................................... 5-2
L NAS voice switch (NVS)........................................................ 5-3
Lateral navigation/vertical navigation Next generation data communications......................... 5-3
(LNAV/VNAV) equipment........................................................ 3-6 Next generation network enabled weather
LF/MF airways............................................................................2-18 (NNEW)...................................................................................... 5-3
Localizer approaches..............................................................4-87 System wide information management (SWIM)........ 5-2
Localizer back course..............................................................4-87 NextGen existing improvements.......................................... 5-3
Localizer DME............................................................................4-87 Noise abatement procedures..............................................1-42
Localizer-Type Directional Aid (LDA)................................4-87 Non-directional beacons (NDBs)........................................6-16
Locator outer markers (LOMs).............................................6-16 Nonradar environment..........................................................4-56
Loss of situational awareness (SA).......................................A-3 Non-radar position reports...................................................2-46
Low, close-in obstacles...........................................................1-18
Lowest usable flight level......................................................2-43

I-3
O Runway hotspots........................................................................ 1-6
Off-airway routes......................................................................2-26 Runway incursions..................................................................... 1-5
Off-route obstruction clearance altitude....................2-27
One-engine-inoperative (OEI) takeoff obstacle S
clearance requirements.........................................................1-19 Safe separation standards....................................................... 2-4
Operational limitations of airborne navigation Inflight requirements and instructions.......................... 2-6
databases....................................................................................6-14 Sectors....................................................................................... 2-5
Operations in other countries..............................................2-44 See and avoid techniques.....................................................1-44
Operations specifications (OpsSpecs)................................ 1-8 Simplified Directional Facility (SDF)..................................4-88
Simultaneous offset instrument approaches
P (SOIAs)..........................................................................................4-79
Path and terminator legs......................................................... 6-5 Stabilization and Automatic Flight Control
Path and terminator limitations....................................... 6-9 System (AFCS).............................................................................. 7-2
Pilot in command (PIC).............................................................A-1 Aerodynamic surfaces.......................................................... 7-2
Pilot proficiency.......................................................................... 7-5 Attitude Retention Systems (ATT).................................... 7-3
Pitot/static system failure........................................................A-3 Autopilot systems (APs)....................................................... 7-3
Position report items...............................................................2-46 Flight directors (FDs)............................................................. 7-3
Additional reports................................................................2-47 Stability Augmentation Systems (SAS)........................... 7-2
Precision Approach Radar (PAR).........................................4-84 Trim systems............................................................................ 7-2
Preferred IFR routes................................................................... 2-7 Stabilized approach.................................................................4-36
Preparing for the arrival.........................................................3-16 Standardized taxi routes.......................................................... 1-6
Present position direct...........................................................3-24 Taxi and movement operations change........................ 1-6
Primary NAVAID........................................................................4-17 Standard Terminal Arrival Routes (STARs).......................3-10
Procedural notes.......................................................................1-42 STAR procedures.......................................................................3-16
Published RNAV routes...........................................................2-23 STAR transitions........................................................................3-12
Composition of designators.............................................2-23 Storage limitations...................................................................6-15
Use of designators in communications.......................2-24 Straight-in procedures.............................................................. 4-9
Substitute airway or route structures................................. 2-9
R Substitute airway en route flight procedures.............. 2-9
Surface Movement Guidance Control System
Radar approaches....................................................................4-84
(SMGCS)......................................................................................... 1-3
Radar departures......................................................................1-37
Clearance bar lights.............................................................. 1-3
Radar vectors to final approach course............................3-24
Geographic position markings......................................... 1-3
Random RNAV routes.............................................................2-25
Runway guard lights............................................................. 1-3
Reduced Vertical Separation Minimums (RSVM)..........2-43
Stop bars lights....................................................................... 1-3
Required navigation performance (RNP).........................2-34
Taxiway centerline lead-on light...................................... 1-3
RNP levels...............................................................................2-35
Surface movement safety....................................................... 1-2
Application of standard RNP levels...........................2-35
Synthetic and enhanced vision systems............................ 5-8
Standard RNP levels........................................................2-35
Developing combined technology................................. 5-9
Required navigation performance (RNP).........................4-26
Enhanced Flight Vision System (EFVS)........................... 5-8
Reviewing the approach........................................................3-16
Synthetic Vision System (SVS)............................................ 5-7
RNAV approach authorization.............................................4-30
Baro-VNAV..............................................................................4-30
T
Hot and cold temperature limitations.....................4-31
RNAV approaches.....................................................................4-59 Takeoff minimums..................................................................... 1-8
RNAV approach types.............................................................4-62 Takeoff minimums for commercial operators.................. 1-8
RNAV (GPS) approach using WAAS....................................4-65 Telephone Information Briefing Service (TIBS)................ 4-4
RNAV minimum en route altitude......................................2-35 Terminal arrival area (TAA)....................................................4-59
RNAV STAR transitions............................................................3-12 Terminal instrument procedures (TERPS)........................1-16
Role of the avionics manufacturer.....................................6-13 Terminal Routes........................................................................4-50
Role of the database provider.............................................6-13 Tower en route control (TEC)...............................................2-10

I-4
Tower en route control route descriptions.................2-10
Transition to a visual approach...........................................4-39

U
Users role.....................................................................................6-14

V
Vectors to final approach course........................................4-54
Vertical navigation...................................................................4-23
Vertical navigation (VNAV) planning.................................. 3-4
VHF airways................................................................................2-18
Visibility........................................................................................1-10
Adequate visual reference................................................1-11
Prevailing visibility...............................................................1-10
Runway visibility value (RVV)...........................................1-10
Runway visual range (RVR)...............................................1-10
Mid-RVR...............................................................................1-11
Rollout RVR........................................................................1-11
Touchdown RVR...............................................................1-11
Tower visibility......................................................................1-10
Visual approaches....................................................................4-56
Visual climb over airport (VCOA)........................................1-42
Visual flight rules (VFR) departures....................................1-44
VOR approach............................................................................4-80

W
Waypoints...................................................................................2-32
Floating waypoints..............................................................2-32
User-defined waypoints....................................................2-32
Weather and the departure environment......................... 1-8
Weather considerations........................................................... 4-2
Weather regulatory requirements........................................ 4-6
Part 91 operators.................................................................... 4-6
Part 121 operators................................................................. 4-7
Part 135 operators................................................................. 4-7
Weather sources......................................................................... 4-2
Wide Area Augmentation System (WAAS)............. 3-6, 4-23
Advantages of WAAS enabled LPV
Approaches............................................................................4-23
Benefits of WAAS in the airport environment...........4-23

I-5
I-6

Das könnte Ihnen auch gefallen